WO2007137300A2 - Modified dendritic cells having enhanced survival and immunogenicity and related compositions and methods - Google Patents

Modified dendritic cells having enhanced survival and immunogenicity and related compositions and methods Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2007137300A2
WO2007137300A2 PCT/US2007/069586 US2007069586W WO2007137300A2 WO 2007137300 A2 WO2007137300 A2 WO 2007137300A2 US 2007069586 W US2007069586 W US 2007069586W WO 2007137300 A2 WO2007137300 A2 WO 2007137300A2
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
akt
protein
region
nucleic acid
cell
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US2007/069586
Other languages
French (fr)
Other versions
WO2007137300A3 (en
WO2007137300A8 (en
Inventor
Dongsu Park
David Spencer
Natalia Lapteva
Original Assignee
Bellicum Pharmaceuticals, Inc.
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Bellicum Pharmaceuticals, Inc. filed Critical Bellicum Pharmaceuticals, Inc.
Priority to US12/301,021 priority Critical patent/US20100196336A1/en
Publication of WO2007137300A2 publication Critical patent/WO2007137300A2/en
Publication of WO2007137300A3 publication Critical patent/WO2007137300A3/en
Publication of WO2007137300A8 publication Critical patent/WO2007137300A8/en
Priority to US13/622,501 priority patent/US8486693B2/en

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N9/00Enzymes; Proenzymes; Compositions thereof; Processes for preparing, activating, inhibiting, separating or purifying enzymes
    • C12N9/10Transferases (2.)
    • C12N9/12Transferases (2.) transferring phosphorus containing groups, e.g. kinases (2.7)
    • C12N9/1205Phosphotransferases with an alcohol group as acceptor (2.7.1), e.g. protein kinases
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/63Introduction of foreign genetic material using vectors; Vectors; Use of hosts therefor; Regulation of expression
    • C12N15/79Vectors or expression systems specially adapted for eukaryotic hosts
    • C12N15/85Vectors or expression systems specially adapted for eukaryotic hosts for animal cells
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/461Cellular immunotherapy characterised by the cell type used
    • A61K39/4615Dendritic cells
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/462Cellular immunotherapy characterized by the effect or the function of the cells
    • A61K39/4622Antigen presenting cells
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/463Cellular immunotherapy characterised by recombinant expression
    • A61K39/4637Other peptides or polypeptides
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/464Cellular immunotherapy characterised by the antigen targeted or presented
    • A61K39/4643Vertebrate antigens
    • A61K39/4644Cancer antigens
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/464Cellular immunotherapy characterised by the antigen targeted or presented
    • A61K39/4643Vertebrate antigens
    • A61K39/4644Cancer antigens
    • A61K39/464454Enzymes
    • A61K39/464456Tyrosinase or tyrosinase related proteinases [TRP-1 or TRP-2]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/464Cellular immunotherapy characterised by the antigen targeted or presented
    • A61K39/4643Vertebrate antigens
    • A61K39/4644Cancer antigens
    • A61K39/464454Enzymes
    • A61K39/464462Kinases, e.g. Raf or Src
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/464Cellular immunotherapy characterised by the antigen targeted or presented
    • A61K39/4643Vertebrate antigens
    • A61K39/4644Cancer antigens
    • A61K39/464484Cancer testis antigens, e.g. SSX, BAGE, GAGE or SAGE
    • A61K39/464486MAGE
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/464Cellular immunotherapy characterised by the antigen targeted or presented
    • A61K39/4643Vertebrate antigens
    • A61K39/4644Cancer antigens
    • A61K39/464493Prostate associated antigens e.g. Prostate stem cell antigen [PSCA]; Prostate carcinoma tumor antigen [PCTA]; Prostatic acid phosphatase [PAP]; Prostate-specific G-protein-coupled receptor [PSGR]
    • A61K39/464495Prostate specific membrane antigen [PSMA]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/464Cellular immunotherapy characterised by the antigen targeted or presented
    • A61K39/464838Viral antigens
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • A61P37/04Immunostimulants
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/63Introduction of foreign genetic material using vectors; Vectors; Use of hosts therefor; Regulation of expression
    • C12N15/79Vectors or expression systems specially adapted for eukaryotic hosts
    • C12N15/85Vectors or expression systems specially adapted for eukaryotic hosts for animal cells
    • C12N15/86Viral vectors
    • C12N15/861Adenoviral vectors
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K2039/51Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies comprising whole cells, viruses or DNA/RNA
    • A61K2039/515Animal cells
    • A61K2039/5154Antigen presenting cells [APCs], e.g. dendritic cells or macrophages
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K2039/51Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies comprising whole cells, viruses or DNA/RNA
    • A61K2039/515Animal cells
    • A61K2039/5156Animal cells expressing foreign proteins
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K2239/00Indexing codes associated with cellular immunotherapy of group A61K39/46
    • A61K2239/38Indexing codes associated with cellular immunotherapy of group A61K39/46 characterised by the dose, timing or administration schedule
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K2319/00Fusion polypeptide
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K2319/00Fusion polypeptide
    • C07K2319/01Fusion polypeptide containing a localisation/targetting motif
    • C07K2319/033Fusion polypeptide containing a localisation/targetting motif containing a motif for targeting to the internal surface of the plasma membrane, e.g. containing a myristoylation motif
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2710/00MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA dsDNA viruses
    • C12N2710/00011Details
    • C12N2710/10011Adenoviridae
    • C12N2710/10311Mastadenovirus, e.g. human or simian adenoviruses
    • C12N2710/10341Use of virus, viral particle or viral elements as a vector
    • C12N2710/10343Use of virus, viral particle or viral elements as a vector viral genome or elements thereof as genetic vector

Definitions

  • the invention pertains generally to immunotherapy, and more specifically to antigen-presenting cells.
  • Immunotherapy treatments generally involve inducing an immune response against a disease- associated antigen in a subject by sensitizing the subject's immune system to the antigen.
  • the immune response often is induced by a vaccine that bears the antigen.
  • the immune system Upon treatment with the vaccine, the immune system attacks cells bearing the antigen, which leads to a therapeutic effect.
  • the immunity induced by vaccines depends largely on the efficiency of the antigen presenting cells (APC) that process and present the antigen.
  • APC antigen presenting cells
  • DCs Dendritic cells
  • APCs are APCs that can be responsible for vaccine efficacy by capturing and processing antigen and stimulating T cell immunity. It is possible to generate ex vivo functional DCs from a subject's peripheral blood monocytes or CD34 haemopoietic stem cells.
  • dendritic cells generated from a patient's peripheral blood monocytes or CD34 haemopoietic stem cells can be loaded with a disease-associated antigen and reinfused into the patient with the aim of generating effective anti-disease immunity.
  • DCs Dendritic cells
  • APCs antigen-presenting cells
  • the modified DCs express an altered protein kinase, referred to herein as “protein kinase B” or "Akt.”
  • Akt protein kinase B
  • the altered Akt associates with cell membranes with greater frequency than unaltered Akt, and is referred to herein as “membrane-targeted Akt.”
  • a dendritic cell which comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt protein.
  • the dendritic cell often originates from a mammal, including, for example, a rodent, (e.g., rat, mouse, rabbit, hamster, guinea pig), dog, cat, ungulate, fish, avian, monkey, ape or human.
  • DCs often are isolated from a subject (e.g., a human) and then cultured ex vivo under conditions suitable for maintaining DCs for one or more days.
  • the membrane-targeted Akt protein comprises a mammalian Akt protein or a fragment thereof.
  • a fragment often includes the protein kinase catalytic domain of Akt, and sometimes does not include the N- terminal pleckstrin homology (PH) domain of native Akt.
  • Amino acid sequences of mammalian Akt proteins or fragments are known, and sometimes the amino acid sequence is a mouse or a human Akt protein, a fragment thereof, a substantially identical variant of the foregoing.
  • a human Akt protein may have the amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 2, 3, or 4, or a substantially identical variant thereof.
  • An Akt protein fragment may have a portion of the amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 2, 3, or 4 or a substantially identical variant thereof, and in some embodiments, the fragment has the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 6 (i.e., encoded by SEQ ID NO: 5).
  • the membrane-targeted Akt protein is in association with a membrane association region, the latter of which can increase the frequency with which the Akt protein is in association with a cell membrane or portion thereof.
  • the membrane -targeted Akt interacts with (e.g., binds with) affinity and selectivity to membrane rafts in cells.
  • the term "in association" as used herein with respect to an Akt region and a membrane association region refers to covalent or non-covalent association of the membrane association region to an Akt protein or fragment.
  • the N- or C- terminus of an Akt protein or fragment may be covalently linked to a membrane association region, and a membrane association region may be linked to a non-terminal portion of an Akt protein or fragment.
  • a protein having an Akt protein region and a membrane association region may be referred to as a "fusion protein” or "chimeric protein.”
  • an Akt chimeric protein does not include a heterologous multimerization region, such as a region that binds to a FK506 molecule or analog thereof, and in such embodiments, the chimeric protein can be constitutively active.
  • An Akt protein or fragment component may be non-covalently associated with a membrane association region component via a complementary member of a binding pair linked to each component.
  • the membrane association region and the Akt protein or fragment in the membrane -targeted Akt often are homologous (e.g., each are a human amino acid sequence), and sometimes are heterologous (e.g., one is a human amino acid sequence and the other is a mouse amino acid sequence).
  • a membrane association region often is an amino acid fragment of a native mammalian protein, or a substantially identical sequence thereof.
  • Membrane association regions include, for example, acylation regions, transmembrane proteins, and transmembrane protein fragments.
  • Acylation regions are capable of being linked to one or more acyl moieties.
  • a dual acylation region is capable of being linked to two acyl moieties.
  • the acylation region is from a protein kinase, such as Fyn, Lck or Src, for example, which can be myristoylated and may be linked to the N-terminus of the Akt protein or fragment.
  • the acylation region comprises a cys-ala-ala sequence, and sometimes the region is from a G-protein, which can be linked to the C-terminus of the Akt protein or fragment.
  • the nucleotide sequence that encodes the membrane -targeted Akt can be incorporated in the dendritic cell in a variety of manners.
  • one or more copies of the nucleotide sequence may be stably inserted into the dendritic cell genomic DNA by random insertion or by non-random insertion (e.g., knock-in), or the nucleotide sequence may be non-stab Iy inserted in the dendritic cell (e.g., in plasmid DNA).
  • each component may be expressed from a nucleotide sequence in functional association with a common promoter or from different promoters.
  • Modified dendritic cells comprising a nucleotide sequence that expresses a membrane -targeted Akt generally (a) survive longer on average than counterpart dendritic cells that do not include the nucleotide sequence, (b) present a greater amount of antigen on average than cells that do not include the nucleotide sequence, and (c) are more immunogenic on average than cells that do not include the nucleotide sequence.
  • Processes for assessing dendritic cell survival periods and antigen presentation and immunogenicity are well known to the person of ordinary skill in the art.
  • a modified dendritic cell described herein sometimes is provided in a composition comprising components suitable for administering the dendritic cell to a subject.
  • dendritic cells can be mixed with Toll-like receptor (TLR) ligands that can increase DC activation locally, such as monophosphoryl lipid A (TLR4 ligand), imiquimod (TLR7/8 ligand), unmethylated CpG oligonucleotides (TLR9 ligand), and others.
  • TLR4 ligand monophosphoryl lipid A
  • imiquimod TLR7/8 ligand
  • TLR9 ligand unmethylated CpG oligonucleotides
  • Additional activation ligands such as those found in monocyte-conditioned media "maturation cocktail" also can be included.
  • included is a non-human organism, sometimes a mammalian organism, comprising a modified dendritic cell described herein.
  • Also provided are methods for preparing a modified dendritic cell which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell with a nucleic acid having a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt protein, whereby the modified dendritic cell survives longer on average than dendritic cells that do not include the nucleotide sequence.
  • the resulting modified dendritic cell often presents a greater amount of antigen on average than cells that do not include the nucleotide sequence, and the resulting modified dendritic cell is more immunogenic on average than cells that do not include the nucleic acid.
  • the nucleic acid sometimes is isolated from a source (e.g., a cell or virus) before contacting the dendritic cell with the nucleic acid, and sometimes the nucleic acid is within a virus and is delivered to the dendritic cell by contacting the cell with the virus, whereby the virus inserts the nucleic acid into the cell.
  • the modified dendritic cell is contacted with an antigen or antigen precursor. Any antigen or precursor suitable for immunotherapy can be utilized, such as an antigen expressed more frequently in cancer cells than in non-cancer cells, for example.
  • the antigen may result from contacting the modified dendritic cell with prostate specific membrane antigen (PSMA) or a fragment thereof.
  • PSMA prostate specific membrane antigen
  • the modified dendritic cell is contacted with a PSMA fragment having the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 10 (e.g., encoded by the nucleotide sequence of SEQ ID NO: 9).
  • a modified dendritic cell with an antigen comprising: contacting a modified dendritic cell with an antigen or antigen precursor, where the modified dendritic cell expresses a membrane -targeted Akt protein, whereby the modified dendritic cell is loaded with the antigen.
  • the antigen can be delivered as a purified protein or purified fragment, or by a viral or non- viral sequence.
  • methods for manufacturing a virus having a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt protein which comprise: transfecting a producer cell with a virus having a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt; and isolating the virus produced by the cells.
  • Akt proteins are also provided.
  • a protein comprising: (a) a mammalian Akt portion lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and (b) a dual acylation portion, or (c) a membrane protein or membrane protein fragment.
  • Portion (a) may be covalently linked or non-covalently linked to portion (b) or portion (c).
  • portion (a) is non-covalently linked to portion (b) or portion (c) by components of a binding pair linked to each of portion (a) and portion (b) or (c).
  • the dual acylation portion is from a protein kinase, such as Fyn, Lck or Src, for example.
  • the dual acylation region comprises two acyl moieties, where one or both of the acyl moieties may be selected from the group consisting of myristoyl, geranyl, farnesyl and prenyl.
  • the acylation region may comprise a cys-ala-ala sequence, and may be from a G-protein.
  • the dual acylation portion is identical to or substantially identical to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 8.
  • the acylation portion, membrane protein or membrane protein fragment may be linked to the N-terminus or C-terminus of the Akt portion.
  • the mammalian Akt portion may be identical to or substantially identical to mouse Akt, or a fragment thereof, or may be identical to or substantially identical to human Akt, or a fragment thereof.
  • the mammalian Akt portion is identical to or substantially identical to the amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence of SEQ ID NO: 6, or a fragment thereof.
  • an antibody or antibody fragment that specifically binds to a membrane-targeted Akt protein.
  • a membrane -targeted Akt protein may include one or more multimerization regions (e.g., one, two, three, four or more multimerization regions), and one or more multimerization regions may be located at the N-terminus of the chimeric protein, within the protein (e.g., between an Akt region and a membrane association region), or at the C-terminus of the protein.
  • a multimeriation region often is heterologous to other regions of the membrane-targeted Akt protein (i.e., the nucleic acid encoding the multimerization region is not linked in vivo to a nucleic acid sequence encoding the Akt protein or the acylation region).
  • a multimerization region may be covalently linked or non-covalently linked to a membrane-targeted Akt protein.
  • An example of a multimerization region is an amino acid sequence that binds to a FK506 molecule or analog thereof.
  • a membrane-targeted Akt protein containing a multimerization region can be referred to as an "inducible membrane-targeted Akt protein.”
  • a membrane -targeted does not contain a multimerization region or a heterologous multimerization region.
  • a membrane -targeted Akt protein not containing a multimerization region or heterologous multimerization region can be referred to as a "constitutively active membrane-targeted Akt protein.”
  • nucleic acid which comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane- targeted Akt protein described herein.
  • the nucleic acid comprises a promoter operably linked to the nucleotide sequence.
  • the promoter sometimes is constitutively active, at times is inducible, and can be from a virus.
  • the nucleic acid in some embodiments comprises one or more nucleotide sequences from a virus, and in certain embodiments, the nucleic acid is derived from a virus. Any suitable virus capable of expressing a protein in cells, and optionally replicating in cells, can be utilized, such as adenovirus.
  • the cell which comprises a nucleic acid described herein.
  • the cell can be an antigen presenting cell, such as a dendritic cell for example, and the cell sometimes is a human cell.
  • the cell containing the nucleic acid often (a) survives longer on average than a counterpart cell that does not include the nucleic acid (i.e., the same type of cell that does not contain the nucleic acid), (b) presents a greater amount of antigen on average than a counterpart cell that does not include the nucleic acid, and/or (c) is more immunogenic on average than a cell that does not include the nucleic acid.
  • the membrane-associated Akt protein encoded by the nucleic acid can be in association with a raft membrane with higher frequency than other portions of the cell membrane, in certain embodiments.
  • a method for inducing an immune response against an antigen which comprises contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane -targeted Akt protein with an antigen or antigen precursor; and administering the dendritic cell to a subject; whereby the immune response against the antigen is induced.
  • a method for detecting an immune response against an antigen which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane-targeted Akt protein with an antigen; administering the dendritic cell to a subject; and detecting the immune response.
  • a method for reducing cell proliferation in a subject which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane-targeted Akt protein with an antigen produced in proliferating cells; and administering the dendritic cell to a subject; whereby cell proliferation is reduced.
  • the antigen or a fragment thereof sometimes is co-administered to the subject (e.g., before, during or after administration of the dendritic cell).
  • Administration of the dendritic cell and/or antigen may be pulsed (e.g., administered multiple times over a period of time (e.g., within a day, once every five days).
  • Also provided is a method for inhibiting tumor growth in a subject which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane -targeted Akt protein with an antigen produced by cells in a tumor; and administering the dendritic cell to a subject having a tumor; whereby tumor growth is inhibited.
  • kits which comprises a nucleic acid comprising a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt protein described herein.
  • the nucleic acid is packaged in a virus, and sometimes the virus is an adenovirus, such as a replication deficient adenovirus.
  • the kit comprises one or more transfection components for inserting the nucleic acid into a dendritic cell.
  • a kit may comprise an antigen, and/or a second nucleic acid that encodes an antigen.
  • Some kits comprise instructions, or directions to obtain instructions (e.g., obtained from a website), for preparing a dendritic cell with the nucleic acid comprising a nucleotide sequence that encodes the membrane-targeted Akt.
  • an isolated nucleic acid which comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein containing: a first region comprising a human Akt sequence lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and a second region linked to the N-terminus of the Akt sequence comprising two or more acylation sites.
  • the second region comprises a Gly-Cys-Xaa-Cys- sequence, and sometimes the second region is about 5 to about 25 amino acids in length and from the N-terminus of the nucleic acid kinase Fyn, Yes or Lck.
  • the second region sometimes comprises two acyl moieties, such as a myristoyl and palmitoyl region, for example.
  • the Akt sequence is identical to or substantially identical to a fragment of an amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 2, 3, or 4. Sometimes the Akt sequence is identical to or substantially identical to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 6, and at times the Akt sequence is identical to or substantially identical to an amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 5.
  • the second region is identical to or substantially identical to the amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 7 (from Fyn).
  • an adenovirus which comprises the nucleotide sequence of any one of the preceding aspects.
  • a cell which comprises the nucleotide sequence of any one of the preceding aspects.
  • the cell is a human antigen presenting cell, such as a human dendritic cell.
  • the cell has been contacted with an antigen, such as a prostate specific membrane antigen or fragment thereof (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 10).
  • a method for inducing an immune response which comprises: (a) contacting a dendritic cell from a human subject with an antigen; (b) contacting the dendritic cell with a nucleic acid that comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein containing: a first region comprising a human Akt sequence lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and a second region linked to the N-terminus of the Akt sequence comprising two or more acylation sites; and administering the dendritic cell after steps (a) and (b) to the subject, whereby an immune response is induced.
  • a nucleic acid that comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein containing: a first region comprising a human Akt sequence lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and a second region linked to the N-terminus of the Akt sequence comprising two or more acylation sites
  • the immune response often is or includes an antigen-specific CTL response, and sometimes the antigen is a prostate specific membrane antigen or fragment thereof (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 10).
  • a method for inducing an immune response comprises: (a) contacting a dendritic cell from a human subject with an antigen; (b) contacting the dendritic cell with a nucleic acid that comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein containing: a first region comprising a human Akt sequence lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and a second region linked to the N-terminus of the Akt sequence comprising two or more acylation sites; and proliferating in vitro antigen-specific CTLs against the dendritic cell after steps (a) and (b), whereby an immune response is induced.
  • the CTLs are administered to the subject, and sometimes the antigen is a prostate specific membrane antigen or fragment thereof (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 10).
  • Figures IA to IF show LPS and CD40 prevent DC death by blocking the down-regulation of Akt and Bcl-2.
  • FIGS. 2A-2F show Aktl is critical for LPS and CD40-mediated DC survival and activation.
  • Figures 3A-3F show functionally optimized Akt induces DC activation and protects DCs from PI3K inhibition.
  • FIG. 4 shows Akt-mediated DC longevity requires Bcl-2.
  • Figures 5A-5E show MF- ⁇ Akt and M- Akt induce BMDC longevity in vitro and in vivo.
  • Figures 6A-6C show MF- ⁇ Akt and M-Akt-expressing BMDCs reveal improved T cell activation and proliferation.
  • Figures 7A-7E show MF- ⁇ Akt expression enhances the efficacy of DC-based therapeutic tumor vaccines.
  • Figures 8A-8C show MF- ⁇ hAkt induces human MoDC longevity leading to improved antigen- specific CTL activation and proliferation.
  • Figures 9A-9C show effects of Akt inhibitors on DC survival.
  • Figure 10 shows a representative analysis of surface markers of Aktl +/+ or Aktl 7" DCs.
  • Figure 11 shows a comparison of bone marrow and spleens isolated from Aktl +/+ or Ak t ⁇ ' ⁇ mice.
  • Figures 12A-12E show effects of different acylation regions.
  • Figures 13A-13D show effects of modified DCs described herein on tumor growth and animal survival.
  • Figure 14 shows representative memory recall responses for particular antigens.
  • Figures 15A- 15B show effects of a combination immunotherapy.
  • Akt molecule refers to a molecule, such as a protein, polypeptide, nucleic acid or expression vector, for example, comprising a native Akt sequence, or fragment thereof or substantially identical variant of the foregoing.
  • An Akt molecule often is capable of enhancing antigen presenting cell longevity and immunogenicity when expressed in an antigen presenting cell in such a manner that it is membrane-targeted, and constitutively active in certain embodiments.
  • An Akt molecule also may include other portions in addition to the Akt sequence, and in such embodiments, the Akt sequence in the Akt molecule sometimes is referred to herein as an "Akt portion" or "Akt region.” Additional sequences that may be included optionally in an Akt molecule are described herein, such as a membrane association sequence and/or a multimerization sequence, for example.
  • An Akt sequence may be a native Akt sequence, a fragment of an Akt sequence or a substantially identical variant of the foregoing.
  • An Akt sequence often is mammalian (e.g., mouse or human), or a fragment or variant sequence thereof.
  • native polynucleotide sequences that encode Akt polypeptides include, but are not limited to, SEQ ID NO: 1 (mouse Aktl), SEQ ID NO: 2 (human Aktl), SEQ ID NO: 2 (human Akt2), SEQ ID NO: 4 (human Akt3), and Akt homologs from other species, often mammals, and including Akt oncogenic viral sequences.
  • Akt sequences include Akt fragment sequences.
  • An AKT fragment sequence may lack one or more nucleotides, amino acids or regions, the latter of which may be a functional region or domain.
  • An Akt fragment sequence can include one or more functional regions, and may lack one or more functional regions compared to a native Akt sequence.
  • Functional regions include a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain (e.g., from about position 6 to about position 107 in human AKTl), a serine/threonine protein kinase catalytic region (e.g., from about position 149 to about position 408 in human AKTl) and a catalytic domain extension region (e.g., from about position 409 to about position 476 in human AKTl).
  • PH pleckstrin homology
  • an Akt fragment sequence may be flanked on each side by a native amino acid sequence from a native Akt sequence.
  • an Akt amino acid fragment sequence is 10 or more, 15 or more, 20 or more, 25 or more, 50 or more, 100 or more, 200 or more, 300 or more, 400 or more or 450 or more amino acids from a native Akt protein.
  • An Akt molecule often includes an Akt protein kinase catalytic domain, and therefore often is capable of catalyzing Ser/Thr protein phosphorylation.
  • An Akt fragment can exclude a PH domain or includes a modified PH domain.
  • a modified PH domain may be truncated or mutated, generated by using standard mutagenesis, insertions, deletions, or substitutions, and the modified form may or may not be functional.
  • Examples of Akt nucleic acids lacking a functional PH domain sequence have the nucleotide sequences of SEQ ID NO: 5 (mouse Akt) and SEQ ID NO: 6 (human Akt).
  • Akt sequences include homologs, alternative transcripts, alleles, functionally equivalent fragments, variants, and analogs of native Akt sequences (e.g., nucleotide sequences described herein).
  • substantially identical variant refers to a nucleotide or amino acid sequence sharing sequence identity to a nucleotide sequence or amino acid sequence of Akt or another molecule described herein (e.g., membrane association region).
  • nucleotide sequences or amino acid sequences 55% or more, 60% or more, 65% or more, 70% or more, 75% or more, 80% or more, 85% or more, 90% or more, 95% or more (each sometimes within a 1%, 2%, 3% or 4% variability) identical to a nucleotide sequence or encoded amino acid sequence described herein, or has one to ten nucleotide or amino acid substitutions.
  • One test for determining whether two nucleotide sequences or amino acids sequences are substantially identical is to determine the percent of identical nucleotide sequences or amino acid sequences shared.
  • sequence identity can be performed as follows. Sequences are aligned for optimal comparison purposes (e.g., gaps can be introduced in one or both of a first and a second amino acid or nucleic acid sequence for optimal alignment and non-homologous sequences can be disregarded for comparison purposes).
  • the length of a reference sequence aligned for comparison purposes is sometimes 30% or more, 40% or more, 50% or more, often 60% or more, and more often 70% or more, 80% or more, 90% or more, or 100% of the length of the reference sequence.
  • the nucleotides or amino acids at corresponding nucleotide or polypeptide positions, respectively, are then compared among the two sequences.
  • the percent identity between the two sequences is a function of the number of identical positions shared by the sequences, taking into account the number of gaps, and the length of each gap, introduced for optimal alignment of the two sequences. Comparison of sequences and determination of percent identity between two sequences can be accomplished using a mathematical algorithm.
  • Percent identity between two amino acid or nucleotide sequences can be determined using the algorithm of Meyers & Miller, CABIOS 4: 11-17 (1989), which has been incorporated into the ALIGN program (version 2.0), using a PAM 120 weight residue table, a gap length penalty of 12 and a gap penalty of 4. Also, percent identity between two amino acid sequences can be determined using the Needleman & Wunsch, J. MoI. Biol. 48: 444-453 (1970) algorithm which has been incorporated into the GAP program in the GCG software package (available at the http address www.gcg.com), using either a Blossum 62 matrix or a PAM250 matrix, and a gap weight of 16, 14, 12, 10, 8, 6, or 4 and a length weight of 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
  • Percent identity between two nucleotide sequences can be determined using the GAP program in the GCG software package (available at http address www.gcg.com), using a NWSgapdna.CMP matrix and a gap weight of 40, 50, 60, 70, or 80 and a length weight of 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
  • a set of parameters often used is a Blossum 62 scoring matrix with a gap open penalty of 12, a gap extend penalty of 4, and a frameshift gap penalty of 5.
  • stringent conditions refers to conditions for hybridization and washing. Stringent conditions are known to those skilled in the art and can be found in Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, John Wiley & Sons, N.Y. , 6.3.1-6.3.6 (1989). Aqueous and nonaqueous methods are described in that reference and either can be used.
  • stringent hybridization conditions is hybridization in 6X sodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45°C, followed by one or more washes in 0.2X SSC, 0.1% SDS at 50 0 C.
  • Another example of stringent hybridization conditions are hybridization in 6X sodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45°C, followed by one or more washes in 0.2X SSC, 0.1% SDS at 55°C.
  • a further example of stringent hybridization conditions is hybridization in 6X sodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45°C, followed by one or more washes in 0.2X SSC, 0.1% SDS at 60 0 C.
  • stringent hybridization conditions are hybridization in 6X sodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45°C, followed by one or more washes in 0.2X SSC, 0.1% SDS at 65°C. More often, stringency conditions are 0.5M sodium phosphate, 7% SDS at 65°C, followed by one or more washes at 0.2X SSC, 1% SDS at 65°C.
  • SSC sodium chloride/sodium citrate
  • nucleotide sequence to a base nucleotide sequence described herein is one that has a different nucleotide sequence but still encodes the same amino acid sequence encoded by the base nucleotide sequence.
  • Another example is a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein having an amino acid sequence 70% or more identical to, sometimes 75% or more, 80% or more, or 85% or more identical to, and often 90% to 99% identical to an amino acid sequence encoded by the base nucleotide sequence.
  • Gapped BLAST can be utilized as described in Altschul et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 25(17): 3389- 3402 (1997).
  • default parameters of the respective programs e.g., XBLAST and NBLAST
  • a protein having a substantially identical amino acid sequence to (i) an amino acid sequence described herein or (ii) an amino acid sequence encoded by a nucleotide sequence described herein, identified by a query sequence search can be considered a substantially identical sequence.
  • Substantially identical nucleotide sequences may include altered codons for enhancing expression of an amino acid sequence in a particular expression system.
  • One or more codons may be altered, and sometimes 10% or more or 20% or more of the codons are altered for optimized expression in an expression system that may include bacteria (e.g., E. coli.), yeast (e.g., S. cervesiae), human (e.g., 293 cells or antigen presenting cells), insect, or rodent (e.g., hamster) cells (e.g., antigen presenting cells).
  • An Akt protein, polypeptide or fragment variant can include one or more amino acid substitutions, deletions or insertions. Any amino acid may be substituted by a conservative or non-conservative substitution.
  • phosphorylatable amino acids e.g., serine, threonine or tyrosine
  • An Akt protein, polypeptide or fragment variant may contain one or more unnatural amino acids.
  • Unnatural amino acids include but are not limited to D-isomer amino acids, ornithine, diaminobutyric acid, norleucine, pyrylalanine, thienylalanine, naphthylalanine and phenylglycine, alpha and alpha- disubstituted amino acids, N-alkyl amino acids, lactic acid, halide derivatives of natural amino acids such as trifluorotyrosine, p-Cl-phenylalanine, p-Br-phenylalanine, p-I-phenylalanine, L-allyl-glycine, beta- alanine, L-alpha-amino butyric acid, L-gamma-amino butyric acid, L-alpha-amino isobutyric acid, L- epsilon-amino caproic acid, 7-amino heptanoic acid, L-methionine sulfone, L-nor
  • Molecules in association with cell membranes contain certain regions that facilitate the membrane association, and such regions can be incorporated into or associated with a protein containing an Akt sequence to generate membrane -targeted Akt molecules (e.g., Akt chimeras).
  • Akt membrane -targeted Akt molecules
  • some proteins contain sequences at the N-terminus or C-terminus that are acylated, and these acyl moieties facilitate membrane association.
  • Such sequences are recognized by acyltransferases and often conform to a particular sequence motif.
  • Certain acylation motifs are capable of being modified with a single acyl moiety and others are capable of being modified with multiple acyl moieties.
  • the N-terminal sequence of the protein kinase Src can comprise a single myristoyl moiety.
  • Dual acylation regions are located within the N-terminal regions of certain protein kinases (e.g., Yes, Fyn, Lck) and G-protein alpha subunits.
  • Such dual acylation regions often are located within the first eighteen amino acids of such proteins, and conform to the sequence motif Met-Gly-Cys-Xaa-Cys, where the Met is cleaved, the GIy is N-acylated and one of the Cys residues is S-acylated.
  • the GIy often is myristoylated and a Cys can be palmitoylated.
  • These and other acylation motifs are known to the person of ordinary skill in the art (e.g., Gauthier-Campbell et al., Molecular Biology of the Cell 15: 2205- 2217 (2004); Glabati et al., Biochem. J.
  • Akt molecules can be incorporated in Akt molecules to induce membrane localization.
  • a native sequence from a protein containing an acylation motif can be linked to an Akt protein.
  • an N-terminal portion of Lck, Fyn or Yes or a G-protein alpha subunit such as the first twenty-five N-terminal amino acids or fewer from such proteins (e.g., about 5 to about 20 amino acids, about 10 to about 19 amino acids, or about 15 to about 19 amino acids of the native sequence with optional mutations), may be linked to the N-terminus of an Akt protein (e.g., a Fyn fragment-Akt molecule is described in the Examples section hereafter).
  • a C- terminal sequence of about 25 amino acids or less from a G-protein gamma subunit containing a CAAX box motif sequence (e.g., about 5 to about 20 amino acids, about 10 to about 18 amino acids, or about 15 to about 18 amino acids of the native sequence with optional mutations) can be linked to the C-terminus of an Akt protein.
  • an acyl moiety has a log p value of +1 to +6, and sometimes has a log p value of +3 to +4.5.
  • Log p values are a measure of hydrophobicity and often are derived from octanol/water partitioning studies, in which molecules with higher hydrophobicity partition into octanol with higher frequency and are characterized as having a higher log p value.
  • Log p values are published for a number of lipophilic molecules and log p values can be calculated using known partitioning processes (e.g., Chemical Reviews, Vol. 71, Issue 6, page 599, where entry 4493 shows lauric acid having a log p value of 4.2).
  • acyl moiety can be linked to a peptide composition described above and tested for antimicrobial activity using known methods and those described hereafter.
  • the acyl moiety sometimes is a C1-C20 alkyl, C2-C20 alkenyl, C2-C20 alkynyl, C3-C6 cycloalkyl, C1-C4 haloalkyl, C4-C12 cyclalkylalkyl, aryl, substituted aryl, or aryl (C1-C4) alkyl, for example.
  • Any acyl-containing moiety sometimes is a fatty acid, and examples of fatty acid moieties are propyl (C3), butyl (C4), pentyl (C5), hexyl (C6), heptyl (C7), octyl (C8), nonyl (C9), decyl (ClO), undecyl (Cl 1), lauryl (C 12), myristyl (C 14), palmityl (C 16), stearyl (C 18), arachidyl (C20), behenyl (C22) and lignoceryl moieties (C24), and each moiety can contain 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 or 8 unsaturations (i.e., double bonds).
  • An acyl moiety sometimes is a lipid molecule, such as a phosphatidyl lipid (e.g., phosphatidyl serine, phosphatidyl inositol, phosphatidyl ethanolamine, phosphatidyl choline), sphingolipid (e.g., shingomyelin, sphigosine, ceramide, ganglioside, cerebroside), or modified versions thereof.
  • a phosphatidyl lipid e.g., phosphatidyl serine, phosphatidyl inositol, phosphatidyl ethanolamine, phosphatidyl choline
  • sphingolipid e.g., shingomyelin, sphigosine, ceramide, ganglioside, cerebroside
  • one, two, three, four or five or more acyl moieties are linked to a membrane association region.
  • An Akt protein also may be linked to a single -pass or multiple pass transmembrane sequence (e.g., to the N-terminus or C-terminus of an Akt protein sequence).
  • Single pass transmembrane regions are found in certain CD molecules, tyrosine kinase receptors, serine/threonine kinase receptors, TGFbeta, BMP, activin and phosphatases.
  • Single pass transmembrane regions can include a signal peptide region and a transmembrane region of about 20 to about 25 amino acids, many of which are hydrophobic amino acids and can form an alpha helix. A short track of positively charged amino acids can follow the transmembrane span.
  • Multiple pass proteins include ion pumps, ion channels, and transporters, and include two or more helices that span the membrane multiple times. All or substantially all of a multiple pass protein can be attached to an Akt molecule. Sequences for single pass and multiple pass transmembrane regions are known and can be selected for incorporation into an Akt molecule by the person of ordinary skill in the art.
  • a membrane association region may be covalently linked to the N-teminus or C-terminus of an Akt protein or fragment, and such fusions sometimes are referred to herein as "chimeric proteins.”
  • Such chimeric proteins can be encoded by a nucleotide sequence in which the membrane association region- encoding sequence is adjacent to the Akt protein or fragment-encoding sequence, with or without an intervening linker sequence.
  • Covalent linkages also can be generated by a chemically reactive binding pair, whereby a one member of the binding pair is linked to the Akt molecule and another member of the binding pair is linked to the membrane association region.
  • binding pairs include without limitation sulfhydryl/maleimide, sulfhydryl/haloacetyl derivative, amine/isotriocyanate, amine/succinimidyl ester, and amine/sulfonyl halides.
  • binding pairs are utilized to generate a covalent linkage, it is possible to join the membrane association region to the N-terminus or C-terminus of the Akt molecule, or to a chemical moiety within the Akt molecule.
  • the membrane association portion may not be covalently attached and may non-covalently associate with the Akt molecule.
  • Non-covalent linkages can be generated by interactive binding pairs, wherein one binding pair member is linked to the membrane association region and the other binding pair member is linked to the Akt molecule.
  • Any suitable interactive binding pair can be utilized to effect a non-covalent linkage, including without limitation biotin/avidin, biotin/streptavidin, folic acid/folate binding protein, vitamin Bl 2/intrinsic factor, nucleic acid/complementary nucleic acid (e.g., DNA, RNA, PNA), and may be antibody/antigen, antibody/antibody, antibody/antibody fragment, antibody/antibody receptor, antibody/protein A or protein G, or hapten/anti-hapten pairs.
  • nucleotide sequences encoding each portion can be located on separate nucleic acids or the same nucleic acid.
  • the nucleotide sequence encoding each portion often are under the control of the same regulatory sequences, and can be under the control of different regulatory sequences (e.g., promoter, internal ribosome entry sequence).
  • Multimerization regions also are known and can be utilized to inducibly join an Akt protein, fragment or variant with a membrane association region in a non-covalent manner.
  • Such inducible systems are referred to herein as "chemically induced dimerization (CID).”
  • CID also is reversible, due to the degradation of the labile dimerizing agent or administration of a monomeric competitive inhibitor.
  • CID systems often involve synthetic bivalent ligands to rapidly crosslink signaling molecules that are fused to ligand-binding domains CID.
  • This system has been used to trigger the oligomerization and activation of cell surface (Spencer et al., 1993; Spencer et al., 1996; Blau et al., 1997), or cytosolic proteins (Luo et al., 1996; MacCorkle et al., 1998), the recruitment of transcription factors to DNA elements to modulate transcription (Ho et al., 1996; Rivera et al., 1996) or the recruitment of signaling molecules to the plasma membrane to simulate signaling (Spencer et al., 1995; Holsinger et al., 1995).
  • the CID system uses a dimeric analog of the lipid permeable immunosuppressant drug, FK506, which loses its normal bioactivity while gaining the ability to crosslink molecules genetically fused to the FK506-binding protein, FKBP 12.
  • FKBP lipid permeable immunosuppressant drug
  • FKBP12 permits specific activation of the recombinant receptor in vivo without the induction of non-specific side effects through endogenous FKBP 12.
  • synthetic ligands are resistant to protease degradation, making them more efficient at activating receptors in vivo than most delivered protein agents.
  • rapamycin analogs crosslink endogenous FKBP 12 with a 89 amino acid domain from FRAP/mTOR, called FRB (FRAP rapamycin binding domain, residues 2025-2113).
  • FRB FRAP rapamycin binding domain, residues 2025-2113.
  • activation of iAkt is based on ligand-dependent recruitment of chimeric Akt (first chimeric protein) to a membrane association protin (second chimeric protein).
  • Ligands utilized for CID are capable of binding to two or more of the ligand-binding domains.
  • One skilled in the art realizes that the chimeric proteins may be able to bind to more than one ligand when they contain more than one ligand-binding domain.
  • the ligand sometimes is a non-protein or a chemical.
  • Exemplary ligands include, but are not limited to dimeric FK506 (e.g., FKl 012), AP1903, rapamycin or a derivative thereof.
  • the ligand-binding region linked to the membrane association region is heterologous to the ligand-binding region linked to the Akt molecule.
  • the ligand- binding region is a rapamycin-binding domain, FRB, from FRAP/mTOR. Representative sequences and methods of incorporating them into expression vectors are set forth in the Examples section hereafter.
  • antigen presenting cells are transfected or transformed with a nucleic acid having a polynucleotide sequence that encodes an Akt molecule described herein.
  • the nucleic acid bearing such a nucleotide sequence can be transferred into the antigen presenting cell in a variety of manners, as described hereafter (e.g., delivery of a naked nucleic acid or encapsulation of the nucleic acid in a liposome or virus).
  • a target nucleotide sequence encoding an Akt molecule and/or other target molecules may be stably integrated into the genomic DNA of the antigen presenting cell, in a random or non-random manner (e.g., knock- in), or may be transiently deposited to the antigen presenting cell.
  • Nucleic acids containing an Akt nucleotide sequence sometimes are referred to herein as "nucleic acid compositions.”
  • a nucleic acid composition can be from any source or composition, such as DNA, cDNA, RNA or mRNA, for example, and can be in any suitable form (e.g., linear, circular, supercoiled, single-stranded, double-stranded, and the like).
  • a nucleic acid composition sometimes is a plasmid, phage, autonomously replicating sequence (ARS), centromere, artificial chromosome or other nucleic acid able to replicate or be replicated in vitro or in a host cell (e.g., dendritic cell).
  • ARS autonomously replicating sequence
  • nucleic acid compositions are selected for their ability to guide production of the desired protein or nucleic acid molecule.
  • the nucleic acid composition can be altered as known in the art such that codons encode for a different amino acid than is normal, including unconventional or unnatural amino acids (including detectably labeled amino acids).
  • a nucleic acid composition can comprise certain elements often selected according to the intended use of the nucleic acid. Any of the following elements can be included in or excluded from a nucleic acid composition.
  • a nucleic acid composition may include one or more or all of the following nucleotide elements: one or more promoter elements, one or more 5' untranslated regions (5'UTRs), one or more regions into which a target nucleotide sequence may be inserted (an "insertion element"), one or more target nucleotide sequences, one or more 3 ' untranslated regions (3 'UTRs), and a selection element.
  • a nucleic acid composition is provided with one or more of such elements and other elements may be inserted into the nucleic acid before the template is contacted with a transcription and/or translation system.
  • a provided nucleic acid composition comprises a promoter, 5'UTR, optional 3'UTR and insertion element(s) by which a target nucleotide sequence is inserted (i.e., cloned) into the template.
  • a provided nucleic acid composition comprises a promoter, insertion element(s) and optional 3'UTR, and a 5' UTR/target nucleotide sequence is inserted with an optional 3'UTR.
  • a nucleic acid composition comprises the following elements in the 5' to 3' direction: (1) promoter element, 5'UTR, and insertion element(s); (2) promoter element, 5'UTR, and target nucleotide sequence; (3) promoter element, 5'UTR, insertion element(s) and 3'UTR; and (4) promoter element, 5'UTR, target nucleotide sequence and 3'UTR.
  • a promoter element typically is required for DNA synthesis and/or RNA synthesis.
  • a promoter often interacts with a RNA polymerase to generate message RNA suitable for translation of a protein, polypeptide or peptide.
  • Promoter sequences are readily accessed and obtained by the artisan, and are readily adapted to nucleic acid compositions described herein.
  • the particular promoter employed to control the expression of a polynucleotide sequence of interest is not believed to be important, so long as it is capable of directing the expression of the polynucleotide in the targeted cell.
  • such a promoter might include either a human or viral promoter.
  • promoters include human cytomegalovirus (CMV) immediate early gene promoter, SV40 early promoter, Rous sarcoma virus long terminal repeat, .beta.-actin, elongation factor 1 -alpha (EF-I. alpha.), rat insulin promoter and glyceraldehyde-3 -phosphate dehydrogenase.
  • CMV human cytomegalovirus
  • SV40 early promoter Rous sarcoma virus long terminal repeat
  • .beta.-actin Rous sarcoma virus long terminal repeat
  • EF-I. alpha. elongation factor 1 -alpha
  • rat insulin promoter glyceraldehyde-3 -phosphate dehydrogenase.
  • the use of other viral or mammalian cellular or bacterial phage promoters which are well known in the art to achieve expression of a coding sequence of
  • a transgene in an immunotherapy vector it is desirable to regulate expression of a transgene in an immunotherapy vector.
  • different viral promoters with varying strengths of activity are utilized depending on the level of expression desired.
  • the CMV immediate early promoter can be used to provide strong transcriptional activation.
  • Modified versions of the CMV promoter that are less potent have also been used when reduced levels of expression of the transgene are desired.
  • retroviral promoters such as the LTRs from MLV or MMTV can be used.
  • viral promoters that are used depending on the desired effect include SV40, RSV LTR, HIV-I and HIV-2 LTR, adenovirus promoters such as from the ElA, E2A, or MLP region, AAV LTR, HSV-TK, and avian sarcoma virus.
  • Tissue specific promoters sometimes are used to effect transcription in specific tissues or cells so as to reduce potential toxicity or undesirable effects to non-targeted tissues.
  • promoters such as the alpha myosin heavy chain (.alpha.MHC) promoter, directing expression to cardiac myocytes.
  • Cytokine and inflammatory protein responsive promoters that can be used include K and T Kininogen (Kageyama et al., 1987), c-fos, TNF-alpha, C-reactive protein (Arcone et al., 1988), haptoglobin (Oliviero et al., 1987), serum amyloid A2, C/EBP alpha, IL-I, IL-6 (PoIi and Cortese, 1989), Complement C3 (Wilson et al., 1990), IL-8, alpha-1 acid glycoprotein (Prowse and Baumann, 1988), alpha-1 antityrpsin, lipoprotein lipase (Zechner et al., 1988), angiotensinogen (Ron et al., 1991), fibrinogen, c-jun (inducible by phorbol
  • ecdysone system (Invitrogen, Carlsbad, Calif.) is one such system. This system is designed to allow regulated expression of a gene of interest in mammalian cells. It consists of a tightly regulated expression mechanism that allows virtually no basal level expression of the transgene, but over 200-fold inducibility. The system is based on the heterodimeric ecdysone receptor of Drosophila, and when ecdysone or an analog such as muristerone A binds to the receptor, the receptor activates a promoter to turn on expression of the downstream transgene high levels of mRNA transcripts are attained.
  • both monomers of the heterodimeric receptor are constitutively expressed from one vector, whereas the ecdysone-responsive promoter, which drives expression of the gene of interest is on another plasmid.
  • Engineering of this type of system into the gene transfer vector of interest would therefore be useful. Cotransfection of plasmids containing the gene of interest and the receptor monomers in the producer cell line would then allow for the production of the gene transfer vector without expression of a potentially toxic transgene. At the appropriate time, expression of the transgene could be activated with ecdysone or muristeron A.
  • Another inducible system is the Tet-Off.TM. or Tet-On.TM.
  • the gene of interest is cloned into a plasmid behind a promoter that has tetracycline -responsive elements present in it.
  • a second plasmid contains a regulatory element called the tetracycline-controlled transactivator, which is composed, in the Tet-Off.TM. system, of the VP16 domain from the herpes simplex virus and the wild-type tertracycline repressor.
  • transcription is constitutively on. In the Tet-On.TM.
  • the tetracycline repressor is not wild type and in the presence of doxycycline activates transcription.
  • the Tet-Offm system would be preferable so that the producer cells could be grown in the presence of tetracycline or doxycycline and prevent expression of a potentially toxic transgene, but when the vector is introduced to the patient, the gene expression would be induced constitutively.
  • a 5' UTR may comprise one or more elements endogenous to the nucleotide sequence from which it originates, and sometimes includes one or more exogenous elements.
  • a 5' UTR can originate from any suitable nucleic acid, such as genomic DNA, plasmid DNA, RNA or mRNA, for example, from any suitable organism (e.g., virus, bacterium, yeast, fungi, plant, insect or mammal). The artisan may select appropriate elements for the 5' UTR based upon the transcription and/or translation system being utilized.
  • a 5' UTR sometimes comprises one or more of the following elements known to the artisan: enhancer sequence (e.g., Eukaryotic Promoter Data Base EPDB), translational enhancer sequence, transcription initiation site, transcription factor binding site, translation regulation site, translation initiation site, translation factor binding site, ribosome binding site, replicon, enhancer element, internal ribosome entry site (IRES), and silencer element.
  • enhancer sequence e.g., Eukaryotic Promoter Data Base EPDB
  • translational enhancer sequence e.g., Eukaryotic Promoter Data Base EPDB
  • transcription factor binding site e.g., transcription factor binding site
  • translation regulation site e.g., translation regulation site
  • translation initiation site e.g., translation factor binding site
  • ribosome binding site e.g., ribosome binding site
  • replicon e.g., internal ribosome entry site (IRES)
  • silencer element e.g., internal ribosome entry site
  • a 5'UTR in the nucleic acid composition can comprise a translational enhancer nucleotide sequence.
  • a translational enhancer nucleotide sequence often is located between the promoter and the target nucleotide sequence in a nucleic acid composition.
  • a translational enhancer sequence often binds to a ribosome, sometimes is an 18S rRNA-binding ribonucleotide sequence (i.e., a 4OS ribosome binding sequence) and sometimes is an internal ribosome entry sequence (IRES).
  • An IRES generally forms an RNA scaffold with precisely placed RNA tertiary structures that contact a 4OS ribosomal subunit via a number of specific intermolecular interactions.
  • ribosomal enhancer sequences are known and can be identified by the artisan (e.g., Mumblee et al., Nucleic Acids Research 33: D141-D146 (2005); Paulous et al., Nucleic Acids Research 31 : 722-733 (2003); Akbergenov et al., Nucleic Acids Research 32: 239-247 (2004); Mignone et al., Genome Biology 3(3): reviews0004.1-0001.10 (2002); Gallie, Nucleic Acids Research 30: 3401-3411 (2002); Shaloiko et al., http address www.interscience.wiley.com, DOI: 10.1002/bit.20267; and Gallie et al., Nucleic Acids Research 15: 3257-3273 (1987)).
  • a translational enhancer sequence sometimes is a eukaryotic sequence, such as a Kozak consensus sequence or other sequence (e.g., hydroid polyp sequence, GenBank accession no. U07128).
  • a translational enhancer sequence sometimes is a prokaryotic sequence, such as a Shine-Dalgarno consensus sequence.
  • the translational enhancer sequence is a viral nucleotide sequence.
  • a translational enhancer sequence sometimes is from a 5'UTR of a plant virus, such as Tobacco Mosaic Virus (TMV), Alfalfa Mosaic Virus (AMV); Tobacco Etch Virus (ETV); Potato Virus Y (PVY); Turnip Mosaic (poty) Virus and Pea Seed Borne Mosaic Virus, for example.
  • TMV Tobacco Mosaic Virus
  • AMV Alfalfa Mosaic Virus
  • ETV Tobacco Etch Virus
  • PVY Potato Virus Y
  • Turnip Mosaic (poty) Virus and Pea Seed Borne Mosaic Virus for example.
  • an omega sequence about 67 bases in length from TMV is included in the nucleic acid composition as a translational enhancer sequence (e.g., devoid of guanosine nucleotides and includes a 25 nucleotide long poly (CAA) central region).
  • CAA nucleotide long poly
  • a translational enhancer sequence comprises one or more ARC-I or ARC- 1 like sequence, such as one of the following nucleotide sequences GCCGGCGGAG, CUC AUAAGGU, GACUUUGAUU, CGGAACCCAA, AUACUCCCCC and CCUUGCGACC, or a substantially identical sequence thereof.
  • a translational enhancer sequence comprises an IRES sequence, such as one or more of EMBL nucleotide sequences J04513, X87949, M95825, M12783, AF025841, AF013263, AF006822, M17169, M13440, M22427, D14838 and M17446, or a substantially identical nucleotide sequence thereof.
  • An IRES sequence may be a type I IRES (e.g., from enterovirus (e.g., poliovirus), rhinovirus (e.g., human rhinovirus)), a type II IRES (e.g., from cardiovirus (e.g., encephalomyocraditis virus), aphthovirus (e.g., foot-and-mouth disease virus)), a type III IRES (e.g., from Hepatitis A virus) or other picornavirus sequence (e.g., Paulos et al. supra, and Jackson et al., RNA 1 : 985-1000 (1995)).
  • enterovirus e.g., poliovirus
  • rhinovirus e.g., human rhinovirus
  • a type II IRES e.g., from cardiovirus (e.g., encephalomyocraditis virus), aphthovirus (e.g., foot-and-mouth disease virus)
  • a 3' UTR may comprise one or more elements endogenous to the nucleotide sequence from which it originates and sometimes includes one or more exogenous elements.
  • a 3' UTR may originate from any suitable nucleic acid, such as genomic DNA, plasmid DNA, RNA or mRNA, for example, from any suitable organism (e.g., a virus, bacterium, yeast, fungi, plant, insect or mammal). The artisan can select appropriate elements for the 3 ' UTR based upon the transcription and/or translation system being utilized.
  • a 3' UTR sometimes comprises one or more of the following elements known to the artisan: transcription regulation site, transcription initiation site, transcription termination site, transcription factor binding site, translation regulation site, translation termination site, translation initiation site, translation factor binding site, ribosome binding site, replicon, enhancer element, silencer element and polyadenosine tail.
  • a 3' UTR can include a polyadenosine tail, and sometimes may not. If a polyadenosine tail is present, one or more adenosine moieties may be added or deleted from the native length (e.g., about 5, about 10, about 15, about 20, about 25, about 30, about 35, about 40, about 45 or about 50 adenosine moieties may be added or subtracted).
  • target nucleotide sequence encodes a nucleic acid, peptide, polypeptide or protein of interest, and may be a ribonucleotide sequence or a deoxyribonucleotide sequence.
  • An Akt nucleotide sequence e.g., a chimeric sequence encoding an Akt sequence and a membrane-association sequence
  • nucleic acid as used herein is generic to polydeoxyribonucleotides (containing 2'-deoxy-D-ribose or modified forms thereof), to polyribonucleotides (containing D-ribose or modified forms thereof), and to any other type of polynucleotide which is an N-glycoside of a purine or pyrimidine bases, or modified purine or pyrimidine bases.
  • a target nucleic acid can include an untranslated ribonucleic acid and sometimes is a translated ribonucleic acid.
  • An untranslated ribonucleic acid may include, but is not limited to, a small interfering ribonucleic acid (siRNA), a short hairpin ribonucleic acid (shRNA), other ribonucleic acid capable of RNA interference (RNAi), an antisense ribonucleic acid, or a ribozyme.
  • siRNA small interfering ribonucleic acid
  • shRNA short hairpin ribonucleic acid
  • RNAi RNA interference
  • antisense ribonucleic acid or a ribozyme.
  • a translatable target nucleotide sequence (e.g., a target ribonucleotide sequence) sometimes encodes a peptide, polypeptide or protein, which are sometimes referred to herein as "target peptides," “target polypeptides” or “target proteins.”
  • protein refers to a molecule having a sequence of amino acids linked by peptide bonds. This term includes fusion proteins, oligopeptides, polypeptides, cyclic peptides, polypeptides and polypeptide derivatives.
  • a protein or polypeptide sometimes is of intracellular origin (e.g., located in the nucleus, cytosol, or interstitial space of host cells in vivo) and sometimes is a cell membrane protein in vivo.
  • a translatable nucleotide sequence generally is located between a start codon (AUG in ribonucleic acids and ATG in deoxyribonucleic acids) and a stop codon (e.g., UAA (ochre), UAG (amber) or UGA (opal) in ribonucleic acids and TAA, TAG or TGA in deoxyribonucleic acids), and sometimes is referred to herein as an "open reading frame" (ORF).
  • a nucleic acid composition sometimes comprises one or more ORFs.
  • An ORF may be from any suitable source, sometimes from genomic DNA, mRNA, reverse transcribed RNA or complementary DNA (cDNA) or a nucleic acid library comprising one or more of the foregoing, and is from any organism species, such as human, insect, nematode, bovine, equine, canine, feline, rat or mouse, for example.
  • An Akt nucleotide sequence often is utilized as an ORF herein, and sometimes a membrane association region-encoding nucleotide sequence is utilized as an ORF.
  • a nucleic acid composition sometimes comprises a nucleotide sequence adjacent to an ORF that is translated in conjunction with the ORF and encodes an amino acid tag.
  • the tag-encoding nucleotide sequence is located 3' and/or 5' of an ORF in the nucleic acid composition, thereby encoding a tag at the C-terminus or N-terminus of the protein or peptide encoded by the ORF.
  • Any tag that does not abrogate or substantially reduce transcription and/or translation may be utilized and may be appropriately selected by the artisan.
  • a tag sometimes specifically binds a molecule or moiety of a solid phase or a detectable label, for example, thereby having utility for isolating, purifying and/or detecting a protein or peptide encoded by the ORF.
  • a tag comprises one or more of the following elements: FLAG (e.g., DYKDDDDKG), AUl (e.g., DTYRYI), V5 (e.g., GKPIPNPLLGLDST), c-MYC (e.g., EQKLISEEDL), HSV (e.g., QPELAPEDPED), influenza hemaglutinin, HA (e.g., YPYDVPDYA), VSV- G (e.g., YTDIEMNRLGK), bacterial glutathione- S-transferase, maltose binding protein, a streptavidin- or avidin-binding tag (e.g., pcDNATM6 BioEaseTM Gateway® Biotinylation System (Invitrogen)), thioredoxin, ⁇ -galactosidase, VSV-glycoprotein, a fluorescent protein (e.g., green fluorescent protein or one of its many color variant
  • a cysteine-rich tag comprises the amino acid sequence CC-X n -CC, wherein X is any amino acid and n is 1 to 3, and the cysteine-rich sequence sometimes is CCPGCC.
  • the tag comprises a cysteine-rich element and a polyhistidine element (e.g., CCPGCC and His 6 ).
  • a tag often conveniently binds to a binding partner.
  • some tags bind to an antibody (e.g., FLAG) and sometimes specifically bind to a small molecule.
  • a polyhistidine tag specifically chelates a bivalent metal, such as copper, zinc and cobalt;
  • a polylysine or polyarginine tag specifically binds to a zinc finger;
  • a glutathione S-transferase tag binds to glutathione;
  • a cysteine-rich tag specifically binds to an arsenic-containing molecule.
  • Arsenic-containing molecules include LUMIOTM agents (Invitrogen, California), such as FlAsHTM (EDT 2 [4',5'-bis(l,3,2-dithioarsolan-2-yl)fluorescein-(l,2- ethanedithiol) 2 ]) and ReAsH reagents (e.g., U.S. Patent 5,932,474 to Tsien et al., entitled “Target Sequences for Synthetic Molecules;" U.S. Patent 6,054,271 to Tsien et al., entitled “Methods of Using Synthetic Molecules and Target Sequences;" U.S.
  • LUMIOTM agents Invitrogen, California
  • FlAsHTM EDT 2 [4',5'-bis(l,3,2-dithioarsolan-2-yl)fluorescein-(l,2- ethanedithiol) 2
  • Patents 6,451,569 and 6,008,378 published U.S. Patent Application 2003/0083373, and published PCT Patent Application WO 99/21013, all to Tsien et al. and all entitled "Synthetic Molecules that Specifically React with Target Sequences”).
  • Such antibodies and small molecules sometimes are linked to a solid phase for convenient isolation of the target protein or target peptide, as described in greater detail hereafter.
  • a tag sometimes comprises a sequence that localizes a translated protein or peptide to a component in a system, which is referred to as a "signal sequence" or “localization signal sequence” herein.
  • a signal sequence often is incorporated at the N-terminus of a target protein or target peptide, and sometimes is incorporated at the C-terminus. Examples of signal sequences are known to the artisan, are readily incorporated into a nucleic acid composition, and often are selected according to the cells from which a cell-free extract is prepared.
  • a signal sequence in some embodiments localizes a translated protein or peptide to a cell membrane.
  • signal sequences include, but are not limited to, a nucleus targeting signal (e.g., steroid receptor sequence and N-terminal sequence of SV40 virus large T antigen); mitochondia targeting signal (e.g., amino acid sequence that forms an amphipathic helix); peroxisome targeting signal (e.g., C-terminal sequence in YFG from S.cerevisiae); and a secretion signal (e.g., N- terminal sequences from invertase, mating factor alpha, PHO5 and SUC2 in S.cerevisiae; multiple N- terminal sequences of B. subtilis proteins (e.g., Tjalsma et al., Microbiol.Molec.
  • a nucleus targeting signal e.g., steroid receptor sequence and N-terminal sequence of SV40 virus large T antigen
  • mitochondia targeting signal e.g., amino acid sequence that forms an amphipathic helix
  • alpha amylase signal sequence e.g., U.S. Patent No. 6,288,302
  • pectate lyase signal sequence e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,846,8178
  • precollagen signal sequence e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,712,114
  • OmpA signal sequence e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,470,719
  • lam beta signal sequence e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,389,529
  • B. brevis signal sequence e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,232,841
  • P. pastoris signal sequence e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,268,273
  • a tag sometimes is directly adjacent to the amino acid sequence encoded by an ORF (i.e., there is no intervening sequence) and sometimes a tag is substantially adjacent to a the ORF encoded amino acid sequence (e.g., an intervening sequence is present).
  • An intervening sequence sometimes includes a recognition site for a protease, which is useful for cleaving a tag from a target protein or peptide.
  • the intervening sequence is cleaved by Factor Xa (e.g., recognition site I(E/D)GR), thrombin (e.g., recognition site LVPRGS), enterokinase (e.g., recognition site DDDDK), TEV protease (e.g., recognition site ENLYFQG) or PreScissionTM protease (e.g., recognition site LEVLFQGP), for example.
  • Factor Xa e.g., recognition site I(E/D)GR
  • thrombin e.g., recognition site LVPRGS
  • enterokinase e.g., recognition site DDDDK
  • TEV protease e.g., recognition site ENLYFQG
  • PreScissionTM protease e.g., recognition site LEVLFQGP
  • linker sequence An intervening sequence sometimes is referred to herein as a "linker sequence,” and may be of any suitable length selected by the artisan.
  • a linker sequence sometimes is about 1 to about 20 amino acids in length, and sometimes about 5 to about 10 amino acids in length. The artisan may select the linker length to substantially preserve target protein or peptide function (e.g., a tag may reduce target protein or peptide function unless separated by a linker), to enhance disassociation of a tag from a target protein or peptide when a protease cleavage site is present (e.g., cleavage may be enhanced when a linker is present), and to enhance interaction of a tag/target protein product with a solid phase.
  • a linker can be of any suitable amino acid content, and often comprises a higher proportion of amino acids having relatively short side chains (e.g., glycine, alanine, serine and threonine).
  • a nucleic acid composition sometimes includes a stop codon between a tag element and an insertion element or ORF, which can be useful for translating an ORF with or without the tag.
  • Mutant tRNA molecules that recognize stop codons (described above) suppress translation termination and thereby are designated "suppressor tRNAs.” Suppressor tRNAs can result in the insertion of amino acids and continuation of translation past stop codons (e.g., U.S. Patent Application No. 60/587,583, filed July 14, 2004, entitled “Production of Fusion Proteins by Cell-Free Protein Synthesis,"; Eggertsson, et al., (1988) Microbiological Review 52(3):354-374, and Engleerg-Kukla, et al.
  • suppressor tRNAs are known, including but not limited to, supE, supP, supD, supF and supZ suppressors, which suppress the termination of translation of the amber stop codon; supB, glT, supL, supN, supC and supM suppressors, which suppress the function of the ochre stop codon and glyT, trpT and Su-9 suppressors, which suppress the function of the opal stop codon.
  • supE, supP, supD, supF and supZ suppressors which suppress the termination of translation of the amber stop codon
  • supB, glT, supL, supN, supC and supM suppressors which suppress the function of the ochre stop codon and glyT, trpT and Su-9 suppressors, which suppress the function of the opal stop codon.
  • suppressor tRNAs contain one or more mutations in the anti-codon loop of the tRNA that allows the tRNA to base pair with a codon that ordinarily functions as a stop codon.
  • the mutant tRNA is charged with its cognate amino acid residue and the cognate amino acid residue is inserted into the translating polypeptide when the stop codon is encountered. Mutations that enhance the efficiency of termination suppressors (i.e., increase stop codon read- through) have been identified.
  • mutations in the uar gene also known as the prfA gene
  • mutations in the ups gene mutations in the sueA, sueB and sueC genes
  • mutations in the rpsD ramA
  • rpsE spcA genes
  • mutations in the rplL gene include, but are not limited to, mutations in the uar gene (also known as the prfA gene), mutations in the ups gene, mutations in the sueA, sueB and sueC genes, mutations in the rpsD (ramA) and rpsE (spcA) genes and mutations in the rplL gene.
  • a nucleic acid composition comprising a stop codon located between an ORF and a tag can yield a translated ORF alone when no suppressor tRNA is present in the translation system, and can yield a translated ORF -tag fusion when a suppressor tRNA is present in the system.
  • the stop codon is located 3' of an insertion element or ORF and 5' of a tag, and the stop codon sometimes is an amber codon.
  • Suppressor tRNA sometimes are within a cell-free extract (e.g., the cell-free extract is prepared from cells that produce the suppressor tRNA), sometimes are added to the cell-free extract as isolated molecules, and sometimes are added to a cell- free extract as part of another extract.
  • a provided suppressor tRNA sometimes is loaded with one of the twenty naturally occurring amino acids or an unnatural amino acid (described herein).
  • Suppressor tRNA can be generated in cells transfected with a nucleic acid encoding the tRNA (e.g., a replication incompetent adenovirus containing the human tRNA- Ser suppressor gene can be transfected into cells).
  • Vectors for synthesizing suppressor tRNA and for translating ORFs with or without a tag are available to the artisan (e.g., Tag-On-DemandTM kit (Invitrogen Corporation, California); Tag-On-DemandTM Suppressor Supernatant Instruction Manual, Version B, 6 June 2003, at http address www.invitrogen.com/content/sfs/ manuals/tagondemand _supernatant_man.pdf; Tag-On-DemandTM Gateway® Vector Instruction Manual, Version B, 20 June, 2003 at http address www.invitrogen.com/content/sfs/ manuals/tagondemand vectors man.pdf; and Capone et al., Amber, ochre and opal suppressor tRNA genes derived from a human serine tRNA gene. EMBO J. 4:213, 1985).
  • Any convenient cloning strategy known to the artisan may be utilized to incorporate an element, such as an ORF, into a nucleic acid composition.
  • Known methods can be utilized to insert an element into the template independent of an insertion element, such as (1) cleaving the template at one or more existing restriction enzyme sites and ligating an element of interest and (2) adding restriction enzyme sites to the template by hybridizing oligonucleotide primers that include one or more suitable restriction enzyme sites and amplifying by polymerase chain reaction (described in greater detail herein).
  • Other cloning strategies take advantage of one or more insertion sites present or inserted into the nucleic acid composition, such as an oligonucleotide primer hybridization site for PCR, for example, and others described hereafter.
  • the nucleic acid composition includes one or more recombinase insertion sites.
  • a recombinase insertion site is a recognition sequence on a nucleic acid molecule that participates in an integration/recombination reaction by recombination proteins.
  • the recombination site for Cre recombinase is loxP, which is a 34 base pair sequence comprised of two 13 base pair inverted repeats (serving as the recombinase binding sites) flanking an 8 base pair core sequence (e.g., Figure 1 of Sauer, B., Curr. Opin. Biotech. 5:521-527 (1994)).
  • recombination sites include attB, attP, attL, and attR sequences, and mutants, fragments, variants and derivatives thereof, which are recognized by the recombination protein ⁇ Int and by the auxiliary proteins integration host factor (IHF), FIS and excisionase (Xis) (e.g., U.S. Patent Nos. 5,888,732; 6,143,557; 6,171,861; 6,270,969; 6,277,608; and 6,720,140; U.S. Patent Appln. Nos. 09/517,466, filed March 2, 2000, and 09/732,914, filed August 14, 2003, and in U.S. patent publication no.
  • IHF auxiliary proteins integration host factor
  • Xis excisionase
  • recombinase cloning nucleic acids are in Gateway® systems (Invitrogen, California), which include at least one recombination site for cloning a desired nucleic acid molecules in vivo or in vitro.
  • Gateway® systems Invitrogen, California
  • the system utilizes vectors that contain at least two different site- specific recombination sites, often based on the bacteriophage lambda system (e.g., attl and att2), and are mutated from the wild-type (attO) sites.
  • Each mutated site has a unique specificity for its cognate partner att site (i.e., its binding partner recombination site) of the same type (for example attBl with attPl, or attLl with attRl) and will not cross-react with recombination sites of the other mutant type or with the wild-type attO site.
  • Different site specificities allow directional cloning or linkage of desired molecules thus providing desired orientation of the cloned molecules.
  • Nucleic acid fragments flanked by recombination sites are cloned and subcloned using the Gateway® system by replacing a selectable marker (for example, ccdB) flanked by att sites on the recipient plasmid molecule, sometimes termed the Destination Vector. Desired clones are then selected by transformation of a ccdB sensitive host strain and positive selection for a marker on the recipient molecule. Similar strategies for negative selection (e.g., use of toxic genes) can be used in other organisms such as thymidine kinase (TK) in mammals and insects.
  • TK thymidine kinase
  • the nucleic acid composition includes one or more topoisomerase insertion sites.
  • a topoisomerase insertion site is a defined nucleotide sequence recognized and bound by a site- specific topoisomerase.
  • the nucleotide sequence 5'-(C/T)CCTT-3' is a topoisomerase recognition site bound specifically by most poxvirus topoisomerases, including vaccinia virus DNA topoisomerase I.
  • the topoisomerase After binding to the recognition sequence, the topoisomerase cleaves the strand at the 3'- most thymidine of the recognition site to produce a nucleotide sequence comprising 5'-(C/T)CCTT-PO 4 - TOPO, a complex of the topoisomerase covalently bound to the 3' phosphate via a tyrosine in the topoisomerase (e.g., Shuman, J. Biol. Chem. 266: 11372-11379, 1991; Sekiguchi and Shuman, Nucl. Acids Res. 22:5360-5365, 1994; U.S. Pat. No. 5,766,891; PCT/US95/16099; and PCT/US98/12372).
  • a complex of the topoisomerase covalently bound to the 3' phosphate via a tyrosine in the topoisomerase
  • nucleotide sequence 5'-GCAACTT-3' is a topoisomerase recognition site for type IA E. coli topoisomerase III.
  • An element to be inserted often is combined with topoisomerase-reacted template and thereby incorporated into the nucleic acid composition (e.g., http address www.invitrogen.com/downloads/F- 13512_Topo_Flyer.pdf; http address at ww.invitrogen.eom/content/sfs/brochures/710 021849%20_B_TOPOCloning_bro.pdf; TOPO TA Cloning® Kit and Zero Blunt® TOPO® Cloning Kit product information).
  • a nucleic acid composition sometimes contains one or more origin of replication (ORI) elements.
  • a template comprises two or more ORIs, where one functions efficiently in one organism (e.g., a bacterium) and another functions efficiently in another organism (e.g., a eukaryote).
  • an ORI may function efficiently in insect cells and another ORI may function efficiently in mammalian cells.
  • a nucleic acid composition also sometimes includes one or more transcription regulation sites.
  • a nucleic acid composition often includes one or more selection elements. Selection elements often are utilized using known processes to determine whether a nucleic acid composition is included in a cell. In some embodiments, a nucleic acid composition includes two or more selection elements, where one functions efficiently in one organisms and another functions efficiently in another organism.
  • selection elements include, but are not limited to, (1) nucleic acid segments that encode products that provide resistance against otherwise toxic compounds (e.g., antibiotics); (2) nucleic acid segments that encode products that are otherwise lacking in the recipient cell (e.g., essential products, tRNA genes, auxotrophic markers); (3) nucleic acid segments that encode products that suppress the activity of a gene product; (4) nucleic acid segments that encode products that can be readily identified (e.g., phenotypic markers such as antibiotics (e.g., ⁇ -lactamase), ⁇ -galactosidase, green fluorescent protein (GFP), yellow fluorescent protein (YFP), red fluorescent protein (RFP), cyan fluorescent protein (CFP), and cell surface proteins); (5) nucleic acid segments that bind products that are otherwise detrimental to cell survival and/or function; (6) nucleic acid segments that otherwise inhibit the activity of any of the nucleic acid segments described in Nos.
  • antibiotics e.g., ⁇ -lactamase), ⁇ -galacto
  • nucleic acid segments that bind products that modify a substrate e.g., restriction endonucleases
  • nucleic acid segments that can be used to isolate or identify a desired molecule e.g., specific protein binding sites
  • nucleic acid segments that encode a specific nucleotide sequence that can be otherwise non-functional e.g., for PCR amplification of subpopulations of molecules
  • nucleic acid segments that, when absent, directly or indirectly confer resistance or sensitivity to particular compounds (11) nucleic acid segments that encode products that either are toxic (e.g., Diphtheria toxin) or convert a relatively non-toxic compound to a toxic compound (e.g., Herpes simplex thymidine kinase, cytosine deaminase) in recipient cells; (12) nucleic acid segments that inhibit replication, partition or heritability of nucleic acid molecules that contain them
  • nucleic acid composition elements such as the promoter, 5'UTR, target sequence, or 3'UTR elements, to enhance or potentially enhance transcription and/or translation before or after such elements are incorporated in a nucleic acid composition.
  • one or more of the following sequences may be modified or removed if they are present in a 5'UTR: a sequence that forms a stable secondary structure (e.g., quadruplex structure or stem loop stem structure (e.g., EMBL sequences X12949, AF274954, AF139980, AF152961, S95936, U194144, AFl 16649 or substantially identical sequences that form such stem loop stem structures)); a translation initiation codon upstream of the target nucleotide sequence start codon; a stop codon upstream of the target nucleotide sequence translation initiation codon; an ORF upstream of the target nucleotide sequence translation initiation codon; an iron responsive element (IRE) or like sequence; and a 5' terminal oligopyrimidine tract (TOP, e.g., consisting of 5-15 pyrimidines adjacent to the cap).
  • a stable secondary structure e.g., quadruplex structure or stem loop stem structure (e.g
  • a translational enhancer sequence and/or an internal ribosome entry site sometimes is inserted into a 5'UTR (e.g., EMBL nucleotide sequences J04513, X87949, M95825, M12783, AF025841, AF013263, AF006822, M17169, M13440, M22427, D14838 and M17446 and substantially identical nucleotide sequences).
  • An AU-rich element e.g., AUUUA repeats
  • splicing junction that follows a non-sense codon sometimes is removed from or modified in a 3'UTR.
  • a polyadenosine tail sometimes is inserted into a 3'UTR if none is present, sometimes is removed if it is present, and adenosine moieties sometimes are added to or removed from a polyadenosine tail present in a 3'UTR.
  • some embodiments are directed to a process comprising: determining whether any nucleotide sequences that reduce or potentially reduce translation efficiency are present in the elements, and removing or modifying one or more of such sequences if they are identified.
  • Certain embodiments are directed to a process comprising: determining whether any nucleotide sequences that increase or potentially increase translation efficiency are not present in the elements, and incorporating such sequences into the nucleic acid composition.
  • An ORF sometimes is mutated or modified (for example, by point mutation, deletion mutation, insertion mutation, and the like) to alter, enhance or increase, reduce, substantially reduce or eliminate the activity of the encoded protein or peptide.
  • the protein or peptide encoded by a modified ORF sometimes is produced in a lower amount or may not be produced at detectable levels, and in other embodiments, the product or protein encoded by the modified ORF is produced at a higher level (e.g., codons sometimes are modified so they are compatible with tRNA in cells used to prepare a cell-free extract).
  • codons sometimes are modified so they are compatible with tRNA in cells used to prepare a cell-free extract.
  • a stop codon at the end of an ORF sometimes is modified to another stop codon, such as an amber stop codon described above.
  • a stop codon is introduced within an ORF, sometimes by insertion or mutation of an existing codon.
  • An ORF comprising a modified terminal stop codon and/or internal stop codon often is translated in a system comprising a suppressor tRNA that recognizes the stop codon.
  • An ORF comprising a stop codon sometimes is translated in a system comprising a suppressor tRNA that incorporates an unnatural amino acid during translation of the target protein or target peptide.
  • Methods for incorporating unnatural amino acids into a target protein or peptide include, for example, processes utilizing a heterologous tRNA/synthetase pair, where the tRNA recognizes an amber stop codon and is loaded with an unnatural amino acid (e.g., http address www.iupac.org/news/prize/2003/wang.pdf). Examples of unnatural amino acids are described above.
  • a nucleic acid composition is of any form useful for in vitro or in vivo transcription and/or translation.
  • a nucleic acid sometimes is a plasmid, such as a supercoiled plasmid, sometimes is a linear nucleic acid (e.g., a linear nucleic acid produced by PCR or by restriction digest), sometimes is single-stranded and sometimes is double-stranded.
  • a nucleic acid composition for transcription and/or translation can be prepared by any suitable process.
  • a nucleic acid composition sometimes is prepared by an amplification process, such as a polymerase chain reaction (PCR) process or transcription-mediated amplification process (TMA).
  • PCR polymerase chain reaction
  • TMA transcription-mediated amplification process
  • TMA two enzymes are used in an isothermal reaction to produce amplification products detected by light emission (see, e.g., Biochemistry 1996 Jun 25;35(25):8429-38 and http address www. devicelink.com/ivdt/archive/OO/ 11/007. html).
  • Standard PCR processes are known (e.g., U. S. Patent Nos. 4,683,202; 4,683,195; 4,965,188; and 5,656,493), and generally are performed in cycles. Each cycle includes heat denaturation, in which hybrid nucleic acids dissociate; cooling, in which primer oligonucleotides hybridize; and extension of the oligonucleotides by a polymerase (i.e., Taq polymerase).
  • a polymerase i.e., Taq polymerase
  • PCR amplification products sometimes are stored for a time at a lower temperature (e.g., at 4°C) and sometimes are frozen (e.g., at -20 0 C) before analysis.
  • a nucleic acid of other molecule described herein is isolated or purified.
  • isolated refers to material removed from its original environment (e.g., the natural environment if it is naturally occurring, or a host cell if expressed exogenously), and thus is altered “by the hand of man” from its original environment.
  • purified as used herein with reference to molecules does not refer to absolute purity. Rather, “purified” refers to a substance in a composition that contains fewer substance species in the same class (e.g., nucleic acid or protein species) other than the substance of interest in comparison to the sample from which it originated.
  • nucleic acid or protein refers to a substance in a composition that contains fewer nucleic acid species or protein species other than the nucleic acid or protein of interest in comparison to the sample from which it originated.
  • a protein or nucleic acid is “substantially pure,” indicating that the protein or nucleic acid represents at least 50% of protein or nucleic acid on a mass basis of the composition.
  • a substantially pure protein or nucleic acid is at least 75% on a mass basis of the composition, and sometimes at least 95% on a mass basis of the composition.
  • nucleic acid compositions can be included in nucleic acid compositions, as selected for an application of the nucleic acid composition by the person of ordinary skill in the art. Certain sequences described in the section below entitled “Nucleic Acid Transfer to Antigen Presenting Cells,” which include viral nucleotide sequences, sometimes are included in nucleic acid compositions.
  • APC antigen presenting cell
  • APC encompasses any cell capable of handling and presenting an antigen to lymphocytes.
  • APCs include, e.g., macrophages, Langerhans dendritic cells and Follicular dendritic cells.
  • B cells have also been shown to have an antigen presenting function and are thus contemplated by the present invention.
  • the APCs often are dendritic cells.
  • a “dendritic cell” (DC) is an APC with a characteristic morphology including lamellipodia extending from the dendritic cell body in several directions.
  • Dendritic cells are able to initiate primary, antigen-specific T cell responses both in vitro and in vivo, and direct a strong mixed leukocyte reaction (MLR) compared to peripheral blood leukocytes, splenocytes, B cells and monocytes.
  • MLR mixed leukocyte reaction
  • DCs can be derived from a number of different hematopoietic precursor cells.
  • APCs can be isolated from any of the tissues where they reside and which are known to those of skill in the art.
  • dendritic cells and their progenitors may be obtained from any tissue source comprising dendritic cell precursors that are capable of proliferating and maturing in vitro into dendritic cells, when cultured and induced to mature according to the methods of the present invention.
  • tissue sources include, e.g., peripheral blood, bone marrow, tumor-infiltrating cells, peritumoral tissues-infiltrating cells, lymph node biopsies, thymus, spleen, skin, umbilical cord blood, monocytes harvested from peripheral blood, CD34 or CD 14 positive cells harvested from peripheral blood, blood marrow or any other suitable tissue or fluid.
  • Dendritic cells sometimes are isolated from bone marrow or from peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMCs).
  • PBMCs peripheral blood mononuclear cells
  • PBMCs can then be prepared from whole blood samples by separating mononuclear cells from red blood cells.
  • There are a number of methods for isolating PBMCs including, e.g., velocity sedimentation, isopyknic sedimentation, affinity purification, and flow cytometry.
  • PBMCs are separated from red blood cells by density gradient (isopyknic) centrifugation, in which the cells sediment to an equilibrium position in the solution equivalent to their own density.
  • Density gradient centrifugation physiological media should be used, the density of the solution should be high, and the media should exert little osmotic pressure.
  • Density gradient centrifugation uses solutions such as sodium ditrizoate-polysucrose, Ficoll, dextran, and Percoll (see, e.g., Freshney, Culture of Animal Cells, 3rd ed. (1994)). Such solutions are commercially available, e.g., HISTOPAQUE.RTM. (Sigma). Examples of methods for isolating dendritic cells from PBMCs are disclosed in, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos.
  • CD34+ PBMCs or CD 14+ PBMCs can further be selected as a source of dendritic cells using a variety of selection techniques known to those of skill in the art.
  • monoclonal antibodies or any protein-specific binding protein
  • a cell surface antigen found on the surface of the PBMC sub-population of interest e.g., CD34 or CD 14 on the surface of CD34+ or CD 14+ PBMCs, respectively. Binding of such specific monoclonal antibodies allows the identification and isolation of the sub-group of PBMCs of interest from a total PBMC population by any of a number of immunoaffinity methods known to those of skill in the art. Examples of immunoaffinity methods for isolating sub- populations of PBMCs are described in, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 6,017,527.
  • the dendritic cells of the present invention can be isolated from bone marrow.
  • dendritic cells from bone marrow can typically be obtained from a number of different sources, including, for example, from aspirated marrow.
  • bone marrow can be extracted from a sacrificed animal by dissecting out the femur, removing soft tissue from the bone and removing the bone marrow with a needle and syringe.
  • Dendritic cells can be identified among the different cell types present in the bone marrow based on their morphological characteristics. For example, cultured immature dendritic cells in one or more phases of their development are loosely adherent to plastic, flattening out with a stellate shape.
  • the tissue source prior to culturing the cells, can be pre-treated to remove cells that may compete with the proliferation and/or the survival of the dendritic cells or of their precursors. Examples of such pre-treatments are described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. No. 5,994,126.
  • APCs can be cultured for any suitable amount of time.
  • Antigen presenting cells often are cultured from 4 to 15 days, can be cultured for 10-12 days (Lutz et al., supra) and may be cultured for 5-7 days (Inaba et al., J. Exp. Med. 176: 1693 (1992); Inaba et al., J. Exp. Med. 175:1157 (1992); Inaba et al., Current Protocols Immunol., Unit 3.7 (Coico et al., eds. 1998); Schneider et al., J. Immunol. Meth. 154:253 (1992)).
  • a cell culture environment includes consideration of such factors as the substrate for cell growth, cell density and cell contract, the gas phase, the medium, the temperature, and the presence of growth factors (see, e.g., Freshney et al., Culture of Animal Cells, 3rd ed. (1994)).
  • Cells can be grown under conditions that provide for cell to cell contact, and may be grown in suspension as three dimensional aggregates.
  • Suspension cultures can be achieved by using, e.g., a flask with a magnetic stirrer or a large surface area paddle, or on a plate that has been coated to prevent the cells from adhering to the bottom of the dish.
  • the cells may be grown in Costar dishes that have been coated with a hydrogel to prevent them from adhering to the bottom of the dish.
  • plastic dishes, flasks, roller bottles, or microcarriers are typically used.
  • Other artificial substrates can be used such as glass and metals.
  • the substrate is often treated by etching, or by coating with substances such as collagen, chondronectin, fibronectin, laminin or poly-L-lysine.
  • the type of culture vessel depends on the culture conditions, e.g., multi-well plates, petri dishes, tissue culture tubes, flasks, roller bottles, microcarriers, and the like. Cells are grown at optimal densities that are determined empirically based on the cell type.
  • Important constituents of the gas phase are oxygen and carbon dioxide.
  • atmospheric oxygen tensions are used for dendritic cell cultures.
  • Culture vessels are usually vented into the incubator atmosphere to allow gas exchange by using gas permeable caps or by preventing sealing of the culture vessels.
  • Carbon dioxide plays a role in pH stabilization, along with buffer in the cell media, and is typically present at a concentration of 1-10% in the incubator.
  • the CO. sub.2 concentration for dendritic cell cultures often is 5%.
  • Cultured cells are normally grown in an incubator that provides a suitable temperature, e.g., the body temperature of the animal from which is the cells were obtained, accounting for regional variations in temperature. Generally, 37.degree. C. often is the temperature for dendritic cell culture. Most incubators are humidified to approximately atmospheric conditions.
  • cell media are available as packaged, premixed powders or presterilized solutions. Examples of commonly used media include Iscove's media, RPMI 1640, DMEM, and McCoy's Medium (see, e.g., GibcoBRL/Life Technologies Catalogue and Reference Guide; Sigma Catalogue).
  • cell culture media are often supplemented with 5-20% serum, e.g., human, horse, calf, or fetal bovine serum. The culture medium is usually buffered to maintain the cells at a pH often from about 7.2 to about 7.4. Other supplements to the media include, e.g., antibiotics, amino acids, sugars, and growth factors (see, e.g., Lutz et al., supra).
  • GM-CSF sometimes is in concentrations ranging from 5 ng/ml to about 20 ng/ml in a culture medium. Other factors described herein and known to stimulate growth of dendritic cells may be included in the culture medium. Some factors will have different effects that are dependent upon the stage of differentiation of the cells, which can be monitored by testing for differentiation markers specific for the cell's stage in the differentiation pathway. GM-CSF can be included in the medium throughout culturing.
  • G-CSF granulocyte colony-stimulating factor
  • M-CSF granulocyte colony-stimulating factor
  • TNF-.alpha. granulocyte colony-stimulating factor
  • IFN-.gamma. IL-I
  • IL-3 IL-3
  • IL-6 IL-6
  • SCF senorized fibroblasts
  • LPS thrombopoietin
  • the culture medium 4 may be present in the culture medium, sometimes at a concentration ranging from 1-100 ng/ml or about
  • Dendritic cells can be recovered and used after cryogenic storage. Precultured DCs can be cryogenically stored, e.g., in liquid nitrogen, for several weeks or months or years. Dendritic cells may be cultured in the presence of GM-CSF, sometimes for about 10 days, prior to being stored cryogenically. The DCs can be stored either as immature cells or as matured APCs, following stimulation by suitable adjuvants, as described herein. Dendritic cells can be cryogenically stored before or following exposure to an antigen of interest.
  • cryopreservation agents can be used and are described in, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,788,963. Controlling the cooling rate, adding cryoprotective agents and/or limiting the heat of fusion phase where water turns to ice help preserve the function of the activated DCs.
  • the cooling procedure can be carried out by use of, e.g., a programmable freezing device or a methanol bath procedure. After thorough freezing, cells can be rapidly transferred to a long-term cryogenic storage vessel.
  • the samples can be cryogenically stored, for example, in liquid nitrogen (-196. degree. C.) or its vapor (-165. degree. C). Such storage is facilitated by the availability of highly efficient liquid nitrogen refrigerators.
  • liquid nitrogen -196. degree. C.
  • vapor -165. degree. C
  • GM- CSF has been found to promote the proliferation in vitro of both nonadherent immature dendritic cells and adherent macrophages (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,994,126; and Lutz et al., supra).
  • Precursor dendritic cells sometimes are cultured in the presence of GM-CSF at a concentration sufficient to promote survival and proliferation.
  • GM-CSF concentration sometimes is of about 1 ng/ml to 100 ng/ml, and at times about 5 ng/ml to about 20 ng/ml.
  • GM-CSF can be obtained from different sources well known to those of skill in the art (see, e.g., Lutz et al., supra; and U.S. Pat. No. 5,994,126).
  • Cytokines that can be used to enhance maturation of dendritic cells ex vivo include, but are not limited to, TNF-alpha, stem cell factor (SCF; also named c-kit ligand, steel factor (SF), mast cell growth factor (MGF); see, e.g., EP 423,980; and U.S. Pat. No.
  • G-CSF granulocyte colony-stimulating factor
  • M-CSF monocyte- macrophage colony-stimulating factor
  • interleukins such as, e.g., IL- l.alpha. and IL-I. beta., IL-3, IL-4, IL-6, and IL- 13 (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 6,017,527 and 5,994,126).
  • some interleukins e.g., IL-4 have been shown to suppresses the overall growth of macrophages and thus favors higher levels of pure DC growth.
  • Cytokines are used in amounts which are effective in increasing the proportion of dendritic cells present in the culture by enhancing either the proliferation or the survival of dendritic cell precursors.
  • dendritic cells and precursors are cultured in the presence of GM-CSF, and sometimes are cultured in the presence of GM-CSF and IL-4.
  • the GM-CSF is sometimes is human GM-CSF (huGM-CSF).
  • Adjuvants also can be used to stimulate the maturation ex vivo of immature dendritic cells.
  • immature dendritic cells can be harvested from the induction cultures described supra and their maturation to end-stage antigen presenting cells can be induced by treating the cells with a variety of adjuvants.
  • Adjuvants that promote maturation of dendritic cells include, but are not limited to, MPL.RTM. immunostimulant and selected synthetic lipid A analogs such as aminoalkyl glucosamide phosphate (AGP).
  • Synthetic lipid A analogs include, for example, lipid A monosaccharide synthetics such as RC- 529, RC-544 and RC-527, and the disaccharide mimetic, RC-511.
  • adjuvants can be used as 10% ethanol-in- water formulations, although any other formulation that promotes the maturation of dendritic cells is suitable for use with the methods of the present invention.
  • Adjuvants can be synthesized or obtained from a variety of sources (see, e.g., Lutz et al., supra; Johnson et al., Bioorganic Medicinal Chemistry Letters 9:2273-2278 (1999)). Maturation of dendritic cells sometimes is induced using MPL or AGP in certain embodiments.
  • Maturation of DCs can be assessed by monitoring a number of molecular markers and cell surface phenotypic alterations. These changes can be analyzed, for example, using flow cytometry techniques. Maturation markers can be labeled using specific antibodies and DCs expressing a marker or a set of markers of interest can be separated from the total DC population using, for example, cell sorting FACS analysis. Markers of DC maturation include genes that are expressed at higher levels in mature DCs compared to immature DCs.
  • Such markers include, but are not limited to, cell surface MHC Class II antigens (in particular HLA-DR), ICAM-I, B7-2, costimulating molecules such as CD40, CD80, CD86, CD83, cell trafficking molecules such as CD54, CDl Ib, CD 18, and the like.
  • Mature dendritic cells also can be identified based on their ability to stimulate the proliferation of naive allogeneic T cells in a mixed leukocyte reaction (MLR).
  • MLR mixed leukocyte reaction
  • the antigen presenting function of dendritic cells can be used to determine the degree of maturation.
  • the antigen presenting function of a dendritic cell can be measured using antigen-dependent, MHC-restricted T cell activation assays as described herein, as well as other standard assays well known to those of skill in the art. T cell activation can further be determined, e.g., by measuring the induction of cytokine production by the stimulated dendritic cells. Stimulation of cytokine production can be quantified using a variety of standard techniques, such as ELISA, known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
  • a DC utilized in a composition or process described herein can be a mature DC, an immature DC, a DC having one or more particular cell markers, a DC contacted with one or more cytokines, a DC contacted with an adjuvant, a DC from a particular source (e.g., bone marrow), a DC contacted with cell culture conditions, and/or a DC contacted with cryogenic conditions, for example, in certain embodiments.
  • Transgene expression in cells requires transfer of a nucleotide sequence encoding the transgene into the cell.
  • Viral and non- viral methods of gene transfer are known to the person of ordinary skill in the art.
  • the nucleic acid is complexed to a cationic polymer.
  • Cationic polymers which are water-soluble complexes, are known in the art and have been utilized in delivery systems for DNA plasmids. This strategy employs the use of a soluble system, which conveys nucleic acid into cells via receptor-mediated endocytosis (Wu & Wu 1988).
  • Complexing nucleic acids with a cationic polymer can neutralize negative charge of the nucleic acid, which facilitates increased endocytic uptake.
  • Examples of cationic polymers include, but are not limited to, polylysine, polyethyleneimine, polyhistidine, protamine, polyvinylamines, polyvinylpyridine, polymethacrylates, and polyornithine.
  • the nucleic acid is entrapped in a liposome.
  • Liposomes are vesicular structures characterized by a phospholipid bilayer membrane and an inner aqueous medium. Multilamellar liposomes have multiple lipid layers separated by aqueous medium. They form spontaneously when phospholipids are suspended in an excess of aqueous solution. Lipid components undergo self- rearrangement before the formation of closed structures and entrap water and dissolved solutes between the lipid bilayers (Ghosh and Bachhawat, 1991).
  • Liposome-mediated nucleic acid delivery and expression of foreign DNA in vitro has been very successful.
  • Wong et al. (1980) demonstrated the feasibility of liposome- mediated delivery and expression of foreign DNA in cultured chick embryo, HeLa, and hepatoma cells.
  • Nicolau et al. (1987) accomplished successful liposome-mediated gene transfer in rats after intravenous injection.
  • various commercial approaches involving "lipofection" technology are also included.
  • the liposome is complexed with a hemagglutinating virus (HVJ). This has been shown to facilitate fusion with the cell membrane and promote cell entry of liposome-encapsulated DNA (Kaneda et al., 1989).
  • HVJ hemagglutinating virus
  • the liposome is complexed or employed in conjunction with nuclear nonhistone chromosomal proteins (HMG-I) (Kato et al., 1991).
  • HMG-I nuclear nonhistone chromosomal proteins
  • the liposome is complexed or employed in conjunction with both HVJ and HMG- 1. In that such expression constructs have been successfully employed in transfer and expression of nucleic acid in vitro and in vivo, then they are applicable for the present invention.
  • the delivery vehicle may comprise a ligand and a liposome.
  • a ligand and a liposome For example, Nicolau et al., (1987) employed lactosyl-ceramide, a galactose-terminal asialganglioside, incorporated into liposomes and observed an increase in the uptake of the insulin gene by hepatocytes.
  • a nucleic acid encoding a therapeutic gene also is specifically delivered into a cell type such as prostate, epithelial or tumor cells, by any number of receptor- ligand systems with or without liposomes.
  • the human prostate- specific antigen (Watt et al., 1986) is used as the receptor for mediated delivery of a nucleic acid in prostate tissue.
  • the expression construct may simply consist of naked recombinant DNA or plasmids. Transfer of the construct is performed by any of the methods mentioned above which physically or chemically permeabilize the cell membrane. This is applicable particularly for transfer in vitro, however, it is applied for in vivo use as well.
  • Dubensky et al., (1984) successfully injected polyomavirus DNA in the form of CaPO4 precipitates into liver and spleen of adult and newborn mice demonstrating active viral replication and acute infection. Benvenisty and Neshif (1986) also demonstrated that direct intraperitoneal injection of CaPU 4 precipitated plasmids results in expression of the transfected genes. It is envisioned that DNA encoding a CAM also is transferred in a similar manner in vivo and express CAM.
  • Another embodiment of the invention for transferring a naked DNA expression construct into cells may involve particle bombardment. This method depends on the ability to accelerate DNA coated microprojectiles to a high velocity by application of a propulsion force, allowing them to pierce cell membranes and enter cells without killing them (Klein et al., 1987).
  • Several devices for accelerating small particles have been developed. One such device relies on a high voltage discharge to generate an electrical current, which in turn provides the motive force (Yang et al., 1990).
  • the microprojectiles used have consisted of biologically inert substances such as tungsten or gold beads.
  • Viral vectors also may be utilized to effect nucleic acid transfer to cells.
  • a transgene is incorporated into a viral particle to mediate gene transfer to a cell.
  • the resulting virus often is exposed to the appropriate host cell under physiologic conditions, permitting uptake of the virus.
  • Such methods are advantageously employed using a variety of viral vectors, as discussed hereafter.
  • Adenovirus sometimes referred to herein as "Ad,” is particularly suitable for use as a gene transfer vector because of its mid-sized DNA genome, ease of manipulation, high titer, wide target-cell range, and high infectivity.
  • the roughly 36 kB viral genome is bounded by 100-200 base pair (bp) inverted terminal repeats (ITR), in which are contained cis-acting elements necessary for viral DNA replication and packaging.
  • ITR inverted terminal repeats
  • the early (E) and late (L) regions of the genome that contain different transcription units are divided by the onset of viral DNA replication.
  • the El region (ElA and ElB) encodes proteins responsible for the regulation of transcription of the viral genome and a few cellular genes.
  • E2A and E2B results in the synthesis of the proteins for viral DNA replication. These proteins are involved in DNA replication, late gene expression, and host cell shut off (Renan, 1990).
  • the products of the late genes (Ll, L2, L3, L4 and L5), including the majority of the viral capsid proteins, are expressed only after significant processing of a single primary transcript issued by the major late promoter (MLP).
  • MLP located at 16.8 map units
  • TL tripartite leader
  • Adenovirus often is optimized for immunotherapy by maximizing its carrying capacity so that large segments of DNA can be included.
  • Large displacement of DNA is possible in adenovirus because the cis elements required for viral DNA replication all are localized in the inverted terminal repeats (ITR) (100- 200 bp) at either end of the linear viral genome. Plasmids containing ITR's can replicate in the presence of a non-defective adenovirus (Hay et al., 1984). Therefore, inclusion of these elements in an adenoviral vector should permit replication.
  • ITR inverted terminal repeats
  • Toxicity and immunologic reaction associated with certain adenoviral products also are minimized for immunotherapy applications.
  • the two goals are, to an extent, coterminous in that elimination of adenoviral genes serves both ends. It is possible achieve both these goals while retaining the ability to manipulate the therapeutic constructs with relative ease.
  • the packaging signal for viral encapsidation is localized between 194-385 bp (0.5-1.1 map units) at the left end of the viral genome (Hearing et al., 1987).
  • This signal mimics the protein recognition site in bacteriophage .lambda. DNA where a specific sequence close to the left end, but outside the cohesive end sequence, mediates the binding to proteins that are required for insertion of the DNA into the head structure.
  • El substitution vectors of Ad have demonstrated that a 450 bp (0-1.25 map units) fragment at the left end of the viral genome could direct packaging in 293 cells (Levrero et al., 1991).
  • adenoviral genome can be incorporated into the genome of mammalian cells and the genes encoded thereby expressed. These cell lines are capable of supporting the replication of an adenoviral vector that is deficient in the adenoviral function encoded by the cell line. There also have been reports of complementation of replication deficient adenoviral vectors by "helping" vectors, e.g., wild-type virus or conditionally defective mutants.
  • Replication-deficient adenoviral vectors can be complemented, in trans, by helper virus. This observation alone does not permit isolation of the replication-deficient vectors, however, since the presence of helper virus, needed to provide replicative functions, would contaminate any preparation. Thus, an additional element was needed that would add specificity to the replication and/or packaging of the replication-deficient vector. That element, as provided for in the present invention, derives from the packaging function of adenovirus.
  • helper viruses that are packaged with varying efficiencies.
  • the mutations are point mutations or deletions.
  • helper viruses with low efficiency packaging are grown in helper cells, the virus is packaged, albeit at reduced rates compared to wild- type virus, thereby permitting propagation of the helper.
  • helper viruses are grown in cells along with virus that contains wild-type packaging signals, however, the wild-type packaging signals are recognized preferentially over the mutated versions.
  • the virus containing the wild- type signals are packaged selectively when compared to the helpers. If the preference is great enough, stocks approaching homogeneity should be achieved.
  • Retrovirus also are useful for transferring Akt-encoding nucleotide sequences into cells.
  • Retroviruses are a group of single-stranded RNA viruses characterized by an ability to convert their RNA to double- stranded DNA in infected cells by a process of reverse-transcription (Coffin, 1990). The resulting DNA then stably integrates into cellular chromosomes as a provirus and directs synthesis of viral proteins. The integration results in the retention of the viral gene sequences in the recipient cell and its descendants.
  • the retroviral genome contains three genes— gag, pol and env— that code for capsid proteins, polymerase enzyme, and envelope components, respectively.
  • a sequence found upstream from the gag gene functions as a signal for packaging of the genome into virions.
  • Two long terminal repeat (LTR) sequences are present at the 5' and 3' ends of the viral genome. These contain strong promoter and enhancer sequences and also are required for integration in the host cell genome (Coffin, 1990).
  • a nucleic acid encoding a promoter is inserted into the viral genome in the place of certain viral sequences to produce a virus that is replication-defective.
  • a packaging cell line containing the gag, pol and env genes but without the LTR and .psi. components is constructed (Mann et al., 1983).
  • a recombinant plasmid containing a human cDNA, together with the retroviral LTR and .psi. sequences is introduced into this cell line (by calcium phosphate precipitation for example), the .psi.
  • Retroviral vectors are able to infect a broad variety of cell types. However, integration and stable expression of many types of retroviruses require the division of host cells (Paskind et al., 1975).
  • An approach designed to allow specific targeting of retrovirus vectors recently was developed based on the chemical modification of a retrovirus by the chemical addition of galactose residues to the viral envelope. This modification could permit the specific infection of cells such as hepatocytes via asialoglycoprotein receptors, should this be desired.
  • Adeno-associated virus also referred to herein as "AAV” also may be utilized to transfer Akt- encoding nucleotide sequences into cells.
  • AAV utilizes a linear, single- stranded DNA of about 4700 base pairs. Inverted terminal repeats flank the genome. Two genes are present within the genome, giving rise to a number of distinct gene products. The first, the cap gene, produces three different virion proteins (VP), designated VP-I, VP-2 and VP-3. The second, the rep gene, encodes four non-structural proteins (NS). One or more of these rep gene products is responsible for transactivating AAV transcription.
  • VP virion proteins
  • NS non-structural proteins
  • the three promoters in AAV are designated by their location, in map units, in the genome. These are, from left to right, p5, pl9 and p40. Transcription gives rise to six transcripts, two initiated at each of three promoters, with one of each pair being spliced.
  • the splice site derived from map units 42-46, is the same for each transcript.
  • the four non-structural proteins apparently are derived from the longer of the transcripts, and three virion proteins all arise from the smallest transcript.
  • AAV is not associated with any pathologic state in humans.
  • AAV requires "helping" functions from viruses such as herpes simplex virus I and II, cytomegalovirus, pseudorabies virus and, of course, adenovirus.
  • the best characterized of the helpers is adenovirus, and many "early" functions for this virus have been shown to assist with AAV replication.
  • Low-level expression of AAV rep proteins is believed to hold AAV structural expression in check, and helper virus infection is thought to remove this block.
  • the terminal repeats of the AAV vector can be obtained by restriction endonuclease digestion of AAV or a plasmid such as p201, which contains a modified AAV genome (Samulski et al., 1987), or by other methods known to the skilled artisan, including but not limited to chemical or enzymatic synthesis of the terminal repeats based upon the published sequence of AAV.
  • the ordinarily skilled artisan can determine, by well-known methods such as deletion analysis, the minimum sequence or part of the AAV ITRs which is required to allow function, i.e., stable and site-specific integration. The ordinarily skilled artisan also can determine which minor modifications of the sequence can be tolerated while maintaining the ability of the terminal repeats to direct stable, site-specific integration.
  • AAV-based vectors have proven to be safe and effective vehicles for gene delivery in vitro, and these vectors are being developed and tested in pre-clinical and clinical stages for a wide range of applications in potential gene therapy, both ex vivo and in vivo (Carter and Flotte, 1995; Chatterjee et al., 1995; Ferrari et al., 1996; Fisher et al., 1996; Flotte et al., 1993; Goodman et al., 1994; Kaplitt et al., 1994; 1996, Kessler et al., 1996; Koeberl et al., 1997; Mizukami et al., 1996).
  • AAV-mediated efficient gene transfer and expression in the lung has led to clinical trials for the treatment of cystic fibrosis (Carter and Flotte, 1995; Flotte et al., 1993).
  • the prospects for treatment of muscular dystrophy by AAV-mediated gene delivery of the dystrophin gene to skeletal muscle, of Parkinson's disease by tyrosine hydroxylase gene delivery to the brain, of hemophilia B by Factor IX gene delivery to the liver, and potentially of myocardial infarction by vascular endothelial growth factor gene to the heart appear promising since AAV-mediated transgene expression in these organs has recently been shown to be highly efficient (Fisher et al., 1996; Flotte et al., 1993; Kaplitt et al., 1994; 1996; Koeberl et al., 1997; McCown et al., 1996; Ping et al., 1996; Xiao et al., 1996).
  • viral vectors also may be utilized for transfer of nucleic acids into cells.
  • Vectors derived from viruses such as vaccinia virus (Ridgeway, 1988; Baichwal and Sugden, 1986; Coupar et al., 1988) canary pox virus, and herpes viruses are employed. These viruses offer several features for use in gene transfer into various mammalian cells.
  • vaccinia virus Roshalose, cowpox virus
  • herpes viruses are employed. These viruses offer several features for use in gene transfer into various mammalian cells.
  • Several viral vectors are known and can be selected by the person of ordinary skill in the art (e.g., U.S. 20020123479, published on September 5, 2002).
  • the nucleic acid encoding the transgene are positioned and expressed at different sites.
  • the nucleic acid encoding the transgene is stably integrated into the genome of the cell. This integration is in the cognate location and orientation via homologous recombination (gene replacement) or it is integrated in a random, non-specific location (gene augmentation).
  • the nucleic acid is stably maintained in the cell as a separate, episomal segment of DNA. Such nucleic acid segments or "episomes" encode sequences sufficient to permit maintenance and replication independent of or in synchronization with the host cell cycle. How the expression construct is delivered to a cell and where in the cell the nucleic acid remains is dependent on the type of expression construct employed.
  • a nucleic acid may be targeted to a dendritic cell by associating a targeting molecule having affinity for a molecule present on the surface of a dendritic cell with the nucleic acid.
  • a wide variety of targeting elements can be utilized to specifically direct a nucleic acid to a dendritic cell.
  • targeting elements are considered to be capable of interacting with a molecule present on the surface of a dendritic cell when a biological effect of the coupled targeting element may be seen in the cell, or, alternatively, when there is greater than at least about a 10-fold difference, and sometimes greater than at least about a 25, 50, or 100-fold difference, between the binding of the targeting element to dendritic cells as compared to non-dendritic cells.
  • the targeting element interact with a molecule present on the surface of the selected cell type with a K.sub.D of less than about 10.sup.-5M, preferably less than about 10.sup.-6M, more preferably less than about 10.sup.-7M, and most preferably less than about 10.sup.-8M, as determined by Scatchard analysis (Scatchard, Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci. 51 :660, 1949).
  • Suitable targeting elements are preferably non- immunogenic, not degraded by proteolysis, and not scavenged by the immune system.
  • Particularly preferred targeting elements should have a half-life within an animal of between about 10 minutes and about 1 week.
  • Targeting elements often are proteins or peptides, although other non-proteinaceous molecules may also function as targeting elements.
  • antibodies or the antigen binding domain thereof
  • Particularly useful antibodies are monoclonal antibodies which interact with the extracellular domains of integral membrane proteins found predominantly, or preferably exclusively, in the cell membranes of dendritic cells, (see generally, Wilchek and Bayer, Anal. Biochem 171 : 1-32, 1988).
  • the Fc portion of such an antibody will serve as the targeting element, targeting the gene delivery vehicle to dendritic cells that express Fc receptor molecules.
  • Suitable markers for antibody generation include CDl Ic, CD54, CD58, CD25, CDl Ia, CD23, CD32, CD40, CDl, CD45, MHC Class I, MHC Class II, Mac-1, Mac-2, and Mac-3. These and other lineage specific markers can be used to separate or purify dendritic cells from more diverse cell populations, in addition to those described above. Both positive and negative selection strategies may be employed. Techniques for conducting cell selection include FACS and affinity chromatography.
  • Suitable targeting elements include hormones, immune accessory molecules (e.g., B7, IL-2, .alpha.-interferon, and .gamma.-interferon), cell adhesion molecules (e.g., ICAM-I, ICAM-2, and ICAM- 3), integrins that bind to ICAMs and receptors known to be expressed on the surface of dendritic cells.
  • immune accessory molecules e.g., B7, IL-2, .alpha.-interferon, and .gamma.-interferon
  • cell adhesion molecules e.g., ICAM-I, ICAM-2, and ICAM- 3
  • integrins that bind to ICAMs and receptors known to be expressed on the surface of dendritic cells.
  • Dendritic cell-specific ligands also may be selected from libraries created utilizing recombinant techniques (Scott and Smith, Science 249:386, 1990; Devlin et al., Science 249:404, 1990; Houghten et al., Nature 354:84 1991; Matthews and Wells, Science 260:1113,1993; Nissim et al., EMBO J. 13(3):692- 698, 1994), or equivalent techniques utilizing organic compound libraries.
  • Targeting molecules can be associated with a nucleic acid in a variety of manners.
  • a targeting molecule can be linked directly to a nucleic acid (e.g., when a nucleic acid is transferred to dendritic cell as naked DNA), can be incorporated into the lipid bilayer of a liposome that bears the nucleic acid, and can be expressed on the surface of a virus bearing the target nucleotide sequence.
  • a nucleic acid delivery vehicle sometimes is purified before it is contacted with an antigen presenting cell for transfer.
  • Techniques utilized for purification are dependent on the type of vehicle used for nucleic acid delivery. If naked nucleic acid is delivered, there are a variety of techniques known in the art including, for example, purification by CsCl-ethidium bromide gradient, ion-exchange chromatography, gel-filtration chromatography, and differential precipitation with polyethylene glycol. Further description of nucleic acids purification is provided in Sambrook et. al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, 2d ed. (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, 1989). For viral delivery vehicles a sulfated oligosaccharide can be added directly to a virus-containing preparation for purification.
  • preparation of liposomes typically involves admixing solutions of one or more purified phospholipids and cholesterol in organic solvents and evaporating the solvents to dryness. An aqueous buffer containing the delivery vehicle then is added to the lipid film and the mixture is sonicated to create a fairly uniform dispersion of liposomes. In certain embodiments, dialysis, gel filtration, or ultracentrifugation is then be used to separate unincorporated components from the intact liposomes.
  • Loading APCs with antigen can be achieved by a variety of methods, including pulsing cells with antigenic peptides or infecting the cells with recombinant viral vectors, for example.
  • Gene therapy techniques can be applied to dendritic cell vaccines. Such techniques use recombinant viral vectors incapable of replication to provide efficient and reliable means of gene transfer. Genetic material can be introduced into dendritic cells to provide them with a renewable source of antigen for presentation; this should lead to more sustained expression of antigen. The expression of viral (and therefore foreign) genes may boost the immune response, but this antiviral immunity primed by dendritic cells may cause the immune system to destroy dendritic cells rapidly in subsequent rounds of immunization.
  • One solution can be to use viral vectors that do not result in the expression of viral genes, such as retroviruses or "gutless" adenoviral vectors.
  • APCs can be pulsed with an antigen. Pulsing processes are known to and can be selected by the person of ordinary skill in the art, and cells may be pulsed with antigen one or more times in appropriate regular or variable cycles. APCs pulsed with an antigen of interest will process and present epitopes of the antigen.
  • Antigens can be from any source, including, e.g., viruses, bacteria, parasites, etc. In one embodiment, the antigen is derived from Mycobacterium sp, Chlamydia sp., Leishmania sp., Trypanosoma sp., Plasmodium sp., or a Candida sp. APCs can be pulsed with either the entire peptide (antigen) or with a fragment thereof having immunogenic properties, e.g., an epitope.
  • the antigen-activated APCs can be produced by exposing, ex vivo, an antigen to the APCs (e.g., the dendritic cells) prepared according to the methods known to the person of ordinary skill in the art.
  • Dendritic cells for example, can be plated in culture dishes and exposed to an antigen of interest in a sufficient amount and for a sufficient period of time to allow the antigen to bind to the dendritic cells.
  • the amount and time necessary to achieve binding of the antigen to the dendritic cells may be determined by using standard immunoassays or binding assays.
  • antigens and fragments thereof may be prepared using any of a variety of procedures well known to those of skill in the art.
  • antigens can be naturally occurring and purified from a natural source.
  • antigens and fragments thereof can be produced recombinantly using a DNA sequence that encodes the antigen, which has been inserted into an appropriate expression vector, i.e., a vector which contains the necessary elements for the transcription and translation of the inserted coding sequence, and expressed in an appropriate host.
  • an appropriate expression vector i.e., a vector which contains the necessary elements for the transcription and translation of the inserted coding sequence, and expressed in an appropriate host.
  • polypeptides may be synthesized using any of the commercially available solid-phase techniques, such as the Merrifield solid-phase synthesis method, where amino acids are sequentially added to a growing amino acid chain (see Merrifield, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 85:2149-2146 (1963)).
  • Equipment for automated synthesis of polypeptides is commercially available from suppliers such as Perkin Elmer/Applied BioSystems Division, Inc., Foster City, Calif, and may be operated according to the manufacturer's instructions.
  • Variants of a native antigen may generally be prepared using standard mutagenesis techniques, such as oligonucleotide-directed site-specific mutagenesis. Sections of the DNA sequence may also be removed using standard techniques to permit preparation of truncated polypeptides.
  • the antigen of interest may be a fusion protein that comprises multiple polypeptides.
  • a fusion protein may, for instance, include an antigen and a fusion partner which may, e.g., assist in providing T helper epitopes, and/or assist in expressing the protein at higher yields than the native recombinant protein.
  • Other fusion partners may be selected so as to increase the solubility of the protein or to enable the protein to be targeted to desired intracellular compartments.
  • Still further fusion partners include affinity tags, which facilitate the purification of the protein. Fusion proteins may generally be prepared using standard techniques, including chemical conjugation and as recombinant proteins.
  • An antigen often is a molecule associated with a disease or condition.
  • pathogen- associated antigens such as viral antigens in virus-associated diseases (e.g., HIV-induced AIDS and HBV-induced liver disease), and portions thereof, can be utilized to prime modified APCs of the invention.
  • pathogen associated antigens include antigens from bacteria (e.g., E.
  • influenza virus e.g., influenza virus, HIV, and Hepatitis A, B and C Virus ("HAV”, “HBV” and “HCV”, respectively)
  • HPV human papiloma virus
  • EBV Epstein-Barr Virus
  • HSV herpes simplex virus
  • hantavirus HTLV I, HTLV II, cytomegalovirus
  • feline leukemia virus e.g., influenza virus, HIV, and Hepatitis A, B and C Virus
  • HPV human papiloma virus
  • EBV Epstein-Barr Virus
  • HSV herpes simplex virus
  • hantavirus e.g., HTLV I, HTLV II, cytomegalovirus (“CMV”)
  • feline leukemia virus e.g., influenza virus, HIV, and Hepatitis A, B and C Virus
  • HPV human papiloma virus
  • EBV Epstein-Barr Virus
  • HSV herpes
  • Antigens critical to the survival and proliferation of the cancer cell in vivo, and portions thereof, can be selected for priming modified APCs of the invention, and include, for example: (a) tissue-specific antigens that are elevated in cancer, such as carcinoembryonic antigen (CEA, colorectal cancer); .alpha.-fetoprotein (liver cancer); prostate cancer antigen (PSA, prostate cancer), mitochondrial creatine kinase (MCK, muscle cancers), myelin basic protein (MBP, oligodendrocyte specific), glial fibrillary acidic protein (GFAP, glial cell specific), tyrosinase (melanoma), and neuron cancer enolase (NSE, neuronal cancers); (b) mutated forms of tumor suppressor genes, such as K-ras (colorectal carcinomas), and p53 (J.
  • CEA carcinoembryonic antigen
  • MCK mitochondrial creatine kinase
  • MBP
  • tumor-specific antigens such as MART-I (melanoma), gplOO (melanoma), HER2/neu (breast and epithelial cancers); NY-ESO-I (testes and various tumors), PSA or PSMA (prostate cancer), thymus-leukemia antigen (TL), and proteins of the MAGE family (hepatocellular cancer and other tumors); (e) survivin and other apoptosis inhibiting proteins expressed preferentially by tumor cells (M.
  • VEGF vascular endothelia growth factor
  • IdI vascular endothelia growth factor
  • Id3 vascular endothelia growth factor
  • Tie-2 preferentially expressed during neoangiogenesis
  • An antigen may be a protein, polypeptide, protein or polypeptide fragment, peptide, dominant epitope peptide that binds to an HLA class I or II molecule, a monosaccharide, a polysaccharide or nucleic acid.
  • one or more subfragments (i.e., portions) of the antigen having a dominant immunogenic epitope may be synthesized based upon the knowledge of the ordinary artisan for selecting epitope subsequences. Sequence motifs for dominant epitopes are known and can be selected based upon whether they are presented by specific MHC I (e.g., peptides of about 8-9 amino acids) and MHC II molecules (e.g., U.S. 20060093617, published on May 4, 2006, and U.S. 20050271676, published on December 8, 2005). Some epitopes conform to "pan DR" motifs and are presented by multiple types of class II DR molecules (e.g., U.S. 20050049197 published on March 3, 2005), and native epitopes may be modified into heteroclitic analogs having enhanced immunogenicity (e.g., U.S. 20030143672, published on July 31, 2003).
  • MHC I e.g., peptides of about 8-9 amino acids
  • a polypeptide antigen Prior to loading, a polypeptide antigen may be covalently conjugated to an immunological partner that provides T cell help (e.g., a carrier molecule).
  • an APC may be pulsed with a non- conjugated immunological partner, separately or in the presence of the antigen.
  • antigen presenting cells are primed with an antigen (e.g., a protein, polypeptide, protein or polypeptide fragment, peptide, dominant immunogenic epitope) for an hour or more before the cells are matured (e.g., contacted with a nucleic acid that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt molecule).
  • the antigen presenting cells may be contacted with a full-length protein or polypeptide antigen, a fragment of the protein or polypeptide antigen or a dominant immunogenic epitope from the antigen that binds to a HLA class I or II molecule.
  • An antigen may be linked to a cell surface receptor that facilitates uptake of the antigen by cells (e.g., DEC-205 or DC-sign receptor ligand).
  • APCs may be transfected with a polynucleotide sequence encoding an antigen of interest (e.g., a protein, polypeptide, protein or polypeptide fragment, peptide, dominant immunogenic epitope) such that the antigen, or an immunogenic portion thereof, is expressed on the cell surface.
  • an antigen of interest e.g., a protein, polypeptide, protein or polypeptide fragment, peptide, dominant immunogenic epitope
  • Such transfection may take place ex vivo, and a composition or vaccine comprising such transfected cells may then be used for therapeutic purposes, as described herein.
  • a gene delivery vehicle that targets a dendritic or other antigen presenting cell may be administered to a patient, resulting in transfection that occurs in vivo.
  • the antigen-encoding sequence and membrane -targeted Akt sequence may be expressed in cis (from the same nucleic acid) or in trans (from different nucleic acids).
  • In vivo and ex vivo transfection of dendritic cells may generally be performed using any methods known in the art, such as those described in WO 97/24447, or the gene gun approach described by Mahvi et al., Immunology and cell Biology 75:456-460 (1997).
  • Antigen loading of dendritic cells may be achieved by incubating dendritic cells or progenitor cells with the antigen, DNA (naked or within a plasmid vector) or RNA; or with antigen-expressing recombinant bacterium or viruses (e.g., vaccinia, fowlpox, adenovirus or lentivirus vectors).
  • Antigen-expressing recombinant bacterium or viruses e.g., vaccinia, fowlpox, adenovirus or lentivirus vectors.
  • Vectors that express multiple antigenic epitopes in "minigenes” also may be utilized (e.g., U.S. 20060093617, published on May 4, 2006).
  • the antigens, antigen fragments or fusion proteins used to pulse the dendritic cells are preferably immunogenic, i.e., they are able to elicit an immune response (e.g., cellular or humoral) in a patient, such as a human, and/or in a biological sample (in vitro).
  • an immune response e.g., cellular or humoral
  • antigens that are immunogenic comprise an epitope recognized by a B-cell and/or a T-cell surface antigen receptor.
  • Antigens that are immunogenic (and immunogenic portions of such antigens) are capable of stimulating cell proliferation, interleukin-12 production and/or interferon-. gamma, production in biological samples comprising one or more cells selected from the group of T cells, NK cells, B cells and macrophages, where the cells have been previously stimulated with the antigen.
  • Immunomodulatory factors may be active in vivo and/or ex vivo, can enhance immunogenicity of an antigen, and may be co-administered (e.g., before, during or after administration of antigen(s)).
  • Representative examples of immunomodulatory factors include, for example, cytokines, such as IL-I, IL- 2 (Karupiah et al., J. Immunology 144:290, 1990: Weber et al., J. Exp. Med. 166:1716, 1987; Gansbacher et al., J. Exp. Med. 172:1217, 1990: U.S. Pat. No. 4,738,927).
  • IL-3 IL-4 (Tepper et al., Cell 57:503, 1989, Golumbek et al., Science 254:713, 1991 and U.S. Pat. No. 5,017,691), IL-5, IL-6 (Brakenhof et al., J. Immunol. 139:4116, 1987, and WO 90/06370), IL-7 (U.S. Pat. No. 4,965,195), IL-8, IL-9, IL-10, IL-11, IL- 12 (Wolf et al., J. Immuno.
  • TNFs tumor necrosis factors
  • CD3 Kerrissanen et al., Immunogenetics 26:258, 1987
  • CD8 ICAM-I
  • ICAM-2 Singer Science 255: 1671, 1992
  • LFA-I Altmann et al., Nature 338:521, 1989
  • LFA-3 Wang et al., J. Exp. Med.
  • HLA Class I molecules HLA Class II molecules
  • B7 Freeman et al., J. Immuno. 143:2714, 1989
  • B7-2 .beta..sub.2-microglubulin (Parnes et al., PNAS 78:2253, 1981), chaperones, and MHC linked transporter proteins or analogs thereof (Powis et al., Nature 354:528, 1991).
  • the choice of which immunomodulatory factor(s) to employ is based upon the therapeutic effects of the factor.
  • Immunomodulatory factors sometimes utilized include .alpha.-interferon, .gamma.-interferon, and IL-2.
  • modified antigen presenting cells described herein have a greater longevity (i.e., lifespan) than unmodified counterparts. Such longevity can be expressed in terms of hours, days weeks, number or fraction of surviving cells and number or fraction of dead cells (e.g., cells that have or are undergoing apoptosis), for example. Enhanced longevity can be expressed in terms of a fold-, fraction- or percentage-increase longevity of modified cells over the longevity of unmodified counterpart cells.
  • Longevity or lifespan can be assessed in vitro, ex vivo or in vivo by a number of techniques know to the person of ordinary skill in the art.
  • methods of observing cell staining e.g., with Annexin, propidium iodide (PI), CFSE dyes), enzymatic activity (e.g., caspase activity), cell sorting (e.g., based upon cell markers associated with apoptosis or cell death) and/or cell morphology can be utilized. Representative methods for determining cell longevity and cell death are described in Examples 9 and 10 hereafter.
  • the modified antigen presenting cells are used to generate an immune response to an antigen of interest.
  • the modified antigen presenting cells described herein often induce a more intense immune response than unmodified counterparts.
  • An enhanced immune response can be expressed in terms of a fold-, fraction- or percentage-increase of an immune response elicited by modified cells over the immune response elicited by unmodified counterpart cells.
  • An immune response to an antigen of interest can be detected by a number of methods available to a person of ordinary skill in the art (e.g., ELISPOT assay described in Example 9).
  • an immune response can be assessed by examining the presence, absence, or enhancement of specific activation of CD4+ or CD8+ T cells or by antibodies.
  • T cells isolated from an immunized individual by routine techniques e.g., by Ficoll/Hypaque density gradient centrifugation of peripheral blood lymphocytes
  • an antigen e.g., such T cells often are incubated with APCs expressing antigen, since T cells generally are poor APCs.
  • T cells may be incubated in vitro for 2-9 days (typically 4 days) at 37. degree. C. with the antigen. It may be desirable to incubate another aliquot of a T cell sample in the absence of the antigen to serve as a control.
  • Specific activation of CD4+ or CD8+ T cells may be detected in a variety of ways.
  • Methods for detecting specific T cell activation include detecting the proliferation of T cells, the production of cytokines, or the generation of cytolytic activity (i.e., generation of cytotoxic T cells specific for an antigen).
  • cytolytic activity i.e., generation of cytotoxic T cells specific for an antigen.
  • an often utilized method for detecting specific T cell activation is the detection of the proliferation of T cells.
  • CD8+ T cells and an often utilized method for detecting specific T cell activation is the detection of the generation of cytolytic activity.
  • T cell proliferation can be detected by measuring the rate of DNA synthesis.
  • T cells which have been stimulated to proliferate exhibit an increased rate of DNA synthesis.
  • a typical way to measure the rate of DNA synthesis is, for example, by pulse-labeling cultures of T cells with tritiated thymidine, a nucleoside precursor which is incorporated into newly synthesized DNA. The amount of tritiated thymidine incorporated can be determined using a liquid scintillation spectrophotometer.
  • T cell proliferation examples include measuring increases in interleukin-2 (IL-2) production, Ca 2+ flux, or dye uptake, such as 3-(4,5-dimethylthiazol-2-yl- )-2,5-diphenyltetrazolium.
  • IL-2 interleukin-2
  • dye uptake such as 3-(4,5-dimethylthiazol-2-yl- )-2,5-diphenyltetrazolium.
  • lymphokines e.g., interferon-gamma (IFN-. gamma.)
  • IFN-. gamma. interferon-gamma
  • IL-2 or IFN-. gamma can be measured by a variety of known techniques, including, but not limited to, the double monoclonal antibody sandwich immunoassay technique of David et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 4,376,110); monoclonal-polyclonal antibody sandwich assays (Wide et al., in Kirkham and Hunter, eds., Radioimmunoassay Methods, E. and S. Livingstone, Edinburgh (1970)); the "western blot" method of Gordon et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 4,452,901); immunoprecipitation of labeled ligand (Brown et al., J. Biol. Chem.
  • CTLs that are produced ex vivo can be expanded by regular stimulation with APCs, which can be DCs or "non-professional" APCs that are modified (e.g., with MHC molecules, B7 and the like) to act as APCs.
  • APCs which can be DCs or "non-professional" APCs that are modified (e.g., with MHC molecules, B7 and the like) to act as APCs.
  • An advantage of artificial APCs is that they can be expanded to appropriate numbers as the T cell populations expand. Mature DCs are terminally differentiated and are utilized for initial T cell activation in certain embodiments.
  • Expanded CTLs can be reinfused into patients by adoptive T cell therapy against virally infected cells or oncogene-transformed cells in certain embodiments and are especially useful for targeting comparatively weak antigens, (e.g., Dudley and Rosenberg, Nature Reviews 2: 666-678 (2003) and Savoldo et al., Blood 100(12): 4059-66 (2002)).
  • APCs can be isolated from a patient, modified with a membrane-associated AKT molecule described herein, cultured and exposed in vitro or ex vivo to an antigen of interest (e.g., isolated peptide epitope or nucleic acid-encoded epitope), and after expansion and/or cryogenic storage are administered back to the patient to stimulate an immune response, including T cell activation (see, e.g., Thurner et al., J. Immunol. Methods 223:1-15 (1999)), in vivo, in some embodiments.
  • the modified APCs are utilized to generate a CTL response in vitro
  • the APCs optionally are separated from the CTLs
  • the CTLs (sometimes in combination with the APCs) are administered to the subject in vivo.
  • modified DCs are exposed ex vivo to an antigen, washed and administered to elicit an immune response or to augment an existing, albeit weak, response.
  • the DCs may constitute a vaccine and/or an immunotherapeutic agent.
  • antigen presenting cells APCs
  • dendritic cells can be used as delivery vehicles for administering pharmaceutical compositions and vaccines.
  • the APCs may, but need not, be genetically modified, e.g., to increase the capacity for presenting the antigen, to improve activation and/or maintenance of the T cell response and/or to be immunologically compatible with the receiver (i.e., matched HLA haplotype).
  • APCs generally may be isolated from any of a variety of biological fluids and organs as described above, and may be autologous, allogeneic, syngeneic or xenogeneic cells.
  • Modified APCs primed with antigen may be administered by parenteral (e.g., intravenous, subcutaneous, and intramuscular) or other traditional direct routes, such as buccal/sublingual, rectal, oral, nasal, topical, (such as transdermal and ophthalmic), vaginal, pulmonary, intraarterial, intraperitoneal, intraocular, or intranasal routes or directly into a specific tissue, such as the liver, bone marrow, or into the tumor in the case of cancer therapy.
  • parenteral e.g., intravenous, subcutaneous, and intramuscular
  • other traditional direct routes such as buccal/sublingual, rectal, oral, nasal, topical, (such as transdermal and ophthalmic), vaginal, pulmonary, intraarterial, intraperitoneal, intraocular, or intranasal routes or directly into a specific tissue, such as the liver, bone marrow, or into the tumor in the case of cancer therapy.
  • Non-parenteral routes are discussed further
  • Dendritic cells modified ex vivo sometimes are administered in vivo by intradermal or subcutaneous injection, sometimes with 5-10 million cells administered per site. Modified DCs sometimes are administered interdermally or subcutaneously at between one to five sites in a subject. Methods for administering dendritic cells to a patient for eliciting an immune response in the patient are described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,849,589; 5,851,756; 5,994,126; and 6,017,527. CTLs expanded by contact with modified APCs of the invention also may be administered to a subject via similar routes. Administration can be repeated at desired intervals based upon the patient's immune response.
  • a DC composition can be administered to a subject via a desired route and the subject may be tested for a desired biological response.
  • Such testing may include immunological screening assays e.g., CTL assays, antibody assays.
  • Other molecules may be detected after APCs or CTLs are administered to a subject, such as by assessing whether the amount of a disease-associated biological marker lowers over time.
  • Other routes and methods for administration include non- parenteral routes, such as are disclosed in U.S. Ser. No. 08/366,788, as well as administration via multiple sites, as disclosed in U.S. Ser. No. 08/366,784.
  • compositions described above can be utilized to elicit a "protective immune response” or "therapeutic immune response,” which as used herein refer to a CTL and/or a T helper (e.g., "CD4+ T helper) response to an antigen derived from an infectious agent or a tumor antigen, which prevents or at least partially arrests or ameliorates disease symptoms or progression.
  • a T helper e.g., "CD4+ T helper
  • An immune response may also include an antibody response which has been facilitated by the stimulation of helper T cells.
  • compositions described above can include components other than the modified APCs or CTLs produced from them.
  • pharmaceutical compositions may include the following types of proteins, fragments, peptides or nucleic acids, or nucleotide sequences (within or not within the APC) that encode such molecules: (a) Toll-like receptor (TLR) ligands that can increase DC activation locally, such as monophosphoryl lipid A (TLR4 ligand), imiquimod (TLR7/8 ligand), unmethylated CpG oligonucleotides (TLR9 ligand), and others, and additional activation ligands, such as those found in monocyte-conditioned media "maturation cocktail" also can be included; (b) targeting ligands; (c) one or more apoptosis-inhibiting factors, such as Bcl-2 or Bcl-xL, for example; (d) antisense, ribozyme or siRNA molecules that target apoptosis-inducing molecules (e
  • modified APCs described herein primed with a tumor-associated antigen can be administered in conjunction (e.g., before, during or after) with an anti-cancer therapeutic, including, but not limited to, radiation treatment (e.g., radioactive implant), chemotherapy or surgery.
  • modified APCs described herein primed with a virus-associated antigen e.g., HIV antigen(s)
  • an antiviral drug e.g., HIV protease inhibitor
  • a DC modified with a membrane -targeted Akt molecule also may be utilized in combination with one or more other agents.
  • agents include, for example, a nucleic acid, a viral particle, an adjuvant and/or another modified DC, in some embodiments.
  • a DC may be may be contacted with a first polynucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane -targeted Akt described herein, and a second polynucleotide sequence that encodes an inducible CD40 molecule.
  • Inducible CD40 molecule embodiments are described, for example, in US publication 20040209836 (published October 21, 2004).
  • the first and second polynucleotide sequences may be in one nucleic acid, in separate nucleic acids, in one viral particle or in separate viral particles.
  • a composition comprising (i) a first polynucleotide sequence that encodes a first chimeric protein comprising an Akt and a membrane- association region, and (ii) a second polynucleotide sequence that encodes a second chimeric protein comprising a membrane-association region, a multimeric ligand binding region and a CD40 cytoplasmic polypeptide region lacking the CD40 extracellular domain.
  • the first and second polynucleotide sequences may be in one nucleic acid, or in separate nucleic acids, in certain embodiments.
  • compositions comprising the first chimeric protein and the second chimeric protein.
  • the composition may comprise a DC that includes the first and second chimeric protein, in certain embodiments.
  • a DC optionally may be contacted with an antigen or fragment thereof or a third polynucleotide sequence encoding the foregoing, and optionally may include an antigen or fragment thereof or a third polynucleotide sequence encoding the foregoing.
  • methods for using such polynucleotides, proteins and DCs are also provided.
  • Kits comprise one or more containers, which contain one or more of the compositions and/or components described herein.
  • a kit comprises one or more of the components in any number of separate containers, packets, tubes, vials, microtiter plates and the like, or the components may be combined in various combinations in such containers.
  • a kit in some embodiments includes a component described herein and provides instructions that direct the user to another component not included in the kit.
  • kits can include components described herein in a variety of combinations.
  • a kit may comprise one, two, three, four, five or more components described herein.
  • a kit can include a nucleic acid having a nucleotide sequence that encodes an Akt molecule.
  • a kit sometimes is utilized in conjunction with a method described herein, and sometimes includes instructions for performing one or more methods described herein and/or a description of one or more compositions described herein. Instructions and/or descriptions may be in printed form and may be included in a kit insert. A kit also may include a written description of an internet location that provides such instructions or descriptions.
  • Akt related components that may be provided in a kit include one or more adjuvants, one or more antigens or antigen-encoding nucleic acids, one or more types of cells (e.g., for producing a nucleic acid), one or more agents for transferring a nucleic acid to antigen presenting cells or another type of cell, one or more reagents or devices for isolating dendritic cells from a subject, one or more devices for transferring modified dendritic cells to a subject, and one or more agents or devices for assessing the presence or absence of an immune response, for example.
  • a kit may include one or more other components described hereafter.
  • a component in a kit sometimes is a molecule that specifically interacts with (e.g., binds to) a nucleic acid, protein, polypeptide or peptide described above.
  • the latter class of components sometimes are referred to herein as "specific interaction reagents" or “specific binding reagents.”
  • a specific binding reagent sometimes is in association with detectable label described in greater detail hereafter. Examples of specific binding reagents include antibodies and antibody fragments; binding partners; chemical compounds; and antisense, ribozyme and siRNA nucleic acids.
  • Antibodies sometimes are IgG, IgM, IgA, IgE, or an isotype thereof (e.g., IgGl, IgG2a, IgG2b or IgG3), sometimes are polyclonal or monoclonal, and sometimes are chimeric, humanized or bispecific versions of such antibodies.
  • Polyclonal and monoclonal antibodies that bind specific antigens are commercially available, and methods for generating such antibodies are known.
  • polyclonal antibodies are produced by injecting an isolated antigen (e.g., an Akt protein or fragment) into a suitable animal (e.g., a goat or rabbit); collecting blood and/or other tissues from the animal containing antibodies specific for the antigen and purifying the antibody.
  • an isolated antigen e.g., an Akt protein or fragment
  • a suitable animal e.g., a goat or rabbit
  • Methods for generating monoclonal antibodies include injecting an animal with an isolated antigen (e.g., often a mouse or a rat); isolating splenocytes from the animal; fusing the splenocytes with myeloma cells to form hybridomas; isolating the hybridomas and selecting hybridomas that produce monoclonal antibodies which specifically bind the antigen (e.g., Kohler & Milstein, Nature 256:495 497 (1975) and StGroth & Scheidegger, J Immunol Methods 5: 1 21 (1980)).
  • an isolated antigen e.g., often a mouse or a rat
  • isolating splenocytes from the animal fusing the splenocytes with myeloma cells to form hybridomas
  • isolating the hybridomas and selecting hybridomas that produce monoclonal antibodies which specifically bind the antigen e.g., Kohler & Milstein, Nature 256
  • variable region of an antibody is formed from six complementarity-determining regions (CDRs) in the heavy and light chain variable regions
  • CDRs complementarity-determining regions
  • one or more CDRs from one antibody can be substituted (i.e., grafted) with a CDR of another antibody to generate chimeric antibodies.
  • humanized antibodies are generated by introducing amino acid substitutions that render the resulting antibody less immunogenic when administered to humans.
  • a specific binding reagent sometimes is an antibody fragment, such as a Fab, Fab', F(ab)'2, Dab, Fv or single-chain Fv (ScFv) fragment, and methods for generating antibody fragments are known (see, e.g., U.S. Patent Nos. 6,099,842 and 5,990,296 and PCT/GBOO/04317).
  • a binding partner in one or more hybrids is a single-chain antibody fragment, which sometimes are constructed by joining a heavy chain variable region with a light chain variable region by a polypeptide linker (e.g., the linker is attached at the C-terminus or N-terminus of each chain) by recombinant molecular biology processes.
  • bifunctional antibodies sometimes are constructed by engineering two different binding specificities into a single antibody chain and sometimes are constructed by joining two Fab' regions together, where each Fab' region is from a different antibody (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 6,342,221).
  • Antibody fragments often comprise engineered regions such as CDR-grafted or humanized fragments.
  • the binding partner is an intact immunoglobulin, and in other embodiments the binding partner is a Fab monomer or a Fab dimer.
  • the artisan may select and prepare a binding partner of Akt as a specific binding reagent.
  • the artisan may utilize a fragment of a binding partner that binds to an Akt protein or fragment as a specific binding reagent in specific embodiments.
  • the artisan also may optimize a binding reagent for a specific use or identify new binding reagents using a variety of procedures.
  • binding partners may be identified by lysing cells and analyzing cell lysates by electrophoretic techniques.
  • a two-hybrid assay or three-hybrid assay can be utilized (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,283,317; Zervos et al., Cell 72:223-232 (1993); Madura et al., J. Biol. Chem. 268: 12046-12054 (1993); Bartel et al., Biotechniques 14: 920-924 (1993); Iwabuchi et al., Oncogene 8: 1693-1696 (1993); and Brent WO94/10300).
  • a two- hybrid system is based on the modular nature of most transcription factors, which consist of separable DNA-binding and activation domains.
  • the assay often utilizes two different DNA constructs.
  • an Akt nucleic acid (sometimes referred to as the "bait") is fused to a gene encoding the DNA binding domain of a known transcription factor (e.g., GAL-4).
  • a DNA sequence from a library of DNA sequences that encodes a potential binding partner (sometimes referred to as the "prey”) is fused to a gene that encodes an activation domain of the known transcription factor.
  • an Akt nucleic acid is linked to the activation domain.
  • the DNA-binding and activation domains of the transcription factor are brought into close proximity. This proximity allows transcription of a reporter gene (e.g., LacZ) which is operably linked to a transcriptional regulatory site responsive to the transcription factor. Expression of the reporter gene can be detected and cell colonies containing the functional transcription factor can be isolated and used to identify the potential binding partner.
  • a reporter gene e.g., LacZ
  • Compounds can be obtained using any of the numerous approaches in combinatorial library methods known in the art, including: biological libraries; peptoid libraries (libraries of molecules having the functionalities of peptides, but with a novel, non-peptide backbone which are resistant to enzymatic degradation but which nevertheless remain bioactive (see, e.g., Zuckermann et al., J. Med. Chem.37: 2678-85 (1994)); spatially addressable parallel solid phase or solution phase libraries; synthetic library methods requiring deconvolution; "one-bead one-compound” library methods; and synthetic library methods using affinity chromatography selection.
  • Biolibrary and peptoid library approaches are typically limited to peptide libraries, while the other approaches are applicable to peptide, non-peptide oligomer or small molecule libraries of compounds (Lam, Anticancer Drug Des. 12: 145, (1997)).
  • Examples of methods for synthesizing molecular libraries are described, for example, in DeWitt et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 90: 6909 (1993); Erb et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 91 : 11422 (1994); Zuckermann et al., J. Med. Chem.
  • Small molecules include, but are not limited to, peptides, peptidomimetics (e.g., peptoids), amino acids, amino acid analogs, polynucleotides, polynucleotide analogs, nucleotides, nucleotide analogs, organic or inorganic compounds (i.e., including heteroorganic and organometallic compounds) having a molecular weight less than about 10,000 grams per mole, organic or inorganic compounds having a molecular weight less than about 5,000 grams per mole, organic or inorganic compounds having a molecular weight less than about 1 ,000 grams per mole, organic or inorganic compounds having a molecular weight less than about 500 grams per mole, and salts, esters, and other pharmaceutically acceptable forms of such compounds.
  • peptides e.g., peptoids
  • amino acids amino acid analogs
  • polynucleotides polynucleotide analogs
  • nucleotides nucleotide analogs
  • Nucleic acids may comprise or consist of analog or derivative nucleic acids, such as polyamide nucleic acids (PNA) and others exemplified in U.S. Pat. Nos.
  • PNA polyamide nucleic acids
  • an “antisense” nucleic acid refers to a nucleotide sequence complementary to a "sense” nucleic acid encoding an Akt protein or fragment (e.g., complementary to the coding strand of a double-stranded cDNA molecule or complementary to an mRNA sequence).
  • the antisense nucleic acid can be complementary to an entire coding strand, or to a portion thereof or a substantially identical sequence thereof.
  • the antisense nucleic acid molecule is antisense to a "noncoding region" of the coding strand of a nucleotide sequence.
  • An antisense nucleic acid can be complementary to the entire coding region of an mRNA encoded by an Akt nucleotide sequence, and often the antisense nucleic acid is an oligonucleotide antisense to only a portion of a coding or noncoding region of the mRNA.
  • the antisense oligonucleotide can be complementary to the region surrounding the translation start site of the mRNA, e.g., between the -10 and +10 regions of the target gene nucleotide sequence of interest.
  • An antisense oligonucleotide can be, for example, about 7, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55, 60, 65, 70, 75, 80, or more nucleotides in length.
  • an antisense nucleic acid can be constructed using chemical synthesis or enzymic ligation reactions using standard procedures.
  • an antisense nucleic acid e.g., an antisense oligonucleotide
  • an antisense nucleic acid can be chemically synthesized using naturally occurring nucleotides or variously modified nucleotides designed to increase the biological stability of the molecules or to increase the physical stability of the duplex formed between the antisense and sense nucleic acids (e.g., phosphorothioate derivatives and acridine substituted nucleotides can be used).
  • Antisense nucleic acid also can be produced biologically using an expression vector into which a nucleic acid has been subcloned in an antisense orientation (i.e., RNA transcribed from the inserted nucleic acid will be of an antisense orientation to a target nucleic acid of interest, described further in the following subsection).
  • antisense nucleic acids When utilized in subjects, antisense nucleic acids typically are administered to a subject (e.g., by direct injection at a tissue site) or generated in situ such that they hybridize with or bind to cellular mRNA and/or genomic DNA encoding a polypeptide and thereby inhibit expression of the polypeptide, for example, by inhibiting transcription and/or translation.
  • antisense nucleic acid molecules can be modified to target selected cells and then are administered systemically.
  • antisense molecules can be modified such that they specifically bind to receptors or antigens expressed on a selected cell surface, for example, by linking antisense nucleic acid molecules to peptides or antibodies which bind to cell surface receptors or antigens.
  • Antisense nucleic acid molecules can also be delivered to cells using the vectors described herein. Sufficient intracellular concentrations of antisense molecules are achieved by incorporating a strong promoter, such as a pol II or pol III promoter, in the vector construct. Antisense nucleic acid molecules sometimes are alpha-anomeric nucleic acid molecules. An alpha-anomeric nucleic acid molecule forms specific double-stranded hybrids with complementary RNA in which, contrary to the usual beta-units, the strands run parallel to each other (Gaultier et al., Nucleic Acids. Res. 15: 6625-6641 (1987)).
  • Antisense nucleic acid molecules also can comprise a 2'-o-methylribonucleotide (Inoue et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 15: 6131-6148 (1987)) or a chimeric RNA-DNA analogue (Inoue et al., FEBS Lett. 215: 327-330 (1987)).
  • Antisense nucleic acids sometimes are composed of DNA or PNA or any other nucleic acid derivatives described previously.
  • An antisense nucleic acid is a ribozyme in some embodiments.
  • a ribozyme having specificity for an Akt nucleotide sequence can include one or more sequences complementary to such a nucleotide sequence, and a sequence having a known catalytic region responsible for mRNA cleavage (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,093,246 or Haselhoff and Gerlach, Nature 334: 585-591 (1988)).
  • Akt mRNA sequences also may be utilized to select a catalytic RNA having a specific ribonuclease activity from a pool of RNA molecules (e.g., Bartel & Szostak, Science 261 : 1411-1418 (1993)).
  • Specific binding reagents sometimes are nucleic acids that can form triple helix structures with an Akt nucleic acid.
  • Akt expression can be inhibited by targeting nucleotide sequences complementary to the regulatory region of a nucleotide sequence referenced herein or a substantially identical sequence (e.g., promoter and/or enhancers) to form triple helical structures that prevent transcription of a gene in target cells (see e.g., Helene, Anticancer Drug Des. 6(6): 569-84 (1991); Helene et al., Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci. 660: 27-36 (1992); and Maher, Bioassays 14(12): 807-15 (1992).
  • Switchback molecules are synthesized in an alternating 5'-3', 3'-5' manner, such that they base pair with first one strand of a duplex and then the other, eliminating the necessity for a sizeable stretch of purines or pyrimidines being present on one strand of a duplex.
  • RNAi interfering RNA
  • siRNA specific binding reagent an interfering RNA (RNAi) or siRNA specific binding reagent for use.
  • the nucleic acid selected sometimes is the RNAi or siRNA or a nucleic acid that encodes such products.
  • RNAi refers to double-stranded RNA (dsRNA) which mediates degradation of specific mRNAs, and can also be used to lower or eliminate gene expression.
  • short interfering nucleic acid refers to any nucleic acid molecule directed against a gene.
  • a siRNA is capable of inhibiting or down regulating gene expression or viral replication, for example by mediating RNA interference "RNAi" or gene silencing in a sequence- specific manner; see for example Zamore et al., 2000, Cell, 101, 25-33; Bass, 2001, Nature, 411, 428-429; Elbashir et al., 2001, Nature, 411, 494-498; and Kreutzer et al., International PCT Publication No. WO 00/44895; Zernicka-Goetz et al., International PCT Publication No. WO 01/36646; Fire, International PCT Publication No. WO 99/32619; Plaetinck et al., International PCT Publication No.
  • modified RNAi and siRNA examples include STEALTHTM forms (Invitrogen Corp., Carlsbad, CA), forms described in U.S. Patent Publication No. 2004/0014956 (appl. no. 10/357,529) and U.S. Patent Application No. 11/049,636, filed February 2, 2005), and other forms described hereafter.
  • a siNA can be a double-stranded polynucleotide molecule comprising self-complementary sense and antisense regions, wherein the antisense region comprises nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence in a target nucleic acid molecule or a portion thereof and the sense region having nucleotide sequence corresponding to the target nucleic acid sequence or a portion thereof.
  • the siNA can be assembled from two separate oligonucleotides, where one strand is the sense strand and the other is the antisense strand, wherein the antisense and sense strands are self-complementary (i.e.
  • each strand comprises nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence in the other strand; such as where the antisense strand and sense strand form a duplex or double stranded structure, for example wherein the double stranded region is about 19 base pairs); the antisense strand comprises nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence in a target nucleic acid molecule or a portion thereof and the sense strand comprises nucleotide sequence corresponding to the target nucleic acid sequence or a portion thereof.
  • the siNA is assembled from a single oligonucleotide, where the self- complementary sense and antisense regions of the siNA are linked by means of a nucleic acid based or non-nucleic acid-based linker(s).
  • the siNA can be a polynucleotide with a duplex, asymmetric duplex, hairpin or asymmetric hairpin secondary structure, having self-complementary sense and antisense regions, wherein the antisense region comprises nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence in a separate target nucleic acid molecule or a portion thereof and the sense region having nucleotide sequence corresponding to the target nucleic acid sequence or a portion thereof.
  • the siNA can be a circular single-stranded polynucleotide having two or more loop structures and a stem comprising self-complementary sense and antisense regions, wherein the antisense region comprises nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence in a target nucleic acid molecule or a portion thereof and the sense region having nucleotide sequence corresponding to the target nucleic acid sequence or a portion thereof, and wherein the circular polynucleotide can be processed either in vivo or in vitro to generate an active siNA molecule capable of mediating RNAi.
  • the siNA can also comprise a single stranded polynucleotide having nucleotide sequence complementary to nucleotide sequence in a target nucleic acid molecule or a portion thereof (for example, where such siNA molecule does not require the presence within the siNA molecule of nucleotide sequence corresponding to the target nucleic acid sequence or a portion thereof), wherein the single stranded polynucleotide can further comprise a terminal phosphate group, such as a 5'-phosphate (see for example Martinez et al., 2002, Cell., 110, 563-574 and Schwarz et al., 2002, Molecular Cell, 10, 537-568), or 5',3'-diphosphate.
  • a terminal phosphate group such as a 5'-phosphate (see for example Martinez et al., 2002, Cell., 110, 563-574 and Schwarz et al., 2002, Molecular Cell, 10, 537-568), or 5',3'-diphosphate.
  • the siNA molecule of the invention comprises separate sense and antisense sequences or regions, wherein the sense and antisense regions are covalently linked by nucleotide or non-nucleotide linkers molecules as is known in the art, or are alternately non-covalently linked by ionic interactions, hydrogen bonding, van der waals interactions, hydrophobic interactions, and/or stacking interactions.
  • the siNA molecules of the invention comprise nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence of a target gene.
  • the siNA molecule of the invention interacts with nucleotide sequence of a target gene in a manner that causes inhibition of expression of the target gene.
  • the double-stranded RNA portions of siRNAs in which two RNA strands pair are not limited to the completely paired forms, and may contain non-pairing portions due to mismatch (the corresponding nucleotides are not complementary), bulge (lacking in the corresponding complementary nucleotide on one strand), and the like.
  • Non-pairing portions can be contained to the extent that they do not interfere with siRNA formation.
  • the "bulge” used herein often comprises 1 to 2 non-pairing nucleotides, and the double-stranded RNA region of siRNAs in which two RNA strands pair up sometimes contains 1 to 7, and at times 1 to 5 bulges.
  • the "mismatch" used herein is contained in the double-stranded RNA region of siRNAs in which two RNA strands pair up, sometimes 1 to 7, and at times 1 to 5, in number.
  • one of the nucleotides is guanine, and the other is uracil.
  • Such a mismatch is due to a mutation from C to T, G to A, or mixtures thereof in DNA coding for sense RNA, but not particularly limited to them.
  • the double-stranded RNA region of siRNAs in which two RNA strands pair up may contain both bulge and mismatched, which sum up to, sometimes 1 to 7, and at times 1 to 5, in number.
  • the terminal structure of siRNA may be either blunt or cohesive (overhanging) as long as siRNA enables to silence the target gene expression due to its RNAi effect.
  • siRNA molecules need not be limited to those molecules containing only RNA, but further encompasses chemically-modified nucleotides and non-nucleotides.
  • RNAi is meant to be equivalent to other terms used to describe sequence specific RNA interference, such as post transcriptional gene silencing, translational inhibition, or epigenetics.
  • siRNA molecules of the invention can be used to epigenetically silence genes at both the post- transcriptional level or the pre-transcriptional level.
  • epigenetic regulation of gene expression by siRNA molecules of the invention can result from siRNA mediated modification of chromatin structure to alter gene expression (see, for example, Verdel et al., 2004, Science, 303, 672-676; Pal-Bhadra et al., 2004, Science, 303, 669-672; Allshire, 2002, Science, 297, 1818-1819; Volpe et al., 2002, Science, 297, 1833-1837; Jenuwein, 2002, Science, 297, 2215-2218; and Hall et al., 2002, Science, 297, 2232-2237).
  • RNAi may be designed by those methods known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
  • siRNA may be designed by classifying RNAi sequences, for example 1000 sequences, based on functionality, with a functional group being classified as having greater than 85% knockdown activity and a non- functional group with less than 85% knockdown activity.
  • the distribution of base composition was calculated for entire the entire RNAi target sequence for both the functional group and the non- functional group.
  • the ratio of base distribution of functional and non- functional group may then be used to build a score matrix for each position of RNAi sequence. For a given target sequence, the base for each position is scored, and then the log ratio of the multiplication of all the positions is taken as a final score.
  • the target sequence may be filtered through both fast NCBI blast and slow Smith Waterman algorithm search against the Unigene database to identify the gene-specific RNAi or siRNA. Sequences with at least one mismatch in the last 12 bases may be selected.
  • Nucleic acid reagents include those which are engineered, for example, to produce dsRNAs.
  • Examples of such nucleic acid molecules include those with a sequence that, when transcribed, folds back upon itself to generate a hairpin molecule containing a double-stranded portion.
  • One strand of the double- stranded portion may correspond to all or a portion of the sense strand of the mRNA transcribed from the gene to be silenced while the other strand of the double-stranded portion may correspond to all or a portion of the antisense strand.
  • nucleic acid molecules may be engineered to have a first sequence that, when transcribed, corresponds to all or a portion of the sense strand of the mRNA transcribed from the gene to be silenced and a second sequence that, when transcribed, corresponds to all or portion of an antisense strand (i.e., the reverse complement) of the mRNA transcribed from the gene to be silenced.
  • an antisense strand i.e., the reverse complement
  • Nucleic acid molecules which mediate RNAi may also be produced ex vivo, for example, by oligonucleotide synthesis. Oligonucleotide synthesis may be used for example, to design dsRNA molecules, as well as other nucleic acid molecules (e.g., other nucleic acid molecules which mediate RNAi) with one or more chemical modification (e.g., chemical modifications not commonly found in nucleic acid molecules such as the inclusion of 2'-O-methyl, 2'-0-ethyl, 2'-O-propyl, 2'-fluoro, etc. groups).
  • Oligonucleotide synthesis may be used for example, to design dsRNA molecules, as well as other nucleic acid molecules (e.g., other nucleic acid molecules which mediate RNAi) with one or more chemical modification (e.g., chemical modifications not commonly found in nucleic acid molecules such as the inclusion of 2'-O-methyl, 2'-0-ethyl, 2'-O
  • a dsRNA to be used to silence a gene may have one or more (e.g., one, two, three, four, five, six, etc.) regions of sequence homology or identity to a gene to be silenced. Regions of homology or identity may be from about 20 bp (base pairs) to about 5 kbp (kilo base pairs) in length, 20 bp to about 4 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 3 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 2.5 kbp in length, from about 20 bp to about 2 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 1.5 kbp in length, from about 20 bp to about 1 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 750 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 500 bp in length, 20 bp to about 400 bp in length, 20 bp to about 300 bp in length, 20 bp to about 250 bp in length, from about
  • a hairpin containing molecule having a double-stranded region may be used as RNAi.
  • the length of the double stranded region may be from about 20 bp (base pairs) to about 2.5 kbp (kilo base pairs) in length, from about 20 bp to about 2 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 1.5 kbp in length, from about 20 bp to about 1 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 750 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 500 bp in length, 20 bp to about 400 bp in length, 20 bp to about 300 bp in length, 20 bp to about 250 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 200 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 150 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 100 bp in length, 20 bp to about 90 bp in length, 20 bp to about 80 bp in length, 20 bp
  • RNA polymerase II may be promoters for RNA polymerase II or RNA polymerase III (e.g., a U6 promoter, an Hl promoter, etc.).
  • suitable promoters include, but are not limited to, T7 promoter, cytomegalovirus (CMV) promoter, mouse mammary tumor virus (MMTV) promoter, metalothionine, RSV (Rous sarcoma virus) long terminal repeat, SV40 promoter, human growth hormone (hGH) promoter.
  • CMV cytomegalovirus
  • MMTV mouse mammary tumor virus
  • RSV Rasarcoma virus
  • SV40 human growth hormone
  • hGH human growth hormone
  • Double-stranded RNAs used in the practice of the invention may vary greatly in size. Further the size of the dsRNAs used will often depend on the cell type contacted with the dsRNA. As an example, animal cells such as those of C. elegans and Drosophila melanogaster do not generally undergo apoptosis when contacted with dsRNAs greater than about 30 nucleotides in length (i.e., 30 nucleotides of double stranded region) while mammalian cells typically do undergo apoptosis when exposed to such dsRNAs. Thus, the design of the particular experiment will often determine the size of dsRNAs employed.
  • the double stranded region of dsRNAs contained within or encoded by nucleic acid molecules used in the practice of the invention will be within the following ranges: from about 20 to about 30 nucleotides, from about 20 to about 40 nucleotides, from about 20 to about 50 nucleotides, from about 20 to about 100 nucleotides, from about 22 to about 30 nucleotides, from about 22 to about 40 nucleotides, from about 20 to about 28 nucleotides, from about 22 to about 28 nucleotides, from about 25 to about 30 nucleotides, from about 25 to about 28 nucleotides, from about 30 to about 100 nucleotides, from about 30 to about 200 nucleotides, from about 30 to about 1,000 nucleotides, from about 30 to about 2,000 nucleotides, from about 50 to about 100 nucleotides, from about 50 to about 1,000 nucleotides, or from about 50 to about 2,000 nucleotides.
  • dsRNA refers to the number of nucleotides present in double stranded regions. Thus, these ranges do not reflect the total length of the dsRNAs themselves. As an example, a blunt ended dsRNA formed from a single transcript of 50 nucleotides in total length with a 6 nucleotide loop, will have a double stranded region of 23 nucleotides.
  • dsRNAs used in the practice of the invention may be blunt ended, may have one blunt end, or may have overhangs on both ends. Further, when one or more overhang is present, the overhang(s) may be on the 3' and/or 5' strands at one or both ends. Additionally, these overhangs may independently be of any length (e.g., one, two, three, four, five, etc. nucleotides). As an example, STEALTHTM RNAi is blunt at both ends. Also included are sets of RNAi and those which generate RNAi. Such sets include those which either (1) are designed to produce or (2) contain more than one dsRNA directed against the same target gene.
  • the invention includes sets of STEALTHTM RNAi wherein more than one STEALTHTM RNAi shares sequence homology or identity to different regions of the same target gene.
  • a protein, fragment or nucleic acid described herein sometimes is in association with detectable label.
  • the detectable label can be covalently linked to the reagent, and sometimes is in association with the reagent in a non-covalent linkage. Methods for attaching such binding pairs to reagents and effecting binding are known to the artisan. Any detectable label suitable for detection of an interaction or biological activity in a system can be appropriately selected and utilized by the artisan.
  • detectable labels are fluorescent labels such as fluorescein, rhodamine, and others (e.g., Anantha, et al., Biochemistry (1998) 37:2709 2714; and Qu & Chaires, Methods Enzymol. (2000) 321 :353 369); radioactive isotopes (e.g., 125 1, 131 1, 35 S, 31 P, 32 P, 14 C, 3 H, 7 Be, 28 Mg, 57 Co, 65 Zn, 67 Cu, 68 Ge, 82 Sr, 83 Rb, 95 Tc, 96 Tc, 103 Pd, 109 Cd, and 127 Xe); light scattering labels (e.g., U.S. Patent No.
  • fluorescent labels such as fluorescein, rhodamine, and others (e.g., Anantha, et al., Biochemistry (1998) 37:2709 2714; and Qu & Chaires, Methods Enzymol. (2000) 321 :353 3
  • chemiluminescent labels and enzyme substrates e.g., dioxetanes and acridinium esters
  • enzymic or protein labels e.g., green fluorescence protein (GFP) or color variant thereof, luciferase, peroxidase
  • GFP green fluorescence protein
  • other chromogenic labels or dyes e.g., cyanine
  • Cells also may be provided in a kit.
  • a cell may over-express or under-express protein, fragment or nucleic acid or other molecule described herein.
  • a cell can be processed in a variety of manners. For example, an artisan may prepare a lysate from a cell and optionally isolate or purify components, may transfect the cell with a nucleic acid reagent, may fix a cell reagent to a slide for analysis (e.g., microscopic analysis) and can immobilize a cell to a solid phase.
  • a cell that "over-expresses" an protein or fragment or nucleic acid described herein produces at least two, three, four or five times or more of the product as compared to a native cell from an organism that has not been genetically modified and/or exhibits no apparent symptom of a cell-proliferative disorder.
  • Over-expressing cells may be stably transfected or transiently transfected with a nucleic acid a protein or fragment or nucleic acid described herein.
  • a cell that "under-expresses" a protein or fragment or nucleic acid described herein produces at least five times less of the product as compared to a native cell from an organism that has not been genetically modified and/or exhibits no apparent symptom of a cell- proliferative disorder.
  • a cell that under-expresses a protein, fragment or nucleic acid contains no nucleic acid that can encode such a product (e.g., the cell is from a knock-out mouse) and no detectable amount of the product is produced.
  • Methods for generating knock-out animals and using associated cells are known (e.g., Miller et al., J. Cell. Biol. 165: 407-419 (2004)).
  • Cells include, but are not limited to, bacterial cells (e.g., Escherichia spp. cells (e.g., ExpresswayTM HTP Cell-Free E. coli Expression Kit, Invitrogen, California) such as DHlOB, Stbl2, DH5-alpha, DB3, DB3.1 for example), DB4, DB5, JDP682 and ccdA-over (e.g., U.S. Application No. 09/518,188), Bacillus spp. cells (e.g., B. subtilis and B. megaterium cells), Streptomyces spp. cells, Erwinia spp. cells, Klebsiella spp. cells, Serratia spp. cells (particularly S.
  • Escherichia spp. cells e.g., ExpresswayTM HTP Cell-Free E. coli Expression Kit, Invitrogen, California
  • DHlOB DHlOB
  • Stbl2 DH5-alpha
  • marcessans cells Pseudomonas spp. cells (particularly P. aeruginosa cells), and Salmonella spp. cells (particularly S. typhimurium and S. typhi cells); photosynthetic bacteria (e.g., green non-sulfur bacteria (e.g., Choroflexus spp. (e.g., C. aurantiacus), Chloronema spp. (e.g., C. gigateum)), green sulfur bacteria (e.g., Chlorobium spp. (e.g., C. limicola), Pelodictyon spp. (e.g., P.
  • green non-sulfur bacteria e.g., Choroflexus spp. (e.g., C. aurantiacus)
  • Chloronema spp. e.g., C. gigateum
  • green sulfur bacteria e.g., Chlorobium spp. (e
  • Rhodospirillum spp. e.g., R. rubrum
  • Rhodobacter spp. e.g., R. sphaeroides, R. capsulatus
  • Rhodomicrobium spp. e.g., R.
  • yeast cells e.g., Saccharomyces cerevisiae cells and Pichia pastoris cells
  • insect cells e.g., Drosophila (e.g., Drosophila melanogaster), Spodoptera (e.g., Spodoptera frugiperda Sf9 and Sf21 cells) and Trichoplusa (e.g., High- Five cells); nematode cells (e.g., C.
  • elegans cells avian cells
  • amphibian cells e.g., Xenopus laevis cells
  • reptilian cells e.g., NIH3T3, 293, CHO, COS, VERO, C127, BHK, Per-C6, Bowes melanoma and HeLa cells.
  • mammalian cells e.g., NIH3T3, 293, CHO, COS, VERO, C127, BHK, Per-C6, Bowes melanoma and HeLa cells.
  • suitable cells are available commercially, for example, from Invitrogen Corporation, (Carlsbad, CA), American Type Culture Collection (Manassas, Virginia), and Agricultural Research Culture Collection (NRRL; Peoria, Illinois).
  • the examples set forth below illustrate but do not limit the invention.
  • the maturation state and lifespan of dendritic cells are critical for the regulation of immunity.
  • current DC preparations based on ex vivo treatment with differentiation and maturation factors can lead to transiently active DCs that may curtail T cell responses following re-infusion.
  • Aktl levels drop rapidly following growth factor withdrawal and are critical for pro-inflammatory signal-mediated DC survival and maturation.
  • LPS or CD40 signaling stabilizes Aktl and promotes both DC activation and survival.
  • Aktl -mediated survival depends on Bcl-2, but not BcI- xL.
  • Adenoviral-mediated overexpression of a novel, lipid-raft targeted Akt allele, MF- ⁇ Akt, is sufficient for murine bone marrow-derived DC maturation and survival, resulting in enhanced T cell proliferation and activation, and eradication of large pre-established thymoma as well as B 16 melanoma.
  • transduction of human DCs with an adenovirus expressing human Aktl, MF- ⁇ hAkt also significantly improves DC survival, antigen-specific T cell proliferation and CD8+ T cell responses.
  • BMDCs bone marrow-derived DCs
  • Bcl-2 and Bcl-xL protein levels were determined in wortmannin-treated DCs pre-exposed to LPS or anti-CD40. Consistent with previous findings, GM-CSF deprivation down-regulated Bcl-xL as well as Bcl-2, but LPS and anti-CD40 treatment reversed this effect. In the presence of wortmannin with LPS or anti-CD40, only Bcl-2 protein was rapidly down regulated, whereas protein levels of Bcl-xL were stable for at least 3 days (Fig. IF).
  • Figure IA shows PI3K and Src kinase are involved in LPS-mediated DC survival. Bone marrow-derived CDl lc+ DCs were incubated for 16 hr with LPS (1 ⁇ g/ml) along with the indicated concentrations ( ⁇ M) of PI3K inhibitor Ly294002, JAK inhibitor AG490, MAPK inhibitor PD98059 or Src kinase inhibitor PP2. Cell viability was assessed 2 days later using propidium iodide (PI) staining.
  • Figure IB shows down-regulation of Akt and Bcl-2 following GM-CSF withdrawal.
  • FIG. 1C shows following GM-CSF withdrawal, BMDCs were treated for 16 hr with 1 ⁇ g/ml of LPS (•), 10 ⁇ g/ml of anti-CD40 antibody (A) or neither ( ⁇ ) before incubation for indicated times, and cell viability was assessed by PI staining.
  • Figure ID shows LPS and anti-CD40 prevent the down-regulation in BMDCs of phospho-Akt and total Akt, as determined by Western blotting using anti- pAkt-S473 and anti-Akt Abs, respectively.
  • Figure IE shows PI3K is essential for both LPS and anti- CD40-mediated DC survival.
  • Aktl-/- DCs showed comparable numbers and viability relative to Aktl+/+ DCs after BMDC isolation (data not shown).
  • GM-CSF withdrawal for 48 hr reduced the survival of Aktl-/- DCs relative to Aktl+/+ DCs.
  • the protective effect of LPS and CD40 was completely abolished in Aktl-/- DCs, indicating that innate (LPS) and acquired (CD40) immune response-related DC survival requires Aktl (Fig. 2C).
  • Akt-I significantly reduced LPS-mediated DC survival (Fig. 9C).
  • transfection of Akt-RNAi (100 nM), a synthetic Aktl-specific siRNA36, into BMDCs suppressed Akt expression and significantly (P ⁇ 0.005) increased DC death even in the presence of LPS compared with control RNAi (Fig. 9A, 9B). Therefore, it was determined Aktl is a critical mediator of DC survival signals, and down-regulation of Aktl is a major regulatory mechanism to control DC longevity.
  • Akt can induce NF-kappaB activity through IKKbeta phosphorylation, critical for DC activation and maturation.
  • IKKbeta phosphorylation critical for DC activation and maturation.
  • Akt 1 surface expression of several MHC and costimulatory molecules was assessed in Aktl+/+ and Aktl-/- BMDCs, including CD40, CD 80, MHC class I Kb and MHC class II I- Ab.
  • Aktl-/- BMDCs showed significantly reduced expression of maturation markers, CD40 (P ⁇ 0.01), CD80 (P ⁇ 0.005) and MHC class I Kb (PO.01), relative to Aktl+/+ DCs on day 6 (Fig. 2D, Fig. 9).
  • Aktl-/- BMDCs revealed a large defect in the further enhancement of maturation markers, such as CD40 and MHC class I Kb (Fig. 2F), as well as CD80 and MHC class II I- Ab (data not shown), even after LPS and CD40 stimulation, suggesting that Aktl plays a critical role in DC differentiation and activation.
  • Figure 2A shows analysis of Akt isoforms in BMDCs.
  • BMDC DC
  • A431 control
  • cell lysates were immunob lotted with specific antibodies against Aktl and Akt2. Protein level of total Akt was determined by reprobing with anti-Akt Ab.
  • Figure 2B shows analysis of Aktl and total Akt protein level in Aktl-/- DCs. Cell lysates from Aktl+/+ or Aktl-/- BMDCs were immunoblotted with antibodies against Aktl or total Akt. Protein loading was normalized by actin immunoblotting.
  • Figure 1C shows comparison of LPS- or anti-CD40-mediated survival in Aktl+/+ or Akt-/- DCs.
  • BMDCs from Aktl+/+ or Aktl-/- mice were untreated (open bars) or treated with LPS (1 ⁇ g/ml, gray bars) or anti-CD40 (10 ⁇ g/ml, filled bars) and further incubated in the presence of wortmannin (0.5 ⁇ M) for 48 hrs. Background % PI+ at day 0 was subtracted from each data point.
  • Figure 2D shows expression of surface markers in Aktl+/+ or Aktl-/- DCs.
  • FIG. 2E shows a comparison of lymph nodes from Aktl+/+ or Akt-/- mice. Size of inguinal lymph nodes isolated from Aktl+/+ or Aktl-/- littermates was measured (bottom scale bar, 1 mm gap) and trypan blue staining assessed total cell numbers within each lymph node.
  • Figure 2F shows reduced maturation of Aktl-/- DCs.
  • BMDCs in the starting wells were further treated with indicated stimuli as above in Figure 2C for 48 hr.
  • DC maturation was assessed by CD40 and MHC class I Kb staining. Numbers indicate percentage of cells in that quadrant.
  • Data represent two ( Figures 2B and 2F), three ( Figures 2C and 2D) or six ( Figure 2E) independent experiments. Error bars indicate mean ⁇ S.D. of results derived from three ( Figures 2D and 2E) independent littermates. *, PO.01, **, PO.005, ⁇ , PO.0005.
  • Akt constitutively active Akt
  • M-Akt constitutively active Akt
  • this construct was compared to several distinct Akt constructs, containing myristoylation-targeting sequences from Src family kinases Src, Fyn and Lck fused to a truncated (denoted " ⁇ ") Akt (Fig. 3A).
  • the pleckstrin homology (PH) domain was removed to improve Akt activity, important when PI3K activity is low.
  • the Fyn myristoylation-targeting sequence showed the most efficient lipid raft localization, 2-3 -fold NF-kappaB induction, about a 6- fold-increased Akt-S473 and GSK3 phosphorylation, and enhanced viability of transfected Jurkat cells following treatment with PI3K inhibitors (Fig. 3A and Fig. 12).
  • MF- ⁇ Akt Fyn myristoylated ⁇ Akt
  • MF- ⁇ Akt Fyn myristoylated ⁇ Akt
  • E308 and D473 key phosphorylation sites
  • BMDCs were treated with either Ad- MF- ⁇ Akt or LPS and Ad-GFP as positive and negative controls, respectively.
  • Flow cytometry analysis after 48 hr of treatment at about 50% transduction efficiency revealed that Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt- transduced DCs had consistently enhanced expression of DC activation markers, including I-Ab, CD40, CD80 and Kb compared with Ad-GFP -transduced DCs, implicating that Akt activity is sufficient to induce DC activation and maturation (Fig. 3F).
  • Figure 3 A shows a schematic of distinct Akt alleles comprised of myristoylation- targeting sequences (residues 1-16) from Src (MS), Fyn (MF) or Lck (ML) fused to PH domain-deleted Akt ( ⁇ Akt 103-408).
  • Activation state and expression of Ms- ⁇ Akt (MS), MF- ⁇ Akt (MF), and ML- ⁇ Akt (ML) were determined using anti-pAkt-S473 and anti-HA antibodies, respectively.
  • Figure 3B shows phosphorylation of substrate GSK3 alpha/beta in BMDCs transduced by adenovectors expressing constitutive Akt.
  • MF- ⁇ Akt Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt
  • M-Akt Ad-MS-Akt
  • pGSK3 anti-phospho-GSK3
  • Figures 3C and 3D show MF- ⁇ Akt protects BMDCs from wortmannin-mediated death in vitro.
  • BMDCs transduced with adenoviruses expressing GFP, M-Akt or MF- ⁇ Akt at 100 m.o.i. were further incubated with LPS (1 ⁇ g/ml) and wortmannin (W, 0.5 nM) for 2 days.
  • Figure 3C cell death was assessed by PI staining under indicated treatment conditions (open diagrams) compared to LPS alone (filled reference histogram). Numbers represent %-gated region of open diagrams.
  • Figure 3D is a graphical representation of Figure 3C.
  • Figure 3E shows Src and PI3K have independent roles in DC survival. Viability of BMDCs was assessed as above in Figure 3D except for replacement of wortmannin with Src kinase inhibitor, PP2 (20 ⁇ M).
  • Figure 4F shows MF- ⁇ Akt induces BMDC activation. Two days after indicated treatments of BMDCs, CDl lc+ DC activation was assessed by CD40, CD80, Kb and I-Ab staining. Numbers indicate percentage of cells in upper right quadrant. Data represent at least two independent experiments. Error bars represent S.D. of triplicate (Figure 3D and 3E) measurements. *, PO.005, **, P ⁇ 0.01.
  • Figures 5A-5E show the anti-apoptotic effect of Ad-M- Akt on DC death, in vitro.
  • BMDCs were left untreated (D), or treated with LPS ( ⁇ ), Ad-GFP (O) or Ad- M-Akt (•) at 100 m.o.i. and further incubated for 2 to 5 days without GM-CSF.
  • In vitro DC apoptosis was examined by Annexin V-PE staining. Histograms of Day 5 (open histogram) were compared to that of Day 2 (filled histogram).
  • numbers represent %-gated region of open histograms.
  • error bars indicate mean ⁇ S.D.
  • FIG. 5C, 5D and 5E show effects of Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt on BMDC longevity, in vivo.
  • Figure 5C shows representative dot plots of CFSE+ populations at day 5 (P ⁇ 0.05, between Ad-M-Akt and all controls). Boxed numbers indicate CFSE+ populations.
  • Figure 5D background CFSE+ from PBS control (-) was subtracted for each value. Error bars indicate mean ⁇ S.E.M. Data represent three independent experiments with similar results.
  • Figure 5E shows representative LNs isolated from indicated mice on day 7 and 10.
  • Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt-transduced DCs induced more T cell proliferation than Ad-GFP-transduced DCs, which was similar to LPS-treated DCs.
  • MF- ⁇ Akt-DCs induced about two-fold higher T cell proliferation than DCs activated with LPS (Fig. 6A).
  • Ad-M-Akt-transduced DCs also consistently showed 5-7-fold higher allogeneic T cell proliferation than DCs pulsed with LPS or Ad-GFP at low DC:effector ratios after 72 hours (Fig. 6B).
  • Akt upregulated Akt improves DC-mediated activation of T cells
  • secretion of IFN-gamma by OT- 1 splenocytes incubated with Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt- or control virus-pulsed DCs was examined.
  • Peptide-pulsed and Akt or GFP virus-transduced DCs were cultured with pooled spleen cells from OT- 1 mice for 24 hr or 72 hr. Then, the OVA peptide-specific splenocyte response was measured ex vivo by IFN-gamma ELISPOT assay.
  • LPS- or Ad-GFP-transduced DCs showed approximately the same numbers of IFN-gamma-producing cells, relative to untreated DCs.
  • MF- ⁇ Akt-DCs induced at least 7-fold higher IFN-gamma production by splenocytes (on both day 1 and day 3 (not shown)) than DCs treated with LPS or Ad-GFP (Fig. 6C). Therefore, in this experimental model, MF- ⁇ Akt-DCs elicit relatively persistent immunity by stimulating proliferation and activation of antigen specific CD8+ T cells.
  • Figures 6A-6C show MF- ⁇ Akt induces DC function to stimulate antigen-specific and allogeneic T cell proliferation.
  • BMDCs alone (D) or pulsed with SIINFEKL peptide for 2 hr (Figure 6A) were left untreated ( ⁇ ) or treated with LPS (A), Ad-EGFP (O) or Ad-M F - ⁇ Akt ( Figure 6A,#) and Ad-M-Akt ( Figure 6B, •) for 16 hr.
  • DCs were mixed in various dilutions with 1 x 10 5 splenocytes from syngeneic OT-I ( Figure 6A) or allogeneic Balb/c (Figure 6B) mice and incubated for an additional 1 to 3 days. T cell proliferative responses were measured by 3H- thymidine uptake (1 mCi/well) for 16 hr.
  • Figure 6C shows the effect of Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt transduction of BMDCs on CD8+ T cell activation.
  • DCs as treated in Figure 6A were incubated with splenocytes from syngeneic OT-I mice for 3 days. IFN-gamma+ spots were assessed. All data represent two to three independent experiments.
  • Example 7 MF- ⁇ Akt enhances the efficacy of DC vaccines to eradicate pre-established tumors
  • MF- ⁇ Akt-DCs successfully suppressed all pre-established EG.7-OVA tumors, although 2 of 5 tumors eventually relapsed (Fig. 13B).
  • H-2Kb OVA257-264 tetramer analysis was performed on peripheral blood CD8+ T cells harvested 14 days after vaccination. Consistent with tumor suppression, this analysis showed that vaccination with peptide-pulsed MF- ⁇ Akt-DCs led to an expanded population of OVA257-264 antigen- specific CD8+ T cells (Fig. 7B).
  • mice vaccinated with MF- ⁇ Akt-DCs showed clinical responses, such as extended reduction of tumor growth associated with tumor necrosis and frequently severe central ulceration.
  • those 5 mice one mouse exhibited stable tumor size and one mouse bearing an ⁇ 2 cm peak tumor size completely rejected its tumor without relapse up to 55 days (Fig. 13C and Fig. 13D).
  • Figure 7A shows growth of pre-established EG.7-OVA tumors following single vaccinations with Akt-transduced DCs.
  • Syngeneic C57BL/6 mice challenged with 2 x 10 6 EG.7-OVA thymoma cells at day 0 were treated at day 7 with PBS (A) or vaccinated with 2 x 10 6 BMDCs pulsed SIINFEKL peptide (20 ⁇ g/ml) alone (O) or treated with LPS (1 ⁇ g/ml) (#), 100 m.o.i.
  • Figure 7B shows the mean percentage of CD8+ and KbSIINFEKL tetramer positive population in PBMCs from two to three mice per group. ⁇ , P ⁇ 0.005.
  • Figure 7C shows tumor growth and Figure 7D shows animal survival regarding pre-established B 16 melanoma tumors following vaccinations with Akt-transduced DCs.
  • Treatment with indicated DC vaccines (2 x 10 6 DCs/mouse) pulsed with TRP2 peptide (10 ⁇ g/ml) was done 4 (or 5), 15 and 25 days after tumor injection (arrow).
  • FIG. 7E shows a memory CD8+ T Cell response by peptide-pulsed Akt-transduced DCs. Long-lived CD8+ memory responses were monitored two months after the third vaccination and 1-week after a booster DC vaccine following the initial three biweekly vaccinations of tumor naive animals with TRP-2-pulsed, PBS, Ad-GFP- or Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt-transduced BMDCs (2 x 10 6 DCs/mouse, 6 mice/group).
  • MoDCs pre-incubated with Ad- MF- ⁇ hAkt maintained viability up to 4 days after GM-CSF withdrawal, whereas Ad-GFP and MC-treated MoDCs showed extensive cell death by day 3, suggesting that targeted upregulation of Akt also inhibits death signals in human MoDCs and is more anti-apoptotic than standard MC.
  • Ad-MF- ⁇ hAkt-transduced MoDCs consistently enhanced expression of DC activation markers, including CD80, CD86 and CCR7 compared with Ad-GFP-transduced MoDCs.
  • MF- ⁇ hAkt-DC-mediated proliferative responses were closely correlated with robust MAGE-3-specific CTL responses against T2 cells pulsed with MAGE-3271-279 peptide and SK-Mel-37 (HLA- A2+/MAGE3+) target cells but not against control target cells, lacking HLA-A2 or MAGE3 (Fig. 8C).
  • MAGE-3271-279 peptide and SK-Mel-37 HLA- A2+/MAGE3+
  • MoDCs also can be primed with other antigens, such as a prostate cancer specific antigen, PSMA (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 10). Isolated MoDCs are incubated with the antigen for a period of time (e.g., approximately 1 -2 hours) and infected with MF- ⁇ hAkt adenovirus described above. After administration of the resulting MoDCs into human subjects, the proliferation response of antigen-specific CD8 + T cells is determined. The immune response against this antigen sometimes is compared against the immune response of control cells (e.g., cells lacking the antigen or a particular HLA molecule).
  • PSMA prostate cancer specific antigen
  • Figure 8A shows an anti-apoptotic effect of Ad-MF- ⁇ hAkt on human MoDC death.
  • MoDCs from two donors were left untreated (O), or treated with maturation cocktail (MC) (•), Ad5f35-GFP (D) or Ad5f35-M F - ⁇ hAkt ( ⁇ ) at 100 m.o.i. and further incubated for 1 to 4 days without hGM-CSF.
  • In vitro DC apoptosis was examined by PI staining.
  • Figure 8B shows enhanced MAGE3 -specific CD8+ T cells after stimulation with MF- ⁇ hAkt-transduced MoDCs.
  • Blood CD8+ T cells from a HLA-A2-positive healthy volunteer were stimulated with DCs untreated (-), or treated with maturation cocktail (+MC), Ad5f35-GFP (+GFP) or Ad5f35 -MF- ⁇ hAkt (+MF-hAkt) and stained with PE-conjugated HLA- A2/MAGE-3271-279 tetramer and FITC-conjugated CD8.
  • the percentages indicate the fraction of tetramer-positive cells within the entire populations of T cells.
  • Figure 8C shows MF- ⁇ hAkt transduced DCs enhance antigen specific CTL killing activity.
  • Human MoDCs were pulsed with MAGE3 peptide and adenoviruses (Ad-GFP, D, and Ad-M F - ⁇ hAkt, ⁇ ) or MC (•) as indicated. After three serial stimulations of autologous T cells with DCs at day 7 and 8, antigen-specific CTL activity was evaluated with 51 Cr release assay. Labeled target cells included melanoma cell lines SK- Mel-37 (MAGE3+, A2+), NA-6-Mel (MAGE3+, A2-), as well as T2 cells (MAGE3-, A2+) loaded with either MAGE3 (positive control) or influenza Ml (IM A2.1) peptides (as negative control). Data represent average of two donors ( Figure 8A) or three independent experiments with similar results ( Figures 8B and 8C). Error bars represent mean ⁇ S.D.
  • Figure 9A shows specificity of small interfering RNA for Akt - 1 (Akt-RNAi).
  • BMDCs were transfected with 100 nM of control RNAi (c - RNAi) or Akt -RNAi and further incubated for indicated times. Akt protein level was assessed by Akt immunobloting.
  • Figure 9B shows an effect of Akt -RNAi on LPS -mediated DC survival.
  • BMDCs ( -) and BMDCs transfected with c -RNAi or Akt -RNAi were incubated with LPS (1 ⁇ g/ml) for 3 days. Loaded proteins were normalized by actin immunobloting (Figure 9A).
  • Figure 10 shows a representative analysis of surface markers of Aktl +/+ or Aktl 7" DCs. After 6 days of DC differentiation, surface expression of MHC and costimulatory molecules in Aktl +/+ or Aktl 7" BMDCs was assessed by CD40, CD80, MHC class I K b and MHC class II I -Abstaining along with CDl Ic. Numbers indicate percentage of cells in that area.
  • Figure 11 shows a comparison of bone marrow and spleens isolated from Aktl +/+ or Ak t 7" mice. Size of spleens isolated form Aktl +/+ or Aktl 7" littermates was measured (bottom scale bar, 1 mm gap) and total cell numbers of bone marrow (pooled from two femurs and tibias) and spleens were assessed by trypan blue staining.
  • FIG. 12A shows a comparison of lipid raft localization of myristoylation-targeting sequences (Myr 1-16) from Src (MS), Fyn (MF) or Lck (ML) fused to GFP in 293 cells.
  • Membrane lipid rafts were stained with cholera toxin B (CTxB -TRITC).
  • Figure 12B shows inducible lipid raft localization of Akt. 293 cells were transfected with membrane docking protein with Fyn myristoylation sequence (M F-FRB 12) and three tandem FKBP domains fused with ⁇ Akt (F3 -GFP- ⁇ Akt), followed by chemically induced dimerization (CID, AP22783, Li, B. et al.
  • CID chemically induced dimerization
  • Figure 12C shows induced phosphorylation of substrate GSK3 by MS- ⁇ Akt, MF- ⁇ Akt, and ML- ⁇ Akt in 293 cells.
  • Figure 12D shows activation of NF- kappaB in Jurkat TAg cells transiently transfected with indicated amounts of control plasmid ( ⁇ ) or plasmids encoding MS- ⁇ Akt (D), MF- ⁇ Akt (•), or ML- ⁇ Akt (O) along with NF-kappaB SEAP reporter.
  • Figure 12E shows protection of wortmannin-mediated cell death by MS- ⁇ Akt (D) or MF- ⁇ Akt (•) in Jurkat TAg cells. Viability was assayed by flow cytometry of PI uptake in triplicate (MFI; mean fluorescent intensity).
  • Figure 13A shows representative examples of EG.7 -OVA tumor-bearing mice vaccinated with Ad- GFP or Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt BMDCs. Tumors were compared on day 7 and 14 after vaccination (day 14 and day 21 respectively).
  • Figures 13B and 13D show growth of individual pre-established EG.7-OVA tumors following single vaccinations with Akt-transduced DCs ( Figure 13B) or individual pre-established B16 tumors following triple vaccination with GFP- or Akt -transduced DCs ( Figure 13D). Numbers indicate individual tumor -bearing mice vaccinated with Akt-transduced DCs ( Figure 13B).
  • Figure 13C shows representative examples of B 16 melanoma tumor-bearing mice vaccinated with Ad-GFP (GFP), LPS or Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt (MF- ⁇ Akt) BMDCs. Tumors were compared on day 35 and 42 after tumor cell challenge.
  • GFP Ad-GFP
  • LPS Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt
  • BMDCs Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt
  • Figure 14 shows three representative animals of memory recall response of antigen-specific CD 8+ T cells by PBS (+PBS), Ad-GFP (+GFP) or Ad-MF- Akt (+MF- ⁇ Akt)-treated BMDCs.
  • Long-lived CD8+ memory responses were quantified by the percentage of the CD 8+ and H-2Kb/TRP2 tetramer positive population in PBMCs one week after a booster vaccination that followed two months after the initial three biweekly vaccinations. Numbers indicate percentage of cells in that area.
  • DCs are the most potent antigen-presenting cells capable of initiating an immune response by activating rare, na ⁇ ve antigen-specific T cells.
  • the outcome of immune responses depends on DC longevity and abundance at the site of T cell priming.
  • pro-inflammatory signals increase life span of DCs through NF-kappaB and Bcl-2 family members, the molecular mechanism of DC survival is still not clearly defined.
  • PI3K/Akt pathway is an essential mediator of LPS- and CD40-triggered survival signals that occur at the initiation of innate and adaptive immunity
  • Bcl-2 is a critical down-stream effector of Akt-mediated DC survival.
  • Aktl-/- BMDCs showed a large defect in the enhancement of DC activation and maturation markers even after LPS and CD40 stimulation (Fig. 2). Consistently, overexpression of Aktl itself was sufficient to enhance the expression of DC activation markers (Fig. 3F).
  • induced surface expression of CCR7 in MF- ⁇ hAkt- transduced DCs supports a model in which Aktl plays a positive role in DC migration.
  • Akt activation plays a critical role in preventing cell death in various cell types and contexts in vitro, only a few studies have reported that constitutively active Akt promotes survival of target cells in vivo. Because the Src myristoylation sequence, used in other Akt constructs, does not target proteins efficiently to lipid rafts, where Akt is most active, their efficacy may have been reduced.
  • the optimization studies described herein led to development of MF- ⁇ Akt, comprised of the Fyn myristoylation sequence ("MF”) fused to truncated Akt, ⁇ Akt, lacking a partially inhibitory pleckstrin homology domain.
  • MF Fyn myristoylation sequence
  • MF- ⁇ Akt functions better than M-Akt in vitro and sustains DC lifespan for at least 10 days post-delivery in vivo, indicating that the described Akt improvements translate to improved DC function.
  • MF- ⁇ Akt also appeared to regulate neurite morphology as well as the survival of cultured sensory neurons. Therefore, in addition to potentiating DC vaccine efficacy, functionally optimized Akt may have numerous applications. Targeting other signaling molecules directly to lipid rafts with the myristoylation-targeting sequence from Fyn, rather than Src, would likely improve many so-called "constitutive" alleles.
  • Aktl in BMDCs led to improved vaccination against both immunogenic tumors and poorly immunogenic B16 tumors (Fig. 7).
  • adenoviral administration of MF- ⁇ Akt provides a more robust and extended activation of DCs relative to the potent adjuvants such as LPS in mouse and maturation cocktails in human.
  • LPS and cytokine cocktails appeared more effective than Akt in maturing a higher percentage of DCs in vitro, most likely due to incomplete transduction of target cells by adenovirus, MF- ⁇ Akt transduced DCs achieved higher T cell proliferation, IFN-gamma production and cytolytic activity than DCs treated with LPS (mouse BMDCs) or maturation cocktails (human MoDCs).
  • MF- ⁇ Akt-DCs also efficiently induced long-lived CD8+ memory responses without detectable signs of autoimmunity (Fig. 7E, Fig. 14). Furthermore, in vivo, Ad- MF- ⁇ Akt led to a significantly improved DC-based tumor vaccine compared to antigen-loaded and LPS- treated DCs, which have been reported to efficiently retard tumor growth via supra-physiological T cell expansion in C57BL/6 mice bearing poorly immunogenic B16-F10 melanoma cells55.
  • the anti-tumor effects are due to the ability of functionally optimized Akt to evade negative feedback mechanisms of DC activation and survival, such as pro-inflammatory receptor desensitization or downregulationl3-15 and TLR-mediated upregulation of pro-apoptotic molecules 12 which can limit the survival signaling capacity of pro-inflammatory signals to maintain homeostasis.
  • functionally optimized Akt to evade negative feedback mechanisms of DC activation and survival, such as pro-inflammatory receptor desensitization or downregulationl3-15 and TLR-mediated upregulation of pro-apoptotic molecules 12 which can limit the survival signaling capacity of pro-inflammatory signals to maintain homeostasis.
  • in vitro transduction of DCs with Ad- MF- ⁇ Akt provides an alternative way to overcome some of the toxicity associated with in vivo administration of microbial adjuvant or systemic administration of soluble CD40L or CD40 specific monoclonal antibody.
  • mice and cell lines Six to eight-week-old female C57BL/6 mice were purchased from the Center for Comparative Medicine (Baylor College of Medicine, Houston, TX). BALB/c mice, Aktl+/-, Bcl-2+/- and OT-I TCR transgenic mice, responsive to OVA257-264 peptide (Kb-restricted SIINFEKL), were purchased from Jackson laboratory. Aktl-/- and Bcl-2-/- mice were obtained by inbreeding.
  • OVA- expressing EG7 thymoma cells were purchased from American Tissue Culture Collection and maintained in RPMI 1640 medium containing 10 % FBS, 0.4 mg/ml G418, 50 ⁇ M beta-mercaptoethanol, 1 mM sodium pyruvate, and antibiotics. All mice were housed in the pathogen- free units of Texas Mouse Facility at Baylor College of Medicine.
  • Reagents Recombinant murine GM-CSF and IL-4 were purchased from RDI Research Diagnostics. E. CoIi LPS and anti-mouse CD40 mAb (3/23) were purchased from Sigma and BD Pharmingen respectively.
  • the PI3-Kinase inhibitors LY294002 and wortmannin, ERK inhibitor PD98059, Src kinase inhibitor PP2, JNK inhibitor AG490 and Akt inhibitor were purchased from Calbiochem.
  • CFSE was purchased from Molecular Probes (Eugene). DC death was assessed using Propidium Iodide (PI; Sigma) and PE-conjugated Annexin V (BD Pharmingen).
  • OVA257-264 peptide (SIINFEKL) and MAGE-3271- 279 (FLWGPRALV) were purchased from (Tetramer Core Facility, Baylor College of Medicine). TRP2 peptide (VYDFFVWL) was utilized in the studies.
  • Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt expressing doubly acylated ⁇ Akt, MF- ⁇ Akt fragments were isolated from pBJ5-MF- ⁇ Akt by Not I/Klenow and EcoR I digestion and subcloned into Smal/EcoRI-digested shuttle vector pDNR-CMV to create pDNR- MF- ⁇ Akt.
  • recombinant adenoviral vector, pLP-Adeno-X-MF- ⁇ Akt, encoding MF- ⁇ Akt was generated by Cre-loxP- mediated recombination according to the Adeno-X-Expression System 2 (BD Biosciences) protocol.
  • MF- ⁇ hAkt (Ad5f35-MF-human ⁇ Aktl)
  • human ⁇ Aktl (lacking its PH domain) fused with myristoylation targeting sequence (MF) was subcloned into shuttle vector, pShuttle-X, sequenced, I-CeuI/PI-Scel-digested and transferred into similarly digested Ad5f35 (BCM Gene Vector Lab).
  • BMDCs Bone marrow derived dendritic cells
  • Aktl-/- mice C57BL/6 mice or two to three-week-old Bcl-2+/- and Bcl-2-/- mice were generated as described previously with minor modifications (Inaba, K. et al. Generation of large numbers of dendritic cells from mouse bone marrow cultures supplemented with granulocyte/macrophage colony-stimulating factor. J Exp Med 176, 1693-702 (1992)).
  • bone marrow cells were isolated from mouse femurs and tibias and cultured in DC medium (RPMI 1640 medium containing 10% FBS, 50 ⁇ M beta-mercaptoethanol, and antibiotics in the presence of 10 ng/ml each of mouse GM-CSF and IL-4). Half the culture medium was replaced every other day. On day 6, BMDCs were collected and enriched with CDl Ic microbeads (Miltenyi Biotec). For the generation of human monocyte-derived DCs (MoDCs) from healthy donors, peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMCs) were isolated by Lymphoprep (Nycomed Pharma AS, Oslo, Norway) and allowed to adhere in culture plates for 2 hr.
  • DC medium RPMI 1640 medium containing 10% FBS, 50 ⁇ M beta-mercaptoethanol, and antibiotics in the presence of 10 ng/ml each of mouse GM-CSF and IL-4.
  • BMDCs were collected and enriched with CDl Ic micro
  • Nonadherent cells were removed by extensive washes and adherent cells were cultured for 5 days in serum free DC medium (CellGenix) with 500U/ml of hIL-4 and 800 U/ml hGM- CSF (R&D Systems).
  • CD 14 microbeads CD 14 microbeads (Miltenyi Biotec) from PBMCs and cultured as described above.
  • BMDCs were treated with LPS (1 ⁇ g/ml), Ad-GFP or Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt for 2 hr, labeled with CFSE dye and injected subcutaneously into hind legs below knees of syngeneic C57BL/6 mice (1 x 106 cells per mouse) as described previously (Nopora, A. & Brocker, T. Bcl-2 controls dendritic cell longevity in vivo. J Immunol 169, 3006-14 (2002)).
  • the draining popliteal lymph nodes were harvested at various time points after injection, and percentage CFSE-positive cells among live LN cells (based on propidium iodide staining) were analyzed by flow cytometry. Flow cytometry analysis. Prior to staining with labeled antibodies, BMDCs were pretreated with Fc blocking antibody (anti-CD 16/CD32 mAb; BD Pharmingen) to avoid nonspecific binding. DCs were then stained with FITC-conjugated anti-mouse CDl Ic and PE-conjugated anti-mouse CD40, CD80, MHC class I Kb, or MHC class II I-Ab (BD Pharmingen).
  • Fc blocking antibody anti-CD 16/CD32 mAb
  • DCs were then stained with FITC-conjugated anti-mouse CDl Ic and PE-conjugated anti-mouse CD40, CD80, MHC class I Kb, or MHC class II I-Ab (BD Pharmingen).
  • peripheral blood lymphocytes were stained with FITC-conjugated anti-mouse CD ⁇ alpha (BD Pharmingen) and PE-conjugated H-2Kb/OVA257-264 tetramer or H-2Kb/TRP2181-188 (VYDFFVWL) respectively (Tetramer Core Facility, Baylor College of Medicine).
  • CD8+ T cells To detect MAGE-3- specific CD8+ T cells, presensitized CD8+ T cells were stained with PE-labeled HLA-A2/MAGE-3271- 279 (FL WGPRALV) tetramer (Tetramer Core Facility, Baylor College of Medicine) for 15 min at 37°C before addition of FITC-conjugated anti-human CD8 mAb (BD Biosciences). Stained cells were analyzed by flow cytometry and Flow Jo (TreeStar, Inc., Ashland, OR) software.
  • FL WGPRALV PE-labeled HLA-A2/MAGE-3271- 279
  • BMDCs Purified BMDCs (C57BL/6) were incubated with LPS (1 ⁇ g/ml), Ad-GFP or Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt virus at 100 m.o.i.
  • LPS 1 ⁇ g/ml
  • Ad-GFP Ad-GFP
  • Ad-MF- ⁇ Akt virus 100 m.o.i.
  • BMDCs were pulsed with SIINFEKL peptide (OVA257-264, Protein Chemistry Core Facility, Baylor College of Medicine) prior to incubation with LPS or recombinant adenoviruses.
  • BMDCs were co-cultured with syngeneic (C57BL/6) or allogeneic (BALB/c) splenocytes at different ratios (1 :50-l :6400) in 96-well round-bottom plates for 1 to 3 days. Thereafter, cells were pulsed with 1 ⁇ Ci of [ H] thymidine (New England Nuclear) per well for 12 hr, and thymidine incorporation was measured by liquid scintillation (1205 BS Betaplate). All experiments were conducted in triplicate and expressed as mean ⁇ S. D.
  • IFN-gamma ELISPOT assay BMDC-mediated T cell activation was assessed by IFN-gamma ELISPOT assay as described previously with minor modifications (Nikitina, E.Y. et al. Versatile prostate cancer treatment with inducible caspase and interleukin-12. Cancer Res 65, 4309-19 (2005)).
  • 2 x 105 OT-I splenocytes and syngeneic BMDCs treated with SIINFEKL peptide and LPS or adenoviruses were cultured for 24 or 72 hours in 96-well Multi-Screen-HA plates (Millipore) coated with 10 ⁇ g/mL of purified rat anti-mouse IFN-gamma monoclonal antibody (clone R4-6A2; PharMingen). Plates were then incubated overnight at 4°C with 5 ⁇ g/mL biotinylated rat anti-mouse IFN-gamma monoclonal antibody (clone XMGl.2; PharMingen). Spots were visualized with 5-bromo-4-chloro-3-indolylphosphate/nitro blue tetrazolium alkaline phosphatase substrate (Sigma) reaction and counted per triplicate well using a stereomicroscope.
  • EG.7-OVA thymoma or B16 melanoma cells were expanded in culture and injected subcutaneously into C57BL/6 mice (2 x 10 6 EG.7-OVA cells/mouse or 0.5 x 10 5 or 1 x 10 5 B 16 melanoma cells/mouse).
  • BMDCs were pulsed with SIINFEKL peptide (20 ⁇ g/ml) for EG.7-OVA cells or tyrosinase-related protein (TRP)-2 peptide (10 ⁇ g/ml, sequence VYDFFVWL) for B 16 cells, transduced with or without adenoviruses or LPS and injected intraperitoneally (2 x 10 6 DCs/mouse).
  • TRP tyrosinase-related protein
  • Single DC vaccine treatment was done 7 days after EG.7- OVA tumor injection (tumor sizes reached approximately 0.4 cm ) or triple DC vaccination was done 4 (or 5), 15 and 25 days after B 16 tumor injection. Two tumor measurements were recorded every 3-4 days. Tumor volumes were estimated as (ml2 x m2 x 0.5236) w 2 *l*0.5236.
  • MAGE3 -specific CTL activity assay For T cell assays, DCs were purified from HLA- A2 -positive healthy volunteers, after HLA typing by flow cytometry with FITC-conjugated anti-HLA-A2 specific antibody (BD Biosciences, San Diego, CA). DCs were pulsed with MAGE3271-279 (FLWGPRALV) peptide (Genemed Synthesis Inc, San Francisco, CA) and transduced with adenoviruses (Ad5f35-GFP or Ad5f35-MF- ⁇ hAkt, 10,000 vp/cell).
  • Cytolytic assays were performed by coculturing DCs with autologous T cells (isolated using a Pan T cell isolation kit (Miltenyi Biotec)) at 1 : 10 ratio. T cells were restimulated twice in the presence of IL-2 (lOU/ml). After 20 days of culture, effector cells were harvested and analyzed by cytolytic assays.
  • Target cells including melanoma cell lines SK-Mel-37 (MAGE3 positive, A2 positive), NA-6-Mel (MAGE3 positive, A2 negative) and T2 cells (MAGE3 negative, A2 positive) loaded with MAGE3271-279 peptide were labeled with 100 ⁇ Ci 51Cr-sodium chromate (Amersham Pharmacia Biotech) and cocultured for 6 hours with effector cells at the indicated cell ratios. The percentage of specific lysis was calculated as: 100* [(experimental - spontaneous release)/(maximum - spontaneous release)].
  • T2 cells were pulsed with flu matrix peptide (IMP) p58-66 GILGFVFT (Genemed Synthesis Inc).
  • siRNAs The previously identified small interfering RNA (siRNA) for Akt- 1 , matching closely all isoforms (siAKTc; Katome, T., et al. J. Biol. Chem. (2003) 278: 28312), was synthesized from Integrated DNA Technologies (Coralville, IA), and negative control siRNA was purchased from Ambion (Austin, TX). Transfection of siRNAs into BMDCs was done by GeneSilencerTM siRNA Transfection (GTS, San Diego, CA) or nucleofection using the Human Dendritic Cell Nucleofector Kit (Amaxa Biosystems, Gaithersburg, MD).
  • NF-kappaB secreted alkaline phosphatase (SEAP) reporter assay Jurkat TAg cells were transfected with indicated amounts of plasmids along with NF-kappaB SEAP reporter plasmid by electroporation. The following day, cells were plated with suboptimal concentrations of phorbol ester PMA (0.5 nM) and further incubated for about 24 hr. Thereafter, supernatants were collected and analyzed for SEAP activity as described previously (Li, B. et al. Gene Therapy (2001) 9: 233-244).
  • SEAP alkaline phosphatase
  • Inducible Akt (iAkt) membrane targeting was effected by (a) linking a modified Akt with a polypeptide that binds to a bifunctional compound, and (b) linking a membrane association component to a another polypeptide that binds to the same bifunctional compound. Adding the bifunctional compound to a system in which component (a) and (b) are present can induce the two components to join with one another and the complex can be recruited to the cell membrane in an inducible manner.
  • the bifunctional compound binds to (a) a derivative of FK binding protein linked to an Akt protein lacking a PH domain, and (b) a rapamycin binding domain from mTOR/FRAP/RAFT linked to a N-terminal myristoylation region from the protein kinase Src.
  • Constructs and methods for generating and using these components are described in U.S. patent application publication US2003/0144204 published on July 31, 2003 and filed on December 19, 2002, entitled "Akt- Based Inducible Survival Switch," which can be consulted by the person of ordinary skill in the art for any details not presented below.
  • Alternative embodiments include substituting the Src N-terminal myristoylation region with a dual acylation region from a different protein (e.g., from Fyn or Lck) or with another membrane protein or membrane protein fragment, as can be accomplished by the person of ordinary skill in the art using standard techniques.
  • a different protein e.g., from Fyn or Lck
  • Akt Plasmid Construction. To generate F3-Akt, F3 -DPH. Akt, F3-AktKM and variants, Akt and .DELTA.PH. Akt were Pfu (Stratagene)-amplified from pCMV6-HA-Akt or pCMV6-HA-AktK179M using Sall-linkered 5' primers, mAkt5SPH (full-length): 5'-agagcgacaacgacgtagccattgtgaaggag-3' or mAkt5S (truncated .DELTA.PH): 5'-agagtcgacaccgccattcagactgtggcc-3'; and 3' primer, mAkt3S: 5'- agagtcgacggctgtgccactggctgagtag-3'.
  • PCR products were subcloned into pCR-Blunt (Invitrogen) or pKSII+(Stratagene) and sequence verified, to createpSH5/mAkt, pSH5/m.DELTA.PH.Akt, and pKS/mAkt.KM.
  • the heterodimeric rapalog/CID.sub.HED can effect the crosslinking of FRBl and FKPB 12 (called F).
  • F the non-toxic variant of FKBP 12, Fpk (FKBP 12(G89P, 190K)), was used to eliminate background toxicity.
  • rapamycin binding domain from human FRAP (res. 2025-2113; T2098L) was Pful-amplified from FRAP*-AD using primers SEQ ID NO: 9 (5'-cgatctcgaggagatgtggcatgaaggcctgg-3') and 3FRBS: SEQ ID NO: 10 (5'- cgatgtcgacctttgagattcgtcggaacacatg-3') and subcloned into pCR-Blunt to produce pSH5/FRB.sub.1.
  • IHS internal ribosome entry sequence
  • the poliovirus IRES sequence (IRESp) was Pful-amplified from pTPOV-3816 with primers, 5pIRES/Mn: 5'-atacaattgccgcggttcgaattctgttttatactcccttccgtaac-3' and 3pIRES/Mun; 5'- tatcaattggtttaaacagcaaacagatagataatgagtctcac-3'.
  • the resulting PCR products were subcloned into pCR- Blunt to create pSH5/IRESp-Mun.
  • the 615-bp IRESp Muni fragment was ligated into EcoRI-digested pSHl/M-FRB.sub.l2-E to create pSHl/M-FRB.sub. l2-E-IRESp.
  • the Notl/EcoRI F3- .DELTA.PH.Akt fragment from pSHl/F3-.DELTA.PH.Akt was blunt-ligated into the Pmel site to create pSHl/M-FRB.sub.l 2-E-IRESp-F3.DELTA.PH.Akt, renamed as iAkt.sub.b.
  • the bicistronic vector iAkt. sub. a utilizes the EMCV IRES and was made by a comparable strategy.
  • Akt inducible Akt
  • F3 three tandem FKBP domains (F3) were fused to the N- or C-termini of wild-type Akt or a variant. .DELTA.PH.Akt), lacking the pleckstrin homology (PH) domain to reduce natural membrane association.
  • 293T human embryonic kidney cells (ATCC) and Jurkat (ATCC), Jurkat-TAg and Jurkat.iAkt were maintained in DMEM or RPMI- 1640, respectively, containing 10% fetal bovine serum (FBS) and antibiotics.
  • the Jurkat.iAkt line was derived by transfecting Jurkat cells with Ndel-linearized pBJ5-neo/iAkt.sub.b plasmid followed by G418 (1 mg/ml) selection. Clones were screened by anti-HA immunoblotting.
  • Akt Kinase Assay Immunoprecipitation and in vitro Akt Kinase Assay.
  • Jurkat.iAkt.sub.b were serum starved for 24 hours followed by treatment with AP22783 or serum for 30 min. Cells were then lysed in a lysis buffer provided with the Akt Kinase Assay kit (Cell Signaling, Beverly, Mass.), and F.sub.pk3-.DELTA.PH.Akt- E was immunoprecipitated with polyclonal anti-HA antibody. Antibody-antigen complexes were washed three times in lysis buffer and once in kinase buffer. In vitro kinase assays for Akt were performed using a GSK3.alpha./.beta. "crosstide". The extent of crosstide phosphorylation was determined by anti- GSK.alpha./.beta. immunoblotting according to the manufacturer's protocol.
  • JurkatiAkt were serum starved for 24 hours followed by pre- treatment with AP22783 in 0, 2 or 10% FBS for 40 min. After incubation with apoptosis-inducing stimuli for the periods indicated, cells were harvested and washed twice in ice-cold PBS and fixed in 70% ethanol. Cells were stained in 50 .mu.g/ml propidium iodide and 100 .mu.g/mlRNase A for 30 min at 37. degree. C, and hypodiploid cells were quantitated by flow cytometry using a Beckman-Coulter EPICS XL-MCL.
  • cell pellets were lysed in Laemmli sample buffer containing 5% (v/v) .beta.-mercaptoethanol (Bio-Rad, Hercules, Calif), and equal amounts of protein were separated on 6 (for PARP) or 12% (for caspase3) SDS-PAGE followed by immunoblotting with anti-caspase-3 and anti-PARP antibodies.
  • NF-kappaB induction is a major target of Akt following growth factor signaling, and multiple reports show that a constitutive Iy active myristoylated Akt (M-Akt) can enhance protein kinase C (PKC) -mediated NF-.kappa.B induction by either phosphorylation of IKK.alpha., the activation domain of p65/RelA, or both. Therefore, in order to optimize iAkt, an NF-.kappa.B-responsive secreted alkaline phosphatase (SEAP) reporter plasmid was used as an assay for Akt activation.
  • SEAP alkaline phosphatase
  • the human T cell line, Jurkat-TAg was cotransfected with reporter plasmid, NF- .kappa.B/SEAP, along with constitutively active M-Akt expression vector or empty control vector. Twenty- four hours after transfection, cells were divided into aliquots that were stimulated with sub- optimal levels (5 ng/ml) of the phorbol ester, PMA, or were untreated. After an additional 24 hours, SEAP activity was measured. Although Akt activity alone was insufficient to induce measurable NF-.kappa.B activity, M-Akt expression potentiated (by 3-4 fold) PKC-induced NF-.kappa.B activity, consistent with multiple reports.
  • Akt constitutively active Akt (T308) kinase, PDKl
  • PDKl constitutively active Akt
  • PH domain membrane-associated following growth factor stimulation
  • membrane recruitment of Akt via its PH domain is necessary for its activation.
  • the PH domain has been shown to suppress basal phosphorylation of T308 and Akt activation when not bound by its lipid ligand, PIP2, this initial phosphorylation should still require interaction with membrane-localized PDKl .
  • Basal Akt activity and activation following membrane recruitment of full length and truncated Akt, lacking the PH domain was compared using a NF-.kappa.B reporter assay.
  • Both full length and .DELTA.PH.Akt were fused to a tandem trimer of the CID-binding domain, F3, at both the amino and carboxyl termini.
  • F3 CID-binding domain
  • Jurkat-TAg cells were cotransfected with reporter plasmid NF- .kappa.B/SEAP along with the membrane docking molecule, M-FRB. sub.12, alone, various F3-Akt chimeras, alone, or both together. Twenty- four hours after transfection, cells were stimulated with 5 ng/ml PMA along with log dilutions of heterodimerizing CID, AP22783. After additional 24 hr incubation, SEAP activity was assayed.
  • Wild type Akt showed significant CID-independent NF-.kappa.B induction that was only slightly increased by crosslinking to the membrane, via M-FRB 12. This was true regardless of whether F3 was fused to the N- or C-terminus of Akt. As expected, membrane recruitment or overexpression of kinase-deficient Akt.KM (K179M) had no detectable effect on NF-.kappa.B induction over PMA alone. Thus, membrane recruitment of full-length Akt only slightly increases its activity due to the high basal activity from its overexpression. In contrast, membrane recruitment of F3-.DELTA.PH.Akt showed a very clear CID-dependent induction of NF-.kappa.B with undetectable CID-independent activity.
  • M.DELTA.PH.Akt was more active than M-Akt in augmenting NF- .kappa.B activation, consistent with an inhibitory function for the PH domain.
  • M-FRB. sub.1 2 alone or recruitment of kinase dead F3-.DELTA.PH.AktKM did not influence NF-.kappa.B induction.
  • adenoviral particles having a polynucleotide sequence encoding the M F - ⁇ Akt molecule and adenoviral particles having a polynucleotide sequence encoding the iCD40 construct were utilized to transduce dendritic cells (DCs).
  • DCs were pulsed with TRP-2i8i_i 88 peptide (10 micrograms/ml; VYDFFVWL) for about 3 hours and treated with the adenoviruses (about 10,000 viral particles/DC for iCD40 particles and control adenoviral particles (Ad-emp) and about 500 viral particles/DC for M F - ⁇ Akt particles) plus or minus LPS (1 ug/ml) as indicated for 2 hours.
  • the transduced DCs were utilized in a triple intraperitoneal vaccination (2 x 10 6 CDl Ic + DCs/lOOul PBS) on days 3, 10 and 17.
  • mice were C57BL/6 (6-8 wks) female mice (8 mice/group), and tumors were established by subcutaneous injection of B16 melanoma cells (100,000/10OuI) on the back of each mouse (day 0). Inducer was administered to the mice intraperitoneally at a dose of 2 mg/kg AP20187/1 OOul/mouse on days 4, 11, 18. Results are shown in Figures 15A and 15B. The combination yielded effects that were at least additive and may be synergistic. Effects of the combination are under additional investigation.
  • mice Six to eight week-old athymic male Balb/c nu/nu mice (NCI at Frederick, MD) are used as hosts for human xenografts (e.g., Xie et al. Cancer Research 61 : 6795-6804 (2001)). Mice are maintained in a specific pathogen-free environment, in compliance with standard guidelines. Cells in logarithmic-phase growth are lightly trypsinized and washed twice with OPTI -medium (GIBCO). Cell suspensions (1 x 10 6 -cells/200 ul) of modified DCs primed with antigen, as described herein (e.g., in Example 8), are subcutaneously injected into the right flank of the mice.
  • OPTI -medium OPTI -medium
  • SEQ ID NO: 1 (Accession no. NM 009652: mouse Aktl) i ccgggaccag cggacggacc gagcagcgtc ctgcggccgg caccgcggcg gcccagatcc
  • SEQ ID NO: 2 (Accession no. NM 001014431 : human Aktl mRNA) i cggcaggacc gagcgcggca ggcggctggc ccagcgcagc cagcgcggcc cgaaggacgg
  • SEQ ID NO: 3 (Accession no. NM OO 1626: human Akt2 mRNA) i gaattccagc ggcggcgccg ttgccgctgc cgggaaacac aaggaaaggg aaccagcgca
  • SEQ ID NO: 4 (Accession no. NM 005465: human Akt3 mRNA) i gcagcagcag agaatccaaa ccctaaagct gatatcacaa agtaccattt ctccaagttg
  • Amino acid sequences of the forgoing mRNA sequences can be obtained by a person of ordinary skill in the art by consulting standard internet resources.
  • Amino acid sequences encoded by SEQ ID NO: 1-4 are designated by Accession nos. NP_033782, NP_001014432, NP_001617 and NP_005456, respectively.
  • Other cloned sequences for each of these Akt forms also are available and accessed by the person of ordinary skill in the art.
  • SEQ ID NO: 5 mRNA of human Aktl lacking a PH domain; ⁇ PHAkt-1 (starting at position 101 of the encoded amino acid sequence): accgccatccagactgtggctgacggcctcaagaagcaggaggaggaggagatggacttccggtcgggctcacccagtgacaactc aggggctgaagagatggaggtgtccctggccaagcccaagcaccgcgtgaccatgaacgagtttgagtacctgaagctgctgggca
  • SEQ ID NO: 6 amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 5
  • SEQ ID NO: 7 (membrane association region from human c-Fyn) atgggctgtgtgcaatgtaaggataaagaagcaacaaactgacggaggag—ctcgag
  • SEQ ID NO: 8 amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 7
  • SEQ ID NO: 9 (nucleotide sequence encoding PSMA)
  • SEQ ID NO: 10 PSMA amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 9

Abstract

Modified antigen presenting cells provided herein have improved lifespan and immunogenicity compared to unmodified antigen presenting cells, and are useful for immunotherapy. The modified antigen presenting cells express an altered protein kinase, referred to herein as 'Akt.' The altered Akt associates with the cell membrane with greater frequency than unaltered Akt, and is referred to herein as 'membrane -targeted Akt.'

Description

MODIFIED DENDRITIC CELLS HAVING ENHANCED SURVIVAL AND IMMUNOGENICITY AND RELATED COMPOSITIONS AND METHODS
Related Patent Application
This patent application claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application no. 60/803,025 filed on May 23, 2006, entitled "Modified Dendritic Cells Having Enhanced Survival and Immunogenicity and Related Compositions and Methods," naming Park et al. as inventors, and designated by attorney docket no. BEL-IOOl-PV. The entire content of this provisional patent application is incorporated herein by reference in jurisdictions permitting such incorporation.
Government Support
This invention was made in part with government support under Grant No. DAMD 17-03-1 - 0156 awarded by the Department of Defense. The government has certain rights in this invention.
Field of the Invention
The invention pertains generally to immunotherapy, and more specifically to antigen-presenting cells.
Background
Immunotherapy treatments generally involve inducing an immune response against a disease- associated antigen in a subject by sensitizing the subject's immune system to the antigen. The immune response often is induced by a vaccine that bears the antigen. Upon treatment with the vaccine, the immune system attacks cells bearing the antigen, which leads to a therapeutic effect. The immunity induced by vaccines depends largely on the efficiency of the antigen presenting cells (APC) that process and present the antigen. Dendritic cells (DCs) are APCs that can be responsible for vaccine efficacy by capturing and processing antigen and stimulating T cell immunity. It is possible to generate ex vivo functional DCs from a subject's peripheral blood monocytes or CD34 haemopoietic stem cells. In ex vivo approaches, dendritic cells generated from a patient's peripheral blood monocytes or CD34 haemopoietic stem cells can be loaded with a disease-associated antigen and reinfused into the patient with the aim of generating effective anti-disease immunity.
Summary
Dendritic cells (DCs) are potent antigen-presenting cells (APCs), justifying their widespread use in vaccination protocols for the treatment of various malignancies. The lifespan of activated DCs is limited to only a few days in draining lymph nodes and phagocytosis or "reprocessing" of antigens from dying DCs to immature APCs can lead to tolerance. The limited lifespan of DCs therefore has been a shortcoming of immunotherapy. Modified DCs provided herein have improved lifespan and immunogenicity, and are useful for immunotherapy. The modified DCs express an altered protein kinase, referred to herein as "protein kinase B" or "Akt." The altered Akt associates with cell membranes with greater frequency than unaltered Akt, and is referred to herein as "membrane-targeted Akt."
Thus, provided herein is a dendritic cell which comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt protein. The dendritic cell (DC) often originates from a mammal, including, for example, a rodent, (e.g., rat, mouse, rabbit, hamster, guinea pig), dog, cat, ungulate, fish, avian, monkey, ape or human. DCs often are isolated from a subject (e.g., a human) and then cultured ex vivo under conditions suitable for maintaining DCs for one or more days.
The membrane-targeted Akt protein comprises a mammalian Akt protein or a fragment thereof. A fragment often includes the protein kinase catalytic domain of Akt, and sometimes does not include the N- terminal pleckstrin homology (PH) domain of native Akt. Amino acid sequences of mammalian Akt proteins or fragments are known, and sometimes the amino acid sequence is a mouse or a human Akt protein, a fragment thereof, a substantially identical variant of the foregoing. A human Akt protein may have the amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 2, 3, or 4, or a substantially identical variant thereof. An Akt protein fragment may have a portion of the amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 2, 3, or 4 or a substantially identical variant thereof, and in some embodiments, the fragment has the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 6 (i.e., encoded by SEQ ID NO: 5).
In certain embodiments, the membrane-targeted Akt protein is in association with a membrane association region, the latter of which can increase the frequency with which the Akt protein is in association with a cell membrane or portion thereof. In some embodiments, the membrane -targeted Akt interacts with (e.g., binds with) affinity and selectivity to membrane rafts in cells. The term "in association" as used herein with respect to an Akt region and a membrane association region refers to covalent or non-covalent association of the membrane association region to an Akt protein or fragment. The N- or C- terminus of an Akt protein or fragment may be covalently linked to a membrane association region, and a membrane association region may be linked to a non-terminal portion of an Akt protein or fragment. A protein having an Akt protein region and a membrane association region may be referred to as a "fusion protein" or "chimeric protein." In certain embodiments, an Akt chimeric protein does not include a heterologous multimerization region, such as a region that binds to a FK506 molecule or analog thereof, and in such embodiments, the chimeric protein can be constitutively active. An Akt protein or fragment component may be non-covalently associated with a membrane association region component via a complementary member of a binding pair linked to each component. The membrane association region and the Akt protein or fragment in the membrane -targeted Akt often are homologous (e.g., each are a human amino acid sequence), and sometimes are heterologous (e.g., one is a human amino acid sequence and the other is a mouse amino acid sequence).
A membrane association region often is an amino acid fragment of a native mammalian protein, or a substantially identical sequence thereof. Membrane association regions include, for example, acylation regions, transmembrane proteins, and transmembrane protein fragments. Acylation regions are capable of being linked to one or more acyl moieties. For example a dual acylation region is capable of being linked to two acyl moieties. In certain embodiments, the acylation region is from a protein kinase, such as Fyn, Lck or Src, for example, which can be myristoylated and may be linked to the N-terminus of the Akt protein or fragment. In some embodiments, the acylation region comprises a cys-ala-ala sequence, and sometimes the region is from a G-protein, which can be linked to the C-terminus of the Akt protein or fragment.
The nucleotide sequence that encodes the membrane -targeted Akt can be incorporated in the dendritic cell in a variety of manners. For example, one or more copies of the nucleotide sequence may be stably inserted into the dendritic cell genomic DNA by random insertion or by non-random insertion (e.g., knock-in), or the nucleotide sequence may be non-stab Iy inserted in the dendritic cell (e.g., in plasmid DNA). For embodiments in which (a) an Akt protein or fragment-binding partner component and (b) a membrane association region-binding partner component, are expressed in a dendritic cell, each component may be expressed from a nucleotide sequence in functional association with a common promoter or from different promoters.
Modified dendritic cells comprising a nucleotide sequence that expresses a membrane -targeted Akt generally (a) survive longer on average than counterpart dendritic cells that do not include the nucleotide sequence, (b) present a greater amount of antigen on average than cells that do not include the nucleotide sequence, and (c) are more immunogenic on average than cells that do not include the nucleotide sequence. Processes for assessing dendritic cell survival periods and antigen presentation and immunogenicity are well known to the person of ordinary skill in the art.
A modified dendritic cell described herein sometimes is provided in a composition comprising components suitable for administering the dendritic cell to a subject. For example, dendritic cells can be mixed with Toll-like receptor (TLR) ligands that can increase DC activation locally, such as monophosphoryl lipid A (TLR4 ligand), imiquimod (TLR7/8 ligand), unmethylated CpG oligonucleotides (TLR9 ligand), and others. Additional activation ligands, such as those found in monocyte-conditioned media "maturation cocktail" also can be included. Thus, included is a non-human organism, sometimes a mammalian organism, comprising a modified dendritic cell described herein.
Also provided are methods for preparing a modified dendritic cell, which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell with a nucleic acid having a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt protein, whereby the modified dendritic cell survives longer on average than dendritic cells that do not include the nucleotide sequence. The resulting modified dendritic cell often presents a greater amount of antigen on average than cells that do not include the nucleotide sequence, and the resulting modified dendritic cell is more immunogenic on average than cells that do not include the nucleic acid. The nucleic acid sometimes is isolated from a source (e.g., a cell or virus) before contacting the dendritic cell with the nucleic acid, and sometimes the nucleic acid is within a virus and is delivered to the dendritic cell by contacting the cell with the virus, whereby the virus inserts the nucleic acid into the cell. In some embodiments, the modified dendritic cell is contacted with an antigen or antigen precursor. Any antigen or precursor suitable for immunotherapy can be utilized, such as an antigen expressed more frequently in cancer cells than in non-cancer cells, for example. The antigen may result from contacting the modified dendritic cell with prostate specific membrane antigen (PSMA) or a fragment thereof. In certain embodiments, the modified dendritic cell is contacted with a PSMA fragment having the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 10 (e.g., encoded by the nucleotide sequence of SEQ ID NO: 9).
Provided also are methods for loading a modified dendritic cell with an antigen, comprising: contacting a modified dendritic cell with an antigen or antigen precursor, where the modified dendritic cell expresses a membrane -targeted Akt protein, whereby the modified dendritic cell is loaded with the antigen. The antigen can be delivered as a purified protein or purified fragment, or by a viral or non- viral sequence. Also provided are methods for manufacturing a virus having a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt protein, which comprise: transfecting a producer cell with a virus having a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt; and isolating the virus produced by the cells.
Also provided are isolated membrane-targeted Akt proteins. For example, included is a protein comprising: (a) a mammalian Akt portion lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and (b) a dual acylation portion, or (c) a membrane protein or membrane protein fragment. Portion (a) may be covalently linked or non-covalently linked to portion (b) or portion (c). In certain embodiments, portion (a) is non-covalently linked to portion (b) or portion (c) by components of a binding pair linked to each of portion (a) and portion (b) or (c). In certain embodiments, the dual acylation portion is from a protein kinase, such as Fyn, Lck or Src, for example. In certain embodiments, the dual acylation region comprises two acyl moieties, where one or both of the acyl moieties may be selected from the group consisting of myristoyl, geranyl, farnesyl and prenyl. The acylation region may comprise a cys-ala-ala sequence, and may be from a G-protein. In some embodiments, the dual acylation portion is identical to or substantially identical to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 8. The acylation portion, membrane protein or membrane protein fragment may be linked to the N-terminus or C-terminus of the Akt portion. The mammalian Akt portion may be identical to or substantially identical to mouse Akt, or a fragment thereof, or may be identical to or substantially identical to human Akt, or a fragment thereof. In certain embodiments, the mammalian Akt portion is identical to or substantially identical to the amino acid sequence encoded by the nucleotide sequence of SEQ ID NO: 6, or a fragment thereof. Also provided is an antibody or antibody fragment that specifically binds to a membrane-targeted Akt protein.
In some embodiments, a membrane -targeted Akt protein may include one or more multimerization regions (e.g., one, two, three, four or more multimerization regions), and one or more multimerization regions may be located at the N-terminus of the chimeric protein, within the protein (e.g., between an Akt region and a membrane association region), or at the C-terminus of the protein. A multimeriation region often is heterologous to other regions of the membrane-targeted Akt protein (i.e., the nucleic acid encoding the multimerization region is not linked in vivo to a nucleic acid sequence encoding the Akt protein or the acylation region). A multimerization region may be covalently linked or non-covalently linked to a membrane-targeted Akt protein. An example of a multimerization region is an amino acid sequence that binds to a FK506 molecule or analog thereof. A membrane-targeted Akt protein containing a multimerization region can be referred to as an "inducible membrane-targeted Akt protein." In certain embodiments, a membrane -targeted does not contain a multimerization region or a heterologous multimerization region. A membrane -targeted Akt protein not containing a multimerization region or heterologous multimerization region can be referred to as a "constitutively active membrane-targeted Akt protein."
Provided also is a nucleic acid which comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane- targeted Akt protein described herein. In certain embodiments, the nucleic acid comprises a promoter operably linked to the nucleotide sequence. The promoter sometimes is constitutively active, at times is inducible, and can be from a virus. The nucleic acid in some embodiments comprises one or more nucleotide sequences from a virus, and in certain embodiments, the nucleic acid is derived from a virus. Any suitable virus capable of expressing a protein in cells, and optionally replicating in cells, can be utilized, such as adenovirus.
Also provided is a cell which comprises a nucleic acid described herein. The cell can be an antigen presenting cell, such as a dendritic cell for example, and the cell sometimes is a human cell. The cell containing the nucleic acid often (a) survives longer on average than a counterpart cell that does not include the nucleic acid (i.e., the same type of cell that does not contain the nucleic acid), (b) presents a greater amount of antigen on average than a counterpart cell that does not include the nucleic acid, and/or (c) is more immunogenic on average than a cell that does not include the nucleic acid. In the cell, the membrane-associated Akt protein encoded by the nucleic acid can be in association with a raft membrane with higher frequency than other portions of the cell membrane, in certain embodiments.
Provided also is a method for inducing an immune response against an antigen, which comprises contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane -targeted Akt protein with an antigen or antigen precursor; and administering the dendritic cell to a subject; whereby the immune response against the antigen is induced. Also included is a method for detecting an immune response against an antigen, which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane-targeted Akt protein with an antigen; administering the dendritic cell to a subject; and detecting the immune response. Provided in addition is a method for reducing cell proliferation in a subject, which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane-targeted Akt protein with an antigen produced in proliferating cells; and administering the dendritic cell to a subject; whereby cell proliferation is reduced. In certain methods, the antigen or a fragment thereof sometimes is co-administered to the subject (e.g., before, during or after administration of the dendritic cell). Administration of the dendritic cell and/or antigen may be pulsed (e.g., administered multiple times over a period of time (e.g., within a day, once every five days). Also provided is a method for inhibiting tumor growth in a subject, which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane -targeted Akt protein with an antigen produced by cells in a tumor; and administering the dendritic cell to a subject having a tumor; whereby tumor growth is inhibited.
Also provided is a kit which comprises a nucleic acid comprising a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt protein described herein. In certain embodiments, the nucleic acid is packaged in a virus, and sometimes the virus is an adenovirus, such as a replication deficient adenovirus. In some embodiments, the kit comprises one or more transfection components for inserting the nucleic acid into a dendritic cell. A kit may comprise an antigen, and/or a second nucleic acid that encodes an antigen. Some kits comprise instructions, or directions to obtain instructions (e.g., obtained from a website), for preparing a dendritic cell with the nucleic acid comprising a nucleotide sequence that encodes the membrane-targeted Akt.
Also provided is an isolated nucleic acid which comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein containing: a first region comprising a human Akt sequence lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and a second region linked to the N-terminus of the Akt sequence comprising two or more acylation sites. In certain embodiments, the second region comprises a Gly-Cys-Xaa-Cys- sequence, and sometimes the second region is about 5 to about 25 amino acids in length and from the N-terminus of the nucleic acid kinase Fyn, Yes or Lck. The second region sometimes comprises two acyl moieties, such as a myristoyl and palmitoyl region, for example. In certain embodiments, the Akt sequence is identical to or substantially identical to a fragment of an amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 2, 3, or 4. Sometimes the Akt sequence is identical to or substantially identical to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 6, and at times the Akt sequence is identical to or substantially identical to an amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 5. In certain embodiments, the second region is identical to or substantially identical to the amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 7 (from Fyn). Provided also is an adenovirus which comprises the nucleotide sequence of any one of the preceding aspects. Also provided is a cell which comprises the nucleotide sequence of any one of the preceding aspects. In some embodiments the cell is a human antigen presenting cell, such as a human dendritic cell. In certain embodiments, the cell has been contacted with an antigen, such as a prostate specific membrane antigen or fragment thereof (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 10).
Also provided is a method for inducing an immune response, which comprises: (a) contacting a dendritic cell from a human subject with an antigen; (b) contacting the dendritic cell with a nucleic acid that comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein containing: a first region comprising a human Akt sequence lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and a second region linked to the N-terminus of the Akt sequence comprising two or more acylation sites; and administering the dendritic cell after steps (a) and (b) to the subject, whereby an immune response is induced. The immune response often is or includes an antigen-specific CTL response, and sometimes the antigen is a prostate specific membrane antigen or fragment thereof (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 10). Provided also is a method for inducing an immune response, which comprises: (a) contacting a dendritic cell from a human subject with an antigen; (b) contacting the dendritic cell with a nucleic acid that comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein containing: a first region comprising a human Akt sequence lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and a second region linked to the N-terminus of the Akt sequence comprising two or more acylation sites; and proliferating in vitro antigen-specific CTLs against the dendritic cell after steps (a) and (b), whereby an immune response is induced. In certain embodiments the CTLs are administered to the subject, and sometimes the antigen is a prostate specific membrane antigen or fragment thereof (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 10).
These and other embodiments are described hereafter in the Detailed Description and in the Claims.
Brief Description of the Drawings
Figures IA to IF show LPS and CD40 prevent DC death by blocking the down-regulation of Akt and Bcl-2.
Figures 2A-2F show Aktl is critical for LPS and CD40-mediated DC survival and activation.
Figures 3A-3F show functionally optimized Akt induces DC activation and protects DCs from PI3K inhibition.
Figure 4 shows Akt-mediated DC longevity requires Bcl-2.
Figures 5A-5E show MF-ΔAkt and M- Akt induce BMDC longevity in vitro and in vivo.
Figures 6A-6C show MF-ΔAkt and M-Akt-expressing BMDCs reveal improved T cell activation and proliferation.
Figures 7A-7E show MF-ΔAkt expression enhances the efficacy of DC-based therapeutic tumor vaccines.
Figures 8A-8C show MF-ΔhAkt induces human MoDC longevity leading to improved antigen- specific CTL activation and proliferation.
Figures 9A-9C show effects of Akt inhibitors on DC survival.
Figure 10 shows a representative analysis of surface markers of Aktl+/+ or Aktl7" DCs.
Figure 11 shows a comparison of bone marrow and spleens isolated from Aktl+/+ or Ak t ~'~ mice.
Figures 12A-12E show effects of different acylation regions.
Figures 13A-13D show effects of modified DCs described herein on tumor growth and animal survival.
Figure 14 shows representative memory recall responses for particular antigens.
Figures 15A- 15B show effects of a combination immunotherapy.
Detailed Description
Akt Molecules
The term "Akt molecule" refers to a molecule, such as a protein, polypeptide, nucleic acid or expression vector, for example, comprising a native Akt sequence, or fragment thereof or substantially identical variant of the foregoing. An Akt molecule often is capable of enhancing antigen presenting cell longevity and immunogenicity when expressed in an antigen presenting cell in such a manner that it is membrane-targeted, and constitutively active in certain embodiments. An Akt molecule also may include other portions in addition to the Akt sequence, and in such embodiments, the Akt sequence in the Akt molecule sometimes is referred to herein as an "Akt portion" or "Akt region." Additional sequences that may be included optionally in an Akt molecule are described herein, such as a membrane association sequence and/or a multimerization sequence, for example.
An Akt sequence may be a native Akt sequence, a fragment of an Akt sequence or a substantially identical variant of the foregoing. An Akt sequence often is mammalian (e.g., mouse or human), or a fragment or variant sequence thereof. Examples of native polynucleotide sequences that encode Akt polypeptides include, but are not limited to, SEQ ID NO: 1 (mouse Aktl), SEQ ID NO: 2 (human Aktl), SEQ ID NO: 2 (human Akt2), SEQ ID NO: 4 (human Akt3), and Akt homologs from other species, often mammals, and including Akt oncogenic viral sequences.
As noted above, Akt sequences include Akt fragment sequences. An AKT fragment sequence may lack one or more nucleotides, amino acids or regions, the latter of which may be a functional region or domain. An Akt fragment sequence can include one or more functional regions, and may lack one or more functional regions compared to a native Akt sequence. Functional regions include a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain (e.g., from about position 6 to about position 107 in human AKTl), a serine/threonine protein kinase catalytic region (e.g., from about position 149 to about position 408 in human AKTl) and a catalytic domain extension region (e.g., from about position 409 to about position 476 in human AKTl). Where an Akt fragment sequence includes one or more functional regions, the region may be flanked on each side by a native amino acid sequence from a native Akt sequence. In certain embodiments, an Akt amino acid fragment sequence is 10 or more, 15 or more, 20 or more, 25 or more, 50 or more, 100 or more, 200 or more, 300 or more, 400 or more or 450 or more amino acids from a native Akt protein. An Akt molecule often includes an Akt protein kinase catalytic domain, and therefore often is capable of catalyzing Ser/Thr protein phosphorylation. An Akt fragment can exclude a PH domain or includes a modified PH domain. A modified PH domain may be truncated or mutated, generated by using standard mutagenesis, insertions, deletions, or substitutions, and the modified form may or may not be functional. Examples of Akt nucleic acids lacking a functional PH domain sequence have the nucleotide sequences of SEQ ID NO: 5 (mouse Akt) and SEQ ID NO: 6 (human Akt).
Akt sequences include homologs, alternative transcripts, alleles, functionally equivalent fragments, variants, and analogs of native Akt sequences (e.g., nucleotide sequences described herein). The term "substantially identical variant" as used herein refers to a nucleotide or amino acid sequence sharing sequence identity to a nucleotide sequence or amino acid sequence of Akt or another molecule described herein (e.g., membrane association region). Included are nucleotide sequences or amino acid sequences 55% or more, 60% or more, 65% or more, 70% or more, 75% or more, 80% or more, 85% or more, 90% or more, 95% or more (each sometimes within a 1%, 2%, 3% or 4% variability) identical to a nucleotide sequence or encoded amino acid sequence described herein, or has one to ten nucleotide or amino acid substitutions. One test for determining whether two nucleotide sequences or amino acids sequences are substantially identical is to determine the percent of identical nucleotide sequences or amino acid sequences shared.
Calculations of sequence identity can be performed as follows. Sequences are aligned for optimal comparison purposes (e.g., gaps can be introduced in one or both of a first and a second amino acid or nucleic acid sequence for optimal alignment and non-homologous sequences can be disregarded for comparison purposes). The length of a reference sequence aligned for comparison purposes is sometimes 30% or more, 40% or more, 50% or more, often 60% or more, and more often 70% or more, 80% or more, 90% or more, or 100% of the length of the reference sequence. The nucleotides or amino acids at corresponding nucleotide or polypeptide positions, respectively, are then compared among the two sequences. When a position in the first sequence is occupied by the same nucleotide or amino acid as the corresponding position in the second sequence, the nucleotides or amino acids are deemed to be identical at that position. The percent identity between the two sequences is a function of the number of identical positions shared by the sequences, taking into account the number of gaps, and the length of each gap, introduced for optimal alignment of the two sequences. Comparison of sequences and determination of percent identity between two sequences can be accomplished using a mathematical algorithm. Percent identity between two amino acid or nucleotide sequences can be determined using the algorithm of Meyers & Miller, CABIOS 4: 11-17 (1989), which has been incorporated into the ALIGN program (version 2.0), using a PAM 120 weight residue table, a gap length penalty of 12 and a gap penalty of 4. Also, percent identity between two amino acid sequences can be determined using the Needleman & Wunsch, J. MoI. Biol. 48: 444-453 (1970) algorithm which has been incorporated into the GAP program in the GCG software package (available at the http address www.gcg.com), using either a Blossum 62 matrix or a PAM250 matrix, and a gap weight of 16, 14, 12, 10, 8, 6, or 4 and a length weight of 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6. Percent identity between two nucleotide sequences can be determined using the GAP program in the GCG software package (available at http address www.gcg.com), using a NWSgapdna.CMP matrix and a gap weight of 40, 50, 60, 70, or 80 and a length weight of 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6. A set of parameters often used is a Blossum 62 scoring matrix with a gap open penalty of 12, a gap extend penalty of 4, and a frameshift gap penalty of 5.
Another manner for determining whether two nucleic acids are substantially identical is to assess whether a polynucleotide homologous to one nucleic acid will hybridize to the other nucleic acid under stringent conditions. As use herein, the term "stringent conditions" refers to conditions for hybridization and washing. Stringent conditions are known to those skilled in the art and can be found in Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, John Wiley & Sons, N.Y. , 6.3.1-6.3.6 (1989). Aqueous and nonaqueous methods are described in that reference and either can be used. An example of stringent hybridization conditions is hybridization in 6X sodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45°C, followed by one or more washes in 0.2X SSC, 0.1% SDS at 500C. Another example of stringent hybridization conditions are hybridization in 6X sodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45°C, followed by one or more washes in 0.2X SSC, 0.1% SDS at 55°C. A further example of stringent hybridization conditions is hybridization in 6X sodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45°C, followed by one or more washes in 0.2X SSC, 0.1% SDS at 600C. Often, stringent hybridization conditions are hybridization in 6X sodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45°C, followed by one or more washes in 0.2X SSC, 0.1% SDS at 65°C. More often, stringency conditions are 0.5M sodium phosphate, 7% SDS at 65°C, followed by one or more washes at 0.2X SSC, 1% SDS at 65°C.
An example of a substantially identical nucleotide sequence to a base nucleotide sequence described herein is one that has a different nucleotide sequence but still encodes the same amino acid sequence encoded by the base nucleotide sequence. Another example is a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein having an amino acid sequence 70% or more identical to, sometimes 75% or more, 80% or more, or 85% or more identical to, and often 90% to 99% identical to an amino acid sequence encoded by the base nucleotide sequence.
Nucleotide sequences and encoded amino acid sequences described herein can be used as "query sequences" to perform a search against public databases to identify other family members or related sequences, for example. Such searches can be performed using the NBLAST and XBLAST programs (version 2.0) of Altschul et al., J. MoI. Biol. 215: 403-10 (1990). BLAST nucleotide searches can be performed with the NBLAST program, score = 100, wordlength = 12 to obtain nucleotide sequences homologous to nucleotide sequences described herein. BLAST polypeptide searches can be performed with the XBLAST program, score = 50, wordlength = 3 to obtain amino acid sequences homologous to those encoded by nucleotide sequences described herein. To obtain gapped alignments for comparison purposes, Gapped BLAST can be utilized as described in Altschul et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 25(17): 3389- 3402 (1997). When utilizing BLAST and Gapped BLAST programs, default parameters of the respective programs (e.g., XBLAST and NBLAST) can be used (see the http World Wide Web address ncbi.nlm.nih.gov). Thus, a protein having a substantially identical amino acid sequence to (i) an amino acid sequence described herein or (ii) an amino acid sequence encoded by a nucleotide sequence described herein, identified by a query sequence search can be considered a substantially identical sequence.
Substantially identical nucleotide sequences may include altered codons for enhancing expression of an amino acid sequence in a particular expression system. One or more codons may be altered, and sometimes 10% or more or 20% or more of the codons are altered for optimized expression in an expression system that may include bacteria (e.g., E. coli.), yeast (e.g., S. cervesiae), human (e.g., 293 cells or antigen presenting cells), insect, or rodent (e.g., hamster) cells (e.g., antigen presenting cells).
An Akt protein, polypeptide or fragment variant can include one or more amino acid substitutions, deletions or insertions. Any amino acid may be substituted by a conservative or non-conservative substitution. For example, phosphorylatable amino acids (e.g., serine, threonine or tyrosine) in an Akt protein or fragment may be modified (e.g., deleted or substituted with an amino acid that cannot be phosphorylated). An Akt protein, polypeptide or fragment variant may contain one or more unnatural amino acids. Unnatural amino acids include but are not limited to D-isomer amino acids, ornithine, diaminobutyric acid, norleucine, pyrylalanine, thienylalanine, naphthylalanine and phenylglycine, alpha and alpha- disubstituted amino acids, N-alkyl amino acids, lactic acid, halide derivatives of natural amino acids such as trifluorotyrosine, p-Cl-phenylalanine, p-Br-phenylalanine, p-I-phenylalanine, L-allyl-glycine, beta- alanine, L-alpha-amino butyric acid, L-gamma-amino butyric acid, L-alpha-amino isobutyric acid, L- epsilon-amino caproic acid, 7-amino heptanoic acid, L-methionine sulfone, L-norleucine, L-norvaline, p- nitro-L-phenylalanine, L-hydroxyproline, L-thioproline, methyl derivatives of phenylalanine (Phe) such as 4-methyl-Phe, pentamethyl-Phe, L-Phe (4-amino), L-Tyr (methyl), L-Phe (4-isopropyl), L-Tic (1,2,3,4- tetrahydroisoquinoline-3-carboxyl acid), L-diaminopropionic acid, L-Phe (4-benzyl), 2,4-diaminobutyric acid, 4-aminobutyric acid (gamma- Abu), 2-amino butyric acid (alpha- Abu), 6-amino hexanoic acid (epsilon-Ahx), 2-amino isobutyric acid (Aib), 3-amino propionic acid, ornithine, norleucine, norvaline, hydroxyproline, sarcosine, citrulline, homocitrulline, cysteic acid, t-butylglycine, t-butylalanine, an amino acid derivitized with a heavy atom or heavy isotope (e.g., Au, deuterium, 15N; useful for synthesizing protein applicable to X-ray crystallographic structural analysis or nuclear magnetic resonance analysis), phenylglycine, cyclohexylalanine, fluoroamino acids, designer amino acids such as beta-methyl amino acids, Ca-methyl amino acids, Na-methyl amino acids, naphthyl alanine, and the like.
Membrane Association Regions
Molecules in association with cell membranes contain certain regions that facilitate the membrane association, and such regions can be incorporated into or associated with a protein containing an Akt sequence to generate membrane -targeted Akt molecules (e.g., Akt chimeras). For example, some proteins contain sequences at the N-terminus or C-terminus that are acylated, and these acyl moieties facilitate membrane association. Such sequences are recognized by acyltransferases and often conform to a particular sequence motif. Certain acylation motifs are capable of being modified with a single acyl moiety and others are capable of being modified with multiple acyl moieties. For example, the N-terminal sequence of the protein kinase Src can comprise a single myristoyl moiety. Dual acylation regions are located within the N-terminal regions of certain protein kinases (e.g., Yes, Fyn, Lck) and G-protein alpha subunits. Such dual acylation regions often are located within the first eighteen amino acids of such proteins, and conform to the sequence motif Met-Gly-Cys-Xaa-Cys, where the Met is cleaved, the GIy is N-acylated and one of the Cys residues is S-acylated. The GIy often is myristoylated and a Cys can be palmitoylated. Acylation regions conforming to the sequence motif Cys-Ala-Ala-Xaa (so called "CAAX boxes"), which can modified with C15 or ClO isoprenyl moieties, from the C-terminus of G-protein gamma subunits and other proteins (e.g., http World Wide Web address ebi.ac.uk/interpro/ DisplayrproEntry?ac=IPR001230) also can be utilized. These and other acylation motifs are known to the person of ordinary skill in the art (e.g., Gauthier-Campbell et al., Molecular Biology of the Cell 15: 2205- 2217 (2004); Glabati et al., Biochem. J. 303: 697-700 (1994) and Zlakine et al., J. Cell Science 110: 673- 679 (1997)), and can be incorporated in Akt molecules to induce membrane localization. In certain embodiments, a native sequence from a protein containing an acylation motif can be linked to an Akt protein. For example, in some embodiments, an N-terminal portion of Lck, Fyn or Yes or a G-protein alpha subunit, such as the first twenty-five N-terminal amino acids or fewer from such proteins (e.g., about 5 to about 20 amino acids, about 10 to about 19 amino acids, or about 15 to about 19 amino acids of the native sequence with optional mutations), may be linked to the N-terminus of an Akt protein (e.g., a Fyn fragment-Akt molecule is described in the Examples section hereafter). In certain embodiments, a C- terminal sequence of about 25 amino acids or less from a G-protein gamma subunit containing a CAAX box motif sequence (e.g., about 5 to about 20 amino acids, about 10 to about 18 amino acids, or about 15 to about 18 amino acids of the native sequence with optional mutations) can be linked to the C-terminus of an Akt protein.
In some embodiments, an acyl moiety has a log p value of +1 to +6, and sometimes has a log p value of +3 to +4.5. Log p values are a measure of hydrophobicity and often are derived from octanol/water partitioning studies, in which molecules with higher hydrophobicity partition into octanol with higher frequency and are characterized as having a higher log p value. Log p values are published for a number of lipophilic molecules and log p values can be calculated using known partitioning processes (e.g., Chemical Reviews, Vol. 71, Issue 6, page 599, where entry 4493 shows lauric acid having a log p value of 4.2). Any acyl moiety can be linked to a peptide composition described above and tested for antimicrobial activity using known methods and those described hereafter. The acyl moiety sometimes is a C1-C20 alkyl, C2-C20 alkenyl, C2-C20 alkynyl, C3-C6 cycloalkyl, C1-C4 haloalkyl, C4-C12 cyclalkylalkyl, aryl, substituted aryl, or aryl (C1-C4) alkyl, for example. Any acyl-containing moiety sometimes is a fatty acid, and examples of fatty acid moieties are propyl (C3), butyl (C4), pentyl (C5), hexyl (C6), heptyl (C7), octyl (C8), nonyl (C9), decyl (ClO), undecyl (Cl 1), lauryl (C 12), myristyl (C 14), palmityl (C 16), stearyl (C 18), arachidyl (C20), behenyl (C22) and lignoceryl moieties (C24), and each moiety can contain 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 or 8 unsaturations (i.e., double bonds). An acyl moiety sometimes is a lipid molecule, such as a phosphatidyl lipid (e.g., phosphatidyl serine, phosphatidyl inositol, phosphatidyl ethanolamine, phosphatidyl choline), sphingolipid (e.g., shingomyelin, sphigosine, ceramide, ganglioside, cerebroside), or modified versions thereof. In certain embodiments, one, two, three, four or five or more acyl moieties are linked to a membrane association region.
An Akt protein also may be linked to a single -pass or multiple pass transmembrane sequence (e.g., to the N-terminus or C-terminus of an Akt protein sequence). Single pass transmembrane regions are found in certain CD molecules, tyrosine kinase receptors, serine/threonine kinase receptors, TGFbeta, BMP, activin and phosphatases. Single pass transmembrane regions can include a signal peptide region and a transmembrane region of about 20 to about 25 amino acids, many of which are hydrophobic amino acids and can form an alpha helix. A short track of positively charged amino acids can follow the transmembrane span. Multiple pass proteins include ion pumps, ion channels, and transporters, and include two or more helices that span the membrane multiple times. All or substantially all of a multiple pass protein can be attached to an Akt molecule. Sequences for single pass and multiple pass transmembrane regions are known and can be selected for incorporation into an Akt molecule by the person of ordinary skill in the art.
Akt and Membrane Association Component Combinations
A membrane association region may be covalently linked to the N-teminus or C-terminus of an Akt protein or fragment, and such fusions sometimes are referred to herein as "chimeric proteins." Such chimeric proteins can be encoded by a nucleotide sequence in which the membrane association region- encoding sequence is adjacent to the Akt protein or fragment-encoding sequence, with or without an intervening linker sequence. Covalent linkages also can be generated by a chemically reactive binding pair, whereby a one member of the binding pair is linked to the Akt molecule and another member of the binding pair is linked to the membrane association region. Examples of chemically reactive binding pairs include without limitation sulfhydryl/maleimide, sulfhydryl/haloacetyl derivative, amine/isotriocyanate, amine/succinimidyl ester, and amine/sulfonyl halides. When binding pairs are utilized to generate a covalent linkage, it is possible to join the membrane association region to the N-terminus or C-terminus of the Akt molecule, or to a chemical moiety within the Akt molecule.
In certain embodiments, the membrane association portion may not be covalently attached and may non-covalently associate with the Akt molecule. Non-covalent linkages can be generated by interactive binding pairs, wherein one binding pair member is linked to the membrane association region and the other binding pair member is linked to the Akt molecule. Any suitable interactive binding pair can be utilized to effect a non-covalent linkage, including without limitation biotin/avidin, biotin/streptavidin, folic acid/folate binding protein, vitamin Bl 2/intrinsic factor, nucleic acid/complementary nucleic acid (e.g., DNA, RNA, PNA), and may be antibody/antigen, antibody/antibody, antibody/antibody fragment, antibody/antibody receptor, antibody/protein A or protein G, or hapten/anti-hapten pairs.
Where the membrane association region and the Akt molecule are provided separately and then joined in a covalent or non-covalent manner, nucleotide sequences encoding each portion can be located on separate nucleic acids or the same nucleic acid. The nucleotide sequence encoding each portion often are under the control of the same regulatory sequences, and can be under the control of different regulatory sequences (e.g., promoter, internal ribosome entry sequence).
Multimerization regions also are known and can be utilized to inducibly join an Akt protein, fragment or variant with a membrane association region in a non-covalent manner. Such inducible systems are referred to herein as "chemically induced dimerization (CID)." In addition to being inducible, CID also is reversible, due to the degradation of the labile dimerizing agent or administration of a monomeric competitive inhibitor.
CID systems often involve synthetic bivalent ligands to rapidly crosslink signaling molecules that are fused to ligand-binding domains CID. This system has been used to trigger the oligomerization and activation of cell surface (Spencer et al., 1993; Spencer et al., 1996; Blau et al., 1997), or cytosolic proteins (Luo et al., 1996; MacCorkle et al., 1998), the recruitment of transcription factors to DNA elements to modulate transcription (Ho et al., 1996; Rivera et al., 1996) or the recruitment of signaling molecules to the plasma membrane to simulate signaling (Spencer et al., 1995; Holsinger et al., 1995).
CID systems often are based upon the notion that surface receptor aggregation effectively activates downstream signaling cascades. In one embodiment, the CID system uses a dimeric analog of the lipid permeable immunosuppressant drug, FK506, which loses its normal bioactivity while gaining the ability to crosslink molecules genetically fused to the FK506-binding protein, FKBP 12. By fusing one or more FKBPs and a myristoylation sequence to the cytoplasmic signaling domain of a target receptor, one can stimulate signaling in a dimerizer drug-dependent, but ligand and ectodomain-independent manner. This approach provides the system with temporal control, reversibility using monomeric drug analogs, and enhanced specificity. The high affinity of third-generation AP20187/AP1903 CIDs for their binding domain (e.g., Pollock and Rivera, Methods Enzymol 306:263-81 (1999)), FKBP12 permits specific activation of the recombinant receptor in vivo without the induction of non-specific side effects through endogenous FKBP 12. In addition, the synthetic ligands are resistant to protease degradation, making them more efficient at activating receptors in vivo than most delivered protein agents.
In specific embodiments, rapamycin analogs crosslink endogenous FKBP 12 with a 89 amino acid domain from FRAP/mTOR, called FRB (FRAP rapamycin binding domain, residues 2025-2113). Thus, in certain embodiments, activation of iAkt is based on ligand-dependent recruitment of chimeric Akt (first chimeric protein) to a membrane association protin (second chimeric protein).
Ligands utilized for CID are capable of binding to two or more of the ligand-binding domains. One skilled in the art realizes that the chimeric proteins may be able to bind to more than one ligand when they contain more than one ligand-binding domain. The ligand sometimes is a non-protein or a chemical. Exemplary ligands include, but are not limited to dimeric FK506 (e.g., FKl 012), AP1903, rapamycin or a derivative thereof.
In specific embodiments, the ligand-binding region linked to the membrane association region is heterologous to the ligand-binding region linked to the Akt molecule. In certain embodiments, the ligand- binding region is a rapamycin-binding domain, FRB, from FRAP/mTOR. Representative sequences and methods of incorporating them into expression vectors are set forth in the Examples section hereafter.
Nucleic Acid Constructs
In certain immunotherapy procedures, antigen presenting cells are transfected or transformed with a nucleic acid having a polynucleotide sequence that encodes an Akt molecule described herein. The nucleic acid bearing such a nucleotide sequence can be transferred into the antigen presenting cell in a variety of manners, as described hereafter (e.g., delivery of a naked nucleic acid or encapsulation of the nucleic acid in a liposome or virus). Based on nucleotide sequences within the nucleic acid, a target nucleotide sequence encoding an Akt molecule and/or other target molecules may be stably integrated into the genomic DNA of the antigen presenting cell, in a random or non-random manner (e.g., knock- in), or may be transiently deposited to the antigen presenting cell.
Nucleic acids containing an Akt nucleotide sequence sometimes are referred to herein as "nucleic acid compositions." A nucleic acid composition can be from any source or composition, such as DNA, cDNA, RNA or mRNA, for example, and can be in any suitable form (e.g., linear, circular, supercoiled, single-stranded, double-stranded, and the like). A nucleic acid composition sometimes is a plasmid, phage, autonomously replicating sequence (ARS), centromere, artificial chromosome or other nucleic acid able to replicate or be replicated in vitro or in a host cell (e.g., dendritic cell). Such nucleic acid compositions are selected for their ability to guide production of the desired protein or nucleic acid molecule. When desired, the nucleic acid composition can be altered as known in the art such that codons encode for a different amino acid than is normal, including unconventional or unnatural amino acids (including detectably labeled amino acids).
A nucleic acid composition can comprise certain elements often selected according to the intended use of the nucleic acid. Any of the following elements can be included in or excluded from a nucleic acid composition. A nucleic acid composition, for example, may include one or more or all of the following nucleotide elements: one or more promoter elements, one or more 5' untranslated regions (5'UTRs), one or more regions into which a target nucleotide sequence may be inserted (an "insertion element"), one or more target nucleotide sequences, one or more 3 ' untranslated regions (3 'UTRs), and a selection element. A nucleic acid composition is provided with one or more of such elements and other elements may be inserted into the nucleic acid before the template is contacted with a transcription and/or translation system. In some embodiments, a provided nucleic acid composition comprises a promoter, 5'UTR, optional 3'UTR and insertion element(s) by which a target nucleotide sequence is inserted (i.e., cloned) into the template. In certain embodiments, a provided nucleic acid composition comprises a promoter, insertion element(s) and optional 3'UTR, and a 5' UTR/target nucleotide sequence is inserted with an optional 3'UTR. The elements can be arranged in any order suitable for transcription and/or translation, and in some embodiments a nucleic acid composition comprises the following elements in the 5' to 3' direction: (1) promoter element, 5'UTR, and insertion element(s); (2) promoter element, 5'UTR, and target nucleotide sequence; (3) promoter element, 5'UTR, insertion element(s) and 3'UTR; and (4) promoter element, 5'UTR, target nucleotide sequence and 3'UTR.
A promoter element typically is required for DNA synthesis and/or RNA synthesis. A promoter often interacts with a RNA polymerase to generate message RNA suitable for translation of a protein, polypeptide or peptide. Promoter sequences are readily accessed and obtained by the artisan, and are readily adapted to nucleic acid compositions described herein. The particular promoter employed to control the expression of a polynucleotide sequence of interest is not believed to be important, so long as it is capable of directing the expression of the polynucleotide in the targeted cell. Thus, where a human cell is targeted, it is preferable to position the polynucleotide sequence-coding region adjacent to and under the control of a promoter that is capable of being expressed in a human cell. Generally speaking, such a promoter might include either a human or viral promoter. Examples of promoters include human cytomegalovirus (CMV) immediate early gene promoter, SV40 early promoter, Rous sarcoma virus long terminal repeat, .beta.-actin, elongation factor 1 -alpha (EF-I. alpha.), rat insulin promoter and glyceraldehyde-3 -phosphate dehydrogenase. The use of other viral or mammalian cellular or bacterial phage promoters which are well known in the art to achieve expression of a coding sequence of interest is contemplated as well, provided that the levels of expression are sufficient for a given purpose. By employing a promoter with well-known properties, the level and pattern of expression of the protein of interest following transfection or transformation can be optimized.
In some circumstances, it is desirable to regulate expression of a transgene in an immunotherapy vector. For example, different viral promoters with varying strengths of activity are utilized depending on the level of expression desired. In mammalian cells, the CMV immediate early promoter can be used to provide strong transcriptional activation. Modified versions of the CMV promoter that are less potent have also been used when reduced levels of expression of the transgene are desired. When expression of a transgene in hematopoetic cells is desired, retroviral promoters such as the LTRs from MLV or MMTV can be used. Other viral promoters that are used depending on the desired effect include SV40, RSV LTR, HIV-I and HIV-2 LTR, adenovirus promoters such as from the ElA, E2A, or MLP region, AAV LTR, HSV-TK, and avian sarcoma virus.
Tissue specific promoters sometimes are used to effect transcription in specific tissues or cells so as to reduce potential toxicity or undesirable effects to non-targeted tissues. For example, promoters such as the alpha myosin heavy chain (.alpha.MHC) promoter, directing expression to cardiac myocytes.
In certain indications, it is desirable to activate transcription at specific times after administration of an immunotherapy vector. Promoters that are hormone or cytokine regulatable often are utilized. Cytokine and inflammatory protein responsive promoters that can be used include K and T Kininogen (Kageyama et al., 1987), c-fos, TNF-alpha, C-reactive protein (Arcone et al., 1988), haptoglobin (Oliviero et al., 1987), serum amyloid A2, C/EBP alpha, IL-I, IL-6 (PoIi and Cortese, 1989), Complement C3 (Wilson et al., 1990), IL-8, alpha-1 acid glycoprotein (Prowse and Baumann, 1988), alpha-1 antityrpsin, lipoprotein lipase (Zechner et al., 1988), angiotensinogen (Ron et al., 1991), fibrinogen, c-jun (inducible by phorbol esters, TNF-alpha, UV radiation, retinoic acid, and hydrogen peroxide), collagenase (induced by phorbol esters and retinoic acid), metallothionein (heavy metal and glucocorticoid inducible), Stromelysin (inducible by phorbol ester, interleukin- 1 and EGF), alpha-2 macroglobulin and alpha- 1 antichymotrypsin. CID promoters also can be utilized (Ho et al., 1996; Rivera et al., 1996). Full citations of certain documents referenced herein are in U.S. 20030144204, published July 31, 2003.
Other inducible promoters are known and can be utilized. An ecdysone system (Invitrogen, Carlsbad, Calif.) is one such system. This system is designed to allow regulated expression of a gene of interest in mammalian cells. It consists of a tightly regulated expression mechanism that allows virtually no basal level expression of the transgene, but over 200-fold inducibility. The system is based on the heterodimeric ecdysone receptor of Drosophila, and when ecdysone or an analog such as muristerone A binds to the receptor, the receptor activates a promoter to turn on expression of the downstream transgene high levels of mRNA transcripts are attained. In this system, both monomers of the heterodimeric receptor are constitutively expressed from one vector, whereas the ecdysone-responsive promoter, which drives expression of the gene of interest is on another plasmid. Engineering of this type of system into the gene transfer vector of interest would therefore be useful. Cotransfection of plasmids containing the gene of interest and the receptor monomers in the producer cell line would then allow for the production of the gene transfer vector without expression of a potentially toxic transgene. At the appropriate time, expression of the transgene could be activated with ecdysone or muristeron A. Another inducible system is the Tet-Off.TM. or Tet-On.TM. system (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.) originally developed by Gossen and Bujard (Gossen and Bujard, 1992; Gossen et al., 1995). This system also allows high levels of gene expression to be regulated in response to tetracycline or tetracycline derivatives such as doxycycline. In the Tet-On.TM. system, gene expression is turned on in the presence of doxycycline, whereas in the Tet- Off.TM. system, gene expression is turned on in the absence of doxycycline. These systems are based on two regulatory elements derived from the tetracycline resistance operon of E. coli. The tetracycline operator sequence to which the tetracycline repressor binds, and the tetracycline repressor protein. The gene of interest is cloned into a plasmid behind a promoter that has tetracycline -responsive elements present in it. A second plasmid contains a regulatory element called the tetracycline-controlled transactivator, which is composed, in the Tet-Off.TM. system, of the VP16 domain from the herpes simplex virus and the wild-type tertracycline repressor. Thus in the absence of doxycycline, transcription is constitutively on. In the Tet-On.TM. system, the tetracycline repressor is not wild type and in the presence of doxycycline activates transcription. For gene therapy vector production, the Tet-Offm system would be preferable so that the producer cells could be grown in the presence of tetracycline or doxycycline and prevent expression of a potentially toxic transgene, but when the vector is introduced to the patient, the gene expression would be induced constitutively.
It is envisioned that any of the above promoters alone or in combination with another can be useful according to the present invention depending on the action desired. In addition, this list of promoters should not be construed to be exhaustive or limiting, those of skill in the art will know of other promoters that are used in conjunction with the promoters and methods disclosed herein.
A 5' UTR may comprise one or more elements endogenous to the nucleotide sequence from which it originates, and sometimes includes one or more exogenous elements. A 5' UTR can originate from any suitable nucleic acid, such as genomic DNA, plasmid DNA, RNA or mRNA, for example, from any suitable organism (e.g., virus, bacterium, yeast, fungi, plant, insect or mammal). The artisan may select appropriate elements for the 5' UTR based upon the transcription and/or translation system being utilized. A 5' UTR sometimes comprises one or more of the following elements known to the artisan: enhancer sequence (e.g., Eukaryotic Promoter Data Base EPDB), translational enhancer sequence, transcription initiation site, transcription factor binding site, translation regulation site, translation initiation site, translation factor binding site, ribosome binding site, replicon, enhancer element, internal ribosome entry site (IRES), and silencer element.
A 5'UTR in the nucleic acid composition can comprise a translational enhancer nucleotide sequence. A translational enhancer nucleotide sequence often is located between the promoter and the target nucleotide sequence in a nucleic acid composition. A translational enhancer sequence often binds to a ribosome, sometimes is an 18S rRNA-binding ribonucleotide sequence (i.e., a 4OS ribosome binding sequence) and sometimes is an internal ribosome entry sequence (IRES). An IRES generally forms an RNA scaffold with precisely placed RNA tertiary structures that contact a 4OS ribosomal subunit via a number of specific intermolecular interactions. Examples of ribosomal enhancer sequences are known and can be identified by the artisan (e.g., Mignone et al., Nucleic Acids Research 33: D141-D146 (2005); Paulous et al., Nucleic Acids Research 31 : 722-733 (2003); Akbergenov et al., Nucleic Acids Research 32: 239-247 (2004); Mignone et al., Genome Biology 3(3): reviews0004.1-0001.10 (2002); Gallie, Nucleic Acids Research 30: 3401-3411 (2002); Shaloiko et al., http address www.interscience.wiley.com, DOI: 10.1002/bit.20267; and Gallie et al., Nucleic Acids Research 15: 3257-3273 (1987)). A translational enhancer sequence sometimes is a eukaryotic sequence, such as a Kozak consensus sequence or other sequence (e.g., hydroid polyp sequence, GenBank accession no. U07128). A translational enhancer sequence sometimes is a prokaryotic sequence, such as a Shine-Dalgarno consensus sequence. In certain embodiments, the translational enhancer sequence is a viral nucleotide sequence. A translational enhancer sequence sometimes is from a 5'UTR of a plant virus, such as Tobacco Mosaic Virus (TMV), Alfalfa Mosaic Virus (AMV); Tobacco Etch Virus (ETV); Potato Virus Y (PVY); Turnip Mosaic (poty) Virus and Pea Seed Borne Mosaic Virus, for example. In certain embodiments, an omega sequence about 67 bases in length from TMV is included in the nucleic acid composition as a translational enhancer sequence (e.g., devoid of guanosine nucleotides and includes a 25 nucleotide long poly (CAA) central region). In some embodiments, a translational enhancer sequence comprises one or more ARC-I or ARC- 1 like sequence, such as one of the following nucleotide sequences GCCGGCGGAG, CUC AUAAGGU, GACUUUGAUU, CGGAACCCAA, AUACUCCCCC and CCUUGCGACC, or a substantially identical sequence thereof. In certain embodiments, a translational enhancer sequence comprises an IRES sequence, such as one or more of EMBL nucleotide sequences J04513, X87949, M95825, M12783, AF025841, AF013263, AF006822, M17169, M13440, M22427, D14838 and M17446, or a substantially identical nucleotide sequence thereof. An IRES sequence may be a type I IRES (e.g., from enterovirus (e.g., poliovirus), rhinovirus (e.g., human rhinovirus)), a type II IRES (e.g., from cardiovirus (e.g., encephalomyocraditis virus), aphthovirus (e.g., foot-and-mouth disease virus)), a type III IRES (e.g., from Hepatitis A virus) or other picornavirus sequence (e.g., Paulos et al. supra, and Jackson et al., RNA 1 : 985-1000 (1995)).
A 3' UTR may comprise one or more elements endogenous to the nucleotide sequence from which it originates and sometimes includes one or more exogenous elements. A 3' UTR may originate from any suitable nucleic acid, such as genomic DNA, plasmid DNA, RNA or mRNA, for example, from any suitable organism (e.g., a virus, bacterium, yeast, fungi, plant, insect or mammal). The artisan can select appropriate elements for the 3 ' UTR based upon the transcription and/or translation system being utilized. A 3' UTR sometimes comprises one or more of the following elements known to the artisan: transcription regulation site, transcription initiation site, transcription termination site, transcription factor binding site, translation regulation site, translation termination site, translation initiation site, translation factor binding site, ribosome binding site, replicon, enhancer element, silencer element and polyadenosine tail. A 3' UTR can include a polyadenosine tail, and sometimes may not. If a polyadenosine tail is present, one or more adenosine moieties may be added or deleted from the native length (e.g., about 5, about 10, about 15, about 20, about 25, about 30, about 35, about 40, about 45 or about 50 adenosine moieties may be added or subtracted).
The term a "target nucleotide sequence" as used herein encodes a nucleic acid, peptide, polypeptide or protein of interest, and may be a ribonucleotide sequence or a deoxyribonucleotide sequence. An Akt nucleotide sequence (e.g., a chimeric sequence encoding an Akt sequence and a membrane-association sequence) may be incorporated into a nucleic acid composition as a target nucleotide sequence. The term "nucleic acid" as used herein is generic to polydeoxyribonucleotides (containing 2'-deoxy-D-ribose or modified forms thereof), to polyribonucleotides (containing D-ribose or modified forms thereof), and to any other type of polynucleotide which is an N-glycoside of a purine or pyrimidine bases, or modified purine or pyrimidine bases. A target nucleic acid can include an untranslated ribonucleic acid and sometimes is a translated ribonucleic acid. An untranslated ribonucleic acid may include, but is not limited to, a small interfering ribonucleic acid (siRNA), a short hairpin ribonucleic acid (shRNA), other ribonucleic acid capable of RNA interference (RNAi), an antisense ribonucleic acid, or a ribozyme. A translatable target nucleotide sequence (e.g., a target ribonucleotide sequence) sometimes encodes a peptide, polypeptide or protein, which are sometimes referred to herein as "target peptides," "target polypeptides" or "target proteins." The term "protein" as used herein refers to a molecule having a sequence of amino acids linked by peptide bonds. This term includes fusion proteins, oligopeptides, polypeptides, cyclic peptides, polypeptides and polypeptide derivatives. A protein or polypeptide sometimes is of intracellular origin (e.g., located in the nucleus, cytosol, or interstitial space of host cells in vivo) and sometimes is a cell membrane protein in vivo.
A translatable nucleotide sequence generally is located between a start codon (AUG in ribonucleic acids and ATG in deoxyribonucleic acids) and a stop codon (e.g., UAA (ochre), UAG (amber) or UGA (opal) in ribonucleic acids and TAA, TAG or TGA in deoxyribonucleic acids), and sometimes is referred to herein as an "open reading frame" (ORF). A nucleic acid composition sometimes comprises one or more ORFs. An ORF may be from any suitable source, sometimes from genomic DNA, mRNA, reverse transcribed RNA or complementary DNA (cDNA) or a nucleic acid library comprising one or more of the foregoing, and is from any organism species, such as human, insect, nematode, bovine, equine, canine, feline, rat or mouse, for example. An Akt nucleotide sequence often is utilized as an ORF herein, and sometimes a membrane association region-encoding nucleotide sequence is utilized as an ORF. A nucleic acid composition sometimes comprises a nucleotide sequence adjacent to an ORF that is translated in conjunction with the ORF and encodes an amino acid tag. The tag-encoding nucleotide sequence is located 3' and/or 5' of an ORF in the nucleic acid composition, thereby encoding a tag at the C-terminus or N-terminus of the protein or peptide encoded by the ORF. Any tag that does not abrogate or substantially reduce transcription and/or translation may be utilized and may be appropriately selected by the artisan. A tag sometimes specifically binds a molecule or moiety of a solid phase or a detectable label, for example, thereby having utility for isolating, purifying and/or detecting a protein or peptide encoded by the ORF. In some embodiments, a tag comprises one or more of the following elements: FLAG (e.g., DYKDDDDKG), AUl (e.g., DTYRYI), V5 (e.g., GKPIPNPLLGLDST), c-MYC (e.g., EQKLISEEDL), HSV (e.g., QPELAPEDPED), influenza hemaglutinin, HA (e.g., YPYDVPDYA), VSV- G (e.g., YTDIEMNRLGK), bacterial glutathione- S-transferase, maltose binding protein, a streptavidin- or avidin-binding tag (e.g., pcDNA™6 BioEase™ Gateway® Biotinylation System (Invitrogen)), thioredoxin, β-galactosidase, VSV-glycoprotein, a fluorescent protein (e.g., green fluorescent protein or one of its many color variants (e.g., yellow, red, blue)), a polylysine or polyarginine sequence, a polyhistidine sequence (e.g., His6) or other sequence that chelates a metal (e.g., cobalt, zinc, copper) and/or a cysteine -rich sequence that binds to an arsenic-containing molecule. In certain embodiments, a cysteine-rich tag comprises the amino acid sequence CC-Xn-CC, wherein X is any amino acid and n is 1 to 3, and the cysteine-rich sequence sometimes is CCPGCC. In certain embodiments, the tag comprises a cysteine-rich element and a polyhistidine element (e.g., CCPGCC and His6).
A tag often conveniently binds to a binding partner. For example, some tags bind to an antibody (e.g., FLAG) and sometimes specifically bind to a small molecule. For example, a polyhistidine tag specifically chelates a bivalent metal, such as copper, zinc and cobalt; a polylysine or polyarginine tag specifically binds to a zinc finger; a glutathione S-transferase tag binds to glutathione; and a cysteine-rich tag specifically binds to an arsenic-containing molecule. Arsenic-containing molecules include LUMIO™ agents (Invitrogen, California), such as FlAsH™ (EDT2[4',5'-bis(l,3,2-dithioarsolan-2-yl)fluorescein-(l,2- ethanedithiol)2]) and ReAsH reagents (e.g., U.S. Patent 5,932,474 to Tsien et al., entitled "Target Sequences for Synthetic Molecules;" U.S. Patent 6,054,271 to Tsien et al., entitled "Methods of Using Synthetic Molecules and Target Sequences;" U.S. Patents 6,451,569 and 6,008,378; published U.S. Patent Application 2003/0083373, and published PCT Patent Application WO 99/21013, all to Tsien et al. and all entitled "Synthetic Molecules that Specifically React with Target Sequences"). Such antibodies and small molecules sometimes are linked to a solid phase for convenient isolation of the target protein or target peptide, as described in greater detail hereafter.
A tag sometimes comprises a sequence that localizes a translated protein or peptide to a component in a system, which is referred to as a "signal sequence" or "localization signal sequence" herein. A signal sequence often is incorporated at the N-terminus of a target protein or target peptide, and sometimes is incorporated at the C-terminus. Examples of signal sequences are known to the artisan, are readily incorporated into a nucleic acid composition, and often are selected according to the cells from which a cell-free extract is prepared. A signal sequence in some embodiments localizes a translated protein or peptide to a cell membrane. Examples of signal sequences include, but are not limited to, a nucleus targeting signal (e.g., steroid receptor sequence and N-terminal sequence of SV40 virus large T antigen); mitochondia targeting signal (e.g., amino acid sequence that forms an amphipathic helix); peroxisome targeting signal (e.g., C-terminal sequence in YFG from S.cerevisiae); and a secretion signal (e.g., N- terminal sequences from invertase, mating factor alpha, PHO5 and SUC2 in S.cerevisiae; multiple N- terminal sequences of B. subtilis proteins (e.g., Tjalsma et al., Microbiol.Molec. Biol. Rev. 64: 515-547 (2000)); alpha amylase signal sequence (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 6,288,302); pectate lyase signal sequence (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,846,818); precollagen signal sequence (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,712,114); OmpA signal sequence (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,470,719); lam beta signal sequence (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,389,529); B. brevis signal sequence (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,232,841); and P. pastoris signal sequence (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,268,273)).
A tag sometimes is directly adjacent to the amino acid sequence encoded by an ORF (i.e., there is no intervening sequence) and sometimes a tag is substantially adjacent to a the ORF encoded amino acid sequence (e.g., an intervening sequence is present). An intervening sequence sometimes includes a recognition site for a protease, which is useful for cleaving a tag from a target protein or peptide. In some embodiments, the intervening sequence is cleaved by Factor Xa (e.g., recognition site I(E/D)GR), thrombin (e.g., recognition site LVPRGS), enterokinase (e.g., recognition site DDDDK), TEV protease (e.g., recognition site ENLYFQG) or PreScission™ protease (e.g., recognition site LEVLFQGP), for example.
An intervening sequence sometimes is referred to herein as a "linker sequence," and may be of any suitable length selected by the artisan. A linker sequence sometimes is about 1 to about 20 amino acids in length, and sometimes about 5 to about 10 amino acids in length. The artisan may select the linker length to substantially preserve target protein or peptide function (e.g., a tag may reduce target protein or peptide function unless separated by a linker), to enhance disassociation of a tag from a target protein or peptide when a protease cleavage site is present (e.g., cleavage may be enhanced when a linker is present), and to enhance interaction of a tag/target protein product with a solid phase. A linker can be of any suitable amino acid content, and often comprises a higher proportion of amino acids having relatively short side chains (e.g., glycine, alanine, serine and threonine).
A nucleic acid composition sometimes includes a stop codon between a tag element and an insertion element or ORF, which can be useful for translating an ORF with or without the tag. Mutant tRNA molecules that recognize stop codons (described above) suppress translation termination and thereby are designated "suppressor tRNAs." Suppressor tRNAs can result in the insertion of amino acids and continuation of translation past stop codons (e.g., U.S. Patent Application No. 60/587,583, filed July 14, 2004, entitled "Production of Fusion Proteins by Cell-Free Protein Synthesis,"; Eggertsson, et al., (1988) Microbiological Review 52(3):354-374, and Engleerg-Kukla, et al. (1996) in Escherichia coli and Salmonella Cellular and Molecular Biology, Chapter 60, pps 909-921, Neidhardt, et al. eds., ASM Press, Washington, DC). A number of suppressor tRNAs are known, including but not limited to, supE, supP, supD, supF and supZ suppressors, which suppress the termination of translation of the amber stop codon; supB, glT, supL, supN, supC and supM suppressors, which suppress the function of the ochre stop codon and glyT, trpT and Su-9 suppressors, which suppress the function of the opal stop codon. In general, suppressor tRNAs contain one or more mutations in the anti-codon loop of the tRNA that allows the tRNA to base pair with a codon that ordinarily functions as a stop codon. The mutant tRNA is charged with its cognate amino acid residue and the cognate amino acid residue is inserted into the translating polypeptide when the stop codon is encountered. Mutations that enhance the efficiency of termination suppressors (i.e., increase stop codon read- through) have been identified. These include, but are not limited to, mutations in the uar gene (also known as the prfA gene), mutations in the ups gene, mutations in the sueA, sueB and sueC genes, mutations in the rpsD (ramA) and rpsE (spcA) genes and mutations in the rplL gene.
Thus, a nucleic acid composition comprising a stop codon located between an ORF and a tag can yield a translated ORF alone when no suppressor tRNA is present in the translation system, and can yield a translated ORF -tag fusion when a suppressor tRNA is present in the system. In some embodiments, the stop codon is located 3' of an insertion element or ORF and 5' of a tag, and the stop codon sometimes is an amber codon. Suppressor tRNA sometimes are within a cell-free extract (e.g., the cell-free extract is prepared from cells that produce the suppressor tRNA), sometimes are added to the cell-free extract as isolated molecules, and sometimes are added to a cell- free extract as part of another extract. A provided suppressor tRNA sometimes is loaded with one of the twenty naturally occurring amino acids or an unnatural amino acid (described herein). Suppressor tRNA can be generated in cells transfected with a nucleic acid encoding the tRNA (e.g., a replication incompetent adenovirus containing the human tRNA- Ser suppressor gene can be transfected into cells). Vectors for synthesizing suppressor tRNA and for translating ORFs with or without a tag are available to the artisan (e.g., Tag-On-Demand™ kit (Invitrogen Corporation, California); Tag-On-Demand™ Suppressor Supernatant Instruction Manual, Version B, 6 June 2003, at http address www.invitrogen.com/content/sfs/ manuals/tagondemand _supernatant_man.pdf; Tag-On-Demand™ Gateway® Vector Instruction Manual, Version B, 20 June, 2003 at http address www.invitrogen.com/content/sfs/ manuals/tagondemand vectors man.pdf; and Capone et al., Amber, ochre and opal suppressor tRNA genes derived from a human serine tRNA gene. EMBO J. 4:213, 1985).
Any convenient cloning strategy known to the artisan may be utilized to incorporate an element, such as an ORF, into a nucleic acid composition. Known methods can be utilized to insert an element into the template independent of an insertion element, such as (1) cleaving the template at one or more existing restriction enzyme sites and ligating an element of interest and (2) adding restriction enzyme sites to the template by hybridizing oligonucleotide primers that include one or more suitable restriction enzyme sites and amplifying by polymerase chain reaction (described in greater detail herein). Other cloning strategies take advantage of one or more insertion sites present or inserted into the nucleic acid composition, such as an oligonucleotide primer hybridization site for PCR, for example, and others described hereafter.
In some embodiments, the nucleic acid composition includes one or more recombinase insertion sites. A recombinase insertion site is a recognition sequence on a nucleic acid molecule that participates in an integration/recombination reaction by recombination proteins. For example, the recombination site for Cre recombinase is loxP, which is a 34 base pair sequence comprised of two 13 base pair inverted repeats (serving as the recombinase binding sites) flanking an 8 base pair core sequence (e.g., Figure 1 of Sauer, B., Curr. Opin. Biotech. 5:521-527 (1994)). Other examples of recombination sites include attB, attP, attL, and attR sequences, and mutants, fragments, variants and derivatives thereof, which are recognized by the recombination protein λ Int and by the auxiliary proteins integration host factor (IHF), FIS and excisionase (Xis) (e.g., U.S. Patent Nos. 5,888,732; 6,143,557; 6,171,861; 6,270,969; 6,277,608; and 6,720,140; U.S. Patent Appln. Nos. 09/517,466, filed March 2, 2000, and 09/732,914, filed August 14, 2003, and in U.S. patent publication no. 2002-0007051 -Al; Landy, Curr. Opin. Biotech. 3:699-707 (1993)). Examples of recombinase cloning nucleic acids are in Gateway® systems (Invitrogen, California), which include at least one recombination site for cloning a desired nucleic acid molecules in vivo or in vitro. In some embodiments, the system utilizes vectors that contain at least two different site- specific recombination sites, often based on the bacteriophage lambda system (e.g., attl and att2), and are mutated from the wild-type (attO) sites. Each mutated site has a unique specificity for its cognate partner att site (i.e., its binding partner recombination site) of the same type (for example attBl with attPl, or attLl with attRl) and will not cross-react with recombination sites of the other mutant type or with the wild-type attO site. Different site specificities allow directional cloning or linkage of desired molecules thus providing desired orientation of the cloned molecules. Nucleic acid fragments flanked by recombination sites are cloned and subcloned using the Gateway® system by replacing a selectable marker (for example, ccdB) flanked by att sites on the recipient plasmid molecule, sometimes termed the Destination Vector. Desired clones are then selected by transformation of a ccdB sensitive host strain and positive selection for a marker on the recipient molecule. Similar strategies for negative selection (e.g., use of toxic genes) can be used in other organisms such as thymidine kinase (TK) in mammals and insects.
In certain embodiments, the nucleic acid composition includes one or more topoisomerase insertion sites. A topoisomerase insertion site is a defined nucleotide sequence recognized and bound by a site- specific topoisomerase. For example, the nucleotide sequence 5'-(C/T)CCTT-3' is a topoisomerase recognition site bound specifically by most poxvirus topoisomerases, including vaccinia virus DNA topoisomerase I. After binding to the recognition sequence, the topoisomerase cleaves the strand at the 3'- most thymidine of the recognition site to produce a nucleotide sequence comprising 5'-(C/T)CCTT-PO4- TOPO, a complex of the topoisomerase covalently bound to the 3' phosphate via a tyrosine in the topoisomerase (e.g., Shuman, J. Biol. Chem. 266: 11372-11379, 1991; Sekiguchi and Shuman, Nucl. Acids Res. 22:5360-5365, 1994; U.S. Pat. No. 5,766,891; PCT/US95/16099; and PCT/US98/12372). In comparison, the nucleotide sequence 5'-GCAACTT-3' is a topoisomerase recognition site for type IA E. coli topoisomerase III. An element to be inserted often is combined with topoisomerase-reacted template and thereby incorporated into the nucleic acid composition (e.g., http address www.invitrogen.com/downloads/F- 13512_Topo_Flyer.pdf; http address at ww.invitrogen.eom/content/sfs/brochures/710 021849%20_B_TOPOCloning_bro.pdf; TOPO TA Cloning® Kit and Zero Blunt® TOPO® Cloning Kit product information).
A nucleic acid composition sometimes contains one or more origin of replication (ORI) elements. In some embodiments, a template comprises two or more ORIs, where one functions efficiently in one organism (e.g., a bacterium) and another functions efficiently in another organism (e.g., a eukaryote). In some embodiments, an ORI may function efficiently in insect cells and another ORI may function efficiently in mammalian cells. A nucleic acid composition also sometimes includes one or more transcription regulation sites.
A nucleic acid composition often includes one or more selection elements. Selection elements often are utilized using known processes to determine whether a nucleic acid composition is included in a cell. In some embodiments, a nucleic acid composition includes two or more selection elements, where one functions efficiently in one organisms and another functions efficiently in another organism. Examples of selection elements include, but are not limited to, (1) nucleic acid segments that encode products that provide resistance against otherwise toxic compounds (e.g., antibiotics); (2) nucleic acid segments that encode products that are otherwise lacking in the recipient cell (e.g., essential products, tRNA genes, auxotrophic markers); (3) nucleic acid segments that encode products that suppress the activity of a gene product; (4) nucleic acid segments that encode products that can be readily identified (e.g., phenotypic markers such as antibiotics (e.g., β-lactamase), β-galactosidase, green fluorescent protein (GFP), yellow fluorescent protein (YFP), red fluorescent protein (RFP), cyan fluorescent protein (CFP), and cell surface proteins); (5) nucleic acid segments that bind products that are otherwise detrimental to cell survival and/or function; (6) nucleic acid segments that otherwise inhibit the activity of any of the nucleic acid segments described in Nos. 1-5 above (e.g., antisense oligonucleotides); (7) nucleic acid segments that bind products that modify a substrate (e.g., restriction endonucleases); (8) nucleic acid segments that can be used to isolate or identify a desired molecule (e.g., specific protein binding sites); (9) nucleic acid segments that encode a specific nucleotide sequence that can be otherwise non-functional (e.g., for PCR amplification of subpopulations of molecules); (10) nucleic acid segments that, when absent, directly or indirectly confer resistance or sensitivity to particular compounds; (11) nucleic acid segments that encode products that either are toxic (e.g., Diphtheria toxin) or convert a relatively non-toxic compound to a toxic compound (e.g., Herpes simplex thymidine kinase, cytosine deaminase) in recipient cells; (12) nucleic acid segments that inhibit replication, partition or heritability of nucleic acid molecules that contain them; and/or (13) nucleic acid segments that encode conditional replication functions, e.g., replication in certain hosts or host cell strains or under certain environmental conditions (e.g., temperature, nutritional conditions, and the like). Certain nucleotide sequences sometimes are added to, modified or removed from one or more of the nucleic acid composition elements, such as the promoter, 5'UTR, target sequence, or 3'UTR elements, to enhance or potentially enhance transcription and/or translation before or after such elements are incorporated in a nucleic acid composition. In some embodiments, one or more of the following sequences may be modified or removed if they are present in a 5'UTR: a sequence that forms a stable secondary structure (e.g., quadruplex structure or stem loop stem structure (e.g., EMBL sequences X12949, AF274954, AF139980, AF152961, S95936, U194144, AFl 16649 or substantially identical sequences that form such stem loop stem structures)); a translation initiation codon upstream of the target nucleotide sequence start codon; a stop codon upstream of the target nucleotide sequence translation initiation codon; an ORF upstream of the target nucleotide sequence translation initiation codon; an iron responsive element (IRE) or like sequence; and a 5' terminal oligopyrimidine tract (TOP, e.g., consisting of 5-15 pyrimidines adjacent to the cap). A translational enhancer sequence and/or an internal ribosome entry site (IRES) sometimes is inserted into a 5'UTR (e.g., EMBL nucleotide sequences J04513, X87949, M95825, M12783, AF025841, AF013263, AF006822, M17169, M13440, M22427, D14838 and M17446 and substantially identical nucleotide sequences). An AU-rich element (ARE, e.g., AUUUA repeats) and/or splicing junction that follows a non-sense codon sometimes is removed from or modified in a 3'UTR. A polyadenosine tail sometimes is inserted into a 3'UTR if none is present, sometimes is removed if it is present, and adenosine moieties sometimes are added to or removed from a polyadenosine tail present in a 3'UTR. Thus, some embodiments are directed to a process comprising: determining whether any nucleotide sequences that reduce or potentially reduce translation efficiency are present in the elements, and removing or modifying one or more of such sequences if they are identified. Certain embodiments are directed to a process comprising: determining whether any nucleotide sequences that increase or potentially increase translation efficiency are not present in the elements, and incorporating such sequences into the nucleic acid composition.
An ORF sometimes is mutated or modified (for example, by point mutation, deletion mutation, insertion mutation, and the like) to alter, enhance or increase, reduce, substantially reduce or eliminate the activity of the encoded protein or peptide. The protein or peptide encoded by a modified ORF sometimes is produced in a lower amount or may not be produced at detectable levels, and in other embodiments, the product or protein encoded by the modified ORF is produced at a higher level (e.g., codons sometimes are modified so they are compatible with tRNA in cells used to prepare a cell-free extract). To determine the relative activity, the activity from the product of the mutated ORF (or cell containing it) can be compared to the activity of the product or protein encoded by the unmodified ORF (or cell containing it).
A stop codon at the end of an ORF sometimes is modified to another stop codon, such as an amber stop codon described above. In some embodiments, a stop codon is introduced within an ORF, sometimes by insertion or mutation of an existing codon. An ORF comprising a modified terminal stop codon and/or internal stop codon often is translated in a system comprising a suppressor tRNA that recognizes the stop codon. An ORF comprising a stop codon sometimes is translated in a system comprising a suppressor tRNA that incorporates an unnatural amino acid during translation of the target protein or target peptide. Methods for incorporating unnatural amino acids into a target protein or peptide are known, which include, for example, processes utilizing a heterologous tRNA/synthetase pair, where the tRNA recognizes an amber stop codon and is loaded with an unnatural amino acid (e.g., http address www.iupac.org/news/prize/2003/wang.pdf). Examples of unnatural amino acids are described above.
A nucleic acid composition is of any form useful for in vitro or in vivo transcription and/or translation. A nucleic acid sometimes is a plasmid, such as a supercoiled plasmid, sometimes is a linear nucleic acid (e.g., a linear nucleic acid produced by PCR or by restriction digest), sometimes is single-stranded and sometimes is double-stranded. A nucleic acid composition for transcription and/or translation can be prepared by any suitable process. A nucleic acid composition sometimes is prepared by an amplification process, such as a polymerase chain reaction (PCR) process or transcription-mediated amplification process (TMA). In TMA, two enzymes are used in an isothermal reaction to produce amplification products detected by light emission (see, e.g., Biochemistry 1996 Jun 25;35(25):8429-38 and http address www. devicelink.com/ivdt/archive/OO/ 11/007. html). Standard PCR processes are known (e.g., U. S. Patent Nos. 4,683,202; 4,683,195; 4,965,188; and 5,656,493), and generally are performed in cycles. Each cycle includes heat denaturation, in which hybrid nucleic acids dissociate; cooling, in which primer oligonucleotides hybridize; and extension of the oligonucleotides by a polymerase (i.e., Taq polymerase). An example of a PCR cyclical process is treating the sample at 95°C for 5 minutes; repeating forty-five cycles of 95°C for 1 minute, 59°C for 1 minute, 10 seconds, and 72°C for 1 minute 30 seconds; and then treating the sample at 72°C for 5 minutes. Multiple cycles frequently are performed using a commercially available thermal cycler. PCR amplification products sometimes are stored for a time at a lower temperature (e.g., at 4°C) and sometimes are frozen (e.g., at -200C) before analysis.
In some embodiments, a nucleic acid of other molecule described herein is isolated or purified. The term "isolated" as used herein refers to material removed from its original environment (e.g., the natural environment if it is naturally occurring, or a host cell if expressed exogenously), and thus is altered "by the hand of man" from its original environment. The term "purified" as used herein with reference to molecules does not refer to absolute purity. Rather, "purified" refers to a substance in a composition that contains fewer substance species in the same class (e.g., nucleic acid or protein species) other than the substance of interest in comparison to the sample from which it originated. "Purified," if a nucleic acid or protein for example, refers to a substance in a composition that contains fewer nucleic acid species or protein species other than the nucleic acid or protein of interest in comparison to the sample from which it originated. Sometimes, a protein or nucleic acid is "substantially pure," indicating that the protein or nucleic acid represents at least 50% of protein or nucleic acid on a mass basis of the composition. Often, a substantially pure protein or nucleic acid is at least 75% on a mass basis of the composition, and sometimes at least 95% on a mass basis of the composition.
Other nucleotide sequences not specifically described herein can be included in nucleic acid compositions, as selected for an application of the nucleic acid composition by the person of ordinary skill in the art. Certain sequences described in the section below entitled "Nucleic Acid Transfer to Antigen Presenting Cells," which include viral nucleotide sequences, sometimes are included in nucleic acid compositions.
Antigen Presenting Cells
Any antigen presenting cell (APC) can be used with the methods of the present invention. The term "APC" encompasses any cell capable of handling and presenting an antigen to lymphocytes. Typically, APCs include, e.g., macrophages, Langerhans dendritic cells and Follicular dendritic cells. In addition, B cells have also been shown to have an antigen presenting function and are thus contemplated by the present invention. The APCs often are dendritic cells. A "dendritic cell" (DC) is an APC with a characteristic morphology including lamellipodia extending from the dendritic cell body in several directions. Dendritic cells are able to initiate primary, antigen-specific T cell responses both in vitro and in vivo, and direct a strong mixed leukocyte reaction (MLR) compared to peripheral blood leukocytes, splenocytes, B cells and monocytes. DCs can be derived from a number of different hematopoietic precursor cells. For a general description of dendritic cells, including their differentiation and maturation, see, e.g. Steinman, Annu Rev Immunol. 9:271-96 (1991), and Lotze and Thomson, Dendritic Cells, 2nd Edition, Academic Press, 2001.
APCs can be isolated from any of the tissues where they reside and which are known to those of skill in the art. In particular, dendritic cells and their progenitors may be obtained from any tissue source comprising dendritic cell precursors that are capable of proliferating and maturing in vitro into dendritic cells, when cultured and induced to mature according to the methods of the present invention. Such suitable tissue sources include, e.g., peripheral blood, bone marrow, tumor-infiltrating cells, peritumoral tissues-infiltrating cells, lymph node biopsies, thymus, spleen, skin, umbilical cord blood, monocytes harvested from peripheral blood, CD34 or CD 14 positive cells harvested from peripheral blood, blood marrow or any other suitable tissue or fluid. Dendritic cells sometimes are isolated from bone marrow or from peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMCs).
Peripheral blood can be collected using any standard apheresis procedure known in the art (see, e.g., Bishop et al., Blood 83:610:616 (1994)). PBMCs can then be prepared from whole blood samples by separating mononuclear cells from red blood cells. There are a number of methods for isolating PBMCs including, e.g., velocity sedimentation, isopyknic sedimentation, affinity purification, and flow cytometry. Typically, PBMCs are separated from red blood cells by density gradient (isopyknic) centrifugation, in which the cells sediment to an equilibrium position in the solution equivalent to their own density. For density gradient centrifugation, physiological media should be used, the density of the solution should be high, and the media should exert little osmotic pressure. Density gradient centrifugation uses solutions such as sodium ditrizoate-polysucrose, Ficoll, dextran, and Percoll (see, e.g., Freshney, Culture of Animal Cells, 3rd ed. (1994)). Such solutions are commercially available, e.g., HISTOPAQUE.RTM. (Sigma). Examples of methods for isolating dendritic cells from PBMCs are disclosed in, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,017,527 and 5,851,756; and in O'Doherty et al., J. Exp. Med. 178: 1067-1078 (1993); Young and Steinman, J. Exp. Med. 171 :1315-1332 (1990); Freudenthal and Steinman, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 57:7698-7702 (1990); Macatonia et al., Immunol. 67: 285-289 (1989); and Markowicz and Engleman, J. Clin. Invest. 85:955-961 (1990).
CD34+ PBMCs or CD 14+ PBMCs can further be selected as a source of dendritic cells using a variety of selection techniques known to those of skill in the art. For example, monoclonal antibodies (or any protein-specific binding protein) can be used to bind to a cell surface antigen found on the surface of the PBMC sub-population of interest (e.g., CD34 or CD 14 on the surface of CD34+ or CD 14+ PBMCs, respectively). Binding of such specific monoclonal antibodies allows the identification and isolation of the sub-group of PBMCs of interest from a total PBMC population by any of a number of immunoaffinity methods known to those of skill in the art. Examples of immunoaffinity methods for isolating sub- populations of PBMCs are described in, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 6,017,527.
Alternatively, the dendritic cells of the present invention can be isolated from bone marrow. For a general description of methods for isolating dendritic cells from bone marrow see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,994,126; Dexter et al., in Long-Term Bone Marrow Culture, pages 57-96, Alan R. Liss, (1984); and Lutz et al., J. Immunol. Methods 223:77-92 (1999). Dendritic cells from bone marrow can typically be obtained from a number of different sources, including, for example, from aspirated marrow. Alternatively, bone marrow can be extracted from a sacrificed animal by dissecting out the femur, removing soft tissue from the bone and removing the bone marrow with a needle and syringe. Dendritic cells can be identified among the different cell types present in the bone marrow based on their morphological characteristics. For example, cultured immature dendritic cells in one or more phases of their development are loosely adherent to plastic, flattening out with a stellate shape.
Optionally, prior to culturing the cells, the tissue source can be pre-treated to remove cells that may compete with the proliferation and/or the survival of the dendritic cells or of their precursors. Examples of such pre-treatments are described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. No. 5,994,126.
Those of skill in the art will recognize that APCs can be cultured for any suitable amount of time. Antigen presenting cells often are cultured from 4 to 15 days, can be cultured for 10-12 days (Lutz et al., supra) and may be cultured for 5-7 days (Inaba et al., J. Exp. Med. 176: 1693 (1992); Inaba et al., J. Exp. Med. 175:1157 (1992); Inaba et al., Current Protocols Immunol., Unit 3.7 (Coico et al., eds. 1998); Schneider et al., J. Immunol. Meth. 154:253 (1992)). Examples of cell culture conditions for dendritic cells and dendritic cell precursors are known to the person of ordinary skill in the art and are described in, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,017,527 and 5,851,756; Inaba et al., J. Exp. Med. 176:1693 (1992); Inaba et al., J. Exp. Med. 175: 1157 (1992); Inaba et al., Current Protocols Immunol., Unit 3.7 (Coico et al., eds. 1998); Schneider et al., J. Immunol. Meth. 154:253 (1992); and Lutz et al., supra.
In general, a cell culture environment includes consideration of such factors as the substrate for cell growth, cell density and cell contract, the gas phase, the medium, the temperature, and the presence of growth factors (see, e.g., Freshney et al., Culture of Animal Cells, 3rd ed. (1994)). Cells can be grown under conditions that provide for cell to cell contact, and may be grown in suspension as three dimensional aggregates. Suspension cultures can be achieved by using, e.g., a flask with a magnetic stirrer or a large surface area paddle, or on a plate that has been coated to prevent the cells from adhering to the bottom of the dish. For example, the cells may be grown in Costar dishes that have been coated with a hydrogel to prevent them from adhering to the bottom of the dish. For cells that grow in a monolayer attached to a substrate, plastic dishes, flasks, roller bottles, or microcarriers are typically used. Other artificial substrates can be used such as glass and metals. The substrate is often treated by etching, or by coating with substances such as collagen, chondronectin, fibronectin, laminin or poly-L-lysine. The type of culture vessel depends on the culture conditions, e.g., multi-well plates, petri dishes, tissue culture tubes, flasks, roller bottles, microcarriers, and the like. Cells are grown at optimal densities that are determined empirically based on the cell type.
Important constituents of the gas phase are oxygen and carbon dioxide. Typically, atmospheric oxygen tensions are used for dendritic cell cultures. Culture vessels are usually vented into the incubator atmosphere to allow gas exchange by using gas permeable caps or by preventing sealing of the culture vessels. Carbon dioxide plays a role in pH stabilization, along with buffer in the cell media, and is typically present at a concentration of 1-10% in the incubator. The CO. sub.2 concentration for dendritic cell cultures often is 5%.
Cultured cells are normally grown in an incubator that provides a suitable temperature, e.g., the body temperature of the animal from which is the cells were obtained, accounting for regional variations in temperature. Generally, 37.degree. C. often is the temperature for dendritic cell culture. Most incubators are humidified to approximately atmospheric conditions.
Defined cell media are available as packaged, premixed powders or presterilized solutions. Examples of commonly used media include Iscove's media, RPMI 1640, DMEM, and McCoy's Medium (see, e.g., GibcoBRL/Life Technologies Catalogue and Reference Guide; Sigma Catalogue). Defined cell culture media are often supplemented with 5-20% serum, e.g., human, horse, calf, or fetal bovine serum. The culture medium is usually buffered to maintain the cells at a pH often from about 7.2 to about 7.4. Other supplements to the media include, e.g., antibiotics, amino acids, sugars, and growth factors (see, e.g., Lutz et al., supra). GM-CSF sometimes is in concentrations ranging from 5 ng/ml to about 20 ng/ml in a culture medium. Other factors described herein and known to stimulate growth of dendritic cells may be included in the culture medium. Some factors will have different effects that are dependent upon the stage of differentiation of the cells, which can be monitored by testing for differentiation markers specific for the cell's stage in the differentiation pathway. GM-CSF can be included in the medium throughout culturing. Other factors that may be included in a culture medium include granulocyte colony-stimulating factor (G-CSF), M-CSF, TNF-.alpha., IFN-.gamma., IL-I, IL-3, IL-6, SCF, LPS, and thrombopoietin. IL-
4 may be present in the culture medium, sometimes at a concentration ranging from 1-100 ng/ml or about
5 ng/ml to about 20 ng/ml. Other factors and methods that can be utilized for DC cell culture are known to the person of ordinary skill in the art (e.g., U.S. 20040033213, published February 19, 2004). Dendritic cells can be recovered and used after cryogenic storage. Precultured DCs can be cryogenically stored, e.g., in liquid nitrogen, for several weeks or months or years. Dendritic cells may be cultured in the presence of GM-CSF, sometimes for about 10 days, prior to being stored cryogenically. The DCs can be stored either as immature cells or as matured APCs, following stimulation by suitable adjuvants, as described herein. Dendritic cells can be cryogenically stored before or following exposure to an antigen of interest. A variety of cryopreservation agents can be used and are described in, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,788,963. Controlling the cooling rate, adding cryoprotective agents and/or limiting the heat of fusion phase where water turns to ice help preserve the function of the activated DCs. The cooling procedure can be carried out by use of, e.g., a programmable freezing device or a methanol bath procedure. After thorough freezing, cells can be rapidly transferred to a long-term cryogenic storage vessel. The samples can be cryogenically stored, for example, in liquid nitrogen (-196. degree. C.) or its vapor (-165. degree. C). Such storage is facilitated by the availability of highly efficient liquid nitrogen refrigerators. For a general description of methods to store DCs cryogenically see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,788,963.
Certain factors may be contacted with dendritic cells to facilitate proliferation and maturation. GM- CSF has been found to promote the proliferation in vitro of both nonadherent immature dendritic cells and adherent macrophages (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,994,126; and Lutz et al., supra). Precursor dendritic cells sometimes are cultured in the presence of GM-CSF at a concentration sufficient to promote survival and proliferation. The dose of GM-CSF depends, e.g., on the amount of competition from other cells (especially macrophages and granulocytes) for the GM-CSF, and on the presence of GM-CSF inactivators in the cell population (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,994,126). GM-CSF concentration sometimes is of about 1 ng/ml to 100 ng/ml, and at times about 5 ng/ml to about 20 ng/ml. GM-CSF can be obtained from different sources well known to those of skill in the art (see, e.g., Lutz et al., supra; and U.S. Pat. No. 5,994,126).
In addition to GM-SCF, a variety of cytokines have been shown to induce proliferation and/or maturation of dendritic cells and other APCs (see, e.g., Caux et al., J. Exp. Med. 180:1263-1272 (1984); Allison, Archivum Immunologiae et Therapiae Experimentalis 45: 141-147 (1997)). Cytokines that can be used to enhance maturation of dendritic cells ex vivo include, but are not limited to, TNF-alpha, stem cell factor (SCF; also named c-kit ligand, steel factor (SF), mast cell growth factor (MGF); see, e.g., EP 423,980; and U.S. Pat. No. 6,017,527), granulocyte colony-stimulating factor (G-CSF), monocyte- macrophage colony-stimulating factor (M-CSF), as well as a number of interleukins, such as, e.g., IL- l.alpha. and IL-I. beta., IL-3, IL-4, IL-6, and IL- 13 (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 6,017,527 and 5,994,126). In addition to promoting maturation of dendritic cells, some interleukins (e.g., IL-4) have been shown to suppresses the overall growth of macrophages and thus favors higher levels of pure DC growth. Cytokines are used in amounts which are effective in increasing the proportion of dendritic cells present in the culture by enhancing either the proliferation or the survival of dendritic cell precursors. In certain embodiments, dendritic cells and precursors are cultured in the presence of GM-CSF, and sometimes are cultured in the presence of GM-CSF and IL-4. When human dendritic precursor cells are cultured, the GM-CSF is sometimes is human GM-CSF (huGM-CSF).
Adjuvants also can be used to stimulate the maturation ex vivo of immature dendritic cells. Specifically, immature dendritic cells can be harvested from the induction cultures described supra and their maturation to end-stage antigen presenting cells can be induced by treating the cells with a variety of adjuvants. Adjuvants that promote maturation of dendritic cells include, but are not limited to, MPL.RTM. immunostimulant and selected synthetic lipid A analogs such as aminoalkyl glucosamide phosphate (AGP). Synthetic lipid A analogs include, for example, lipid A monosaccharide synthetics such as RC- 529, RC-544 and RC-527, and the disaccharide mimetic, RC-511. These adjuvants can be used as 10% ethanol-in- water formulations, although any other formulation that promotes the maturation of dendritic cells is suitable for use with the methods of the present invention. Adjuvants can be synthesized or obtained from a variety of sources (see, e.g., Lutz et al., supra; Johnson et al., Bioorganic Medicinal Chemistry Letters 9:2273-2278 (1999)). Maturation of dendritic cells sometimes is induced using MPL or AGP in certain embodiments.
Maturation of DCs can be assessed by monitoring a number of molecular markers and cell surface phenotypic alterations. These changes can be analyzed, for example, using flow cytometry techniques. Maturation markers can be labeled using specific antibodies and DCs expressing a marker or a set of markers of interest can be separated from the total DC population using, for example, cell sorting FACS analysis. Markers of DC maturation include genes that are expressed at higher levels in mature DCs compared to immature DCs. Such markers include, but are not limited to, cell surface MHC Class II antigens (in particular HLA-DR), ICAM-I, B7-2, costimulating molecules such as CD40, CD80, CD86, CD83, cell trafficking molecules such as CD54, CDl Ib, CD 18, and the like. Mature dendritic cells also can be identified based on their ability to stimulate the proliferation of naive allogeneic T cells in a mixed leukocyte reaction (MLR).
It has been shown that immature dendritic cells are efficient at antigen uptake but are poor antigen presenting cells, and mature dendritic cells are poor at antigen uptake but are very efficient antigen presenting cells. Accordingly, the antigen presenting function of dendritic cells can be used to determine the degree of maturation. The antigen presenting function of a dendritic cell can be measured using antigen-dependent, MHC-restricted T cell activation assays as described herein, as well as other standard assays well known to those of skill in the art. T cell activation can further be determined, e.g., by measuring the induction of cytokine production by the stimulated dendritic cells. Stimulation of cytokine production can be quantified using a variety of standard techniques, such as ELISA, known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
Thus, a DC utilized in a composition or process described herein can be a mature DC, an immature DC, a DC having one or more particular cell markers, a DC contacted with one or more cytokines, a DC contacted with an adjuvant, a DC from a particular source (e.g., bone marrow), a DC contacted with cell culture conditions, and/or a DC contacted with cryogenic conditions, for example, in certain embodiments.
Transferring Target Nucleotide Sequences Into Antigen Presenting Cells
Transgene expression in cells requires transfer of a nucleotide sequence encoding the transgene into the cell. Viral and non- viral methods of gene transfer are known to the person of ordinary skill in the art.
Several non- viral methods for transferring nucleic acids into cells are known. These transfer methods include, for example, calcium phosphate precipitation (Graham and Van Der Eb, 1973; Chen and Okayama, 1987; Rippe et al., 1990) DEAE-dextran (Gopal, 1985), electroporation (Tur-Kaspa et al., 1986; Potter et al., 1984), direct microinjection (Harland and Weintraub, 1985), DNA- loaded liposomes (Nicolau and Sene, 1982; Fraley et al., 1979), cell sonication (Fechheimer et al., 1987), gene bombardment using high velocity microprojectiles (Yang et al., 1990), and receptor-mediated transfection (Wu and Wu, 1987; Wu and Wu, 1988).
In certain embodiments, the nucleic acid is complexed to a cationic polymer. Cationic polymers, which are water-soluble complexes, are known in the art and have been utilized in delivery systems for DNA plasmids. This strategy employs the use of a soluble system, which conveys nucleic acid into cells via receptor-mediated endocytosis (Wu & Wu 1988). Complexing nucleic acids with a cationic polymer can neutralize negative charge of the nucleic acid, which facilitates increased endocytic uptake. Examples of cationic polymers include, but are not limited to, polylysine, polyethyleneimine, polyhistidine, protamine, polyvinylamines, polyvinylpyridine, polymethacrylates, and polyornithine.
In a some transfer embodiments, the nucleic acid is entrapped in a liposome. Liposomes are vesicular structures characterized by a phospholipid bilayer membrane and an inner aqueous medium. Multilamellar liposomes have multiple lipid layers separated by aqueous medium. They form spontaneously when phospholipids are suspended in an excess of aqueous solution. Lipid components undergo self- rearrangement before the formation of closed structures and entrap water and dissolved solutes between the lipid bilayers (Ghosh and Bachhawat, 1991). Addition of nucleic acids to cationic liposomes causes a topological transition from liposomes to optically birefringent liquid-crystalline condensed globules (Radler et al., 1997). These DNA-lipid complexes are potential non- viral vectors for use in immunotherapy.
Liposome-mediated nucleic acid delivery and expression of foreign DNA in vitro has been very successful. Using the .beta.-lactamase gene, Wong et al., (1980) demonstrated the feasibility of liposome- mediated delivery and expression of foreign DNA in cultured chick embryo, HeLa, and hepatoma cells. Nicolau et al., (1987) accomplished successful liposome-mediated gene transfer in rats after intravenous injection. Also included are various commercial approaches involving "lipofection" technology.
In certain embodiments, the liposome is complexed with a hemagglutinating virus (HVJ). This has been shown to facilitate fusion with the cell membrane and promote cell entry of liposome-encapsulated DNA (Kaneda et al., 1989). In other embodiments, the liposome is complexed or employed in conjunction with nuclear nonhistone chromosomal proteins (HMG-I) (Kato et al., 1991). In yet further embodiments, the liposome is complexed or employed in conjunction with both HVJ and HMG- 1. In that such expression constructs have been successfully employed in transfer and expression of nucleic acid in vitro and in vivo, then they are applicable for the present invention.
In other embodiments, the delivery vehicle may comprise a ligand and a liposome. For example, Nicolau et al., (1987) employed lactosyl-ceramide, a galactose-terminal asialganglioside, incorporated into liposomes and observed an increase in the uptake of the insulin gene by hepatocytes. Thus, it is feasible that a nucleic acid encoding a therapeutic gene also is specifically delivered into a cell type such as prostate, epithelial or tumor cells, by any number of receptor- ligand systems with or without liposomes. For example, the human prostate- specific antigen (Watt et al., 1986) is used as the receptor for mediated delivery of a nucleic acid in prostate tissue.
In another embodiment of the invention, the expression construct may simply consist of naked recombinant DNA or plasmids. Transfer of the construct is performed by any of the methods mentioned above which physically or chemically permeabilize the cell membrane. This is applicable particularly for transfer in vitro, however, it is applied for in vivo use as well. Dubensky et al., (1984) successfully injected polyomavirus DNA in the form of CaPO4 precipitates into liver and spleen of adult and newborn mice demonstrating active viral replication and acute infection. Benvenisty and Neshif (1986) also demonstrated that direct intraperitoneal injection of CaPU4 precipitated plasmids results in expression of the transfected genes. It is envisioned that DNA encoding a CAM also is transferred in a similar manner in vivo and express CAM.
Another embodiment of the invention for transferring a naked DNA expression construct into cells may involve particle bombardment. This method depends on the ability to accelerate DNA coated microprojectiles to a high velocity by application of a propulsion force, allowing them to pierce cell membranes and enter cells without killing them (Klein et al., 1987). Several devices for accelerating small particles have been developed. One such device relies on a high voltage discharge to generate an electrical current, which in turn provides the motive force (Yang et al., 1990). The microprojectiles used have consisted of biologically inert substances such as tungsten or gold beads.
Viral vectors also may be utilized to effect nucleic acid transfer to cells. In certain embodiments, a transgene is incorporated into a viral particle to mediate gene transfer to a cell. The resulting virus often is exposed to the appropriate host cell under physiologic conditions, permitting uptake of the virus. Such methods are advantageously employed using a variety of viral vectors, as discussed hereafter.
Adenovirus, sometimes referred to herein as "Ad," is particularly suitable for use as a gene transfer vector because of its mid-sized DNA genome, ease of manipulation, high titer, wide target-cell range, and high infectivity. The roughly 36 kB viral genome is bounded by 100-200 base pair (bp) inverted terminal repeats (ITR), in which are contained cis-acting elements necessary for viral DNA replication and packaging. The early (E) and late (L) regions of the genome that contain different transcription units are divided by the onset of viral DNA replication. The El region (ElA and ElB) encodes proteins responsible for the regulation of transcription of the viral genome and a few cellular genes. The expression of the E2 region (E2A and E2B) results in the synthesis of the proteins for viral DNA replication. These proteins are involved in DNA replication, late gene expression, and host cell shut off (Renan, 1990). The products of the late genes (Ll, L2, L3, L4 and L5), including the majority of the viral capsid proteins, are expressed only after significant processing of a single primary transcript issued by the major late promoter (MLP). The MLP (located at 16.8 map units) is particularly efficient during the late phase of infection, and all the mRNAs issued from this promoter possess a 5' tripartite leader (TL) sequence, which makes them often utilized mRNAs for translation.
Adenovirus often is optimized for immunotherapy by maximizing its carrying capacity so that large segments of DNA can be included. Large displacement of DNA is possible in adenovirus because the cis elements required for viral DNA replication all are localized in the inverted terminal repeats (ITR) (100- 200 bp) at either end of the linear viral genome. Plasmids containing ITR's can replicate in the presence of a non-defective adenovirus (Hay et al., 1984). Therefore, inclusion of these elements in an adenoviral vector should permit replication.
Toxicity and immunologic reaction associated with certain adenoviral products also are minimized for immunotherapy applications. The two goals are, to an extent, coterminous in that elimination of adenoviral genes serves both ends. It is possible achieve both these goals while retaining the ability to manipulate the therapeutic constructs with relative ease.
In addition, the packaging signal for viral encapsidation is localized between 194-385 bp (0.5-1.1 map units) at the left end of the viral genome (Hearing et al., 1987). This signal mimics the protein recognition site in bacteriophage .lambda. DNA where a specific sequence close to the left end, but outside the cohesive end sequence, mediates the binding to proteins that are required for insertion of the DNA into the head structure. El substitution vectors of Ad have demonstrated that a 450 bp (0-1.25 map units) fragment at the left end of the viral genome could direct packaging in 293 cells (Levrero et al., 1991).
Previously, it has been shown that certain regions of the adenoviral genome can be incorporated into the genome of mammalian cells and the genes encoded thereby expressed. These cell lines are capable of supporting the replication of an adenoviral vector that is deficient in the adenoviral function encoded by the cell line. There also have been reports of complementation of replication deficient adenoviral vectors by "helping" vectors, e.g., wild-type virus or conditionally defective mutants.
Replication-deficient adenoviral vectors can be complemented, in trans, by helper virus. This observation alone does not permit isolation of the replication-deficient vectors, however, since the presence of helper virus, needed to provide replicative functions, would contaminate any preparation. Thus, an additional element was needed that would add specificity to the replication and/or packaging of the replication-deficient vector. That element, as provided for in the present invention, derives from the packaging function of adenovirus.
It has been shown that a packaging signal for adenovirus exists in the left end of the conventional adenovirus map (Tibbetts, 1977). Later studies showed that a mutant with a deletion in the ElA (194-358 bp) region of the genome grew poorly even in a cell line that complemented the early (ElA) function (Hearing and Shenk, 1983). When a compensating adenoviral DNA (0-353 bp) was recombined into the right end of the mutant, the virus was packaged normally. Further mutational analysis identified a short, repeated, position-dependent element in the left end of the Ad5 genome. One copy of the repeat was found to be sufficient for efficient packaging if present at either end of the genome, but not when moved towards the interior of the Ad5 DNA molecule (Hearing et al., 1987).
By using mutated versions of the packaging signal, it is possible to create helper viruses that are packaged with varying efficiencies. Typically, the mutations are point mutations or deletions. When helper viruses with low efficiency packaging are grown in helper cells, the virus is packaged, albeit at reduced rates compared to wild- type virus, thereby permitting propagation of the helper. When these helper viruses are grown in cells along with virus that contains wild-type packaging signals, however, the wild-type packaging signals are recognized preferentially over the mutated versions. Given a limiting amount of packaging factor, the virus containing the wild- type signals are packaged selectively when compared to the helpers. If the preference is great enough, stocks approaching homogeneity should be achieved.
Retrovirus also are useful for transferring Akt-encoding nucleotide sequences into cells. Retroviruses are a group of single-stranded RNA viruses characterized by an ability to convert their RNA to double- stranded DNA in infected cells by a process of reverse-transcription (Coffin, 1990). The resulting DNA then stably integrates into cellular chromosomes as a provirus and directs synthesis of viral proteins. The integration results in the retention of the viral gene sequences in the recipient cell and its descendants. The retroviral genome contains three genes— gag, pol and env— that code for capsid proteins, polymerase enzyme, and envelope components, respectively. A sequence found upstream from the gag gene, termed .psi., functions as a signal for packaging of the genome into virions. Two long terminal repeat (LTR) sequences are present at the 5' and 3' ends of the viral genome. These contain strong promoter and enhancer sequences and also are required for integration in the host cell genome (Coffin, 1990).
In order to construct a retroviral vector, a nucleic acid encoding a promoter is inserted into the viral genome in the place of certain viral sequences to produce a virus that is replication-defective. In order to produce virions, a packaging cell line containing the gag, pol and env genes but without the LTR and .psi. components is constructed (Mann et al., 1983). When a recombinant plasmid containing a human cDNA, together with the retroviral LTR and .psi. sequences is introduced into this cell line (by calcium phosphate precipitation for example), the .psi. sequence allows the RNA transcript of the recombinant plasmid to be packaged into viral particles, which are then secreted into the culture media (Nicolas and Rubenstein, 1988; Temin, 1986; Mann et al., 1983). The media containing the recombinant retroviruses is collected, optionally concentrated, and used for gene transfer. Retroviral vectors are able to infect a broad variety of cell types. However, integration and stable expression of many types of retroviruses require the division of host cells (Paskind et al., 1975). An approach designed to allow specific targeting of retrovirus vectors recently was developed based on the chemical modification of a retrovirus by the chemical addition of galactose residues to the viral envelope. This modification could permit the specific infection of cells such as hepatocytes via asialoglycoprotein receptors, should this be desired.
A different approach to targeting of recombinant retroviruses was designed in which biotinylated antibodies against a retroviral envelope protein and against a specific cell receptor were used. The antibodies were coupled via the biotin components by using streptavidin (Roux et al., 1989). Using antibodies against major histocompatibility complex class I and class II antigens, the infection of a variety of human cells that bore those surface antigens was demonstrated with an ecotropic virus in vitro (Roux et al., 1989).
Adeno-associated virus, also referred to herein as "AAV," also may be utilized to transfer Akt- encoding nucleotide sequences into cells. AAV utilizes a linear, single- stranded DNA of about 4700 base pairs. Inverted terminal repeats flank the genome. Two genes are present within the genome, giving rise to a number of distinct gene products. The first, the cap gene, produces three different virion proteins (VP), designated VP-I, VP-2 and VP-3. The second, the rep gene, encodes four non-structural proteins (NS). One or more of these rep gene products is responsible for transactivating AAV transcription.
The three promoters in AAV are designated by their location, in map units, in the genome. These are, from left to right, p5, pl9 and p40. Transcription gives rise to six transcripts, two initiated at each of three promoters, with one of each pair being spliced. The splice site, derived from map units 42-46, is the same for each transcript. The four non-structural proteins apparently are derived from the longer of the transcripts, and three virion proteins all arise from the smallest transcript.
AAV is not associated with any pathologic state in humans. Interestingly, for efficient replication, AAV requires "helping" functions from viruses such as herpes simplex virus I and II, cytomegalovirus, pseudorabies virus and, of course, adenovirus. The best characterized of the helpers is adenovirus, and many "early" functions for this virus have been shown to assist with AAV replication. Low-level expression of AAV rep proteins is believed to hold AAV structural expression in check, and helper virus infection is thought to remove this block.
The terminal repeats of the AAV vector can be obtained by restriction endonuclease digestion of AAV or a plasmid such as p201, which contains a modified AAV genome (Samulski et al., 1987), or by other methods known to the skilled artisan, including but not limited to chemical or enzymatic synthesis of the terminal repeats based upon the published sequence of AAV. The ordinarily skilled artisan can determine, by well-known methods such as deletion analysis, the minimum sequence or part of the AAV ITRs which is required to allow function, i.e., stable and site-specific integration. The ordinarily skilled artisan also can determine which minor modifications of the sequence can be tolerated while maintaining the ability of the terminal repeats to direct stable, site-specific integration.
AAV-based vectors have proven to be safe and effective vehicles for gene delivery in vitro, and these vectors are being developed and tested in pre-clinical and clinical stages for a wide range of applications in potential gene therapy, both ex vivo and in vivo (Carter and Flotte, 1995; Chatterjee et al., 1995; Ferrari et al., 1996; Fisher et al., 1996; Flotte et al., 1993; Goodman et al., 1994; Kaplitt et al., 1994; 1996, Kessler et al., 1996; Koeberl et al., 1997; Mizukami et al., 1996).
AAV-mediated efficient gene transfer and expression in the lung has led to clinical trials for the treatment of cystic fibrosis (Carter and Flotte, 1995; Flotte et al., 1993). Similarly, the prospects for treatment of muscular dystrophy by AAV-mediated gene delivery of the dystrophin gene to skeletal muscle, of Parkinson's disease by tyrosine hydroxylase gene delivery to the brain, of hemophilia B by Factor IX gene delivery to the liver, and potentially of myocardial infarction by vascular endothelial growth factor gene to the heart, appear promising since AAV-mediated transgene expression in these organs has recently been shown to be highly efficient (Fisher et al., 1996; Flotte et al., 1993; Kaplitt et al., 1994; 1996; Koeberl et al., 1997; McCown et al., 1996; Ping et al., 1996; Xiao et al., 1996).
Other viral vectors also may be utilized for transfer of nucleic acids into cells. Vectors derived from viruses such as vaccinia virus (Ridgeway, 1988; Baichwal and Sugden, 1986; Coupar et al., 1988) canary pox virus, and herpes viruses are employed. These viruses offer several features for use in gene transfer into various mammalian cells. Several viral vectors are known and can be selected by the person of ordinary skill in the art (e.g., U.S. 20020123479, published on September 5, 2002).
Once the construct has been delivered into the cell, the nucleic acid encoding the transgene are positioned and expressed at different sites. In certain embodiments, the nucleic acid encoding the transgene is stably integrated into the genome of the cell. This integration is in the cognate location and orientation via homologous recombination (gene replacement) or it is integrated in a random, non-specific location (gene augmentation). In yet further embodiments, the nucleic acid is stably maintained in the cell as a separate, episomal segment of DNA. Such nucleic acid segments or "episomes" encode sequences sufficient to permit maintenance and replication independent of or in synchronization with the host cell cycle. How the expression construct is delivered to a cell and where in the cell the nucleic acid remains is dependent on the type of expression construct employed.
A nucleic acid may be targeted to a dendritic cell by associating a targeting molecule having affinity for a molecule present on the surface of a dendritic cell with the nucleic acid. A wide variety of targeting elements can be utilized to specifically direct a nucleic acid to a dendritic cell. As utilized herein, targeting elements are considered to be capable of interacting with a molecule present on the surface of a dendritic cell when a biological effect of the coupled targeting element may be seen in the cell, or, alternatively, when there is greater than at least about a 10-fold difference, and sometimes greater than at least about a 25, 50, or 100-fold difference, between the binding of the targeting element to dendritic cells as compared to non-dendritic cells. Generally, it is preferable that the targeting element interact with a molecule present on the surface of the selected cell type with a K.sub.D of less than about 10.sup.-5M, preferably less than about 10.sup.-6M, more preferably less than about 10.sup.-7M, and most preferably less than about 10.sup.-8M, as determined by Scatchard analysis (Scatchard, Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci. 51 :660, 1949). Suitable targeting elements are preferably non- immunogenic, not degraded by proteolysis, and not scavenged by the immune system. Particularly preferred targeting elements should have a half-life within an animal of between about 10 minutes and about 1 week.
Targeting elements often are proteins or peptides, although other non-proteinaceous molecules may also function as targeting elements. For example, antibodies (or the antigen binding domain thereof) can be utilized to target dendritic cells. Particularly useful antibodies are monoclonal antibodies which interact with the extracellular domains of integral membrane proteins found predominantly, or preferably exclusively, in the cell membranes of dendritic cells, (see generally, Wilchek and Bayer, Anal. Biochem 171 : 1-32, 1988). In some embodiments the Fc portion of such an antibody will serve as the targeting element, targeting the gene delivery vehicle to dendritic cells that express Fc receptor molecules. Suitable markers for antibody generation include CDl Ic, CD54, CD58, CD25, CDl Ia, CD23, CD32, CD40, CDl, CD45, MHC Class I, MHC Class II, Mac-1, Mac-2, and Mac-3. These and other lineage specific markers can be used to separate or purify dendritic cells from more diverse cell populations, in addition to those described above. Both positive and negative selection strategies may be employed. Techniques for conducting cell selection include FACS and affinity chromatography.
Other suitable targeting elements include hormones, immune accessory molecules (e.g., B7, IL-2, .alpha.-interferon, and .gamma.-interferon), cell adhesion molecules (e.g., ICAM-I, ICAM-2, and ICAM- 3), integrins that bind to ICAMs and receptors known to be expressed on the surface of dendritic cells. Dendritic cell-specific ligands also may be selected from libraries created utilizing recombinant techniques (Scott and Smith, Science 249:386, 1990; Devlin et al., Science 249:404, 1990; Houghten et al., Nature 354:84 1991; Matthews and Wells, Science 260:1113,1993; Nissim et al., EMBO J. 13(3):692- 698, 1994), or equivalent techniques utilizing organic compound libraries.
Targeting molecules can be associated with a nucleic acid in a variety of manners. For example, a targeting molecule can be linked directly to a nucleic acid (e.g., when a nucleic acid is transferred to dendritic cell as naked DNA), can be incorporated into the lipid bilayer of a liposome that bears the nucleic acid, and can be expressed on the surface of a virus bearing the target nucleotide sequence.
A nucleic acid delivery vehicle sometimes is purified before it is contacted with an antigen presenting cell for transfer. Techniques utilized for purification are dependent on the type of vehicle used for nucleic acid delivery. If naked nucleic acid is delivered, there are a variety of techniques known in the art including, for example, purification by CsCl-ethidium bromide gradient, ion-exchange chromatography, gel-filtration chromatography, and differential precipitation with polyethylene glycol. Further description of nucleic acids purification is provided in Sambrook et. al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, 2d ed. (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, 1989). For viral delivery vehicles a sulfated oligosaccharide can be added directly to a virus-containing preparation for purification.
When the delivery vehicle is a liposome, a variety of purification methods known to those skilled in the art may be utilized and are described in more detail in Mannino and Gould-Fogerite (BioTechniques 6:682, 1988). Briefly, preparation of liposomes typically involves admixing solutions of one or more purified phospholipids and cholesterol in organic solvents and evaporating the solvents to dryness. An aqueous buffer containing the delivery vehicle then is added to the lipid film and the mixture is sonicated to create a fairly uniform dispersion of liposomes. In certain embodiments, dialysis, gel filtration, or ultracentrifugation is then be used to separate unincorporated components from the intact liposomes. (Stryer, L., Biochemistry, pp:236 1975 (W. H. Freeman, San Francisco): Szoka et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta 600: 1, 1980; Bayer et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta. 550:464, 1979; Rivnay et al., Meth. Enzymol. 149: 119, 1987; Wang et al., PNAS 84: 7851, 1987 and, Plant et al., Anal. Biochem. 176:420, 1989.
Priming Modified Antigen Presenting Cells with Antigen
Loading APCs with antigen can be achieved by a variety of methods, including pulsing cells with antigenic peptides or infecting the cells with recombinant viral vectors, for example. Gene therapy techniques can be applied to dendritic cell vaccines. Such techniques use recombinant viral vectors incapable of replication to provide efficient and reliable means of gene transfer. Genetic material can be introduced into dendritic cells to provide them with a renewable source of antigen for presentation; this should lead to more sustained expression of antigen. The expression of viral (and therefore foreign) genes may boost the immune response, but this antiviral immunity primed by dendritic cells may cause the immune system to destroy dendritic cells rapidly in subsequent rounds of immunization. One solution can be to use viral vectors that do not result in the expression of viral genes, such as retroviruses or "gutless" adenoviral vectors.
Following expansion in culture and maturation, APCs can be pulsed with an antigen. Pulsing processes are known to and can be selected by the person of ordinary skill in the art, and cells may be pulsed with antigen one or more times in appropriate regular or variable cycles. APCs pulsed with an antigen of interest will process and present epitopes of the antigen. Antigens can be from any source, including, e.g., viruses, bacteria, parasites, etc. In one embodiment, the antigen is derived from Mycobacterium sp, Chlamydia sp., Leishmania sp., Trypanosoma sp., Plasmodium sp., or a Candida sp. APCs can be pulsed with either the entire peptide (antigen) or with a fragment thereof having immunogenic properties, e.g., an epitope.
Briefly, the antigen-activated APCs (e.g., antigen-activated dendritic cells) can be produced by exposing, ex vivo, an antigen to the APCs (e.g., the dendritic cells) prepared according to the methods known to the person of ordinary skill in the art. Dendritic cells, for example, can be plated in culture dishes and exposed to an antigen of interest in a sufficient amount and for a sufficient period of time to allow the antigen to bind to the dendritic cells. The amount and time necessary to achieve binding of the antigen to the dendritic cells may be determined by using standard immunoassays or binding assays. Any other method known to those of skill in the art may also be used to detect the presence of antigen on the dendritic cells following their exposure to the antigen. Methods for pulsing dendritic cells with an antigen of interest are described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. No. 6,017,527.
In general, antigens and fragments thereof may be prepared using any of a variety of procedures well known to those of skill in the art. For example, antigens can be naturally occurring and purified from a natural source. Alternatively, antigens and fragments thereof can be produced recombinantly using a DNA sequence that encodes the antigen, which has been inserted into an appropriate expression vector, i.e., a vector which contains the necessary elements for the transcription and translation of the inserted coding sequence, and expressed in an appropriate host. Methods which are well known to those skilled in the art may be used to construct expression vectors containing sequences encoding a polypeptide of interest and appropriate transcriptional and translational control elements. These methods include in vitro recombinant DNA techniques, synthetic techniques, and in vivo genetic recombination. Such techniques are described in Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratories, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y. (1989); and Ausubel et al., Current Protocols in Molecular Biology (1995 supplement). In addition, antigens and portions thereof may also be generated by synthetic means. Synthetic polypeptides having fewer than about 100 amino acids, and generally fewer than about 50 amino acids, may be generated using techniques well known in the art. For example, such polypeptides may be synthesized using any of the commercially available solid-phase techniques, such as the Merrifield solid-phase synthesis method, where amino acids are sequentially added to a growing amino acid chain (see Merrifield, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 85:2149-2146 (1963)). Equipment for automated synthesis of polypeptides is commercially available from suppliers such as Perkin Elmer/Applied BioSystems Division, Inc., Foster City, Calif, and may be operated according to the manufacturer's instructions. Variants of a native antigen may generally be prepared using standard mutagenesis techniques, such as oligonucleotide-directed site-specific mutagenesis. Sections of the DNA sequence may also be removed using standard techniques to permit preparation of truncated polypeptides.
Within certain embodiments, the antigen of interest may be a fusion protein that comprises multiple polypeptides. A fusion protein may, for instance, include an antigen and a fusion partner which may, e.g., assist in providing T helper epitopes, and/or assist in expressing the protein at higher yields than the native recombinant protein. Other fusion partners may be selected so as to increase the solubility of the protein or to enable the protein to be targeted to desired intracellular compartments. Still further fusion partners include affinity tags, which facilitate the purification of the protein. Fusion proteins may generally be prepared using standard techniques, including chemical conjugation and as recombinant proteins.
An antigen often is a molecule associated with a disease or condition. For example, pathogen- associated antigens, such as viral antigens in virus-associated diseases (e.g., HIV-induced AIDS and HBV-induced liver disease), and portions thereof, can be utilized to prime modified APCs of the invention. Representative examples of pathogen associated antigens include antigens from bacteria (e.g., E. coli, streptococcus, staphylococcus, mycobacteria, and the like), fungi, parasites, and viruses (e.g., influenza virus, HIV, and Hepatitis A, B and C Virus ("HAV", "HBV" and "HCV", respectively), human papiloma virus ("HPV"), Epstein-Barr Virus ("EBV"), herpes simplex virus ("HSV"), hantavirus, HTLV I, HTLV II, cytomegalovirus ("CMV"), and feline leukemia virus). Antigens critical to the survival and proliferation of the cancer cell in vivo, and portions thereof, can be selected for priming modified APCs of the invention, and include, for example: (a) tissue-specific antigens that are elevated in cancer, such as carcinoembryonic antigen (CEA, colorectal cancer); .alpha.-fetoprotein (liver cancer); prostate cancer antigen (PSA, prostate cancer), mitochondrial creatine kinase (MCK, muscle cancers), myelin basic protein (MBP, oligodendrocyte specific), glial fibrillary acidic protein (GFAP, glial cell specific), tyrosinase (melanoma), and neuron cancer enolase (NSE, neuronal cancers); (b) mutated forms of tumor suppressor genes, such as K-ras (colorectal carcinomas), and p53 (J. L. Bos, Cancer Res. 49:4682, 1989; Chiba et al., Oncogene 5: 1603, 1990; (c) viral proteins expressed by virally induced cancers, such as human papillomavirus 16/18 E6 and E7 proteins (cervical cancer) or Epstein Barr Virus peptides (EBV, B cell malignancies); (d) tumor-specific antigens such as MART-I (melanoma), gplOO (melanoma), HER2/neu (breast and epithelial cancers); NY-ESO-I (testes and various tumors), PSA or PSMA (prostate cancer), thymus-leukemia antigen (TL), and proteins of the MAGE family (hepatocellular cancer and other tumors); (e) survivin and other apoptosis inhibiting proteins expressed preferentially by tumor cells (M. Zeiss et al., J. Immunol. 170:5391, 2003); and (f) components involved in angiogenesis, such as vascular endothelia growth factor (VEGF, expressed in angiogenic stroma and tumor cells), VEGF receptor 2, IdI, Id3, and Tie-2 (preferentially expressed during neoangiogenesis) (US 2004/0115174 Al). These and other cancer-associated antigens can be selected by the person of ordinary skill in the art. General reviews for tumor related antigens useful as cancer vaccine targets include the text Tumor Antigens Recognized by T Cells and Antibodies by H. J. Stauss, Y. Kawakami, & G. Parmiani, CRC Press, 2003; and articles by Rosenberg, Immunity 10:281, 1999; Nestle et al., Nat. Med. 4:328, 1998; Dermime et al., Br. Med. Bull. 62: 149, 2002; and Berzofsky et al., J. Clin. Invest. 113:1515, 2004. Methods for identifying additional cancer target antigens are described in Barnea et al., Eur J Immunol. 32:213, 2002; Schirle et al., Eur J Immunol. 30:2216, 2000; Vinals et al., Vaccine 19:2607, 2001; Perez- Diez et al., Cell. MoI. Life Sci. 59:230, 2002; Radvanyi et al., Int. Arch. Allergy Immunol. 133:179, 2004. An antigen may be a protein, polypeptide, protein or polypeptide fragment, peptide, dominant epitope peptide that binds to an HLA class I or II molecule, a monosaccharide, a polysaccharide or nucleic acid.
Once an antigen is selected, one or more subfragments (i.e., portions) of the antigen having a dominant immunogenic epitope may be synthesized based upon the knowledge of the ordinary artisan for selecting epitope subsequences. Sequence motifs for dominant epitopes are known and can be selected based upon whether they are presented by specific MHC I (e.g., peptides of about 8-9 amino acids) and MHC II molecules (e.g., U.S. 20060093617, published on May 4, 2006, and U.S. 20050271676, published on December 8, 2005). Some epitopes conform to "pan DR" motifs and are presented by multiple types of class II DR molecules (e.g., U.S. 20050049197 published on March 3, 2005), and native epitopes may be modified into heteroclitic analogs having enhanced immunogenicity (e.g., U.S. 20030143672, published on July 31, 2003).
Prior to loading, a polypeptide antigen may be covalently conjugated to an immunological partner that provides T cell help (e.g., a carrier molecule). Alternatively, an APC may be pulsed with a non- conjugated immunological partner, separately or in the presence of the antigen. Often, antigen presenting cells are primed with an antigen (e.g., a protein, polypeptide, protein or polypeptide fragment, peptide, dominant immunogenic epitope) for an hour or more before the cells are matured (e.g., contacted with a nucleic acid that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt molecule). The antigen presenting cells may be contacted with a full-length protein or polypeptide antigen, a fragment of the protein or polypeptide antigen or a dominant immunogenic epitope from the antigen that binds to a HLA class I or II molecule. An antigen may be linked to a cell surface receptor that facilitates uptake of the antigen by cells (e.g., DEC-205 or DC-sign receptor ligand).
APCs may be transfected with a polynucleotide sequence encoding an antigen of interest (e.g., a protein, polypeptide, protein or polypeptide fragment, peptide, dominant immunogenic epitope) such that the antigen, or an immunogenic portion thereof, is expressed on the cell surface. Such transfection may take place ex vivo, and a composition or vaccine comprising such transfected cells may then be used for therapeutic purposes, as described herein. Alternatively, a gene delivery vehicle that targets a dendritic or other antigen presenting cell may be administered to a patient, resulting in transfection that occurs in vivo. In the latter embodiments, the antigen-encoding sequence and membrane -targeted Akt sequence may be expressed in cis (from the same nucleic acid) or in trans (from different nucleic acids). In vivo and ex vivo transfection of dendritic cells, for example, may generally be performed using any methods known in the art, such as those described in WO 97/24447, or the gene gun approach described by Mahvi et al., Immunology and cell Biology 75:456-460 (1997). Antigen loading of dendritic cells may be achieved by incubating dendritic cells or progenitor cells with the antigen, DNA (naked or within a plasmid vector) or RNA; or with antigen-expressing recombinant bacterium or viruses (e.g., vaccinia, fowlpox, adenovirus or lentivirus vectors). Vectors that express multiple antigenic epitopes in "minigenes" also may be utilized (e.g., U.S. 20060093617, published on May 4, 2006).
In the context of the present invention, the antigens, antigen fragments or fusion proteins used to pulse the dendritic cells are preferably immunogenic, i.e., they are able to elicit an immune response (e.g., cellular or humoral) in a patient, such as a human, and/or in a biological sample (in vitro). In particular, antigens that are immunogenic (and portions of such antigens that are immunogenic) comprise an epitope recognized by a B-cell and/or a T-cell surface antigen receptor. Antigens that are immunogenic (and immunogenic portions of such antigens) are capable of stimulating cell proliferation, interleukin-12 production and/or interferon-. gamma, production in biological samples comprising one or more cells selected from the group of T cells, NK cells, B cells and macrophages, where the cells have been previously stimulated with the antigen.
Immunomodulatory factors may be active in vivo and/or ex vivo, can enhance immunogenicity of an antigen, and may be co-administered (e.g., before, during or after administration of antigen(s)). Representative examples of immunomodulatory factors include, for example, cytokines, such as IL-I, IL- 2 (Karupiah et al., J. Immunology 144:290, 1990: Weber et al., J. Exp. Med. 166:1716, 1987; Gansbacher et al., J. Exp. Med. 172:1217, 1990: U.S. Pat. No. 4,738,927). IL-3, IL-4 (Tepper et al., Cell 57:503, 1989, Golumbek et al., Science 254:713, 1991 and U.S. Pat. No. 5,017,691), IL-5, IL-6 (Brakenhof et al., J. Immunol. 139:4116, 1987, and WO 90/06370), IL-7 (U.S. Pat. No. 4,965,195), IL-8, IL-9, IL-10, IL-11, IL- 12 (Wolf et al., J. Immuno. 46:3074, 1991 and Gubler et al., PNAS 88:4143, 1991), IL- 13 (WO 94/04680), IL- 14, IL- 15, .alpha. -interferon (Finter et al., Drugs 42(5):749, 1991, Nagata et al., Nature 284:316, 1980; Familletti et al., Methods in Enz. 78:387, 1981, Twu et al., PNAS USA 86:2046, 1989, Faktor et al., Oncogene 5:867, 1990, U.S. Pat. No. 4,892,743, U.S. Pat. No. 4,966,843, and WO 85/02862), .beta.-interferon (Seif et al., J. Vir. 65:664, 1991), .gamma. -interferons (Radford et al., The American Society of Hepatology 9:2008, 1991, Watanabe et al. PNAS 86:9456, 1989, Gansbacher et al., Cancer Research 50:7820, 1990, Maio et al., Can. Immunol. Immunother. 30:34, 1989, U.S. Pat. No. 4,762,791, and U.S. Pat. No. 4,727,138). G-CSF (U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,999,291 and 4,810,643), GM-CSF (WO 85/04188). tumor necrosis factors (TNFs) (Jayaraman et al., J. Immunology 144:942, 1990), CD3 (Krissanen et al., Immunogenetics 26:258, 1987), CD8, ICAM-I (Altman et al., Nature 338:512, 1989; Simmons et al., Nature 331 :624, 1988), ICAM-2 (Singer Science 255: 1671, 1992), LFA-I (Altmann et al., Nature 338:521, 1989), LFA-3 (Wallner et al., J. Exp. Med. 166(4):923, 1987), and other proteins such as HLA Class I molecules. HLA Class II molecules, B7 (Freeman et al., J. Immuno. 143:2714, 1989). B7-2, .beta..sub.2-microglubulin (Parnes et al., PNAS 78:2253, 1981), chaperones, and MHC linked transporter proteins or analogs thereof (Powis et al., Nature 354:528, 1991). The choice of which immunomodulatory factor(s) to employ is based upon the therapeutic effects of the factor. Immunomodulatory factors sometimes utilized include .alpha.-interferon, .gamma.-interferon, and IL-2.
A variety of standard assays for measuring the immunogenic properties of a polypeptide of interest or of a portion thereof are available and known to those of skill in the art (see, e.g., Paul, Fundamental Immunology, 3d ed., Raven Press, pp. 243-247 (1993), and references cited therein), and as described hereafter.
Assessing Modified Dendritic Cell Longevity and Induced Immune Response In certain embodiments, modified antigen presenting cells described herein have a greater longevity (i.e., lifespan) than unmodified counterparts. Such longevity can be expressed in terms of hours, days weeks, number or fraction of surviving cells and number or fraction of dead cells (e.g., cells that have or are undergoing apoptosis), for example. Enhanced longevity can be expressed in terms of a fold-, fraction- or percentage-increase longevity of modified cells over the longevity of unmodified counterpart cells. In certain embodiments, Longevity or lifespan can be assessed in vitro, ex vivo or in vivo by a number of techniques know to the person of ordinary skill in the art. In certain embodiments, methods of observing cell staining (e.g., with Annexin, propidium iodide (PI), CFSE dyes), enzymatic activity (e.g., caspase activity), cell sorting (e.g., based upon cell markers associated with apoptosis or cell death) and/or cell morphology can be utilized. Representative methods for determining cell longevity and cell death are described in Examples 9 and 10 hereafter.
In one aspect of the invention, the modified antigen presenting cells (e.g., the modified dendritic cells) are used to generate an immune response to an antigen of interest. The modified antigen presenting cells described herein often induce a more intense immune response than unmodified counterparts. An enhanced immune response can be expressed in terms of a fold-, fraction- or percentage-increase of an immune response elicited by modified cells over the immune response elicited by unmodified counterpart cells. An immune response to an antigen of interest can be detected by a number of methods available to a person of ordinary skill in the art (e.g., ELISPOT assay described in Example 9). For example, an immune response can be assessed by examining the presence, absence, or enhancement of specific activation of CD4+ or CD8+ T cells or by antibodies. Typically, T cells isolated from an immunized individual by routine techniques (e.g., by Ficoll/Hypaque density gradient centrifugation of peripheral blood lymphocytes) are incubated with an antigen (e.g., such T cells often are incubated with APCs expressing antigen, since T cells generally are poor APCs). For example, T cells may be incubated in vitro for 2-9 days (typically 4 days) at 37. degree. C. with the antigen. It may be desirable to incubate another aliquot of a T cell sample in the absence of the antigen to serve as a control.
Specific activation of CD4+ or CD8+ T cells may be detected in a variety of ways. Methods for detecting specific T cell activation include detecting the proliferation of T cells, the production of cytokines, or the generation of cytolytic activity (i.e., generation of cytotoxic T cells specific for an antigen). For CD4+ T cells, an often utilized method for detecting specific T cell activation is the detection of the proliferation of T cells. For CD8+ T cells, and an often utilized method for detecting specific T cell activation is the detection of the generation of cytolytic activity.
Detection of the proliferation of T cells may be accomplished by a variety of known techniques. For example, T cell proliferation can be detected by measuring the rate of DNA synthesis. T cells which have been stimulated to proliferate exhibit an increased rate of DNA synthesis. A typical way to measure the rate of DNA synthesis is, for example, by pulse-labeling cultures of T cells with tritiated thymidine, a nucleoside precursor which is incorporated into newly synthesized DNA. The amount of tritiated thymidine incorporated can be determined using a liquid scintillation spectrophotometer. Other ways to detect T cell proliferation include measuring increases in interleukin-2 (IL-2) production, Ca2+ flux, or dye uptake, such as 3-(4,5-dimethylthiazol-2-yl- )-2,5-diphenyltetrazolium. Alternatively, synthesis of lymphokines (e.g., interferon-gamma (IFN-. gamma.)) can be measured or the relative number of T cells that can respond to the antigen may be quantified.
Secretion of IL-2 or IFN-. gamma, can be measured by a variety of known techniques, including, but not limited to, the double monoclonal antibody sandwich immunoassay technique of David et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 4,376,110); monoclonal-polyclonal antibody sandwich assays (Wide et al., in Kirkham and Hunter, eds., Radioimmunoassay Methods, E. and S. Livingstone, Edinburgh (1970)); the "western blot" method of Gordon et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 4,452,901); immunoprecipitation of labeled ligand (Brown et al., J. Biol. Chem. 255:4980-4983 (1980)); radioimmunoassays (RIA); enzyme-linked immunosorbent assays (ELISA) as described, for example, by Raines et al., J. Biol. Chem. 257:5154-5160 (1982); immunocytochemical techniques, including the use of fluorochromes (Brooks et al., Clin. Exp. Immunol. 39:477 (1980)); and neutralization of activity (Bowen-Pope et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 81 :2396- 2400 (1984)). In addition to the immunoassays described above, a number of other immunoassays are available, including those described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,817,827; 3,850,752; 3,901,654; 3,935,074; 3,984,533; 3,996,345; 4,034,074; and 4,098,876.
CTLs that are produced ex vivo can be expanded by regular stimulation with APCs, which can be DCs or "non-professional" APCs that are modified (e.g., with MHC molecules, B7 and the like) to act as APCs. An advantage of artificial APCs is that they can be expanded to appropriate numbers as the T cell populations expand. Mature DCs are terminally differentiated and are utilized for initial T cell activation in certain embodiments. Expanded CTLs can be reinfused into patients by adoptive T cell therapy against virally infected cells or oncogene-transformed cells in certain embodiments and are especially useful for targeting comparatively weak antigens, (e.g., Dudley and Rosenberg, Nature Reviews 2: 666-678 (2003) and Savoldo et al., Blood 100(12): 4059-66 (2002)).
Administration and Immunotherapy
APCs can be isolated from a patient, modified with a membrane-associated AKT molecule described herein, cultured and exposed in vitro or ex vivo to an antigen of interest (e.g., isolated peptide epitope or nucleic acid-encoded epitope), and after expansion and/or cryogenic storage are administered back to the patient to stimulate an immune response, including T cell activation (see, e.g., Thurner et al., J. Immunol. Methods 223:1-15 (1999)), in vivo, in some embodiments. In certain embodiments, the modified APCs are utilized to generate a CTL response in vitro, the APCs optionally are separated from the CTLs, and the CTLs (sometimes in combination with the APCs) are administered to the subject in vivo.
In certain embodiments, modified DCs (e.g., obtained as described herein) are exposed ex vivo to an antigen, washed and administered to elicit an immune response or to augment an existing, albeit weak, response. As such, the DCs may constitute a vaccine and/or an immunotherapeutic agent. In addition, antigen presenting cells (APCs), and in particular dendritic cells, can be used as delivery vehicles for administering pharmaceutical compositions and vaccines. In this context, the APCs may, but need not, be genetically modified, e.g., to increase the capacity for presenting the antigen, to improve activation and/or maintenance of the T cell response and/or to be immunologically compatible with the receiver (i.e., matched HLA haplotype). APCs generally may be isolated from any of a variety of biological fluids and organs as described above, and may be autologous, allogeneic, syngeneic or xenogeneic cells.
Modified APCs primed with antigen may be administered by parenteral (e.g., intravenous, subcutaneous, and intramuscular) or other traditional direct routes, such as buccal/sublingual, rectal, oral, nasal, topical, (such as transdermal and ophthalmic), vaginal, pulmonary, intraarterial, intraperitoneal, intraocular, or intranasal routes or directly into a specific tissue, such as the liver, bone marrow, or into the tumor in the case of cancer therapy. Non-parenteral routes are discussed further in U.S. Appln. No. 08/366,788, filed Dec. 3, 1994. Dendritic cells modified ex vivo sometimes are administered in vivo by intradermal or subcutaneous injection, sometimes with 5-10 million cells administered per site. Modified DCs sometimes are administered interdermally or subcutaneously at between one to five sites in a subject. Methods for administering dendritic cells to a patient for eliciting an immune response in the patient are described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,849,589; 5,851,756; 5,994,126; and 6,017,527. CTLs expanded by contact with modified APCs of the invention also may be administered to a subject via similar routes. Administration can be repeated at desired intervals based upon the patient's immune response.
A DC composition can be administered to a subject via a desired route and the subject may be tested for a desired biological response. Such testing may include immunological screening assays e.g., CTL assays, antibody assays. Other molecules may be detected after APCs or CTLs are administered to a subject, such as by assessing whether the amount of a disease-associated biological marker lowers over time. Administration by many of the routes of administration described herein or otherwise known in the art and may be accomplished simply by direct administration using a needle, catheter or related device, at a single time point or at multiple time points. Other routes and methods for administration include non- parenteral routes, such as are disclosed in U.S. Ser. No. 08/366,788, as well as administration via multiple sites, as disclosed in U.S. Ser. No. 08/366,784.
Pharmaceutical compositions described above can be utilized to elicit a "protective immune response" or "therapeutic immune response," which as used herein refer to a CTL and/or a T helper (e.g., "CD4+ T helper) response to an antigen derived from an infectious agent or a tumor antigen, which prevents or at least partially arrests or ameliorates disease symptoms or progression. An immune response may also include an antibody response which has been facilitated by the stimulation of helper T cells.
Pharmaceutical compositions described above can include components other than the modified APCs or CTLs produced from them. For example, pharmaceutical compositions may include the following types of proteins, fragments, peptides or nucleic acids, or nucleotide sequences (within or not within the APC) that encode such molecules: (a) Toll-like receptor (TLR) ligands that can increase DC activation locally, such as monophosphoryl lipid A (TLR4 ligand), imiquimod (TLR7/8 ligand), unmethylated CpG oligonucleotides (TLR9 ligand), and others, and additional activation ligands, such as those found in monocyte-conditioned media "maturation cocktail" also can be included; (b) targeting ligands; (c) one or more apoptosis-inhibiting factors, such as Bcl-2 or Bcl-xL, for example; (d) antisense, ribozyme or siRNA molecules that target apoptosis-inducing molecules (e.g., Bax, Bak, caspases) and/or molecules that block homeostatic feedback (e.g., SOCS-I, c-CBL, CBL-b, SHP-I). APCs also can be administered in conjunction with other therapeutic regimens. In the treatment of a cancer, for example, modified APCs described herein primed with a tumor-associated antigen (e.g., PSMA) can be administered in conjunction (e.g., before, during or after) with an anti-cancer therapeutic, including, but not limited to, radiation treatment (e.g., radioactive implant), chemotherapy or surgery. In the treatment of a virus infection, for example, modified APCs described herein primed with a virus-associated antigen (e.g., HIV antigen(s)) can be administered in conjunction with an antiviral drug (e.g., HIV protease inhibitor). The person of ordinary skill in the art can select other therapies in combination with administration of modified APCs described herein based upon the disease being treated.
A DC modified with a membrane -targeted Akt molecule also may be utilized in combination with one or more other agents. Such agents include, for example, a nucleic acid, a viral particle, an adjuvant and/or another modified DC, in some embodiments. For example, a DC may be may be contacted with a first polynucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane -targeted Akt described herein, and a second polynucleotide sequence that encodes an inducible CD40 molecule. Inducible CD40 molecule embodiments are described, for example, in US publication 20040209836 (published October 21, 2004). The first and second polynucleotide sequences may be in one nucleic acid, in separate nucleic acids, in one viral particle or in separate viral particles. Thus, provided herein is a composition comprising (i) a first polynucleotide sequence that encodes a first chimeric protein comprising an Akt and a membrane- association region, and (ii) a second polynucleotide sequence that encodes a second chimeric protein comprising a membrane-association region, a multimeric ligand binding region and a CD40 cytoplasmic polypeptide region lacking the CD40 extracellular domain. The first and second polynucleotide sequences may be in one nucleic acid, or in separate nucleic acids, in certain embodiments. Also provided herein is a composition comprising the first chimeric protein and the second chimeric protein. The composition may comprise a DC that includes the first and second chimeric protein, in certain embodiments. Such a DC optionally may be contacted with an antigen or fragment thereof or a third polynucleotide sequence encoding the foregoing, and optionally may include an antigen or fragment thereof or a third polynucleotide sequence encoding the foregoing. Also provided are methods for using such polynucleotides, proteins and DCs.
Kits
Kits comprise one or more containers, which contain one or more of the compositions and/or components described herein. A kit comprises one or more of the components in any number of separate containers, packets, tubes, vials, microtiter plates and the like, or the components may be combined in various combinations in such containers. A kit in some embodiments includes a component described herein and provides instructions that direct the user to another component not included in the kit.
A kit can include components described herein in a variety of combinations. A kit may comprise one, two, three, four, five or more components described herein. For example, a kit can include a nucleic acid having a nucleotide sequence that encodes an Akt molecule.
A kit sometimes is utilized in conjunction with a method described herein, and sometimes includes instructions for performing one or more methods described herein and/or a description of one or more compositions described herein. Instructions and/or descriptions may be in printed form and may be included in a kit insert. A kit also may include a written description of an internet location that provides such instructions or descriptions.
Akt related components that may be provided in a kit include one or more adjuvants, one or more antigens or antigen-encoding nucleic acids, one or more types of cells (e.g., for producing a nucleic acid), one or more agents for transferring a nucleic acid to antigen presenting cells or another type of cell, one or more reagents or devices for isolating dendritic cells from a subject, one or more devices for transferring modified dendritic cells to a subject, and one or more agents or devices for assessing the presence or absence of an immune response, for example. A kit may include one or more other components described hereafter.
A component in a kit sometimes is a molecule that specifically interacts with (e.g., binds to) a nucleic acid, protein, polypeptide or peptide described above. The latter class of components sometimes are referred to herein as "specific interaction reagents" or "specific binding reagents." A specific binding reagent sometimes is in association with detectable label described in greater detail hereafter. Examples of specific binding reagents include antibodies and antibody fragments; binding partners; chemical compounds; and antisense, ribozyme and siRNA nucleic acids.
A variety of antibodies and antibody fragments are available to the artisan, and can be generated by the artisan, for use as a specific binding reagent. Antibodies sometimes are IgG, IgM, IgA, IgE, or an isotype thereof (e.g., IgGl, IgG2a, IgG2b or IgG3), sometimes are polyclonal or monoclonal, and sometimes are chimeric, humanized or bispecific versions of such antibodies. Polyclonal and monoclonal antibodies that bind specific antigens are commercially available, and methods for generating such antibodies are known. In general, polyclonal antibodies are produced by injecting an isolated antigen (e.g., an Akt protein or fragment) into a suitable animal (e.g., a goat or rabbit); collecting blood and/or other tissues from the animal containing antibodies specific for the antigen and purifying the antibody. Methods for generating monoclonal antibodies, in general, include injecting an animal with an isolated antigen (e.g., often a mouse or a rat); isolating splenocytes from the animal; fusing the splenocytes with myeloma cells to form hybridomas; isolating the hybridomas and selecting hybridomas that produce monoclonal antibodies which specifically bind the antigen (e.g., Kohler & Milstein, Nature 256:495 497 (1975) and StGroth & Scheidegger, J Immunol Methods 5: 1 21 (1980)).
Methods for generating chimeric and humanized antibodies also are known (see, e.g., U.S. patent No. 5,530,101 (Queen, et al.), U.S. patent No. 5,707,622 (Fung, et al.) and U.S. patent Nos. 5,994,524 and 6,245,894 (Matsushima, et al.)), which generally involve transplanting an antibody variable region from one species (e.g., mouse) into an antibody constant domain of another species (e.g., human). Antigen- binding regions of antibodies (e.g., Fab regions) include a light chain and a heavy chain, and the variable region is composed of regions from the light chain and the heavy chain. Given that the variable region of an antibody is formed from six complementarity-determining regions (CDRs) in the heavy and light chain variable regions, one or more CDRs from one antibody can be substituted (i.e., grafted) with a CDR of another antibody to generate chimeric antibodies. Also, humanized antibodies are generated by introducing amino acid substitutions that render the resulting antibody less immunogenic when administered to humans.
A specific binding reagent sometimes is an antibody fragment, such as a Fab, Fab', F(ab)'2, Dab, Fv or single-chain Fv (ScFv) fragment, and methods for generating antibody fragments are known (see, e.g., U.S. Patent Nos. 6,099,842 and 5,990,296 and PCT/GBOO/04317). In some embodiments, a binding partner in one or more hybrids is a single-chain antibody fragment, which sometimes are constructed by joining a heavy chain variable region with a light chain variable region by a polypeptide linker (e.g., the linker is attached at the C-terminus or N-terminus of each chain) by recombinant molecular biology processes. Such fragments often exhibit specificities and affinities for an antigen similar to the original monoclonal antibodies. Bifunctional antibodies sometimes are constructed by engineering two different binding specificities into a single antibody chain and sometimes are constructed by joining two Fab' regions together, where each Fab' region is from a different antibody (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 6,342,221). Antibody fragments often comprise engineered regions such as CDR-grafted or humanized fragments. In certain embodiments the binding partner is an intact immunoglobulin, and in other embodiments the binding partner is a Fab monomer or a Fab dimer.
The artisan may select and prepare a binding partner of Akt as a specific binding reagent. Multiple binding partners of an Akt protein exist (e.g., CK2, IRAKI, MAP3K8, TNFl 1, MTTL7 (http address www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/entrez/query.fcgi?db=gene&cmd=Retrieve&dopt=full_report&list_uids=207)). The artisan may utilize a fragment of a binding partner that binds to an Akt protein or fragment as a specific binding reagent in specific embodiments. The artisan also may optimize a binding reagent for a specific use or identify new binding reagents using a variety of procedures. For example, binding partners may be identified by lysing cells and analyzing cell lysates by electrophoretic techniques. Alternatively, a two-hybrid assay or three-hybrid assay can be utilized (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,283,317; Zervos et al., Cell 72:223-232 (1993); Madura et al., J. Biol. Chem. 268: 12046-12054 (1993); Bartel et al., Biotechniques 14: 920-924 (1993); Iwabuchi et al., Oncogene 8: 1693-1696 (1993); and Brent WO94/10300). A two- hybrid system is based on the modular nature of most transcription factors, which consist of separable DNA-binding and activation domains. The assay often utilizes two different DNA constructs. In one construct, an Akt nucleic acid (sometimes referred to as the "bait") is fused to a gene encoding the DNA binding domain of a known transcription factor (e.g., GAL-4). In another construct, a DNA sequence from a library of DNA sequences that encodes a potential binding partner (sometimes referred to as the "prey") is fused to a gene that encodes an activation domain of the known transcription factor. Sometimes, an Akt nucleic acid is linked to the activation domain. If the "bait" and the "prey" molecules interact in vivo, the DNA-binding and activation domains of the transcription factor are brought into close proximity. This proximity allows transcription of a reporter gene (e.g., LacZ) which is operably linked to a transcriptional regulatory site responsive to the transcription factor. Expression of the reporter gene can be detected and cell colonies containing the functional transcription factor can be isolated and used to identify the potential binding partner.
The artisan of ordinary skill can select a chemical compound as a specific binding reagent. Compounds can be obtained using any of the numerous approaches in combinatorial library methods known in the art, including: biological libraries; peptoid libraries (libraries of molecules having the functionalities of peptides, but with a novel, non-peptide backbone which are resistant to enzymatic degradation but which nevertheless remain bioactive (see, e.g., Zuckermann et al., J. Med. Chem.37: 2678-85 (1994)); spatially addressable parallel solid phase or solution phase libraries; synthetic library methods requiring deconvolution; "one-bead one-compound" library methods; and synthetic library methods using affinity chromatography selection. Biological library and peptoid library approaches are typically limited to peptide libraries, while the other approaches are applicable to peptide, non-peptide oligomer or small molecule libraries of compounds (Lam, Anticancer Drug Des. 12: 145, (1997)). Examples of methods for synthesizing molecular libraries are described, for example, in DeWitt et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 90: 6909 (1993); Erb et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 91 : 11422 (1994); Zuckermann et al., J. Med. Chem. 37: 2678 (1994); Cho et al., Science 261 : 1303 (1993); Carrell et al., Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. Engl. 33: 2059 (1994); Carell et al., Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. Engl. 33: 2061 (1994); and in Gallop et al., J. Med. Chem. 37: 1233 (1994). Libraries of compounds may be presented in solution (e.g., Houghten, Biotechniques 13: 412-421 (1992)), or on beads (Lam, Nature 354: 82-84 (1991)), chips (Fodor, Nature 364: 555-556 (1993)), bacteria or spores (Ladner, United States Patent No. 5,223,409), plasmids (Cull et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 89: 1865-1869 (1992)) or on phage (Scott and Smith, Science 249: 386-390 (1990); Devlin, Science 249: 404-406 (1990); Cwirla et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 87: 6378-6382 (1990); Felici, J. MoI. Biol. 222: 301-310 (1991); Ladner supra.). A compound often is a small molecule. Small molecules include, but are not limited to, peptides, peptidomimetics (e.g., peptoids), amino acids, amino acid analogs, polynucleotides, polynucleotide analogs, nucleotides, nucleotide analogs, organic or inorganic compounds (i.e., including heteroorganic and organometallic compounds) having a molecular weight less than about 10,000 grams per mole, organic or inorganic compounds having a molecular weight less than about 5,000 grams per mole, organic or inorganic compounds having a molecular weight less than about 1 ,000 grams per mole, organic or inorganic compounds having a molecular weight less than about 500 grams per mole, and salts, esters, and other pharmaceutically acceptable forms of such compounds.
The artisan of ordinary skill can select and prepare a nucleic acid specific binding reagent for use. Nucleic acids may comprise or consist of analog or derivative nucleic acids, such as polyamide nucleic acids (PNA) and others exemplified in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,469,863; 5,536,821; 5,541,306; 5,637,683; 5,637,684; 5,700,922; 5,717,083; 5,719,262; 5,739,308; 5,773,601; 5,886,165; 5,929,226; 5,977,296; 6,140,482; 5,614,622; 5,739,314; 5,955,599; 5,962,674; 6,117,992; WIPO publications WO 00/56746, WO 00/75372 and WO 01/14398, and related publications. An antisense nucleic acid sometimes is designed, prepared and/or utilized by the artisan to inhibit an Akt nucleic acid. An "antisense" nucleic acid refers to a nucleotide sequence complementary to a "sense" nucleic acid encoding an Akt protein or fragment (e.g., complementary to the coding strand of a double-stranded cDNA molecule or complementary to an mRNA sequence). The antisense nucleic acid can be complementary to an entire coding strand, or to a portion thereof or a substantially identical sequence thereof. In another embodiment, the antisense nucleic acid molecule is antisense to a "noncoding region" of the coding strand of a nucleotide sequence.
An antisense nucleic acid can be complementary to the entire coding region of an mRNA encoded by an Akt nucleotide sequence, and often the antisense nucleic acid is an oligonucleotide antisense to only a portion of a coding or noncoding region of the mRNA. For example, the antisense oligonucleotide can be complementary to the region surrounding the translation start site of the mRNA, e.g., between the -10 and +10 regions of the target gene nucleotide sequence of interest. An antisense oligonucleotide can be, for example, about 7, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55, 60, 65, 70, 75, 80, or more nucleotides in length. An antisense nucleic acid can be constructed using chemical synthesis or enzymic ligation reactions using standard procedures. For example, an antisense nucleic acid (e.g., an antisense oligonucleotide) can be chemically synthesized using naturally occurring nucleotides or variously modified nucleotides designed to increase the biological stability of the molecules or to increase the physical stability of the duplex formed between the antisense and sense nucleic acids (e.g., phosphorothioate derivatives and acridine substituted nucleotides can be used). Antisense nucleic acid also can be produced biologically using an expression vector into which a nucleic acid has been subcloned in an antisense orientation (i.e., RNA transcribed from the inserted nucleic acid will be of an antisense orientation to a target nucleic acid of interest, described further in the following subsection).
When utilized in subjects, antisense nucleic acids typically are administered to a subject (e.g., by direct injection at a tissue site) or generated in situ such that they hybridize with or bind to cellular mRNA and/or genomic DNA encoding a polypeptide and thereby inhibit expression of the polypeptide, for example, by inhibiting transcription and/or translation. Alternatively, antisense nucleic acid molecules can be modified to target selected cells and then are administered systemically. For systemic administration, antisense molecules can be modified such that they specifically bind to receptors or antigens expressed on a selected cell surface, for example, by linking antisense nucleic acid molecules to peptides or antibodies which bind to cell surface receptors or antigens. Antisense nucleic acid molecules can also be delivered to cells using the vectors described herein. Sufficient intracellular concentrations of antisense molecules are achieved by incorporating a strong promoter, such as a pol II or pol III promoter, in the vector construct. Antisense nucleic acid molecules sometimes are alpha-anomeric nucleic acid molecules. An alpha-anomeric nucleic acid molecule forms specific double-stranded hybrids with complementary RNA in which, contrary to the usual beta-units, the strands run parallel to each other (Gaultier et al., Nucleic Acids. Res. 15: 6625-6641 (1987)). Antisense nucleic acid molecules also can comprise a 2'-o-methylribonucleotide (Inoue et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 15: 6131-6148 (1987)) or a chimeric RNA-DNA analogue (Inoue et al., FEBS Lett. 215: 327-330 (1987)). Antisense nucleic acids sometimes are composed of DNA or PNA or any other nucleic acid derivatives described previously.
An antisense nucleic acid is a ribozyme in some embodiments. A ribozyme having specificity for an Akt nucleotide sequence can include one or more sequences complementary to such a nucleotide sequence, and a sequence having a known catalytic region responsible for mRNA cleavage (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,093,246 or Haselhoff and Gerlach, Nature 334: 585-591 (1988)). For example, a derivative of a Tetrahymena L- 19 IVS RNA is sometimes utilized in which the nucleotide sequence of the active site is complementary to the nucleotide sequence to be cleaved in a mRNA (e.g., Cech et al. U.S. Patent No. 4,987,071; and Cech et al. U.S. Patent No. 5,116,742). Akt mRNA sequences also may be utilized to select a catalytic RNA having a specific ribonuclease activity from a pool of RNA molecules (e.g., Bartel & Szostak, Science 261 : 1411-1418 (1993)).
Specific binding reagents sometimes are nucleic acids that can form triple helix structures with an Akt nucleic acid. Akt expression can be inhibited by targeting nucleotide sequences complementary to the regulatory region of a nucleotide sequence referenced herein or a substantially identical sequence (e.g., promoter and/or enhancers) to form triple helical structures that prevent transcription of a gene in target cells (see e.g., Helene, Anticancer Drug Des. 6(6): 569-84 (1991); Helene et al., Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci. 660: 27-36 (1992); and Maher, Bioassays 14(12): 807-15 (1992). Triple helix formation can be enhanced by generating a "switchback" nucleic acid molecule. Switchback molecules are synthesized in an alternating 5'-3', 3'-5' manner, such that they base pair with first one strand of a duplex and then the other, eliminating the necessity for a sizeable stretch of purines or pyrimidines being present on one strand of a duplex.
An artisan may select an interfering RNA (RNAi) or siRNA specific binding reagent for use. The nucleic acid selected sometimes is the RNAi or siRNA or a nucleic acid that encodes such products. The term "RNAi" as used herein refers to double-stranded RNA (dsRNA) which mediates degradation of specific mRNAs, and can also be used to lower or eliminate gene expression. The term "short interfering nucleic acid", "siNA", "short interfering RNA", "siRNA", "short interfering nucleic acid molecule", "short interfering oligonucleotide molecule", or "chemically-modified short interfering nucleic acid molecule" as used herein refers to any nucleic acid molecule directed against a gene. For example, a siRNA is capable of inhibiting or down regulating gene expression or viral replication, for example by mediating RNA interference "RNAi" or gene silencing in a sequence- specific manner; see for example Zamore et al., 2000, Cell, 101, 25-33; Bass, 2001, Nature, 411, 428-429; Elbashir et al., 2001, Nature, 411, 494-498; and Kreutzer et al., International PCT Publication No. WO 00/44895; Zernicka-Goetz et al., International PCT Publication No. WO 01/36646; Fire, International PCT Publication No. WO 99/32619; Plaetinck et al., International PCT Publication No. WO 00/01846; Mello and Fire, International PCT Publication No. WO 01/29058; Deschamps-Depaillette, International PCT Publication No. WO 99/07409; and Li et al., International PCT Publication No. WO 00/44914; Allshire, 2002, Science, 297, 1818-1819; Volpe et al., 2002, Science, 297, 1833-1837; Jenuwein, 2002, Science, 297, 2215-2218; and Hall et al., 2002, Science, 297, 2232-2237; Hutvagner and Zamore, 2002, Science, 297, 2056-60; McManus et al., 2002, RNA, 8, 842-850; Reinhart et al., 2002, Gene & Dev., 16, 1616-1626; and Reinhart & Bartel, 2002, Science, 297, 1831). There is no particular limitation in the length of siRNA as long as it does not show toxicity. Examples of modified RNAi and siRNA include STEALTH™ forms (Invitrogen Corp., Carlsbad, CA), forms described in U.S. Patent Publication No. 2004/0014956 (appl. no. 10/357,529) and U.S. Patent Application No. 11/049,636, filed February 2, 2005), and other forms described hereafter.
A siNA can be a double-stranded polynucleotide molecule comprising self-complementary sense and antisense regions, wherein the antisense region comprises nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence in a target nucleic acid molecule or a portion thereof and the sense region having nucleotide sequence corresponding to the target nucleic acid sequence or a portion thereof. The siNA can be assembled from two separate oligonucleotides, where one strand is the sense strand and the other is the antisense strand, wherein the antisense and sense strands are self-complementary (i.e. each strand comprises nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence in the other strand; such as where the antisense strand and sense strand form a duplex or double stranded structure, for example wherein the double stranded region is about 19 base pairs); the antisense strand comprises nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence in a target nucleic acid molecule or a portion thereof and the sense strand comprises nucleotide sequence corresponding to the target nucleic acid sequence or a portion thereof. Alternatively, the siNA is assembled from a single oligonucleotide, where the self- complementary sense and antisense regions of the siNA are linked by means of a nucleic acid based or non-nucleic acid-based linker(s). The siNA can be a polynucleotide with a duplex, asymmetric duplex, hairpin or asymmetric hairpin secondary structure, having self-complementary sense and antisense regions, wherein the antisense region comprises nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence in a separate target nucleic acid molecule or a portion thereof and the sense region having nucleotide sequence corresponding to the target nucleic acid sequence or a portion thereof. The siNA can be a circular single-stranded polynucleotide having two or more loop structures and a stem comprising self-complementary sense and antisense regions, wherein the antisense region comprises nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence in a target nucleic acid molecule or a portion thereof and the sense region having nucleotide sequence corresponding to the target nucleic acid sequence or a portion thereof, and wherein the circular polynucleotide can be processed either in vivo or in vitro to generate an active siNA molecule capable of mediating RNAi. The siNA can also comprise a single stranded polynucleotide having nucleotide sequence complementary to nucleotide sequence in a target nucleic acid molecule or a portion thereof (for example, where such siNA molecule does not require the presence within the siNA molecule of nucleotide sequence corresponding to the target nucleic acid sequence or a portion thereof), wherein the single stranded polynucleotide can further comprise a terminal phosphate group, such as a 5'-phosphate (see for example Martinez et al., 2002, Cell., 110, 563-574 and Schwarz et al., 2002, Molecular Cell, 10, 537-568), or 5',3'-diphosphate. In certain embodiments, the siNA molecule of the invention comprises separate sense and antisense sequences or regions, wherein the sense and antisense regions are covalently linked by nucleotide or non-nucleotide linkers molecules as is known in the art, or are alternately non-covalently linked by ionic interactions, hydrogen bonding, van der waals interactions, hydrophobic interactions, and/or stacking interactions. In certain embodiments, the siNA molecules of the invention comprise nucleotide sequence that is complementary to nucleotide sequence of a target gene. In another embodiment, the siNA molecule of the invention interacts with nucleotide sequence of a target gene in a manner that causes inhibition of expression of the target gene.
The double-stranded RNA portions of siRNAs in which two RNA strands pair are not limited to the completely paired forms, and may contain non-pairing portions due to mismatch (the corresponding nucleotides are not complementary), bulge (lacking in the corresponding complementary nucleotide on one strand), and the like. Non-pairing portions can be contained to the extent that they do not interfere with siRNA formation. The "bulge" used herein often comprises 1 to 2 non-pairing nucleotides, and the double-stranded RNA region of siRNAs in which two RNA strands pair up sometimes contains 1 to 7, and at times 1 to 5 bulges. In addition, the "mismatch" used herein is contained in the double-stranded RNA region of siRNAs in which two RNA strands pair up, sometimes 1 to 7, and at times 1 to 5, in number. In an often utilized mismatch, one of the nucleotides is guanine, and the other is uracil. Such a mismatch is due to a mutation from C to T, G to A, or mixtures thereof in DNA coding for sense RNA, but not particularly limited to them. Furthermore, in the present invention, the double-stranded RNA region of siRNAs in which two RNA strands pair up may contain both bulge and mismatched, which sum up to, sometimes 1 to 7, and at times 1 to 5, in number. The terminal structure of siRNA may be either blunt or cohesive (overhanging) as long as siRNA enables to silence the target gene expression due to its RNAi effect.
As used herein, siRNA molecules need not be limited to those molecules containing only RNA, but further encompasses chemically-modified nucleotides and non-nucleotides. In addition, as used herein, the term RNAi is meant to be equivalent to other terms used to describe sequence specific RNA interference, such as post transcriptional gene silencing, translational inhibition, or epigenetics. For example, siRNA molecules of the invention can be used to epigenetically silence genes at both the post- transcriptional level or the pre-transcriptional level. In a non-limiting example, epigenetic regulation of gene expression by siRNA molecules of the invention can result from siRNA mediated modification of chromatin structure to alter gene expression (see, for example, Verdel et al., 2004, Science, 303, 672-676; Pal-Bhadra et al., 2004, Science, 303, 669-672; Allshire, 2002, Science, 297, 1818-1819; Volpe et al., 2002, Science, 297, 1833-1837; Jenuwein, 2002, Science, 297, 2215-2218; and Hall et al., 2002, Science, 297, 2232-2237).
RNAi may be designed by those methods known to those of ordinary skill in the art. In one example, siRNA may be designed by classifying RNAi sequences, for example 1000 sequences, based on functionality, with a functional group being classified as having greater than 85% knockdown activity and a non- functional group with less than 85% knockdown activity. The distribution of base composition was calculated for entire the entire RNAi target sequence for both the functional group and the non- functional group. The ratio of base distribution of functional and non- functional group may then be used to build a score matrix for each position of RNAi sequence. For a given target sequence, the base for each position is scored, and then the log ratio of the multiplication of all the positions is taken as a final score. Using this score system, a very strong correlation may be found of the functional knockdown activity and the log ratio score. Once the target sequence is selected, it may be filtered through both fast NCBI blast and slow Smith Waterman algorithm search against the Unigene database to identify the gene-specific RNAi or siRNA. Sequences with at least one mismatch in the last 12 bases may be selected.
Nucleic acid reagents include those which are engineered, for example, to produce dsRNAs. Examples of such nucleic acid molecules include those with a sequence that, when transcribed, folds back upon itself to generate a hairpin molecule containing a double-stranded portion. One strand of the double- stranded portion may correspond to all or a portion of the sense strand of the mRNA transcribed from the gene to be silenced while the other strand of the double-stranded portion may correspond to all or a portion of the antisense strand. Other methods of producing dsRNAs may be used, for example, nucleic acid molecules may be engineered to have a first sequence that, when transcribed, corresponds to all or a portion of the sense strand of the mRNA transcribed from the gene to be silenced and a second sequence that, when transcribed, corresponds to all or portion of an antisense strand (i.e., the reverse complement) of the mRNA transcribed from the gene to be silenced.
Nucleic acid molecules which mediate RNAi may also be produced ex vivo, for example, by oligonucleotide synthesis. Oligonucleotide synthesis may be used for example, to design dsRNA molecules, as well as other nucleic acid molecules (e.g., other nucleic acid molecules which mediate RNAi) with one or more chemical modification (e.g., chemical modifications not commonly found in nucleic acid molecules such as the inclusion of 2'-O-methyl, 2'-0-ethyl, 2'-O-propyl, 2'-fluoro, etc. groups).
In some embodiments, a dsRNA to be used to silence a gene may have one or more (e.g., one, two, three, four, five, six, etc.) regions of sequence homology or identity to a gene to be silenced. Regions of homology or identity may be from about 20 bp (base pairs) to about 5 kbp (kilo base pairs) in length, 20 bp to about 4 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 3 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 2.5 kbp in length, from about 20 bp to about 2 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 1.5 kbp in length, from about 20 bp to about 1 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 750 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 500 bp in length, 20 bp to about 400 bp in length, 20 bp to about 300 bp in length, 20 bp to about 250 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 200 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 150 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 100 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 90 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 80 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 70 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 60 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 50 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 40 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 30 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 25 bp in length, from about 15 bp to about 25 bp in length, from about 17 bp to about 25 bp in length, from about 19 bp to about 25 bp in length, from about 19 bp to about 23 bp in length, or from about 19 bp to about 21 bp in length.
A hairpin containing molecule having a double-stranded region may be used as RNAi. The length of the double stranded region may be from about 20 bp (base pairs) to about 2.5 kbp (kilo base pairs) in length, from about 20 bp to about 2 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 1.5 kbp in length, from about 20 bp to about 1 kbp in length, 20 bp to about 750 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 500 bp in length, 20 bp to about 400 bp in length, 20 bp to about 300 bp in length, 20 bp to about 250 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 200 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 150 bp in length, from about 20 bp to about 100 bp in length, 20 bp to about 90 bp in length, 20 bp to about 80 bp in length, 20 bp to about 70 bp in length, 20 bp to about 60 bp in length, 20 bp to about 50 bp in length, 20 bp to about 40 bp in length, 20 bp to about 30 bp in length, or from about 20 bp to about 25 bp in length. The non-base-paired portion of the hairpin (i.e., loop) can be of any length that permits the two regions of homology that make up the double- stranded portion of the hairpin to fold back upon one another.
Any suitable promoter may be used to control the production of RNA from the nucleic acid reagent, such as a promoter described above. Promoters may be those recognized by any polymerase enzyme. For example, promoters may be promoters for RNA polymerase II or RNA polymerase III (e.g., a U6 promoter, an Hl promoter, etc.). Other suitable promoters include, but are not limited to, T7 promoter, cytomegalovirus (CMV) promoter, mouse mammary tumor virus (MMTV) promoter, metalothionine, RSV (Rous sarcoma virus) long terminal repeat, SV40 promoter, human growth hormone (hGH) promoter. Other suitable promoters are known to those skilled in the art and are within the scope of the present invention.
Double-stranded RNAs used in the practice of the invention may vary greatly in size. Further the size of the dsRNAs used will often depend on the cell type contacted with the dsRNA. As an example, animal cells such as those of C. elegans and Drosophila melanogaster do not generally undergo apoptosis when contacted with dsRNAs greater than about 30 nucleotides in length (i.e., 30 nucleotides of double stranded region) while mammalian cells typically do undergo apoptosis when exposed to such dsRNAs. Thus, the design of the particular experiment will often determine the size of dsRNAs employed.
In many instances, the double stranded region of dsRNAs contained within or encoded by nucleic acid molecules used in the practice of the invention will be within the following ranges: from about 20 to about 30 nucleotides, from about 20 to about 40 nucleotides, from about 20 to about 50 nucleotides, from about 20 to about 100 nucleotides, from about 22 to about 30 nucleotides, from about 22 to about 40 nucleotides, from about 20 to about 28 nucleotides, from about 22 to about 28 nucleotides, from about 25 to about 30 nucleotides, from about 25 to about 28 nucleotides, from about 30 to about 100 nucleotides, from about 30 to about 200 nucleotides, from about 30 to about 1,000 nucleotides, from about 30 to about 2,000 nucleotides, from about 50 to about 100 nucleotides, from about 50 to about 1,000 nucleotides, or from about 50 to about 2,000 nucleotides. The ranges above refer to the number of nucleotides present in double stranded regions. Thus, these ranges do not reflect the total length of the dsRNAs themselves. As an example, a blunt ended dsRNA formed from a single transcript of 50 nucleotides in total length with a 6 nucleotide loop, will have a double stranded region of 23 nucleotides.
As suggested above, dsRNAs used in the practice of the invention may be blunt ended, may have one blunt end, or may have overhangs on both ends. Further, when one or more overhang is present, the overhang(s) may be on the 3' and/or 5' strands at one or both ends. Additionally, these overhangs may independently be of any length (e.g., one, two, three, four, five, etc. nucleotides). As an example, STEALTH™ RNAi is blunt at both ends. Also included are sets of RNAi and those which generate RNAi. Such sets include those which either (1) are designed to produce or (2) contain more than one dsRNA directed against the same target gene. As an example, the invention includes sets of STEALTH™ RNAi wherein more than one STEALTH™ RNAi shares sequence homology or identity to different regions of the same target gene. A protein, fragment or nucleic acid described herein sometimes is in association with detectable label. The detectable label can be covalently linked to the reagent, and sometimes is in association with the reagent in a non-covalent linkage. Methods for attaching such binding pairs to reagents and effecting binding are known to the artisan. Any detectable label suitable for detection of an interaction or biological activity in a system can be appropriately selected and utilized by the artisan. Examples of detectable labels are fluorescent labels such as fluorescein, rhodamine, and others (e.g., Anantha, et al., Biochemistry (1998) 37:2709 2714; and Qu & Chaires, Methods Enzymol. (2000) 321 :353 369); radioactive isotopes (e.g., 1251, 1311, 35S, 31P, 32P, 14C, 3H, 7Be, 28Mg, 57Co, 65Zn, 67Cu, 68Ge, 82Sr, 83Rb, 95Tc, 96Tc, 103Pd, 109Cd, and 127Xe); light scattering labels (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 6,214,560, and commercially available from Genicon Sciences Corporation, CA); chemiluminescent labels and enzyme substrates (e.g., dioxetanes and acridinium esters), enzymic or protein labels (e.g., green fluorescence protein (GFP) or color variant thereof, luciferase, peroxidase); other chromogenic labels or dyes (e.g., cyanine), and labels described previously. Use of reagents in association with a detectable label are described in greater detail hereafter.
Cells also may be provided in a kit. A cell may over-express or under-express protein, fragment or nucleic acid or other molecule described herein. A cell can be processed in a variety of manners. For example, an artisan may prepare a lysate from a cell and optionally isolate or purify components, may transfect the cell with a nucleic acid reagent, may fix a cell reagent to a slide for analysis (e.g., microscopic analysis) and can immobilize a cell to a solid phase.
A cell that "over-expresses" an protein or fragment or nucleic acid described herein produces at least two, three, four or five times or more of the product as compared to a native cell from an organism that has not been genetically modified and/or exhibits no apparent symptom of a cell-proliferative disorder. Over-expressing cells may be stably transfected or transiently transfected with a nucleic acid a protein or fragment or nucleic acid described herein. A cell that "under-expresses" a protein or fragment or nucleic acid described herein produces at least five times less of the product as compared to a native cell from an organism that has not been genetically modified and/or exhibits no apparent symptom of a cell- proliferative disorder. In some embodiments, a cell that under-expresses a protein, fragment or nucleic acid contains no nucleic acid that can encode such a product (e.g., the cell is from a knock-out mouse) and no detectable amount of the product is produced. Methods for generating knock-out animals and using associated cells are known (e.g., Miller et al., J. Cell. Biol. 165: 407-419 (2004)). A cell that under- expresses a protein, fragment or nucleic acid described herein, for example, sometimes is in contact with a nucleic acid inhibitor that blocks or reduces the amount of the product produced by the cell in the absence of the inhibitor.
Cells include, but are not limited to, bacterial cells (e.g., Escherichia spp. cells (e.g., Expressway™ HTP Cell-Free E. coli Expression Kit, Invitrogen, California) such as DHlOB, Stbl2, DH5-alpha, DB3, DB3.1 for example), DB4, DB5, JDP682 and ccdA-over (e.g., U.S. Application No. 09/518,188), Bacillus spp. cells (e.g., B. subtilis and B. megaterium cells), Streptomyces spp. cells, Erwinia spp. cells, Klebsiella spp. cells, Serratia spp. cells (particularly S. marcessans cells), Pseudomonas spp. cells (particularly P. aeruginosa cells), and Salmonella spp. cells (particularly S. typhimurium and S. typhi cells); photosynthetic bacteria (e.g., green non-sulfur bacteria (e.g., Choroflexus spp. (e.g., C. aurantiacus), Chloronema spp. (e.g., C. gigateum)), green sulfur bacteria (e.g., Chlorobium spp. (e.g., C. limicola), Pelodictyon spp. (e.g., P. luteolum), purple sulfur bacteria (e.g., Chromatium spp. (e.g., C. okenii)), and purple non-sulfur bacteria (e.g., Rhodospirillum spp. (e.g., R. rubrum), Rhodobacter spp. (e.g., R. sphaeroides, R. capsulatus), Rhodomicrobium spp. (e.g., R. vanellii)); yeast cells (e.g., Saccharomyces cerevisiae cells and Pichia pastoris cells); insect cells (e.g., Drosophila (e.g., Drosophila melanogaster), Spodoptera (e.g., Spodoptera frugiperda Sf9 and Sf21 cells) and Trichoplusa (e.g., High- Five cells); nematode cells (e.g., C. elegans cells); avian cells; amphibian cells (e.g., Xenopus laevis cells); reptilian cells; and mammalian cells (e.g., NIH3T3, 293, CHO, COS, VERO, C127, BHK, Per-C6, Bowes melanoma and HeLa cells). These and other suitable cells are available commercially, for example, from Invitrogen Corporation, (Carlsbad, CA), American Type Culture Collection (Manassas, Virginia), and Agricultural Research Culture Collection (NRRL; Peoria, Illinois).
Examples
The examples set forth below illustrate but do not limit the invention. The maturation state and lifespan of dendritic cells (DCs) are critical for the regulation of immunity. However, current DC preparations based on ex vivo treatment with differentiation and maturation factors can lead to transiently active DCs that may curtail T cell responses following re-infusion. Here, it is shown that Aktl levels drop rapidly following growth factor withdrawal and are critical for pro-inflammatory signal-mediated DC survival and maturation. Conversely, LPS or CD40 signaling stabilizes Aktl and promotes both DC activation and survival. Also, it is shown that Aktl -mediated survival depends on Bcl-2, but not BcI- xL. Adenoviral-mediated overexpression of a novel, lipid-raft targeted Akt allele, MF-ΔAkt, is sufficient for murine bone marrow-derived DC maturation and survival, resulting in enhanced T cell proliferation and activation, and eradication of large pre-established thymoma as well as B 16 melanoma. In addition, transduction of human DCs with an adenovirus expressing human Aktl, MF-ΔhAkt, also significantly improves DC survival, antigen-specific T cell proliferation and CD8+ T cell responses. These data demonstrate that Aktl is a critical regulator of DC lifespan and can significantly improve the efficacy of DC-based tumor vaccines. Results presented herein also is presented in Park et al., Nat Biotechnol. 2006 Dec 24(12):1581-90.
Example 1
Rapid down-regulation of Akt following cytokine withdrawal is prevented by signals of innate and acquired immune responses
To investigate pathways involved in DC survival following inflammatory stimuli, signaling proteins induced by LPS that have been previously implicated in cell survival were assessed. In addition to the NF-kappaB pathway, a variety of signaling molecules, such as MAPK30, JAK31, PI3K24 and Src family kinases32, are activated by LPS treatment of DCs and macrophages. Therefore, LPS-treated bone marrow-derived DCs (BMDCs) were incubated with effective concentrations of specific inhibitors for 48 hr to substantially block these proteins. Treatment with PI3K and Src kinase inhibitors significantly antagonized LPS-mediated survival, whereas JAK and MAPK inhibitors had almost no effect (Fig. IA).
To further study the role of PI3K in DC survival, kinetics of Akt expression, a key down-stream effector of PI3K signaling were determined, during GM-CSF deprivation-mediated DC death. Within 24 hours of GM-CSF deprivation, prior to DC death, total Akt protein levels were rapidly down regulated. In addition down-regulation of Akt closely correlated with decreases in the protein level of Bcl-2, known to be down-regulated during DC maturation (Fig. IB). To test whether innate and adaptive immune response-triggering molecules modulate Akt protein level, leading to DC survival, it first was confirmed that anti-CD40 mAb and LPS both protect DCs against GM-CSF deprivation-mediated death (Fig. 1C). While GM-CSF deprivation consistently down-regulated Akt protein levels, LPS or anti-CD40 treatment prevented this down-regulation of Akt. Like previous reports, it was determined that minimal manipulation of DCs, such as re-plating, contributed to DC activation, reflected by DC maturation markers (data not shown) and the increase in Akt phosphorylation at day 2 after GM-CSF withdrawal. By contrast, LPS and CD40 signals induced high Akt phosphorylation and protein levels on day 4, suggesting that LPS and CD40 stimulation regulate not only the phosphorylation state but also the steady-state protein level of Akt, thereby promoting DC survival (Fig. ID).
To further test the hypothesis that PI3K and Akt are common regulators for immune response- mediated DC survival, we evaluated effects of various concentrations (0.05 μM - 5 μM) of another PI3K inhibitor, wortmannin, on DCs treated with LPS or anti-CD40. Even low wortmannin concentrations (0.05 - 0.5 μM), having little effect on other cell types (data not shown), led to death of both LPS- and anti- CD40-treated DCs, implicating an essential role for PI3K for DC survival (Fig. IE). Anti-apoptotic molecules Bcl-x and Bcl-2 are essential in preventing DC death and are purportedly differentially regulated during innate and acquired immune responses 12. Therefore, Bcl-2 and Bcl-xL protein levels were determined in wortmannin-treated DCs pre-exposed to LPS or anti-CD40. Consistent with previous findings, GM-CSF deprivation down-regulated Bcl-xL as well as Bcl-2, but LPS and anti-CD40 treatment reversed this effect. In the presence of wortmannin with LPS or anti-CD40, only Bcl-2 protein was rapidly down regulated, whereas protein levels of Bcl-xL were stable for at least 3 days (Fig. IF). By contrast, LPS and anti-CD40-induced Bcl-xL did not prevent DC death triggered by PI3K inhibition, suggesting that Akt and Bcl-2 were critical effectors of PI3K-dependent DC survival, and Bcl-xL was regulated independently.
A description of Figures IA to IF follows. Figure IA shows PI3K and Src kinase are involved in LPS-mediated DC survival. Bone marrow-derived CDl lc+ DCs were incubated for 16 hr with LPS (1 μg/ml) along with the indicated concentrations (μM) of PI3K inhibitor Ly294002, JAK inhibitor AG490, MAPK inhibitor PD98059 or Src kinase inhibitor PP2. Cell viability was assessed 2 days later using propidium iodide (PI) staining. Figure IB shows down-regulation of Akt and Bcl-2 following GM-CSF withdrawal. Total Akt and Bcl-2 protein levels of BMDCs were determined after incubation for 1 -4 days without GM-CSF. Figure 1C shows following GM-CSF withdrawal, BMDCs were treated for 16 hr with 1 μg/ml of LPS (•), 10 μg/ml of anti-CD40 antibody (A) or neither (■) before incubation for indicated times, and cell viability was assessed by PI staining. Figure ID shows LPS and anti-CD40 prevent the down-regulation in BMDCs of phospho-Akt and total Akt, as determined by Western blotting using anti- pAkt-S473 and anti-Akt Abs, respectively. Figure IE shows PI3K is essential for both LPS and anti- CD40-mediated DC survival. DC viability was assessed by PI staining at indicated time points after LPS or alpha-CD40 treatment along with 0 (■), 0.05 (•), 0.5 (O) or 5 (D) μM wortmannin. Figure IF shows down-regulation of Akt correlates with Bcl-2, but not Bcl-xL, expression levels. Protein levels were determined by Western blotting at indicated time points. The amount of loaded proteins was normalized to actin. All data represent two (Figures IB, ID and IF) or three (Figures IA, 1C and IE) independent experiments with similar results. Error bars represent S. D. of duplicate measurements (Figures IA and IE).
Example 2 Activation and maintenance of DC survival requires Aktl
Despite an essential role for PI3K in DC survival and the commonly pivotal position of Akt in PI3K signaling, it was also possible that the observed Akt down-regulation following GM-CSF withdrawal was a secondary outcome of DC death. Therefore, to directly evaluate the role of Akt, it was determined whether endogenous Akt activity was essential for LPS or CD40-mediated DC survival. First, expression pattern of Akt subtypes was assessed in DCs. Of the two Akt isoforms commonly found in hematopoietic cells, Aktl was identified as the predominant isoform in BMDCs (Fig. 2A). Based on these results, LPS or CD40-mediated survival of DCs was tested from Aktl+/+ and Aktl-/- mice. Although the total protein level of Akt is much less in Aktl -deficient BMDCs (Fig. 2B), Aktl-/- DCs showed comparable numbers and viability relative to Aktl+/+ DCs after BMDC isolation (data not shown). However, GM-CSF withdrawal for 48 hr reduced the survival of Aktl-/- DCs relative to Aktl+/+ DCs. In addition, the protective effect of LPS and CD40 was completely abolished in Aktl-/- DCs, indicating that innate (LPS) and acquired (CD40) immune response-related DC survival requires Aktl (Fig. 2C).
To further confirm the role of Aktl in LPS-mediated DC survival from cytokine deprivation, growth factor-starved BMDCs were treated with moderate concentrations (5 μM) of Akt specific inhibitor Akt-I (IC50 = 5 μM) along with LPS for 16 hr, followed by incubation for an additional 48 hr in GM- CSF-free DC medium. Consistently, Akt-I significantly reduced LPS-mediated DC survival (Fig. 9C). Moreover, transfection of Akt-RNAi (100 nM), a synthetic Aktl-specific siRNA36, into BMDCs suppressed Akt expression and significantly (P<0.005) increased DC death even in the presence of LPS compared with control RNAi (Fig. 9A, 9B). Therefore, it was determined Aktl is a critical mediator of DC survival signals, and down-regulation of Aktl is a major regulatory mechanism to control DC longevity.
In addition to promoting DC survival, Akt can induce NF-kappaB activity through IKKbeta phosphorylation, critical for DC activation and maturation. However, the role of Akt in DC differentiation from bone marrow precursors has not been tested. Therefore, to investigate the effects of Akt 1 on DC differentiation and activation, surface expression of several MHC and costimulatory molecules was assessed in Aktl+/+ and Aktl-/- BMDCs, including CD40, CD 80, MHC class I Kb and MHC class II I- Ab. Although there was no difference in viability, the surface expression of lineage markers, CDl Ib and CDl Ic, and several MHC and costimulatory molecules on day 0 and 2 after DC differentiation, Aktl-/- BMDCs showed significantly reduced expression of maturation markers, CD40 (P<0.01), CD80 (P<0.005) and MHC class I Kb (PO.01), relative to Aktl+/+ DCs on day 6 (Fig. 2D, Fig. 9). In addition, Aktl-/- BMDCs revealed a large defect in the further enhancement of maturation markers, such as CD40 and MHC class I Kb (Fig. 2F), as well as CD80 and MHC class II I- Ab (data not shown), even after LPS and CD40 stimulation, suggesting that Aktl plays a critical role in DC differentiation and activation.
To further investigate the physiological effects of Aktl deficiency in DCs, size and cellularity of lymph nodes and spleen were examined in Aktl-/- and Aktl+/+ mice. Although the relative distribution of T cell, B cell and CDl lc+ cells was normal with only a partial decrease of CD8+ T cells (data not shown), the total cell number of inguinal lymph nodes and spleen was dramatically reduced (86% and 43%, respectively) in Aktl-/- mice when compared to Aktl+/+ littermates (Fig. 2E, Fig. 11), supporting the tenet that reduced survival and activation defects in Aktl-/- DCs results in reduction of size, cellularity and likely functions of secondary lymphoid organs.
A description of Figures 2A-2F follows. Figure 2A shows analysis of Akt isoforms in BMDCs. BMDC (DC) or control (A431) cell lysates were immunob lotted with specific antibodies against Aktl and Akt2. Protein level of total Akt was determined by reprobing with anti-Akt Ab. Figure 2B shows analysis of Aktl and total Akt protein level in Aktl-/- DCs. Cell lysates from Aktl+/+ or Aktl-/- BMDCs were immunoblotted with antibodies against Aktl or total Akt. Protein loading was normalized by actin immunoblotting. Figure 1C shows comparison of LPS- or anti-CD40-mediated survival in Aktl+/+ or Akt-/- DCs. BMDCs from Aktl+/+ or Aktl-/- mice were untreated (open bars) or treated with LPS (1 μg/ml, gray bars) or anti-CD40 (10 μg/ml, filled bars) and further incubated in the presence of wortmannin (0.5 μM) for 48 hrs. Background % PI+ at day 0 was subtracted from each data point. Figure 2D shows expression of surface markers in Aktl+/+ or Aktl-/- DCs. On day 6 after DC differentiation, surface expression of MHC and costimulatory molecules in Aktl+/+ or Aktl-/- BMDCs was assessed by CD40, CD80, MHC class I Kb and MHC class II I-Ab staining along with CDl Ic. MFI, is mean fluorescence intensity. Figure 2E shows a comparison of lymph nodes from Aktl+/+ or Akt-/- mice. Size of inguinal lymph nodes isolated from Aktl+/+ or Aktl-/- littermates was measured (bottom scale bar, 1 mm gap) and trypan blue staining assessed total cell numbers within each lymph node. Figure 2F shows reduced maturation of Aktl-/- DCs. After 6 days of BMDC differentiation, BMDCs in the starting wells were further treated with indicated stimuli as above in Figure 2C for 48 hr. DC maturation was assessed by CD40 and MHC class I Kb staining. Numbers indicate percentage of cells in that quadrant. Data represent two (Figures 2B and 2F), three (Figures 2C and 2D) or six (Figure 2E) independent experiments. Error bars indicate mean ± S.D. of results derived from three (Figures 2D and 2E) independent littermates. *, PO.01, **, PO.005, ♦, PO.0005.
Example 3 Aktl is sufficient for activation and maintenance of LPS-mediated DC survival
To further study the molecular mechanism of Akt in PI3K- and Src kinase-mediated DC survival, we initially utilized a previously described constitutively active Akt (M-Akt) allele, consisting of full length Akt, targeted to intracellular membranes with a myristoylation-targeting sequence from c-Src. However, because dual acylation, such as palmitoylation and myristoylation, is important for lipid raft localization of Src family kinases, c-Src, which is only myristoylated, may be excluded from lipid rafts (Fig. 12A). Therefore, to test the possibility that efficient lipid raft localization of Akt improves its function, this construct was compared to several distinct Akt constructs, containing myristoylation-targeting sequences from Src family kinases Src, Fyn and Lck fused to a truncated (denoted "Δ") Akt (Fig. 3A). The pleckstrin homology (PH) domain (residues 1-102) was removed to improve Akt activity, important when PI3K activity is low. Among the three membrane-targeting sequences, the Fyn myristoylation-targeting sequence (MF) showed the most efficient lipid raft localization, 2-3 -fold NF-kappaB induction, about a 6- fold-increased Akt-S473 and GSK3 phosphorylation, and enhanced viability of transfected Jurkat cells following treatment with PI3K inhibitors (Fig. 3A and Fig. 12). To further enhance Akt activity, Fyn myristoylated ΔAkt (MF-ΔAkt) was generated, which carried point mutations at both key phosphorylation sites (E308 and D473). However, these mutations failed to further improve reporter gene activity (data not shown). Therefore, MF-ΔAkt is referred to as "functionally optimized" Akt and was used in most subsequent experiments. For improved expression in BMDCs, we generated replication-defective adenovirus (Ad), Ad-MF-ΔAkt.
To evaluate the functional activity of Ad-MF-ΔAkt in BMDCs, phosphorylation of GSK3 alpha/beta was examined in transduced cells. Consistently, Ad-MF-ΔAkt led to higher GSK3 alpha/beta phosphorylation in BMDCs, compared with Ad-M- Akt39 (Fig. 3B). It was next tested whether DCs transduced with either Ad-M-Akt or Ad-MF-ΔAkt escaped death triggered by PI3K inhibition. In vitro DC survival assays indicated that both constructs, unlike Ad-GFP, significantly inhibited wortmannin- mediated lethality in BMDCs (P<0.005). In addition, Ad-MF-ΔAkt protected DCs better than Ad-M-Akt (Fig. 3c, d, P<0.01). Meanwhile, over-expression of functionally optimized Akt had no effect on PP2- mediated DC death (Fig. 3E). These findings indicated that functionally optimized Akt almost completely suppressed DC death initiated by PI3K, but not Src, inhibition, suggesting that PI3K and Src kinase likely control DC survival by distinct pathways.
To directly investigate the effects of Aktl on DC phenotype, BMDCs were treated with either Ad- MF-ΔAkt or LPS and Ad-GFP as positive and negative controls, respectively. Flow cytometry analysis after 48 hr of treatment at about 50% transduction efficiency, revealed that Ad-MF-ΔAkt- transduced DCs had consistently enhanced expression of DC activation markers, including I-Ab, CD40, CD80 and Kb compared with Ad-GFP -transduced DCs, implicating that Akt activity is sufficient to induce DC activation and maturation (Fig. 3F).
A description of Figures 3A-3F follows. Figure 3 A shows a schematic of distinct Akt alleles comprised of myristoylation- targeting sequences (residues 1-16) from Src (MS), Fyn (MF) or Lck (ML) fused to PH domain-deleted Akt (ΔAkt 103-408). Activation state and expression of Ms-ΔAkt (MS), MF- ΔAkt (MF), and ML-ΔAkt (ML) were determined using anti-pAkt-S473 and anti-HA antibodies, respectively. Figure 3B shows phosphorylation of substrate GSK3 alpha/beta in BMDCs transduced by adenovectors expressing constitutive Akt. Activity and expression of Ad-MF-ΔAkt (MF-ΔAkt) or Ad- MS-Akt (M-Akt) were determined using anti-phospho-GSK3 (pGSK3) and anti-HA antibodies respectively. Protein loading was normalized by alpha-tubulin immunoblotting. Figures 3C and 3D show MF-ΔAkt protects BMDCs from wortmannin-mediated death in vitro. BMDCs transduced with adenoviruses expressing GFP, M-Akt or MF-ΔAkt at 100 m.o.i. were further incubated with LPS (1 μg/ml) and wortmannin (W, 0.5 nM) for 2 days. In Figure 3C cell death was assessed by PI staining under indicated treatment conditions (open diagrams) compared to LPS alone (filled reference histogram). Numbers represent %-gated region of open diagrams. Figure 3D is a graphical representation of Figure 3C. Figure 3E shows Src and PI3K have independent roles in DC survival. Viability of BMDCs was assessed as above in Figure 3D except for replacement of wortmannin with Src kinase inhibitor, PP2 (20 μM). Figure 4F shows MF-ΔAkt induces BMDC activation. Two days after indicated treatments of BMDCs, CDl lc+ DC activation was assessed by CD40, CD80, Kb and I-Ab staining. Numbers indicate percentage of cells in upper right quadrant. Data represent at least two independent experiments. Error bars represent S.D. of triplicate (Figure 3D and 3E) measurements. *, PO.005, **, P<0.01.
Example 4 Bcl-2 is required for Akt-mediated DC survival
Since the kinetics of Akt protein down-regulation following cytokine withdrawal correlated with BcI- 2 protein levels (Fig. IB), it was hypothesized that Bcl-2 might be a critical downstream effector of PI3K/Akt. To test this hypothesis, Akt-mediated survival of DCs was compared in Bcl-2+/- and Bcl-2-/- mice. Overall viability of Bcl-2-/- DCs was similar to that of Bcl-2+/- DCs in complete DC medium (data not shown). Consistent with previous results, treatment of DCs with the PI3K inhibitor, wortmannin, rapidly induced cell death both in Bcl-2+/- and Bcl-2-/- DCs. Ad-MF-ΔAkt transduction prior to wortmannin treatment, however, overcame the deleterious effects of PI3K inhibition, leading to enhanced survival of Bcl-2+/- DCs (Fig. 4, left). By contrast, the protective effect of Ad-MF-ΔAkt-transduction was completely abolished in Bcl-2-/- DCs, indicating that Akt mediated DC survival requires Bcl-2 (Fig. 4, right). In Figure 4, BMDCs from Bcl2+/- or Bcl2-/- mice were left untreated (A) or transduced with Ad-GFP (■) or Ad-MF-ΔAkt (•) and further incubated in the presence of wortmannin (W, 0.5 μM) for indicated times. Viability was assayed by flow cytometry based on PI uptake in triplicate. Data represent three independent experiments with similar results. Error bars represent the mean ± S.D. of triplicate measurements.
Example 5 Akt-transduced DCs show prolonged longevity in vitro and in vivo
Previous reports demonstrated a correlation between prolonging DC lifespan and the adjuvant potency of DC-based vaccines and T cell dependent immunity. Therefore, whether the induction of Akt activity promoted the survival of BMDCs under various conditions was tested. Initially, effects of Ad-M-Akt and LPS on DC survival were compared following growth factor deprivation. As shown in Fig. 5A and 5B, DCs pre-incubated with LPS (1 μg/ml) or infected with Ad-M-Akt maintained viability for at least 5 days after GM-CSF withdrawal, whereas untreated or Ad-GFP -transduced DCs underwent significant cell death by day 4, suggesting that the induction of Akt inhibits cell death signals mediated by GM-CSF withdrawal in vitro.
To further investigate Akt-mediated survival of DCs in vivo, the viability of Ad-MF-ΔAkt-transduced DCs with LPS-treated or Ad-GFP-transduced DCs was compared in draining lymph nodes. DCs were stained with the fluorescent dye CFSE followed by subcutaneous (s.c.) delivery into the hind legs of syngeneic mice (Fig. 5C). On day 5 after delivery, the quantity of CFSE+ MF-ΔAkt-DCs residing in the draining popliteal lymph nodes was -1% of total lymph node cells, which was a 2-3 -fold higher percentage than control Ad-GFP-DC-treated mice. Consistent with previous findings, the percentage of CFSE+ DCs from control mice injected with untreated or LPS-treated DCs rapidly decreased at later time points, whereas Akt-transduced DCs sustained their disproportionate representation for at least 10 days post-delivery (Fig. 5D). Prolonged survival of Ad-GFP-transduced DCs at day 10 may be due to transfer of long-lived EGFP to resident phagocytes. In addition, the average volume of draining lymph nodes exposed to MF-ΔAkt-DCs was approximately 4-8-fold more than control mice, indicating that Ad-MF- ΔAkt transduction enhances the number of lymph node resident leukocytes compared to all negative control groups as well as LPS-treated DCs (Fig. 5E). Because the arrival of CFSE+ DCs does not apparently differ significantly among the groups in the first 24 hr after injection, these data strongly suggest that ex vivo transduction of DCs with Ad-MF-ΔAkt promotes their prolonged lifespan, which results in sustained immunity by overcoming various DC death signals in lymphoid tissues.
A description of Figures 5A-5E follows. Figures 5A and 5B show the anti-apoptotic effect of Ad-M- Akt on DC death, in vitro. BMDCs were left untreated (D), or treated with LPS (■), Ad-GFP (O) or Ad- M-Akt (•) at 100 m.o.i. and further incubated for 2 to 5 days without GM-CSF. In vitro DC apoptosis was examined by Annexin V-PE staining. Histograms of Day 5 (open histogram) were compared to that of Day 2 (filled histogram). In Figure 5 A, numbers represent %-gated region of open histograms. In Figure 5B, error bars indicate mean ± S.D. of results pooled from three independent experiments. *, P<0.05 between Ad-EGFP and Ad-M-Akt. Figures 5C, 5D and 5E show effects of Ad-MF-ΔAkt on BMDC longevity, in vivo. CFSE-stained BMDCs were left untreated (D), or treated with LPS (■), Ad- GFP (O) or Ad-MF-ΔAkt (•) for 2 hr before injection into the hind legs of syngeneic mice (n=2 - 4 per time point). After indicated times, cells from draining LNs (popliteal) were stained with PI. Within PI- populations, CFSE+ cells were analyzed by flow cytometry. Figure 5C shows representative dot plots of CFSE+ populations at day 5 (P<0.05, between Ad-M-Akt and all controls). Boxed numbers indicate CFSE+ populations. In Figure 5D background CFSE+ from PBS control (-) was subtracted for each value. Error bars indicate mean ± S.E.M. Data represent three independent experiments with similar results. Figure 5E shows representative LNs isolated from indicated mice on day 7 and 10.
Example 6 Akt improves DC ability to stimulate T cell functions
In addition to promoting DC survival, optimal maturation and DC activation, accompanied by IL- 12 production, are important for naϊve T cell priming, leading to T cell proliferation and IFN-gamma production. However, it has been suggested that PI3K negatively regulates IL- 12 production in DCs. Therefore, to test whether enhanced survival and activation of MF-ΔAkt-DCs promotes T cell function, the proliferative response of allogeneic (BALB/c) and syngeneic OT- 1 T cells (expressing transgenic TCRs specific for Kb-restricted OVA257-264 peptide (SIINFEKL)) to peptide-pulsed, Akt-transduced DCs was examined. After 24-hr incubation of DCs with syngeneic splenocytes from OT- 1 mice, Ad-MF- ΔAkt-transduced DCs induced more T cell proliferation than Ad-GFP-transduced DCs, which was similar to LPS-treated DCs. Moreover, after -72 hr incubation, MF-ΔAkt-DCs induced about two-fold higher T cell proliferation than DCs activated with LPS (Fig. 6A). Ad-M-Akt-transduced DCs also consistently showed 5-7-fold higher allogeneic T cell proliferation than DCs pulsed with LPS or Ad-GFP at low DC:effector ratios after 72 hours (Fig. 6B). These data support a model in which Akt induces DC maturation and survival, leading to robust T cell proliferation.
To further determine whether upregulated Akt improves DC-mediated activation of T cells, secretion of IFN-gamma by OT- 1 splenocytes incubated with Ad-MF-ΔAkt- or control virus-pulsed DCs was examined. Peptide-pulsed and Akt or GFP virus-transduced DCs were cultured with pooled spleen cells from OT- 1 mice for 24 hr or 72 hr. Then, the OVA peptide-specific splenocyte response was measured ex vivo by IFN-gamma ELISPOT assay. LPS- or Ad-GFP-transduced DCs showed approximately the same numbers of IFN-gamma-producing cells, relative to untreated DCs. In contrast, MF-ΔAkt-DCs induced at least 7-fold higher IFN-gamma production by splenocytes (on both day 1 and day 3 (not shown)) than DCs treated with LPS or Ad-GFP (Fig. 6C). Therefore, in this experimental model, MF-ΔAkt-DCs elicit relatively persistent immunity by stimulating proliferation and activation of antigen specific CD8+ T cells.
A description of Figures 6A-6C follows. Figures 6A and 6B show MF-ΔAkt induces DC function to stimulate antigen-specific and allogeneic T cell proliferation. BMDCs alone (D) or pulsed with SIINFEKL peptide for 2 hr (Figure 6A) were left untreated (■) or treated with LPS (A), Ad-EGFP (O) or Ad-MF-ΔAkt (Figure 6A,#) and Ad-M-Akt (Figure 6B, •) for 16 hr. DCs were mixed in various dilutions with 1 x 105 splenocytes from syngeneic OT-I (Figure 6A) or allogeneic Balb/c (Figure 6B) mice and incubated for an additional 1 to 3 days. T cell proliferative responses were measured by 3H- thymidine uptake (1 mCi/well) for 16 hr. Figure 6C shows the effect of Ad-MF-ΔAkt transduction of BMDCs on CD8+ T cell activation. DCs as treated in Figure 6A were incubated with splenocytes from syngeneic OT-I mice for 3 days. IFN-gamma+ spots were assessed. All data represent two to three independent experiments.
Example 7 MF-ΔAkt enhances the efficacy of DC vaccines to eradicate pre-established tumors
To better evaluate the clinical relevance of MF-ΔAkt-DCs, anti-tumor efficacy was tested against two distinct models. Initially, the induction of antitumor immunity by Ad-MF-ΔAkt-transduced DC vaccines was monitored after immunization of C57BL/6 mice bearing large (about 0.4 cm3) subcutaneous EG.7- OVA thymomas. While control or LPS-treated and SIINFEKL-pulsed DC vaccines failed to inhibit tumor growth or increase survival in most animals, immunization with a single intraperitoneal dose of peptide-pulsed MF-ΔAkt-DCs led to significant tumor growth inhibition (P<0.05) (Fig. 7A, Fig. 13). At early time points, MF-ΔAkt-DCs successfully suppressed all pre-established EG.7-OVA tumors, although 2 of 5 tumors eventually relapsed (Fig. 13B). To measure sustained antigen-specific T cell responses in tumor-bearing mice, H-2Kb OVA257-264 tetramer analysis was performed on peripheral blood CD8+ T cells harvested 14 days after vaccination. Consistent with tumor suppression, this analysis showed that vaccination with peptide-pulsed MF-ΔAkt-DCs led to an expanded population of OVA257-264 antigen- specific CD8+ T cells (Fig. 7B). Anti-tumor effects of MF-ΔAkt-DCs against a "natural" tumor associated antigen, tyrosinase-related protein (TRP) 2, that is expressed in poorly immunogenic B 16 melanoma, next was tested. Once again, peptide-pulsed LPS-treated mature DCs were not significantly better than control DCs. However, immunization with a single or triple intraperitoneal dose of TRP-2 peptide-pulsed MF-ΔAkt-DCs significantly reduced the growth of pre-established B 16 melanoma, leading to increased survival of tumor-bearing mice relative to vaccination with control DCs (p = 0.003) or LPS- DCs (p = 0.006). (Fig. 7C, Fig. 7D). In addition, it was observed that only mice vaccinated with MF- ΔAkt-DCs (5 out of 9) showed clinical responses, such as extended reduction of tumor growth associated with tumor necrosis and frequently severe central ulceration. Among those 5 mice, one mouse exhibited stable tumor size and one mouse bearing an ~ 2 cm peak tumor size completely rejected its tumor without relapse up to 55 days (Fig. 13C and Fig. 13D).
To further assess the induction of recall memory responses in MF-ΔAkt-BMDC-treated mice, long- lived CD8+ memory responses to TRP-2 were tested in tumor naϊve mice 1 week after a booster DC vaccination that followed two months after three initial biweekly vaccinations. Up to 30% of all peripheral blood CD8+ T cells were TRP-2-specific from MF-ΔAkt-DC-vaccinated mice, whereas only 1- 3% of all peripheral blood CD8+ T cells from control DC-treated mice were TRP-2-specific (PO.0005) (Fig. 7E, Fig. 14). Concomitantly, up to 3 months after the initiation of DC treatment, no evidence of autoimmunity-induced depigmentation (i.e. vitiligo) or toxicity was observed, including measurements of body weight, complete blood cell counts and serum biochemistry (e.g. AST, ALT, glucose, blood urea nitrogen, creatine kinase, etc) (data not shown). These findings support the hypothesis that upregulation of Akt activity in DCs improves DC function, producing enhanced long-term anti-tumor effects even in the aggressive, poorly immunogenic B 16 tumor model without apparent autoimmunity and toxicity.
A description of Figures 7A- 7E follows. Figure 7A shows growth of pre-established EG.7-OVA tumors following single vaccinations with Akt-transduced DCs. Syngeneic C57BL/6 mice (n=5 per group) challenged with 2 x 106 EG.7-OVA thymoma cells at day 0 were treated at day 7 with PBS (A) or vaccinated with 2 x 106 BMDCs pulsed SIINFEKL peptide (20 μg/ml) alone (O) or treated with LPS (1 μg/ml) (#), 100 m.o.i. Ad-GFP (D) or Ad-MF-ΔAkt (»), and tumor sizes were estimated as w2*l*0.5236 and recorded biweekly. Numbers indicate fraction of mice bearing palpable tumors (> 0.1 cm3). ♦, P<0.05; MF-ΔAkt-DCs versus GFP-DCs. Figure 7B shows Ad-MF-ΔAkt-transduced BMDCs significantly increased numbers of tumor antigen-specific CD8+ T cells. For the left portion of Figure 7B, PBMCs from indicated group at day 21 were isolated and stained with PE-conjugated KbSIINFEKL tetramer and FITC-conjugated CD8. The right portion of Figure 7B shows the mean percentage of CD8+ and KbSIINFEKL tetramer positive population in PBMCs from two to three mice per group. ♦♦, P<0.005. Figure 7C shows tumor growth and Figure 7D shows animal survival regarding pre-established B 16 melanoma tumors following vaccinations with Akt-transduced DCs. B16 melanoma cells were injected subcutaneously into syngeneic C57BL/6 mice (1 x 105 cells/mouse, n=9 or 10 per group) at day 0. Treatment with indicated DC vaccines (2 x 106 DCs/mouse) pulsed with TRP2 peptide (10 μg/ml) was done 4 (or 5), 15 and 25 days after tumor injection (arrow). Two tumor measurements were recorded every 3-4 days. Mice which had about 3 cm3 tumors were euthanized and plotted with the last recorded volume. ♦, P<0.05 based on one-way ANOVA test. In Figure 7D, P<0.005, MF-ΔAkt-DCs versus control DCs and GFP-DCs; PO.01, MF-ΔAkt-DCs versus LPS-DCs based on log rank test. Similar trends were observed for single dosing and triple dosing of DC vaccine and tumors established with 0.5 x 105 B 16 melanoma cells, and for single dosing of DC vaccine and tumors established with 1 x 105 B 16 melanoma cells. Controls with (1) LPS and CD40 ligand, and (2) MF-ΔAkt with LPS and CD40 ligand also were tested. The trend for the latter control followed the trend for the MF-ΔAkt alone, indicating that LPS and CD40 ligand did not further enhance DC effectiveness. Figure 7E shows a memory CD8+ T Cell response by peptide-pulsed Akt-transduced DCs. Long-lived CD8+ memory responses were monitored two months after the third vaccination and 1-week after a booster DC vaccine following the initial three biweekly vaccinations of tumor naive animals with TRP-2-pulsed, PBS, Ad-GFP- or Ad-MF- ΔAkt-transduced BMDCs (2 x 106 DCs/mouse, 6 mice/group). Recall response of antigen-specific CD8+ T cell was measured by the percentage of the CD8+ and H-2Kb/TRP2 tetramer positive population in PBMCs using flow cytometry. Data shown is gated on CD8+ T cells. *, P<0.0005. Data represent two (Figures 7A and 7B) or three (Figures 7C and 7D) independent experiments with comparable results. Error bars represent mean ± S.E.M. Example 8 MF-ΔhAkt is a potent adjuvant to induce human MoDC longevity and CTL function
To test whether upregulation of Akt can also enhance human monocyte-derived DC (MoDC) function, a "humanized" MF-ΔhAkt was developed, and subcloned it into an Ad5f35 vector to improve transduction of human DCs. First, viability of Ad- MF-ΔhAkt- transduced MoDCs was compared with Ad- GFP-transduced MoDCs and DCs treated with standard maturation cocktail (MC)(Le. IL-I, IL-6, TNFD, and PGE2). As shown in Fig. 8 A, MoDCs pre-incubated with Ad- MF-ΔhAkt maintained viability up to 4 days after GM-CSF withdrawal, whereas Ad-GFP and MC-treated MoDCs showed extensive cell death by day 3, suggesting that targeted upregulation of Akt also inhibits death signals in human MoDCs and is more anti-apoptotic than standard MC. In addition, we observed that Ad-MF-ΔhAkt-transduced MoDCs consistently enhanced expression of DC activation markers, including CD80, CD86 and CCR7 compared with Ad-GFP-transduced MoDCs.
To further determine whether upregulated Akt also improves MoDC-mediated activation of antigen- specific human T cells, we performed HLA- A2/MAGE-3271-279 tetramer analysis on peripheral blood CD8+ T cells from healthy volunteers. Consistent with the proliferative responses observed for allogeneic (BALB/c) and syngeneic OT- 1 T cells to Ad-MF -ΔAkt-transduced DCs, vaccination with MF-ΔhAkt- transduced and peptide -pulsed DCs led to an expanded population of MAGE-3271-279 antigen-specific CD8+ T cells with higher IFN-gamma production (Fig. 8B). Moreover, MF-ΔhAkt-DC-mediated proliferative responses were closely correlated with robust MAGE-3-specific CTL responses against T2 cells pulsed with MAGE-3271-279 peptide and SK-Mel-37 (HLA- A2+/MAGE3+) target cells but not against control target cells, lacking HLA-A2 or MAGE3 (Fig. 8C). Taken together, these data clearly showed that administration of activated Akt into human MoDCs is a more potent adjuvant than conventional cytokine maturation cocktail and is attractive for clinical applications.
MoDCs also can be primed with other antigens, such as a prostate cancer specific antigen, PSMA (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 10). Isolated MoDCs are incubated with the antigen for a period of time (e.g., approximately 1 -2 hours) and infected with MF-ΔhAkt adenovirus described above. After administration of the resulting MoDCs into human subjects, the proliferation response of antigen-specific CD8+ T cells is determined. The immune response against this antigen sometimes is compared against the immune response of control cells (e.g., cells lacking the antigen or a particular HLA molecule).
A description of Figures 8A-8C follows. Figure 8A shows an anti-apoptotic effect of Ad-MF-ΔhAkt on human MoDC death. MoDCs from two donors were left untreated (O), or treated with maturation cocktail (MC) (•), Ad5f35-GFP (D) or Ad5f35-MF-ΔhAkt (■) at 100 m.o.i. and further incubated for 1 to 4 days without hGM-CSF. In vitro DC apoptosis was examined by PI staining. Figure 8B shows enhanced MAGE3 -specific CD8+ T cells after stimulation with MF-ΔhAkt-transduced MoDCs. Blood CD8+ T cells from a HLA-A2-positive healthy volunteer were stimulated with DCs untreated (-), or treated with maturation cocktail (+MC), Ad5f35-GFP (+GFP) or Ad5f35 -MF-ΔhAkt (+MF-hAkt) and stained with PE-conjugated HLA- A2/MAGE-3271-279 tetramer and FITC-conjugated CD8. The percentages indicate the fraction of tetramer-positive cells within the entire populations of T cells. Figure 8C shows MF-ΔhAkt transduced DCs enhance antigen specific CTL killing activity. Human MoDCs were pulsed with MAGE3 peptide and adenoviruses (Ad-GFP, D, and Ad-MF-ΔhAkt, ■) or MC (•) as indicated. After three serial stimulations of autologous T cells with DCs at day 7 and 8, antigen-specific CTL activity was evaluated with 51Cr release assay. Labeled target cells included melanoma cell lines SK- Mel-37 (MAGE3+, A2+), NA-6-Mel (MAGE3+, A2-), as well as T2 cells (MAGE3-, A2+) loaded with either MAGE3 (positive control) or influenza Ml (IM A2.1) peptides (as negative control). Data represent average of two donors (Figure 8A) or three independent experiments with similar results (Figures 8B and 8C). Error bars represent mean ± S.D.
A description of Figures 9 to 14 are described hereafter. Figure 9A shows specificity of small interfering RNA for Akt - 1 (Akt-RNAi). BMDCs were transfected with 100 nM of control RNAi (c - RNAi) or Akt -RNAi and further incubated for indicated times. Akt protein level was assessed by Akt immunobloting. Figure 9B shows an effect of Akt -RNAi on LPS -mediated DC survival. BMDCs ( -) and BMDCs transfected with c -RNAi or Akt -RNAi were incubated with LPS (1 μg/ml) for 3 days. Loaded proteins were normalized by actin immunobloting (Figure 9A). (c) Effect of Akt inhibitor on LPS - mediated DC survival. BMDCs were left untreated ( -) or treated with LPS with or without Akt inhibitor (Akt -i) and further incubated for 3 days. Cell viability was assayed by PI staining. Data represent three independent experiments with triplicate measurements (9Figures 9B and 9C). Error bars represent mean ± S.D. *, P<0.005.
Figure 10 shows a representative analysis of surface markers of Aktl+/+ or Aktl7" DCs. After 6 days of DC differentiation, surface expression of MHC and costimulatory molecules in Aktl+/+ or Aktl7" BMDCs was assessed by CD40, CD80, MHC class I K band MHC class II I -Abstaining along with CDl Ic. Numbers indicate percentage of cells in that area.
Figure 11 shows a comparison of bone marrow and spleens isolated from Aktl+/+ or Ak t 7" mice. Size of spleens isolated form Aktl+/+ or Aktl7" littermates was measured (bottom scale bar, 1 mm gap) and total cell numbers of bone marrow (pooled from two femurs and tibias) and spleens were assessed by trypan blue staining.
Figure 12A shows a comparison of lipid raft localization of myristoylation-targeting sequences (Myr 1-16) from Src (MS), Fyn (MF) or Lck (ML) fused to GFP in 293 cells. Membrane lipid rafts were stained with cholera toxin B (CTxB -TRITC). Figure 12B shows inducible lipid raft localization of Akt. 293 cells were transfected with membrane docking protein with Fyn myristoylation sequence (M F-FRB 12) and three tandem FKBP domains fused with ΔAkt (F3 -GFP-ΔAkt), followed by chemically induced dimerization (CID, AP22783, Li, B. et al. Gene Therapy (2001) 9: 2 33-244). Figure 12C shows induced phosphorylation of substrate GSK3 by MS-ΔAkt, MF-ΔAkt, and ML-ΔAkt in 293 cells. Figure 12D shows activation of NF- kappaB in Jurkat TAg cells transiently transfected with indicated amounts of control plasmid (■) or plasmids encoding MS-ΔAkt (D), MF-ΔAkt (•), or ML-ΔAkt (O) along with NF-kappaB SEAP reporter. Figure 12E shows protection of wortmannin-mediated cell death by MS-ΔAkt (D) or MF-ΔAkt (•) in Jurkat TAg cells. Viability was assayed by flow cytometry of PI uptake in triplicate (MFI; mean fluorescent intensity).
Figure 13A shows representative examples of EG.7 -OVA tumor-bearing mice vaccinated with Ad- GFP or Ad-MF-ΔAkt BMDCs. Tumors were compared on day 7 and 14 after vaccination (day 14 and day 21 respectively). Figures 13B and 13D show growth of individual pre-established EG.7-OVA tumors following single vaccinations with Akt-transduced DCs (Figure 13B) or individual pre-established B16 tumors following triple vaccination with GFP- or Akt -transduced DCs (Figure 13D). Numbers indicate individual tumor -bearing mice vaccinated with Akt-transduced DCs (Figure 13B). Figure 13C shows representative examples of B 16 melanoma tumor-bearing mice vaccinated with Ad-GFP (GFP), LPS or Ad-MF- ΔAkt (MF-ΔAkt) BMDCs. Tumors were compared on day 35 and 42 after tumor cell challenge.
Figure 14 shows three representative animals of memory recall response of antigen-specific CD 8+ T cells by PBS (+PBS), Ad-GFP (+GFP) or Ad-MF- Akt (+MF-ΔAkt)-treated BMDCs. Long-lived CD8+ memory responses were quantified by the percentage of the CD 8+ and H-2Kb/TRP2 tetramer positive population in PBMCs one week after a booster vaccination that followed two months after the initial three biweekly vaccinations. Numbers indicate percentage of cells in that area.
Provided hereafter is a discussion of results presented in this Example and previous Examples. DCs are the most potent antigen-presenting cells capable of initiating an immune response by activating rare, naϊve antigen-specific T cells. The outcome of immune responses depends on DC longevity and abundance at the site of T cell priming. Although previous studies suggested that pro-inflammatory signals increase life span of DCs through NF-kappaB and Bcl-2 family members, the molecular mechanism of DC survival is still not clearly defined. Here, we show that the PI3K/Akt pathway is an essential mediator of LPS- and CD40-triggered survival signals that occur at the initiation of innate and adaptive immunity, Bcl-2 is a critical down-stream effector of Akt-mediated DC survival.
A recent report showed that pathogen-derived pro-inflammatory signals induce in bone marrow- derived DCs both a conserved, Bcl-xL-dependent DC survival pathway and a Bim-dependent DC apoptotic pathway, which is transiently suppressed by Bcl-2, serving as a "molecular timer". It was determined by the studies reported in these Examples that the protein levels of Bcl-2 and Bcl-xL were independently regulated by pro-inflammatory signals. In addition, it was determined that Akt acts as a "life switch" to control Bcl-2 levels and regulates both DC lifespan and their ability to stimulate an immune response. Furthermore, it was demonstrated that DC death correlated with a rapid down- regulation of Akt following GM-CSF withdrawal. Withdrawal of other growth factors, like IL-3, insulin, and VEGF, has also been shown to trigger rapid down-regulation of Akt, mediated, in part, by its degradation. For example, caspase and proteasome inhibitors have a protective effect on Akt protein level following VEGF removal and promote endothelial cell viability. Therefore, it is possible that proteasome and/or caspase-targeted degradation of Akt regulate the PI3K/Akt signaling pathway to control DC lifespan. Although the activity of Akt is dependent on PI3K function, the precise role of PI3K in DC function is controversial. One group observed that the reduction of class IA PI3K activity by disruption of p85-alpha along with wortmannin treatment enhanced IL- 12 production in DCs, suggesting that PI3K may have a negative role in IL- 12 production by DCs43. However, an independent report showed that defective DC migration and subsequent down-regulation of adaptive immunity occurs in PBKgamma-deficient mice, indicating complex, non-redundant roles of PI3K isoforms in DC function. In addition, other reports have shown that CD40L-induced human DC survival is mediated by PI3K signaling, and inhibition of PI3K significantly reduces CD40L and CpG-mediated IL- 12 production by BMDCs. A more recent study showed that tyrosine phosphorylation of TLR3 initiated by double-strand RNA recruits and activates PI3K and Akt, leading to full phosphorylation and activation of IRF-3, suggesting also an essential role of PBK/Akt in TLR3-mediated gene expression.
Consistent with a largely stimulatory role for PI3K, it was observed that expression of PI3K substrate Akt, via Ad-MF-ΔAkt, induces DC maturation and activation, leading to enhanced T cell proliferation and IFN-gamma production by activated T cells. Moreover, it was observed that Akt deficiency reduces BMDC differentiation following GM-CSF treatment. Although expression of lineage markers CDl Ib and CDl Ic are similar in immature BMDCs from both Aktl+/+ and Aktl-/- mice, expression of some DC markers, such as MHC class I molecules, was clearly reduced. In addition, Aktl-/- BMDCs showed a large defect in the enhancement of DC activation and maturation markers even after LPS and CD40 stimulation (Fig. 2). Consistently, overexpression of Aktl itself was sufficient to enhance the expression of DC activation markers (Fig. 3F). In addition, induced surface expression of CCR7 in MF-ΔhAkt- transduced DCs supports a model in which Aktl plays a positive role in DC migration. Together, these observations demonstrate that Akt is involved in both DC activation and maturation.
While Akt activation plays a critical role in preventing cell death in various cell types and contexts in vitro, only a few studies have reported that constitutively active Akt promotes survival of target cells in vivo. Because the Src myristoylation sequence, used in other Akt constructs, does not target proteins efficiently to lipid rafts, where Akt is most active, their efficacy may have been reduced. The optimization studies described herein led to development of MF-ΔAkt, comprised of the Fyn myristoylation sequence ("MF") fused to truncated Akt, ΔAkt, lacking a partially inhibitory pleckstrin homology domain. MF-ΔAkt functions better than M-Akt in vitro and sustains DC lifespan for at least 10 days post-delivery in vivo, indicating that the described Akt improvements translate to improved DC function. In an independent study, MF-ΔAkt also appeared to regulate neurite morphology as well as the survival of cultured sensory neurons. Therefore, in addition to potentiating DC vaccine efficacy, functionally optimized Akt may have numerous applications. Targeting other signaling molecules directly to lipid rafts with the myristoylation-targeting sequence from Fyn, rather than Src, would likely improve many so-called "constitutive" alleles.
Studies provided herein also showed that overexpressing Aktl in BMDCs led to improved vaccination against both immunogenic tumors and poorly immunogenic B16 tumors (Fig. 7). In addition, adenoviral administration of MF-ΔAkt provides a more robust and extended activation of DCs relative to the potent adjuvants such as LPS in mouse and maturation cocktails in human. Although LPS and cytokine cocktails appeared more effective than Akt in maturing a higher percentage of DCs in vitro, most likely due to incomplete transduction of target cells by adenovirus, MF-ΔAkt transduced DCs achieved higher T cell proliferation, IFN-gamma production and cytolytic activity than DCs treated with LPS (mouse BMDCs) or maturation cocktails (human MoDCs). MF-ΔAkt-DCs also efficiently induced long-lived CD8+ memory responses without detectable signs of autoimmunity (Fig. 7E, Fig. 14). Furthermore, in vivo, Ad- MF-ΔAkt led to a significantly improved DC-based tumor vaccine compared to antigen-loaded and LPS- treated DCs, which have been reported to efficiently retard tumor growth via supra-physiological T cell expansion in C57BL/6 mice bearing poorly immunogenic B16-F10 melanoma cells55. It is proposed that the anti-tumor effects are due to the ability of functionally optimized Akt to evade negative feedback mechanisms of DC activation and survival, such as pro-inflammatory receptor desensitization or downregulationl3-15 and TLR-mediated upregulation of pro-apoptotic molecules 12 which can limit the survival signaling capacity of pro-inflammatory signals to maintain homeostasis. In addition, in vitro transduction of DCs with Ad- MF-ΔAkt provides an alternative way to overcome some of the toxicity associated with in vivo administration of microbial adjuvant or systemic administration of soluble CD40L or CD40 specific monoclonal antibody.
In summary, the role of Aktl was characterized in dendritic cell survival and therapeutic applications were evaluated. Previously, it has been shown that a synthetic dimerizing drug-inducible allele of CD40 (called iCD40) leads to increased lifespan and prolonged activation of DCs, resulting in more potent T cell-mediated immune responses. The studies presented herein suggest that at least a subset of the signals provided by iCD40 in vivo may be attainable independently of pharmacological reagents. Use of enhanced DCs should complement previous efforts to identify tumor-associated antigens and apply in vitro expanded and matured DCs to tumor immunotherapy.
Example 9 Materials and methods utilized in Examples 1-8
Mice and cell lines. Six to eight-week-old female C57BL/6 mice were purchased from the Center for Comparative Medicine (Baylor College of Medicine, Houston, TX). BALB/c mice, Aktl+/-, Bcl-2+/- and OT-I TCR transgenic mice, responsive to OVA257-264 peptide (Kb-restricted SIINFEKL), were purchased from Jackson laboratory. Aktl-/- and Bcl-2-/- mice were obtained by inbreeding. OVA- expressing EG7 thymoma cells were purchased from American Tissue Culture Collection and maintained in RPMI 1640 medium containing 10 % FBS, 0.4 mg/ml G418, 50 μM beta-mercaptoethanol, 1 mM sodium pyruvate, and antibiotics. All mice were housed in the pathogen- free units of Texas Mouse Facility at Baylor College of Medicine.
Reagents. Recombinant murine GM-CSF and IL-4 were purchased from RDI Research Diagnostics. E. CoIi LPS and anti-mouse CD40 mAb (3/23) were purchased from Sigma and BD Pharmingen respectively. The PI3-Kinase inhibitors LY294002 and wortmannin, ERK inhibitor PD98059, Src kinase inhibitor PP2, JNK inhibitor AG490 and Akt inhibitor were purchased from Calbiochem. The following antibodies were used for Western blotting: anti-Akt, anti-phospho-Akt (Ser473) and anti-phospho- GSK3 alpha/beta (Ser21/9) (Cell Signaling Technology), anti-Aktl and anti-Akt2 (Upstate cell signaling solutions), anti-Bcl-2 and anti-Bcl-XL (BD Biosciences), anti-actin (1-19) and anti-alpha-tubulin (Santa Cruz Biotechnology), and anti-mouse hemagglutinin (HA) epitope (HA-11, Covance). CFSE was purchased from Molecular Probes (Eugene). DC death was assessed using Propidium Iodide (PI; Sigma) and PE-conjugated Annexin V (BD Pharmingen). OVA257-264 peptide (SIINFEKL) and MAGE-3271- 279 (FLWGPRALV) were purchased from (Tetramer Core Facility, Baylor College of Medicine). TRP2 peptide (VYDFFVWL) was utilized in the studies.
Preparation of plasmids and recombinant adenoviruses. The recombinant adenovirus encoding constitutive Iy active Akt (Ad- M- Akt) is described in Guha, M. et al., Lipopolysaccharide activation of the MEK-ERK 1/2 pathway in human monocytic cells mediates tissue factor and tumor necrosis factor alpha expression by inducing EIk-I phosphorylation and Egr-1 expression. Blood 98, 1429-39 (2001). Preparation of plasmids and generation of recombinant adenovirus encoding myristoylation- targeting sequences from Fyn kinase fused to a PH domain truncated murine Aktl (Ad-MF-ΔAkt) or human Aktl (Ad5f35-MF-ΔhAkt) are described hereafter. Large-scale expansion of adenoviruses expressing M-Akt (Ad-M- Akt), MF-ΔAkt (Ad-MF-ΔAkt), MF-ΔhAkt (Ad5f35-MF-ΔhAkt) and control adenovirus encoding EGFP (Ad-GFP for mouse DCs and Ad5f35-GFP for human DCs) was carried out in the Viral Vector Core Facility (Baylor College of Medicine).
For the construction of Src-, Fyn- or Lck-myristoylated ΔAkt or EGFP, annealed oligonucleotide duplexes encoding Src, Fyn or Lck myristoylation targeting sequences (Src; 5MyrS17: 5'- ggccaccatgggtagcaacaagagcaagcccaaggatgccagccag cggcgccgcagcc-3', 3MyrS17 : 5'- tcgaggctgcggcgccgctggctggcatccttgggcttgctcttgttgctacccatggtggccgc-3', Fyn; 5MyrL17: 5'- ggccaccatgggctgtgtctgcagctcaaaccctgaagatgactggatggagaacattc-3', 3MyrL17: 5'- tcgagaatgttctccatccagtcatcttcagggtttgagctgcagacacagcccatggtggccgc-3', Lck; 5MyrF17: 5'- ggccaccatgggctgtgtgcaatgtaaggataaagaagcaacaaaactgacggaggagc-3 ' , 3MyrF 17: 5 ' - tcgagctcctccgtcagttttgttgcttctttatccttacattgcacacagcccatggtggccgc-3') were subcloned into expression vector, pBJ5(Spencer '93) at Sst II and Xho I. Fragments encoding Sal I-linkered EGFP or Sal I linkered ΔAkt (lacking its PH domain), which were removed from plasmids pSHl/M-ΔAkt-E (Li, B. et al. Gene Therapy (2001) 9: 233-244), were subcloned in- frame into the Xho I and Sal I sites downstream of each myristoylation-targeting sequence. To generate adenovirus, Ad-MF-ΔAkt, expressing doubly acylated ΔAkt, MF-ΔAkt fragments were isolated from pBJ5-MF-ΔAkt by Not I/Klenow and EcoR I digestion and subcloned into Smal/EcoRI-digested shuttle vector pDNR-CMV to create pDNR- MF-ΔAkt. Finally, recombinant adenoviral vector, pLP-Adeno-X-MF-ΔAkt, encoding MF-ΔAkt, was generated by Cre-loxP- mediated recombination according to the Adeno-X-Expression System 2 (BD Biosciences) protocol. To generate adenovirus expressing MF-ΔhAkt (Ad5f35-MF-human ΔAktl), human ΔAktl (lacking its PH domain) fused with myristoylation targeting sequence (MF) was subcloned into shuttle vector, pShuttle-X, sequenced, I-CeuI/PI-Scel-digested and transferred into similarly digested Ad5f35 (BCM Gene Vector Lab). Generation, purification and titration of recombinant adenoviruses expressing MF-ΔAkt (Ad-MF- ΔAkt) and MF-hΔAkt (Ad5f35-MF-hΔAkt) were performed as described in the manufacturer's protocol (BD Biosciences).
Mouse and human DC preparation. Bone marrow derived dendritic cells (BMDCs) from six to eight- week-old wild type C57BL/6 mice and Aktl-/- (C57BL/6) mice or two to three-week-old Bcl-2+/- and Bcl-2-/- mice were generated as described previously with minor modifications (Inaba, K. et al. Generation of large numbers of dendritic cells from mouse bone marrow cultures supplemented with granulocyte/macrophage colony-stimulating factor. J Exp Med 176, 1693-702 (1992)). Briefly, bone marrow cells were isolated from mouse femurs and tibias and cultured in DC medium (RPMI 1640 medium containing 10% FBS, 50 μM beta-mercaptoethanol, and antibiotics in the presence of 10 ng/ml each of mouse GM-CSF and IL-4). Half the culture medium was replaced every other day. On day 6, BMDCs were collected and enriched with CDl Ic microbeads (Miltenyi Biotec). For the generation of human monocyte-derived DCs (MoDCs) from healthy donors, peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMCs) were isolated by Lymphoprep (Nycomed Pharma AS, Oslo, Norway) and allowed to adhere in culture plates for 2 hr. Nonadherent cells were removed by extensive washes and adherent cells were cultured for 5 days in serum free DC medium (CellGenix) with 500U/ml of hIL-4 and 800 U/ml hGM- CSF (R&D Systems). For cell survival experiments, MoDCs precursors were purified by positive sorting using CD 14 microbeads (Miltenyi Biotec) from PBMCs and cultured as described above.
In vitro mouse and human DC survival assay. Purified mouse BMDCs (2 x 106 cells/ml) were incubated with combinations of LPS (1 μg/ml), anti-CD40 (10 μg/ml) and chemical inhibitors as indicated in the Results section or transduced with Ad-GFP, Ad-M-Akt or Ad-MF- D Akt vectors at 100 m.o.i. under GM-CSF-free conditions. For human DC survival assays, purified human MoDCs (2 x 106 cells/ml) were transduced with adenoviruses (Ad5f35-GFP or Ad5f35-MF-ΔhAkt) at 100 m.o.i. or stimulated with maturation cocktail (MC) containing 10 ng/ml TNF-alpha, 10 ng/ml IL-lbeta, 150 ng/ml IL-6 (R&D Systems) and 1 μg/ml of PGE2 (Cayman Chemicals). After 16-20 hr, DCs were washed and further incubated in 96-well plates (2 x 105 cells/well) in complete DC medium without GM-CSF and IL-4. DC death was assessed by loss of propidium iodide exclusion (PI+) and by binding of PE-conjugated Annexin-V (Annexin-V+) using flow cytometry (Epics® XL-MCL).
In vivo DC survival assay. To analyze DC survival in vivo, BMDCs were treated with LPS (1 μg/ml), Ad-GFP or Ad-MF-ΔAkt for 2 hr, labeled with CFSE dye and injected subcutaneously into hind legs below knees of syngeneic C57BL/6 mice (1 x 106 cells per mouse) as described previously (Nopora, A. & Brocker, T. Bcl-2 controls dendritic cell longevity in vivo. J Immunol 169, 3006-14 (2002)). The draining popliteal lymph nodes were harvested at various time points after injection, and percentage CFSE-positive cells among live LN cells (based on propidium iodide staining) were analyzed by flow cytometry. Flow cytometry analysis. Prior to staining with labeled antibodies, BMDCs were pretreated with Fc blocking antibody (anti-CD 16/CD32 mAb; BD Pharmingen) to avoid nonspecific binding. DCs were then stained with FITC-conjugated anti-mouse CDl Ic and PE-conjugated anti-mouse CD40, CD80, MHC class I Kb, or MHC class II I-Ab (BD Pharmingen). For counting ovalbumin-specific or TRP2-specific CD8+ T cells, peripheral blood lymphocytes were stained with FITC-conjugated anti-mouse CDδalpha (BD Pharmingen) and PE-conjugated H-2Kb/OVA257-264 tetramer or H-2Kb/TRP2181-188 (VYDFFVWL) respectively (Tetramer Core Facility, Baylor College of Medicine). To detect MAGE-3- specific CD8+ T cells, presensitized CD8+ T cells were stained with PE-labeled HLA-A2/MAGE-3271- 279 (FL WGPRALV) tetramer (Tetramer Core Facility, Baylor College of Medicine) for 15 min at 37°C before addition of FITC-conjugated anti-human CD8 mAb (BD Biosciences). Stained cells were analyzed by flow cytometry and Flow Jo (TreeStar, Inc., Ashland, OR) software.
Allogeneic and autologous T cell proliferation assays. Purified BMDCs (C57BL/6) were incubated with LPS (1 μg/ml), Ad-GFP or Ad-MF-ΔAkt virus at 100 m.o.i. For autologous T cell proliferation assays, BMDCs were pulsed with SIINFEKL peptide (OVA257-264, Protein Chemistry Core Facility, Baylor College of Medicine) prior to incubation with LPS or recombinant adenoviruses. After 16-hr incubation, BMDCs were co-cultured with syngeneic (C57BL/6) or allogeneic (BALB/c) splenocytes at different ratios (1 :50-l :6400) in 96-well round-bottom plates for 1 to 3 days. Thereafter, cells were pulsed with 1 μCi of [ H] thymidine (New England Nuclear) per well for 12 hr, and thymidine incorporation was measured by liquid scintillation (1205 BS Betaplate). All experiments were conducted in triplicate and expressed as mean ± S. D.
IFN-gamma ELISPOT assay. BMDC-mediated T cell activation was assessed by IFN-gamma ELISPOT assay as described previously with minor modifications (Nikitina, E.Y. et al. Versatile prostate cancer treatment with inducible caspase and interleukin-12. Cancer Res 65, 4309-19 (2005)). Briefly, 2 x 105 OT-I splenocytes and syngeneic BMDCs treated with SIINFEKL peptide and LPS or adenoviruses were cultured for 24 or 72 hours in 96-well Multi-Screen-HA plates (Millipore) coated with 10 μg/mL of purified rat anti-mouse IFN-gamma monoclonal antibody (clone R4-6A2; PharMingen). Plates were then incubated overnight at 4°C with 5 μg/mL biotinylated rat anti-mouse IFN-gamma monoclonal antibody (clone XMGl.2; PharMingen). Spots were visualized with 5-bromo-4-chloro-3-indolylphosphate/nitro blue tetrazolium alkaline phosphatase substrate (Sigma) reaction and counted per triplicate well using a stereomicroscope.
In vivo tumor vaccination studies. EG.7-OVA thymoma or B16 melanoma cells (ATCC) were expanded in culture and injected subcutaneously into C57BL/6 mice (2 x 106 EG.7-OVA cells/mouse or 0.5 x 105 or 1 x 105 B 16 melanoma cells/mouse). For therapeutic DC vaccines, BMDCs were pulsed with SIINFEKL peptide (20 μg/ml) for EG.7-OVA cells or tyrosinase-related protein (TRP)-2 peptide (10 μg/ml, sequence VYDFFVWL) for B 16 cells, transduced with or without adenoviruses or LPS and injected intraperitoneally (2 x 106 DCs/mouse). Single DC vaccine treatment was done 7 days after EG.7- OVA tumor injection (tumor sizes reached approximately 0.4 cm ) or triple DC vaccination was done 4 (or 5), 15 and 25 days after B 16 tumor injection. Two tumor measurements were recorded every 3-4 days. Tumor volumes were estimated as (ml2 x m2 x 0.5236) w2*l*0.5236.
MAGE3 -specific CTL activity assay. For T cell assays, DCs were purified from HLA- A2 -positive healthy volunteers, after HLA typing by flow cytometry with FITC-conjugated anti-HLA-A2 specific antibody (BD Biosciences, San Diego, CA). DCs were pulsed with MAGE3271-279 (FLWGPRALV) peptide (Genemed Synthesis Inc, San Francisco, CA) and transduced with adenoviruses (Ad5f35-GFP or Ad5f35-MF-ΔhAkt, 10,000 vp/cell). Cytolytic assays were performed by coculturing DCs with autologous T cells (isolated using a Pan T cell isolation kit (Miltenyi Biotec)) at 1 : 10 ratio. T cells were restimulated twice in the presence of IL-2 (lOU/ml). After 20 days of culture, effector cells were harvested and analyzed by cytolytic assays. Target cells including melanoma cell lines SK-Mel-37 (MAGE3 positive, A2 positive), NA-6-Mel (MAGE3 positive, A2 negative) and T2 cells (MAGE3 negative, A2 positive) loaded with MAGE3271-279 peptide were labeled with 100 μCi 51Cr-sodium chromate (Amersham Pharmacia Biotech) and cocultured for 6 hours with effector cells at the indicated cell ratios. The percentage of specific lysis was calculated as: 100* [(experimental - spontaneous release)/(maximum - spontaneous release)]. For control purposes, T2 cells were pulsed with flu matrix peptide (IMP) p58-66 GILGFVFT (Genemed Synthesis Inc).
Statistical analysis. Statistical significance was determined based on the student t-test between indicated groups or one-way ANOVA with a multiple comparison test. Animal survival was analyzed using Kaplan-Meier survival curves with log rank test (Prism v4, GraphPad Software, Inc.).
Preparation of siRNAs. The previously identified small interfering RNA (siRNA) for Akt- 1 , matching closely all isoforms (siAKTc; Katome, T., et al. J. Biol. Chem. (2003) 278: 28312), was synthesized from Integrated DNA Technologies (Coralville, IA), and negative control siRNA was purchased from Ambion (Austin, TX). Transfection of siRNAs into BMDCs was done by GeneSilencerTM siRNA Transfection (GTS, San Diego, CA) or nucleofection using the Human Dendritic Cell Nucleofector Kit (Amaxa Biosystems, Gaithersburg, MD).
NF-kappaB secreted alkaline phosphatase (SEAP) reporter assay. Jurkat TAg cells were transfected with indicated amounts of plasmids along with NF-kappaB SEAP reporter plasmid by electroporation. The following day, cells were plated with suboptimal concentrations of phorbol ester PMA (0.5 nM) and further incubated for about 24 hr. Thereafter, supernatants were collected and analyzed for SEAP activity as described previously (Li, B. et al. Gene Therapy (2001) 9: 233-244).
Fluorescent confocal microscopy. 293 cells cultured on poly-L-lysine-coated coverslips were transfected with indicated plasmids in 6-well plates and further incubated for 24 hr. For drug-dependent lipid-raft localization, 100 nM of Rapalog (Rapa-B) was added for an additional 4 hr. After fixation with 4% paraformaldehyde for 30 min, cells were labeled with cholera toxin B (CTx-B-TRITC) to detect glycosphingolipid in membrane lipid-rafts (List Biological Laboratories, Campbell, CA), and analyzed by LSM 430 confocal microscopy. Example 10 Inducible Akt (iAkt) membrane targeting
Inducible Akt (iAkt) membrane targeting was effected by (a) linking a modified Akt with a polypeptide that binds to a bifunctional compound, and (b) linking a membrane association component to a another polypeptide that binds to the same bifunctional compound. Adding the bifunctional compound to a system in which component (a) and (b) are present can induce the two components to join with one another and the complex can be recruited to the cell membrane in an inducible manner. In the example below, the bifunctional compound, a rapamycin derivative, binds to (a) a derivative of FK binding protein linked to an Akt protein lacking a PH domain, and (b) a rapamycin binding domain from mTOR/FRAP/RAFT linked to a N-terminal myristoylation region from the protein kinase Src. Constructs and methods for generating and using these components are described in U.S. patent application publication US2003/0144204 published on July 31, 2003 and filed on December 19, 2002, entitled "Akt- Based Inducible Survival Switch," which can be consulted by the person of ordinary skill in the art for any details not presented below. Alternative embodiments include substituting the Src N-terminal myristoylation region with a dual acylation region from a different protein (e.g., from Fyn or Lck) or with another membrane protein or membrane protein fragment, as can be accomplished by the person of ordinary skill in the art using standard techniques.
Plasmid Construction. To generate F3-Akt, F3 -DPH. Akt, F3-AktKM and variants, Akt and .DELTA.PH. Akt were Pfu (Stratagene)-amplified from pCMV6-HA-Akt or pCMV6-HA-AktK179M using Sall-linkered 5' primers, mAkt5SPH (full-length): 5'-agagcgacaacgacgtagccattgtgaaggag-3' or mAkt5S (truncated .DELTA.PH): 5'-agagtcgacaccgccattcagactgtggcc-3'; and 3' primer, mAkt3S: 5'- agagtcgacggctgtgccactggctgagtag-3'. PCR products were subcloned into pCR-Blunt (Invitrogen) or pKSII+(Stratagene) and sequence verified, to createpSH5/mAkt, pSH5/m.DELTA.PH.Akt, and pKS/mAkt.KM. The 1440-bp full-length Akt and 1130-bp .DELTA.PH.Akt fragments were removed with Sail and subcloned into XhoI/Sall-digested M-Fpk 3-E, or Xhol or Sail-digested S-F.sub.pk 3-E (MacCorkle et al., 1998), to create M- Akt (and Akt variants), Akt-F3 (and variants) and F3-Akt (and variants). All chimeric proteins contain the HA epitope (E), but the "E" is left off (along with "pk" subscripts) for simplicity. The heterodimeric rapalog/CID.sub.HED can effect the crosslinking of FRBl and FKPB 12 (called F). In these experiments, the non-toxic variant of FKBP 12, Fpk (FKBP 12(G89P, 190K)), was used to eliminate background toxicity.
To generate myristoylated rapalogue-binding domains, the rapamycin binding domain (FRB) from human FRAP (res. 2025-2113; T2098L) was Pful-amplified from FRAP*-AD using primers SEQ ID NO: 9 (5'-cgatctcgaggagatgtggcatgaaggcctgg-3') and 3FRBS: SEQ ID NO: 10 (5'- cgatgtcgacctttgagattcgtcggaacacatg-3') and subcloned into pCR-Blunt to produce pSH5/FRB.sub.1. One or two copies of the Xhol/Sall FRBl domain were subcloned into XhoI/Sall-digested M-F.sub.pk 3-E to create M-FRB. sub.1 and M-FRB. sub.1 2. Also, the NF-.kappa.B-SEAP reporter plasmid was produced. Thus, a constitutively active, myristoylated Akt (M- Akt) or M-.DELTA.PH.Akt and kinase-dead mutant versions (i.e. Akt.K179M, named AktKM) of chimeric Akt constructs were developed.
To make the bicistronic iAkt constructs, two different internal ribosome entry sequence (IRES) elements from EMCV or poliovirus were used to link M-FRB. sub.12 and F3-.DELTA.PH.Akt on the same transcript. The poliovirus IRES sequence (IRESp) was Pful-amplified from pTPOV-3816 with primers, 5pIRES/Mn: 5'-atacaattgccgcggttcgaattctgttttatactcccttcccgtaac-3' and 3pIRES/Mun; 5'- tatcaattggtttaaacagcaaacagatagataatgagtctcac-3'. The resulting PCR products were subcloned into pCR- Blunt to create pSH5/IRESp-Mun. The 615-bp IRESp Muni fragment was ligated into EcoRI-digested pSHl/M-FRB.sub.l2-E to create pSHl/M-FRB.sub. l2-E-IRESp. Finally, the Notl/EcoRI F3- .DELTA.PH.Akt fragment from pSHl/F3-.DELTA.PH.Akt was blunt-ligated into the Pmel site to create pSHl/M-FRB.sub.l 2-E-IRESp-F3.DELTA.PH.Akt, renamed as iAkt.sub.b. The bicistronic vector iAkt. sub. a utilizes the EMCV IRES and was made by a comparable strategy.
For establishing JurkatiAkt cell lines, the bicistronic Notl/Munl fragment from iAkt.sub.b was subcloned into Notl/EcoRI-digested pBJ5-neo to create pBJ5-neo/iAkt.sub.b.
To generate inducible Akt (iAkt) molecules, three tandem FKBP domains (F3) were fused to the N- or C-termini of wild-type Akt or a variant. .DELTA.PH.Akt), lacking the pleckstrin homology (PH) domain to reduce natural membrane association.
Cell Culture. 293T human embryonic kidney cells (ATCC) and Jurkat (ATCC), Jurkat-TAg and Jurkat.iAkt were maintained in DMEM or RPMI- 1640, respectively, containing 10% fetal bovine serum (FBS) and antibiotics. The Jurkat.iAkt line was derived by transfecting Jurkat cells with Ndel-linearized pBJ5-neo/iAkt.sub.b plasmid followed by G418 (1 mg/ml) selection. Clones were screened by anti-HA immunoblotting.
Electroporation and SEAP Assay. Jurkat-TAg cells in logarithmic -phase growth were electroporated (950 mF, 250 V; Gene Pulser II (BIO-RAD)) with expression plasmids and the NF-.kappa.B-SEAP reporter plasmid. After 24 hours, transfected cells were stimulated with sub-optimal levels of the phorbol ester PMA (5 ng/ml) along with log dilutions of the heterodimerizing CID, AP22783, and additional treatments. After an additional 24 hours, supernatants were assayed for SEAP activity.
Western Blots. 293T cells seeded in 6-well plates were transiently transfected with 2 .mu.g of different expression constructs in 6 .mu.l FuGENEό (Boehringer-Mannheim, Indianapolis, Ind.) in Opti- MEM-I medium for 24 hours followed by serum starvation for an additional 24 hours. Cells were then treated with different agents and harvested at different time points. After washing (2.times.) in ice-cold PBS, cell pellets were lysed in RIPA buffer containing protease inhibitors (CytoSignal, Irvine, Calif). Equal amounts of protein from each sample were separated on 10% SDS-PAGE gels and transferred to PVDF membrane (Amersham Pharmacia Biotech, Piscataway, N.J.). Phospho-specific antibodies against Akt (T308 or S473 site) (Cell Signaling, Beverly, Mass.) were used for measuring Akt phosphorylation, and the signal was detected by AP-conjugated secondary antibodies (NEB, Beverly, Mass.) and CDP-Star chemiluminescence reagent (NEN life science, Boston, Mass.).
Immunoprecipitation and in vitro Akt Kinase Assay. Jurkat.iAkt.sub.b were serum starved for 24 hours followed by treatment with AP22783 or serum for 30 min. Cells were then lysed in a lysis buffer provided with the Akt Kinase Assay kit (Cell Signaling, Beverly, Mass.), and F.sub.pk3-.DELTA.PH.Akt- E was immunoprecipitated with polyclonal anti-HA antibody. Antibody-antigen complexes were washed three times in lysis buffer and once in kinase buffer. In vitro kinase assays for Akt were performed using a GSK3.alpha./.beta. "crosstide". The extent of crosstide phosphorylation was determined by anti- GSK.alpha./.beta. immunoblotting according to the manufacturer's protocol.
Apoptosis and Flow Cytometry. JurkatiAkt were serum starved for 24 hours followed by pre- treatment with AP22783 in 0, 2 or 10% FBS for 40 min. After incubation with apoptosis-inducing stimuli for the periods indicated, cells were harvested and washed twice in ice-cold PBS and fixed in 70% ethanol. Cells were stained in 50 .mu.g/ml propidium iodide and 100 .mu.g/mlRNase A for 30 min at 37. degree. C, and hypodiploid cells were quantitated by flow cytometry using a Beckman-Coulter EPICS XL-MCL.
For determination of caspase-3 activation and PARP cleavage after staurosporine treatment, cell pellets were lysed in Laemmli sample buffer containing 5% (v/v) .beta.-mercaptoethanol (Bio-Rad, Hercules, Calif), and equal amounts of protein were separated on 6 (for PARP) or 12% (for caspase3) SDS-PAGE followed by immunoblotting with anti-caspase-3 and anti-PARP antibodies.
Inducible membrane recruitment of iAkt. Two key requirements for efficient synthetic regulation of a biological event are highly specific conditional dependency and low background. NF-kappaB induction is a major target of Akt following growth factor signaling, and multiple reports show that a constitutive Iy active myristoylated Akt (M-Akt) can enhance protein kinase C (PKC) -mediated NF-.kappa.B induction by either phosphorylation of IKK.alpha., the activation domain of p65/RelA, or both. Therefore, in order to optimize iAkt, an NF-.kappa.B-responsive secreted alkaline phosphatase (SEAP) reporter plasmid was used as an assay for Akt activation.
Briefly, the human T cell line, Jurkat-TAg, was cotransfected with reporter plasmid, NF- .kappa.B/SEAP, along with constitutively active M-Akt expression vector or empty control vector. Twenty- four hours after transfection, cells were divided into aliquots that were stimulated with sub- optimal levels (5 ng/ml) of the phorbol ester, PMA, or were untreated. After an additional 24 hours, SEAP activity was measured. Although Akt activity alone was insufficient to induce measurable NF-.kappa.B activity, M-Akt expression potentiated (by 3-4 fold) PKC-induced NF-.kappa.B activity, consistent with multiple reports. Furthermore, inhibition of PI3K by LY294002 (5 .mu.M) or wortmannin (1 .mu.M) did not prevent NF-.kappa.B activation by M-Akt plus PKC, although inhibition of "typical" PKC isoforms with R0318220 (1 .mu.M) led to complete inhibition of NF-.kappa.B as expected (FIG. 2).
Since the constitutively active Akt (T308) kinase, PDKl, is primarily membrane-associated following growth factor stimulation, membrane recruitment of Akt via its PH domain is necessary for its activation. Furthermore, although the PH domain has been shown to suppress basal phosphorylation of T308 and Akt activation when not bound by its lipid ligand, PIP2, this initial phosphorylation should still require interaction with membrane-localized PDKl . Basal Akt activity and activation following membrane recruitment of full length and truncated Akt, lacking the PH domain, was compared using a NF-.kappa.B reporter assay. Both full length and .DELTA.PH.Akt were fused to a tandem trimer of the CID-binding domain, F3, at both the amino and carboxyl termini. As before Jurkat-TAg cells were cotransfected with reporter plasmid NF- .kappa.B/SEAP along with the membrane docking molecule, M-FRB. sub.12, alone, various F3-Akt chimeras, alone, or both together. Twenty- four hours after transfection, cells were stimulated with 5 ng/ml PMA along with log dilutions of heterodimerizing CID, AP22783. After additional 24 hr incubation, SEAP activity was assayed. Wild type Akt showed significant CID-independent NF-.kappa.B induction that was only slightly increased by crosslinking to the membrane, via M-FRB 12. This was true regardless of whether F3 was fused to the N- or C-terminus of Akt. As expected, membrane recruitment or overexpression of kinase-deficient Akt.KM (K179M) had no detectable effect on NF-.kappa.B induction over PMA alone. Thus, membrane recruitment of full-length Akt only slightly increases its activity due to the high basal activity from its overexpression. In contrast, membrane recruitment of F3-.DELTA.PH.Akt showed a very clear CID-dependent induction of NF-.kappa.B with undetectable CID-independent activity. Moreover, myristoylated M.DELTA.PH.Akt was more active than M-Akt in augmenting NF- .kappa.B activation, consistent with an inhibitory function for the PH domain. Again, M-FRB. sub.1 2 alone or recruitment of kinase dead F3-.DELTA.PH.AktKM did not influence NF-.kappa.B induction.
These results indicated that the chimeric F3-.DELTA.PH.Akt allele is strongly CID-inducible with very low basal activity. Also, these results are consistent with previous reports that the PH domain of Akt kinase is responsible for its translocation to the plasma membrane and also has an inhibitory function. Since most applications of CID technology have been based partly, at least, on empirically designed inducible chimeric proteins, CID-mediated targeting or crosslinking might not always faithfully reflect physiological signaling. Further, CID-binding domains, like FKBP 12, could potentially sterically hinder an essential target protein domain(s). Therefore, .DELTA.PH.Akt with F3 fused to both termini of .DELTA.PH.Akt was tested. The N-terminal fusion chimera, F3-.DELTA.PH.Akt, potentiated NF- .kappa.B transactivation somewhat better than the C-terminal chimera, .DELTA.PH.Akt-F3. Since both molecules were expressed at similar levels, membrane recruitment of F3-. DELTA.PH.Akt may place Akt in a more favorable orientation for interacting with PDKl or other interacting proteins. In either orientation, however, both iAkt versions were devoid of detectable basal NF-.kappa.B signaling.
Since M-FRB. sub.1 2 could potentially recruit two chimeric Akt molecules simultaneously, it was determine if membrane recruitment of one Akt molecule was sufficient for optimal activation or whether oligomerization of multiple Akt molecules might enhance activation. Therefore, CID-mediated iAkt activity was compared when the membrane docking molecule, contained one or two FRB. sub.1 domains (FRB. sub.1 vs FRB. sub.1 2, respectively). There was no significant difference in NF-.kappa.B induction by iAkt whether one or two tandem FRB. sub.1 domains were used for the docking site, indicating that forced Akt oligomerization is not a prerequisite for its activation. It was also shown that CID dependent membrane targeting of Akt resulted in rapid phosphorylation and activation of endogenous Akt. Example 12 Combination Immunotherapeutics
Tumor challenges similar to those described in Example 7 and reported in Figures 7C and 7D were performed to determine effects of combination immunotherapies. The combined effects of MF-ΔAkt and an inducible CD40 (iCD40, described in US publication 20040209836 (published October 21, 2004)) were assessed. Briefly, adenoviral particles having a polynucleotide sequence encoding the MF-ΔAkt molecule and adenoviral particles having a polynucleotide sequence encoding the iCD40 construct were utilized to transduce dendritic cells (DCs). DCs were pulsed with TRP-2i8i_i88 peptide (10 micrograms/ml; VYDFFVWL) for about 3 hours and treated with the adenoviruses (about 10,000 viral particles/DC for iCD40 particles and control adenoviral particles (Ad-emp) and about 500 viral particles/DC for MF-ΔAkt particles) plus or minus LPS (1 ug/ml) as indicated for 2 hours. The transduced DCs were utilized in a triple intraperitoneal vaccination (2 x 106 CDl Ic+ DCs/lOOul PBS) on days 3, 10 and 17. Host animals were C57BL/6 (6-8 wks) female mice (8 mice/group), and tumors were established by subcutaneous injection of B16 melanoma cells (100,000/10OuI) on the back of each mouse (day 0). Inducer was administered to the mice intraperitoneally at a dose of 2 mg/kg AP20187/1 OOul/mouse on days 4, 11, 18. Results are shown in Figures 15A and 15B. The combination yielded effects that were at least additive and may be synergistic. Effects of the combination are under additional investigation.
Example 13 Immunotherapeutic effect on human tumors
Six to eight week-old athymic male Balb/c nu/nu mice (NCI at Frederick, MD) are used as hosts for human xenografts (e.g., Xie et al. Cancer Research 61 : 6795-6804 (2001)). Mice are maintained in a specific pathogen-free environment, in compliance with standard guidelines. Cells in logarithmic-phase growth are lightly trypsinized and washed twice with OPTI -medium (GIBCO). Cell suspensions (1 x 106-cells/200 ul) of modified DCs primed with antigen, as described herein (e.g., in Example 8), are subcutaneously injected into the right flank of the mice. To establish LNCaP tumors, a 1 :4 mix of 100-ul cell suspension (1 x 106 cells) with Matrigel™ (Becton Dickinson, Bedford, MA) is injected before, contemporaneously or after, injection of the modified DCs. The effect of the modified DCs described herein on tumor growth is determined according to standard measurements and procedures. Example 13 Representative Sequences
Provided hereafter are examples of representative sequences. SEQ ID NO: 1 (Accession no. NM 009652: mouse Aktl) i ccgggaccag cggacggacc gagcagcgtc ctgcggccgg caccgcggcg gcccagatcc
61 ggccagcagc gcgcgcccgg acgccgctgc cttcagccgg ccccgcccag cgcccgcccg
121 cgggatgcgg agcggcgggc gcccgaggcc gcggcccggc taggcccagt cgcccgcacg
181 cggcggcccg acgctgcggc caggccggct gggctcagcc taccgagaag agactctgat
241 catcatccct gggttacccc tgtctctggg ggccacggat accatgaacg acgtagccat
301 tgtgaaggag ggctggctgc acaaacgagg ggaatatatt aaaacctggc ggccacgcta
361 cttcctcctc aagaacgatg gcacctttat tggctacaag gaacggcctc aggatgtgga
421 tcagcgagag tccccactca acaacttctc agtggcacaa tgccagctga tgaagacaga
481 gcggccaagg cccaacacct ttatcatccg ctgcctgcag tggaccacag tcattgagcg
541 caccttccat gtggaaacgc ctgaggagcg ggaagaatgg gccaccgcca ttcagactgt
601 ggccgatgga ctcaagaggc aggaagaaga gacgatggac ttccgatcag gctcacccag
661 tgacaactca ggggctgaag agatggaggt gtccctggcc aagcccaagc accgtgtgac
721 catgaacgag tttgagtacc tgaaactact gggcaagggc acctttggga aagtgattct
781 ggtgaaagag aaggccacag gccgctacta tgccatgaag atcctcaaga aggaggtcat
841 cgtcgccaag gatgaggttg cccacacgct tactgagaac cgtgtcctgc agaactctag
901 gcatcccttc cttacggccc tcaagtactc attccagacc cacgaccgcc tctgctttgt
961 catggagtat gccaacgggg gcgagctctt cttccacctg tctcgagagc gcgtgttctc
1021 cgaggaccgg gcccgcttct atggtgcgga gattgtgtct gccctggact acttgcactc
1081 cgagaagaac gtggtgtacc gggacctgaa gctggagaac ctcatgctgg acaaggacgg
1141 gcacatcaag ataacggact tcgggctgtg caaggagggg atcaaggatg gtgccactat
1201 gaagacattc tgcggaacgc cggagtacct ggcccctgag gtgctggagg acaacgacta
1261 cggccgtgca gtggactggt gggggctggg cgtggtcatg tatgagatga tgtgtggccg
1321 cctgcccttc tacaaccagg accacgagaa gctgttcgag ctgatcctca tggaggagat
1381 ccgcttcccg cgcacactcg gccctgaggc caagtccctg ctctccgggc tgctcaagaa
1441 ggaccctaca cagaggctcg gtgggggctc tgaggatgcc aaggagatca tgcagcaccg
1501 gttctttgcc aacatcgtgt ggcaggatgt gtatgagaag aagctgagcc cacctttcaa
1561 gccccaggtc acctctgaga ctgacaccag gtatttcgat gaggagttca cagctcagat
1621 gatcaccatc acgccgcctg atcaagatga cagcatggag tgtgtggaca gtgagcggag
1681 gccgcacttc ccccagttct cctactcagc cagtggcaca gcctgaggcc tggggcagcg
1741 gctggcagct ccacgctcct ctgcattgcc gagtccagaa gccccgcatg gatcatctga
1801 acctgatgtt ttgtttctcg gatgcgctgg ggaggaacct tgccagcctc caggaccagg
1861 ggaggatgtt tctactgtgg gcagcagcct acctcccagc caggtcagga ggaaaactat
1921 cctggggttt ttcttaattt atttcatcca gtttgagacc acacatgtgg cctcagtgcc
1981 cagaacaatt agattcatgt agaaaactat taaggactga cgcgaccatg tgcaatgtgg
2041 gctcatgggt ctgggtgggt cccgtcactg cccccattgg cctgtccacc ctggccgcca
2101 cctgtctcta gggtccaggg ccaaagtcca gcaagaaggc accagaagca cctccctgtg
2161 gtatgctaac tggccctctc cctctgggcg gggagaggtc acagctgctt cagccctagg
2221 gctggatggg atggccaggg ctcaagtgag gttgacagag gaacaagaat ccagtttgtt
2281 gctgtgtccc atgctgttca gagacattta ggggatttta atcttggtga caggagagcc
2341 cctgccctcc cgctcctgcg tggtggctct tagcgggtac cctgggagcg cctgcctcac
2401 gtgagccctc tcctagcact tgtcctttta gatgctttcc ctctcccgct gtccgtcacc
2461 ctggcctgtc ccctcccgcc agacgctggc cattgctgca ccatgtcgtt ttttacaaca
2521 ttcagcttca gcatttttac tattataata agaaactgtc cctccaaatt caataaaaat
2581 tgcttttcaa gcttgaaaaa aaaaaaaaaa aaaaaaaaaa aaaaaa
SEQ ID NO: 2 (Accession no. NM 001014431 : human Aktl mRNA) i cggcaggacc gagcgcggca ggcggctggc ccagcgcagc cagcgcggcc cgaaggacgg
61 gagcaggcgg ccgagcaccg agcgctgggc accgggcacc gagcggcggc ggcacgcgag
121 gcccggcccc gagcagcgcc cccgcccgcc gcggcctcca gcccggcccc gcccagcgcc
181 ggcccgcggg gatgcggagc ggcgggcgcc ggaggccgcg gcccggctag gcccgcgctc
241 gcgcccggac gcggcggccc gaggctgtgg ccaggccagc tgggctcggg gagcgccagc
301 ctgagaggag cgcgtgagcg tcgcgggagc ctcgggcacc atgagcgacg tggctattgt
361 gaaggagggt tggctgcaca aacgagggga gtacatcaag acctggcggc cacgctactt
421 cctcctcaag aatgatggca ccttcattgg ctacaaggag cggccgcagg atgtggacca
481 acgtgaggct cccctcaaca acttctctgt ggcgcagtgc cagctgatga agacggagcg
541 gccccggccc aacaccttca tcatccgctg cctgcagtgg accactgtca tcgaacgcac
601 cttccatgtg gagactcctg aggagcggga ggagtggaca accgccatcc agactgtggc
661 tgacggcctc aagaagcagg aggaggagga gatggacttc cggtcgggct cacccagtga
721 caactcaggg gctgaagaga tggaggtgtc cctggccaag cccaagcacc gcgtgaccat
781 gaacgagttt gagtacctga agctgctggg caagggcact ttcggcaagg tgatcctggt
841 gaaggagaag gccacaggcc gctactacgc catgaagatc ctcaagaagg aagtcatcgt
901 ggccaaggac gaggtggccc acacactcac cgagaaccgc gtcctgcaga actccaggca
961 ccccttcctc acagccctga agtactcttt ccagacccac gaccgcctct gctttgtcat
1021 ggagtacgcc aacgggggcg agctgttctt ccacctgtcc cgggagcgtg tgttctccga
1081 ggaccgggcc cgcttctatg gcgctgagat tgtgtcagcc ctggactacc tgcactcgga
1141 gaagaacgtg gtgtaccggg acctcaagct ggagaacctc atgctggaca aggacgggca
1201 cattaagatc acagacttcg ggctgtgcaa ggaggggatc aaggacggtg ccaccatgaa 1261 gaccttttgc ggcacacctg agtacctggc ccccgaggtg ctggaggaca atgactacgg 1321 ccgtgcagtg gactggtggg ggctgggcgt ggtcatgtac gagatgatgt gcggtcgcct 1381 gcccttctac aaccaggacc atgagaagct ttttgagctc atcctcatgg aggagatccg 1441 cttcccgcgc acgcttggtc ccgaggccaa gtccttgctt tcagggctgc tcaagaagga 1501 ccccaagcag aggcttggcg ggggctccga ggacgccaag gagatcatgc agcatcgctt 1561 ctttgccggt atcgtgtggc agcacgtgta cgagaagaag ctcagcccac ccttcaagcc 1621 ccaggtcacg tcggagactg acaccaggta ttttgatgag gagttcacgg cccagatgat 1681 caccatcaca ccacctgacc aagatgacag catggagtgt gtggacagcg agcgcaggcc 1741 ccacttcccc cagttctcct actcggccag cggcacggcc tgaggcggcg gtggactgcg 1801 ctggacgata gcttggaggg atggagaggc ggcctcgtgc catgatctgt atttaatggt 1861 ttttatttct cgggtgcatt tgagagaagc cacgctgtcc tctcgagccc agatggaaag 1921 acgtttttgt gctgtgggca gcaccctccc ccgcagcggg gtagggaaga aaactatcct 1981 gcgggtttta atttatttca tccagtttgt tctccgggtg tggcctcagc cctcagaaca 2041 atccgattca cgtagggaaa tgttaaggac ttctgcagct atgcgcaatg tggcattggg 2101 gggccgggca ggtcctgccc atgtgtcccc tcactctgtc agccagccgc cctgggctgt 2161 ctgtcaccag ctatctgtca tctctctggg gccctgggcc tcagttcaac ctggtggcac 2221 cagatgcaac ctcactatgg tatgctggcc agcaccctct cctgggggtg gcaggcacac 2281 agcagccccc cagcactaag gccgtgtctc tgaggacgtc atcggaggct gggcccctgg 2341 gatgggacca gggatggggg atgggccagg gtttacccag tgggacagag gagcaaggtt 2401 taaatttgtt attgtgtatt atgttgttca aatgcatttt gggggttttt aatctttgtg 2461 acaggaaagc cctccccctt ccccttctgt gtcacagttc ttggtgactg tcccaccggg 2521 agcctccccc tcagatgatc tctccacggt agcacttgac cttttcgacg cttaaccttt 2581 ccgctgtcgc cccaggccct ccctgactcc ctgtgggggt ggccatccct gggcccctcc 2641 acgcctcctg gccagacgct gccgctgccg ctgcaccacg gcgttttttt acaacattca 2701 actttagtat ttttactatt ataatataat atggaacctt ccctccaaat tcttcaataa 2761 aagttgcttt tcaaaaaaaa aaaaaaaaaa aaaa
SEQ ID NO: 3 (Accession no. NM OO 1626: human Akt2 mRNA) i gaattccagc ggcggcgccg ttgccgctgc cgggaaacac aaggaaaggg aaccagcgca
61 gcgtggcgat gggcgggggt agagccccgc cggagaggct gggcggctgc cggtgacaga
121 ctgtgccctg tccacggtgc ctcctgcatg tcctgctgcc ctgagctgtc ccgagctagg
181 tgacagcgta ccacgctgcc accatgaatg aggtgtctgt catcaaagaa ggctggctcc
241 acaagcgtgg tgaatacatc aagacctgga ggccacggta cttcctgctg aagagcgacg
301 gctccttcat tgggtacaag gagaggcccg aggcccctga tcagactcta ccccccttaa
361 acaacttctc cgtagcagaa tgccagctga tgaagaccga gaggccgcga cccaacacct
421 ttgtcatacg ctgcctgcag tggaccacag tcatcgagag gaccttccac gtggattctc
481 cagacgagag ggaggagtgg atgcgggcca tccagatggt cgccaacagc ctcaagcagc
541 gggccccagg cgaggacccc atggactaca agtgtggctc ccccagtgac tcctccacga
601 ctgaggagat ggaagtggcg gtcagcaagg cacgggctaa agtgaccatg aatgacttcg
661 actatctcaa actccttggc aagggaacct ttggcaaagt catcctggtg cgggagaagg
721 ccactggccg ctactacgcc atgaagatcc tgcgaaagga agtcatcatt gccaaggatg
781 aagtcgctca cacagtcacc gagagccggg tcctccagaa caccaggcac ccgttcctca
841 ctgcgctgaa gtatgccttc cagacccacg accgcctgtg ctttgtgatg gagtatgcca
901 acgggggtga gctgttcttc cacctgtccc gggagcgtgt cttcacagag gagcgggccc
961 ggttttatgg tgcagagatt gtctcggctc ttgagtactt gcactcgcgg gacgtggtat
1021 accgcgacat caagctggaa aacctcatgc tggacaaaga tggccacatc aagatcactg
1081 actttggcct ctgcaaagag ggcatcagtg acggggccac catgaaaacc ttctgtggga
1141 ccccggagta cctggcgcct gaggtgctgg aggacaatga ctatggccgg gccgtggact
1201 ggtgggggct gggtgtggtc atgtacgaga tgatgtgcgg ccgcctgccc ttctacaacc
1261 aggaccacga gcgcctcttc gagctcatcc tcatggaaga gatccgcttc ccgcgcacgc
1321 tcagccccga ggccaagtcc ctgcttgctg ggctgcttaa gaaggacccc aagcagaggc
1381 ttggtggggg gcccagcgat gccaaggagg tcatggagca caggttcttc ctcagcatca
1441 actggcagga cgtggtccag aagaagctcc tgccaccctt caaacctcag gtcacgtccg
1501 aggtcgacac aaggtacttc gatgatgaat ttaccgccca gtccatcaca atcacacccc
1561 ctgaccgcta tgacagcctg ggcttactgg agctggacca gcggacccac ttcccccagt
1621 tctcctactc ggccagcatc cgcgagtgag cagtctgccc acgcagagga cgcacgctcg
1681 ctgccatcac cgctgggtgg ttttttaccc ctgcc
SEQ ID NO: 4 (Accession no. NM 005465: human Akt3 mRNA) i gcagcagcag agaatccaaa ccctaaagct gatatcacaa agtaccattt ctccaagttg
61 ggggctcaga ggggagtcat catgagcgat gttaccattg tgaaagaagg ttgggttcag 121 aagaggggag aatatataaa aaactggagg ccaagatact tccttttgaa gacagatggc 181 tcattcatag gatataaaga gaaacctcaa gatgtggatt taccttatcc cctcaacaac 241 ttttcagtgg caaaatgcca gttaatgaaa acagaacgac caaagccaaa cacatttata 301 atcagatgtc tccagtggac tactgttata gagagaacat ttcatgtaga tactccagag 361 gaaagggaag aatggacaga agctatccag gctgtagcag acagactgca gaggcaagaa 421 gaggagagaa tgaattgtag tccaacttca caaattgata atataggaga ggaagagatg 481 gatgcctcta caacccatca taaaagaaag acaatgaatg attttgacta tttgaaacta 541 ctaggtaaag gcacttttgg gaaagttatt ttggttcgag agaaggcaag tggaaaatac 601 tatgctatga agattctgaa gaaagaagtc attattgcaa aggatgaagt ggcacacact 661 ctaactgaaa gcagagtatt aaagaacact agacatccct ttttaacatc cttgaaatat 721 tccttccaga caaaagaccg tttgtgtttt gtgatggaat atgttaatgg gggcgagctg 781 tttttccatt tgtcgagaga gcgggtgttc tctgaggacc gcacacgttt ctatggtgca 841 gaaattgtct ctgccttgga ctatctacat tccggaaaga ttgtgtaccg tgatctcaag 901 ttggagaatc taatgctgga caaagatggc cacataaaaa ttacagattt tggactttgc 961 aaagaaggga tcacagatgc agccaccatg aagacattct gtggcactcc agaatatctg 1021 gcaccagagg tgttagaaga taatgactat ggccgagcag tagactggtg gggcctaggg 1081 gttgtcatgt atgaaatgat gtgtgggagg ttacctttct acaaccagga ccatgagaaa 1141 ctttttgaat taatattaat ggaagacatt aaatttcctc gaacactctc ttcagatgca 1201 aaatcattgc tttcagggct cttgataaag gatccaaata aacgccttgg tggaggacca 1261 gatgatgcaa aagaaattat gagacacagt ttcttctctg gagtaaactg gcaagatgta 1321 tatgataaaa agcttgtacc tccttttaaa cctcaagtaa catctgagac agatactaga 1381 tattttgatg aagaatttac agctcagact attacaataa caccacctga aaaatatgat 1441 gaggatggta tggactgcat ggacaatgag aggcggccgc atttccctca attttcctac 1501 tctgcaagtg gacgagaata agtctctttc attctgctac ttcactgtca tcttcaattt 1561 attactgaaa atgattcctg gacatcacca gtcctagctc ttacacatag caggggcacc 1621 ttccgacatc ccagaccagc caagggtcct cacccctcgc cacctttcac cctcatgaaa 1681 acacacatac acgcaaatac actccagttt ttgtttttgc atgaaattgt atctcagtct 1741 aaggtctcat gctgttgctg ctactgtctt actattatag caactttaag aagtaatttt 1801 ccaacctttg gaagtcatga gcccaccatt gttcatttgt gcaccaatta tcatcttttg 1861 atcttttagt ttttccctca gtgaaggcta aatgagatac actgattcta ggtacatttt 1921 ttaactttct agaagagaaa aactaactag actaagaaga tttagtttat aaattcagaa 1981 caagcaattg tggaagggtg gtggcgtgca tatgtaaagc acatcagatc cgtgcgtgaa 2041 gtaggcatat atcactaagc tgtggctgga attgattagg aagcatttgg tagaaggact 2101 gaacaactgt tgggatatat atatatatat ataatttttt ttttttaaat tcctggtgga 2161 tactgtagaa gaagcccata tcacatgtgg atgtcgagac ttcacgggca atcatgagca 2221 agtgaacact gttctaccaa gaactgaagg catatgcaca gtcaaggtca cttaaagggt 2281 cttatgaaac aatttgagcc agagagcatc tttcccctgt gcttggaaac cttttttcct 2341 tcttgacatt tatcacctct gatggctgaa gaatgtagac aggtataatg atactgcttt 2401 tcaccaaaat ttctacacca aggtaaacag gtgtttgcct tatttaattt tttactttca 2461 gttctacgtg aattagcttt ttctcagatg ttgaaacttt gaatgtcctt ttatgatttt 2521 gtttatattg cagtagtatt tattttttag tgatgagaat tgtatgtcat gttagcaaac 2581 gcagctccaa cttatataaa atagacttac tgcagttact tttgacccat gtgcaaggat 2641 tgtacacgct gatgagaatc atgcactttt tctcctctgt taaaaaaaat gataaggctc 2701 tgaaatggaa tatattggtt agaatttggc tttgggagaa gagatgctgc catttaaccc 2761 cttggtactg aaaatgagaa aatccccaac tatgcatgcc aaggggttaa tgaaacaaat 2821 agctgttgac gtttgctcat ttaagaattt gaaacgttat gatgacctgg caacaaaaag 2881 taatgaagaa aattgagacc tgagtgaaga taagaaatga tctttacgtg gcaaaatgaa 2941 cacatcttga gtatttagga aatgggcagt gaaggctaag aacctggtgt gtttcttggg 3001 atcatggtac atttatcact gaattaagcc atcagggaaa aaacaacaaa aaaagagaac 3061 acctccagct tttctttttc tgtatatact catgtccccc agattccaac atttctcact 3121 gaaagggggc atgtatgcaa acctcatctt tctccttcat taatgatgat cttcagatta 3181 aaccctttgg tgctaggagc tgacaatttc caaagcagcc tgtgaagtcc taggggctgg 3241 gggccactct tgcggcaagc agaaggccat cctactccgc ggagtgatca tggaaatgta 3301 ttttagttaa actctgacag ctcccaaacg gaagactaca gcatgacgta gtattatgat 3361 tgcattgtat gaaagagcaa gtgactttct aagtaggatg aatcatattc atatgcagat 3421 gtcttagcct cttgacgctg gaagtgtgga tttatagcta tgaaaccact gctggcagtg 3481 ggtgggccac tgggactgac gggggttaaa gggcatttta ctaaggcagc taagacatat 3541 tcagacatca acgttatcct tctttttcat atttctacct gagtgaag
Amino acid sequences of the forgoing mRNA sequences can be obtained by a person of ordinary skill in the art by consulting standard internet resources. Amino acid sequences encoded by SEQ ID NO: 1-4 are designated by Accession nos. NP_033782, NP_001014432, NP_001617 and NP_005456, respectively. Other cloned sequences for each of these Akt forms also are available and accessed by the person of ordinary skill in the art.
SEQ ID NO: 5 (mRNA of human Aktl lacking a PH domain; ΔPHAkt-1 (starting at position 101 of the encoded amino acid sequence)): accgccatccagactgtggctgacggcctcaagaagcaggaggaggaggagatggacttccggtcgggctcacccagtgacaactc aggggctgaagagatggaggtgtccctggccaagcccaagcaccgcgtgaccatgaacgagtttgagtacctgaagctgctgggca
ctctttccagacccacgaccgcctctgctttgtcatggagtacgccaacgggggcgagctgttcttccacctgtcccgggagcgtg tgttctccgaggaccgggcccgcttctatggcgctgagattgtgtcagccctggactacctgcactcggagaagaacgtggtgtac
tggactggtgggggctgggcgtggtcatgtacgagatgatgtgcggtcgcctgcccttctacaaccaggaccatgagaagcttttt
Figure imgf000085_0001
ctactcggccagcgcgacggcctga
SEQ ID NO: 6 (amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 5)
ThrAlalleGlnThrValAlaAspGlyLeuLysLysGlnGluGluGluGluMetAspPheArgSerGlySerProSerAspAsnSe
ValAlaLysAspGluValAlaHisThrLeuThrGluAsnArgValLeuGlnAsnSerArgHisProPheLeuThrAlaLeuLysTy rSerPheGlnThrHisAspArgLeuCysPheValMetGluTyrAlaAsnGlyGlyGluLeuPhePheHisLeuSerArgGluArgV
sAspGlyAlaThrMetLysThrPheCysGlyThrProGluTyrLeuAlaProGluValLeuGluAspAsnAspTyrGlyArgAlaV alAspTrpTrpGlyLeuGlyValValMetTyrGluMetMetCysGlyArgLeuProPheTyrAsnGlnAspHisGluLysLeuPhe
alTyrGluLysLysLeuSerProProPheLysProGlnValThrSerGluThrAspThrArgTyrPheAspGluGluPheThrAla GlnMetlleThrlleThrProProAspGlnAspAspSerMetGluCysValAspSerGluArgArgProHisPheProGlnPheSe rTyrSerAlaSerAlaThrAla
SEQ ID NO: 7 (membrane association region from human c-Fyn) atgggctgtgtgcaatgtaaggataaagaagcaacaaaactgacggaggag—ctcgag
SEQ ID NO: 8 (amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 7)
MetGlyCysValGlnCysLysAspLysGluAlaThrLysLeuThrGluGlu—LeuGlu
SEQ ID NO: 9 (nucleotide sequence encoding PSMA)
Figure imgf000086_0001
cagagggcgatctagtgtatgttaactatgcacgaactgaagacttctttaaattggaacgggacatgaaaatcaattgctctggg aaaattgtaattgccagatatgggaaagttttcagaggaaataaggttaaaaatgcccagctggcaggggccaaaggagtcattct
gaggctgttggtcttccaagtattcctgttcatccaattggatactatgatgcacagaagctcctagaaaaaatgggtggctcagc accaccagatagcagctggagaggaagtctcaaagtgccctacaatgttggacctggctttactggaaacttttctacacaaaaag
gaggagctttggaacactgaaaaaggaagggtggagacctagaagaacaattttgtttgcaagctgggatgcagaagaatttggtc
Figure imgf000086_0002
acaaacaaattcagcggctatccactgtatcacagtgtctatgaaacatatgagttggtggaaaagttttatgatccaatgtttaa
Figure imgf000086_0003
gcatgtcatctatgctccaagcagccacaacaagtatgcaggggagtcattcccaggaatttatgatgctctgtttgatattgaaa ttgagtgaagtagcctaagcggccgcatagca
SEQ ID NO: 10 (PSMA amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 9)
Figure imgf000086_0004
DPSKAWGEVKRQIYVAAFTVQAAAETLSEVA
The entirety of each patent, patent application, publication and document referenced herein hereby is incorporated by reference. Citation of the above patents, patent applications, publications and documents is not an admission that any of the foregoing is pertinent prior art, nor does it constitute any admission as to the contents or date of these publications or documents.
Modifications may be made to the foregoing without departing from the basic aspects of the invention. Although the invention has been described in substantial detail with reference to one or more specific embodiments, those of ordinary skill in the art will recognize that changes may be made to the embodiments specifically disclosed in this application, and yet these modifications and improvements are within the scope and spirit of the invention. The invention illustratively described herein suitably may be practiced in the absence of any element(s) not specifically disclosed herein. Thus, for example, in each instance herein any of the terms "comprising", "consisting essentially of, and "consisting of may be replaced with either of the other two terms. Thus, the terms and expressions which have been employed are used as terms of description and not of limitation, equivalents of the features shown and described, or portions thereof, are not excluded, and it is recognized that various modifications are possible within the scope of the invention. Embodiments of the invention are set forth in the following claims.

Claims

What is claimed is:
1. A protein comprising: a mammalian Akt region lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and a dual acylation region covalently linked to the mammalian Akt region.
2. The protein of claim 1, wherein the dual acylation region is from a non-Akt protein.
3. The protein of claim 1 or 2, which is in association with a raft membrane.
4. The protein of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the dual acylation region is from a protein kinase.
5. The protein of claim 4, wherein the protein kinase is Fyn or Lck.
6. The protein of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the dual acylation region comprises two acyl moieties.
7. The protein of claim 6, wherein one of the acyl moieties is a myristoyl moiety.
8. The protein of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the acylation region is linked to the N- terminus of the Akt region.
9. The protein of claim 6, wherein one of the acyl moieties is selected from the group consisting of palmitoyl, geranyl, farnesyl and prenyl
10. The protein of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the acylation region is linked to the C- terminus of the Akt region.
11. The protein of claim 10, wherein the acylation region comprises a cys-ala-ala sequence.
12. The protein of claim 11, wherein the cys-ala-ala sequence is from a G-protein.
13. The protein of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the mammalian Akt region is substantially identical to mouse Akt.
14. The protein of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the mammalian Akt region is substantially identical to human Akt.
15. The protein of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the mammalian Akt region is substantially identical to the amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 2, 3 or 4.
16. The protein of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the mammalian Akt region consists of the amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 5.
17. The protein of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the dual acylation region is substantially identical to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 8.
18. The protein of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the dual acylation region consists of the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 8.
19. A protein comprising: a mammalian Akt region; and a membrane protein or membrane protein region covalently linked to the mammalian Akt region.
20. The protein of claim 19, wherein the Akt region lacks a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain.
21. The protein of claim 19 or 20, wherein the membrane protein or membrane protein region is linked to the N-terminus of the Akt region.
22. The protein of any one of claims 19-21, wherein the membrane protein or membrane protein region is linked to the C-terminus of the Akt region.
23. The protein of any one of claims 19-21, wherein the mammalian Akt region is from mouse Akt.
24. The protein of any one of claims 19-21 , wherein the mammalian Akt region is from human Akt.
25. A nucleic acid which comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes the protein of any one of claims 1-24.
26. The nucleic acid of claim 25, which comprises a promoter operably linked to the nucleotide sequence.
27. The nucleic acid of claim 26, wherein the promoter is constitutively active.
28. The nucleic acid of claim 26, wherein the promoter is inducible.
29. The nucleic acid of claim 26, wherein the promoter is from a virus.
30. The nucleic acid of any one of claims 25-29, which comprises one or more nucleotide sequences from a virus.
31. The nucleic acid of claim 30, which is derived from a virus.
32. The nucleic acid of any one of claims 29-31, wherein the virus is adenovirus.
33. A cell which comprises a nucleic acid of any one of claims 25-32.
34. The cell of claim 33, which is a dendritic cell.
35. The cell of claim 33 or 34, wherein the cell is a human cell.
36. The cell of any one of claims 33-35, which survives longer than cells that do not include the nucleic acid.
37. The cell of any one of claims 33-35, which presents a greater amount of antigen than cells that do not include the nucleic acid.
38. The cell of any one of claims 33-35, which is more immunogenic than cells that do not include the nucleic acid.
39. A dendritic cell which comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt protein.
40. The dendritic cell of claim 39, wherein the membrane-targeted Akt protein is acylated.
41. The dendritic cell of claim 39 or 40, wherein the membrane -targeted Akt protein comprises an acylation region.
42. The dendritic cell of claim 41, wherein the acylation region is a dual acylation region.
43. The dendritic cell of claim 39, wherein the membrane-targeted Akt protein comprises a membrane protein or a membrane protein region.
44. The dendritic cell of any one of claims 39-44, which is a mammalian dendritic cell.
45. The dendritic cell of claim 44, wherein the mammalian dendritic cell is a human dendritic cell.
46. The dendritic cell of claim 44, wherein the mammalian dendritic cell is a mouse dendritic cell.
47. The dendritic cell of any one of claims 39-46, which survives longer than cells that do not include the nucleic acid.
48. The dendritic cell of any one of claims 39-47, which presents a greater amount of antigen than cells that do not include the nucleic acid.
49. The dendritic cell of any one of claims 39-47, which is more immunogenic than cells that do not include the nucleic acid.
50. The dendritic cell of any one of claims 39-47, wherein the membrane-targeted Akt is in association with a raft membrane.
51. The dendritic cell of any one of claims 39-51, which is in a composition comprising an adjuvant.
52. A non-human organism, such as a canine, feline, rabbit, rat, guinea pig or ungulate (e.g., equine, bovine, porcine, caprine), comprising a dendritic cell of any one of claims 39-51.
53. A method for preparing a modified dendritic cell, which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell with a nucleic acid that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt protein, whereby the modified dendritic cell survives longer than dendritic cells that do not include the nucleic acid.
54. The method of claim 53, wherein the modified dendritic cell presents a greater amount of antigen than cells that do not include the nucleic acid.
55. The method of claim 53, wherein the modified dendritic cell is more immunogenic than cells that do not include the nucleic acid.
56. The method of any one of claims 53-55, which comprises contacting the modified dendritic cell with an antigen.
57. The method of claim 56, wherein the antigen is prostate specific membrane antigen.
58. The method of claim 57, wherein the antigen has a sequence substantially identical to SEQ ID NO: 10.
59. The method of any one of claims 53-58, wherein the dendritic cell is a human cell.
60. The method of any one of claims 53-59, wherein the membrane targeted Akt protein comprises a mammalian Akt region lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain
61. The method of any one of the preceding claims 53-60, wherein the membrane-targeted Akt comprises one or more binding partner components.
62. The method of claim 61, wherein the dendritic cell comprises an acylation region having one or more binding partner components, wherein at least one of the binding partner components binds to a binding partner component of the membrane-targeted Akt.
63. The method of claim 60, wherein the membrane-targeted Akt comprises at least one acylation region.
64. The method of claim 62 or 63, wherein the acylation region is a dual acylation region.
65. The method of claim 62 or 63, wherein the acylation region is from a protein kinase.
66. The method of claim 65, wherein the protein kinase is Fyn or Lck.
67. The method of claim 64, wherein the protein kinase is Src.
68. The method of any one of the preceding claims 63-67, wherein the acylation region is linked to the N-terminus of the Akt region.
69. The method of any one of the preceding claims 63-67, wherein the acylation region is linked to the C-terminus of the Akt region.
70. The method of claim 62 or 63, wherein the acylation region comprises a cys-ala-ala sequence.
71. The method of claim 70, wherein the cys-ala-ala sequence is from a G-protein.
72. The method of any one of preceding claims 53-71, wherein the mammalian Akt region is substantially identical to mouse Akt.
73. The method of any one of preceding claims 53-71, wherein the mammalian Akt region is substantially identical to human Akt.
74. The method of any one of preceding claims 53-71, wherein the mammalian Akt region is substantially identical to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 6.
75. The method of any one of preceding claims 53-71, wherein the mammalian Akt region consists of the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 6.
76. The method of claim 62 or 63, wherein the acylation region is substantially identical to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 8.
77. The method of claim 62 or 63, wherein the acylation region consists of the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 8.
78. The method of claim 62, wherein the acylation region having one or more binding partner components is encoded by a nucleotide sequence in the dendritic cell.
79. The method of any one of claims 53-60, wherein the membrane -targeted Akt comprises a membrane protein or membrane protein region linked to the mammalian Akt region.
80. The method of claim 61, wherein the dendritic cell comprises a membrane protein or membrane protein region having one or more binding partner components, wherein at least one of the binding partner components binds to a binding partner component of the membrane -targeted Akt.
81. The method of claim 80, wherein the membrane protein or membrane protein region having one or more binding partner components is encoded by a nucleotide sequence in the dendritic cell.
82. The method of any one of preceding claims 53-81, wherein the nucleic acid is from a virus.
83. The method of claim 82, wherein the dendritic cell is contacted with a virus that contains the nucleic acid.
84. A method for loading a modified dendritic cell with an antigen, comprising: contacting a modified dendritic cell with an antigen or antigen precursor, wherein the modified dendritic cell expresses a membrane-targeted Akt protein, whereby the modified dendritic cell is loaded with the antigen.
85. The method of claim 84, to which any one of preceding claims 54-83 apply.
86. A method for manufacturing a virus having a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane- targeted Akt, which comprises: transfecting a producer cell with a virus having a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane-targeted Akt; and isolating the virus produced by the cells.
87. The method of claim 86, to which any one of preceding claims 54-83 apply.
88. A method for inducing an immune response against an antigen, which comprises contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane -targeted Akt protein with an antigen or antigen precursor; and administering the dendritic cell to a subject; whereby the immune response against the antigen is induced.
89. A method for detecting an immune response against an antigen, which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane -targeted Akt protein with an antigen; administering the dendritic cell to a subject; and detecting the immune response.
90. A method for reducing cell proliferation in a subject, which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane -targeted Akt protein with an antigen produced in proliferating cells; and administering the dendritic cell to a subject; whereby cell proliferation is reduced.
91. A method for inhibiting tumor growth in a subject, which comprises: contacting a dendritic cell that expresses a membrane -targeted Akt protein with an antigen produced by cells in a tumor; and administering the dendritic cell to a subject having a tumor; whereby tumor growth is inhibited.
92. The method of any one of claims 88-92, to which any one of preceding claims 54-83 apply.
93. A kit which comprises a nucleic acid comprising a nucleotide sequence that encodes a membrane- targeted Akt protein described herein.
94. The kit of claim 93, wherein the nucleic acid is packaged in a virus.
95. The kit of claim 94, wherein the virus is an adenovirus.
96. The kit of claim 95, wherein the adenovirus is replication deficient.
97. The kit of any one of claims 93-96, which comprises one or more transfection components for inserting the nucleic acid into a dendritic cell.
98. The kit of any one of claims 93-97, which comprises an antigen.
99. The kit of any one of claims 93-97, which comprises a second nucleic acid that encodes an antigen.
100. The kit of any one of claims 93-99, which comprises instructions for preparing a dendritic cell with the nucleic acid comprising a nucleotide sequence that encodes the membrane-targeted Akt.
101. An isolated nucleic acid which comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein containing: a first region comprising a human Akt sequence lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and a second region linked to the N-terminus of the Akt sequence comprising two or more acylation sites.
102. The nucleic acid of claim 101, wherein the second region comprises a Gly-Cys-Xaa-Cys- sequence.
103. The nucleic acid of claim 102, wherein the second region is about 5 to about 25 amino acids in length and from the N-terminus of the nucleic acid kinase Fyn, Yes or Lck.
104. The nucleic acid of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the second region comprises two acyl moieties.
105. The nucleic acid of claim 104, wherein one of the acyl moieties is a myristoyl moiety.
106. The nucleic acid of claim 104, wherein one of the acyl moieties is a palmitoyl moiety.
107. The nucleic acid of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the Akt sequence is identical to or substantially identical to a fragment of an amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 2, 3, or 4.
108. The nucleic acid of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the Akt sequence is identical to or substantially identical to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 6.
109. The nucleic acid of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the Akt sequence is identical to or substantially identical to an amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 5.
110. The nucleic acid of any one of the preceding claims, wherein the second region is identical to or substantially identical to the amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 7.
111. An adenovirus which comprises the nucleotide sequence of any one of the preceding claims 101-110.
112. A cell which comprises the nucleotide sequence of any one of the preceding claims 101-110.
113. The cell of claim 112, which is a human antigen presenting cell.
114. The cell of claim 113, wherein the antigen presenting cell is a human dendritic cell.
115. The cell of claim 114, which has been contacted with an antigen.
116. The cell of claim 115, wherein the antigen is a prostate specific membrane antigen or fragment thereof.
117. The cell of claim 116, wherein the antigen comprises the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 10.
118. A method for inducing an immune response, which comprises: a. contacting a dendritic cell from a human subject with an antigen; b. contacting the dendritic cell with a nucleic acid that comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein containing: a first region comprising a human Akt sequence lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and a second region linked to the N-terminus of the Akt sequence comprising two or more acylation sites; and administering the dendritic cell after steps a and b to the subject, whereby an immune response is induced.
119. The method of claim 118, wherein the immune response is an antigen-specific CTL response.
120. A method for inducing an immune response, which comprises: a. contacting a dendritic cell from a human subject with an antigen; b. contacting the dendritic cell with a nucleic acid that comprises a nucleotide sequence that encodes a protein containing: a first region comprising a human Akt sequence lacking a pleckstrin homology (PH) domain; and a second region linked to the N-terminus of the Akt sequence comprising two or more acylation sites; and proliferating in vitro antigen-specific CTLs against the dendritic cell after steps a and b, whereby an immune response is induced.
121. The method of claim 120, wherein the CTLs are administered to the subject.
122. A composition comprising (i) a first polynucleotide sequence that encodes a first chimeric protein comprising an Akt and a membrane-association region, and (ii) a second polynucleotide sequence that encodes a second chimeric protein comprising a membrane-association region, a multimeric ligand binding region and a CD40 cytoplasmic polypeptide region lacking the CD40 extracellular domain.
123. The composition of claim 122, wherein the first and second polynucleotide sequences are in one nucleic acid.
124. The composition of claim 122, wherein the first and second polynucleotide sequence are in separate nucleic acids.
125. A composition comprising the first chimeric protein and the second chimeric protein of claim 122.
126. An antigen presenting cell that comprises the first and second polynucleotide sequence of claim 122 and/or the first and second chimeric proteins of claim 122.
127. The antigen presenting cell of claim 126, which is a dendritic cell.
128. The antigen presenting cell of claim 127, wherein the dendritic cell is a human dendritic cell.
129. An antigen presenting cell of any one of claims 126-128, which comprises a third polynucleotide sequence encoding an antigen or fragment thereof and/or a polypeptide antigen or fragment thereof.
130. A method for using an antigen presenting cell of any one of claims 126-129 for ex vivo vivo immunotherapy.
PCT/US2007/069586 2006-05-23 2007-05-23 Modified dendritic cells having enhanced survival and immunogenicity and related compositions and methods WO2007137300A2 (en)

Priority Applications (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US12/301,021 US20100196336A1 (en) 2006-05-23 2007-05-23 Modified dendritic cells having enhanced survival and immunogenicity and related compositions and methods
US13/622,501 US8486693B2 (en) 2006-05-23 2012-09-19 Modified dendritic cells having enhanced survival and immunogenicity and related compositions and methods

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US80302506P 2006-05-23 2006-05-23
US60/803,025 2006-05-23

Related Child Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/301,021 A-371-Of-International US20100196336A1 (en) 2006-05-23 2007-05-23 Modified dendritic cells having enhanced survival and immunogenicity and related compositions and methods
US13/622,501 Continuation US8486693B2 (en) 2006-05-23 2012-09-19 Modified dendritic cells having enhanced survival and immunogenicity and related compositions and methods

Publications (3)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2007137300A2 true WO2007137300A2 (en) 2007-11-29
WO2007137300A3 WO2007137300A3 (en) 2008-06-19
WO2007137300A8 WO2007137300A8 (en) 2009-07-23

Family

ID=38724115

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2007/069586 WO2007137300A2 (en) 2006-05-23 2007-05-23 Modified dendritic cells having enhanced survival and immunogenicity and related compositions and methods

Country Status (2)

Country Link
US (2) US20100196336A1 (en)
WO (1) WO2007137300A2 (en)

Cited By (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2012055551A3 (en) * 2010-10-26 2012-07-19 Friedrich-Alexander-Universität Erlangen-Nürnberg NF-ĸB SIGNAL PATH-MANIPULATED DENDRITIC CELLS
US20200306303A1 (en) * 2017-09-29 2020-10-01 Chiou Hwa YUH Methods and compositions enhancing survival and functionality of anti-tumor and anti-viral t cells

Families Citing this family (30)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2004073641A2 (en) 2003-02-18 2004-09-02 Kevin Slawin Induced activation in dendritic cells
US20100196336A1 (en) 2006-05-23 2010-08-05 Dongsu Park Modified dendritic cells having enhanced survival and immunogenicity and related compositions and methods
EP2465510B1 (en) * 2006-10-19 2018-11-28 Baylor College Of Medicine Methods and compositions for generating an immune response by inducing CD40 and pattern recognition receptors and adaptors thereof
JP6133538B2 (en) * 2008-09-22 2017-05-24 ベイラー カレッジ オブ メディスンBaylor College Of Medicine Methods and compositions for generating an immune response by inducing CD40 and pattern recognition receptor adapters
US9089520B2 (en) 2010-05-21 2015-07-28 Baylor College Of Medicine Methods for inducing selective apoptosis
US9434935B2 (en) 2013-03-10 2016-09-06 Bellicum Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Modified caspase polypeptides and uses thereof
JP6541639B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2019-07-10 ベリカム ファーマシューティカルズ, インコーポレイテッド Methods to control T cell proliferation
EP3569253A1 (en) 2013-06-05 2019-11-20 Bellicum Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods for inducing partial apoptosis using caspase polypeptides
JP6772063B2 (en) 2014-02-14 2020-10-21 ベリカム ファーマシューティカルズ, インコーポレイテッド Methods for activating cells using inducible chimeric polypeptides
US10888608B2 (en) 2014-09-02 2021-01-12 Bellicum Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Costimulation of chimeric antigen receptors by MyD88 and CD40 polypeptides
DE202014104926U1 (en) * 2014-10-16 2016-01-19 Grass Gmbh Wall component, drawer with such a wall component and furniture
EP3215522B1 (en) 2014-11-03 2021-12-01 Academisch Ziekenhuis Leiden H.O.D.N. Leids Universitair Medisch Centrum T cell receptors directed against bob1 and uses thereof
WO2016100236A2 (en) * 2014-12-15 2016-06-23 Bellicum Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods for controlled elimination of therapeutic cells
KR102397674B1 (en) 2016-04-01 2022-05-18 카이트 파마 인코포레이티드 BCMA binding molecules and methods of use thereof
AU2017240801A1 (en) 2016-04-01 2018-10-25 Amgen Inc. Chimeric receptors to FLT3 and methods of use thereof
AR108427A1 (en) 2016-04-01 2018-08-22 Kite Pharma Inc CHEMERIC ANTIGEN AND T-CELL RECEPTORS AND METHODS OF USE
AU2017240788B2 (en) 2016-04-01 2020-04-09 Amgen Inc. Chimeric receptors and methods of use thereof
JOP20180042A1 (en) 2017-04-24 2019-01-30 Kite Pharma Inc Humanized Antigen-Binding Domains and Methods of Use
ES2769128T3 (en) * 2017-09-20 2020-06-24 Immunicum Ab Improved allogeneic dendritic cells for use in cancer treatment
EP3710471A1 (en) 2017-11-16 2020-09-23 Kite Pharma, Inc. Modified chimeric antigen receptors and methods of use
MA52203A (en) 2018-04-10 2021-02-17 Amgen Inc CHEMER RECEIVERS FOR DLL3 AND PROCESSES FOR USING THEM
AU2019307607A1 (en) 2018-07-18 2021-02-11 Amgen Inc. Chimeric receptors to STEAP1 and methods of use thereof
BR112021012172A2 (en) 2018-12-12 2021-08-31 Kite Pharma, Inc. CHIMERIC AND T-CELL ANTIGEN RECEPTORS AND METHODS OF USE
KR20210138574A (en) 2019-03-01 2021-11-19 알로젠 테라퓨틱스 인코포레이티드 DLL3 Targeting Chimeric Antigen Receptor and Binding Agent
CN113748201A (en) 2019-04-26 2021-12-03 艾洛基治疗公司 Methods of making allogeneic CAR T cells
CA3134308A1 (en) 2019-04-26 2020-10-29 Thomas Charles PERTEL Rituximab-resistant chimeric antigen receptors and uses thereof
MX2022001578A (en) * 2019-08-06 2022-04-26 Yeda Res & Dev Anti-viral central memory cd8+ veto cells in haploidentical stem cell transplantation.
WO2021252496A1 (en) * 2020-06-10 2021-12-16 Richard Lowenthal Engineered adenovirus vectors and uses thereof
US20220227832A1 (en) 2020-12-21 2022-07-21 Allogene Therapeutics, Inc. Protease-activating cd45-gate car
US20230060292A1 (en) 2021-07-26 2023-03-02 Kite Pharma, Inc. Split chimeric antigen receptors and methods of use

Family Cites Families (93)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
NL154598B (en) 1970-11-10 1977-09-15 Organon Nv PROCEDURE FOR DETERMINING AND DETERMINING LOW MOLECULAR COMPOUNDS AND PROTEINS THAT CAN SPECIFICALLY BIND THESE COMPOUNDS AND TEST PACKAGING.
US3901654A (en) 1971-06-21 1975-08-26 Biological Developments Receptor assays of biologically active compounds employing biologically specific receptors
US3817827A (en) 1972-03-30 1974-06-18 Scott Paper Co Soft absorbent fibrous webs containing elastomeric bonding material and formed by creping and embossing
US3935074A (en) 1973-12-17 1976-01-27 Syva Company Antibody steric hindrance immunoassay with two antibodies
US3996345A (en) 1974-08-12 1976-12-07 Syva Company Fluorescence quenching with immunological pairs in immunoassays
US4034074A (en) 1974-09-19 1977-07-05 The Board Of Trustees Of Leland Stanford Junior University Universal reagent 2-site immunoradiometric assay using labelled anti (IgG)
US3984533A (en) 1975-11-13 1976-10-05 General Electric Company Electrophoretic method of detecting antigen-antibody reaction
US4098876A (en) 1976-10-26 1978-07-04 Corning Glass Works Reverse sandwich immunoassay
US4452901A (en) 1980-03-20 1984-06-05 Ciba-Geigy Corporation Electrophoretically transferring electropherograms to nitrocellulose sheets for immuno-assays
US4376110A (en) 1980-08-04 1983-03-08 Hybritech, Incorporated Immunometric assays using monoclonal antibodies
US4469863A (en) 1980-11-12 1984-09-04 Ts O Paul O P Nonionic nucleic acid alkyl and aryl phosphonates and processes for manufacture and use thereof
AU561343B2 (en) 1981-10-19 1987-05-07 Genentech Inc. Human immune interferon by recombinant dna
EP0091539B2 (en) 1982-03-31 1996-11-27 Ajinomoto Co., Inc. Gene coding for interleukin-2 polypeptide, recombinant DNA carrying said gene, cell lines possessing the recombinant DNA,and method for producing interleukin-2 using said cells
US4966843A (en) 1982-11-01 1990-10-30 Cetus Corporation Expression of interferon genes in Chinese hamster ovary cells
US4892743A (en) 1983-12-21 1990-01-09 Schering Corporation Novel hybrid interferon species
EP0165942A1 (en) 1983-12-23 1986-01-02 Monash University PRODUCTION OF HUMAN INTERFERON-$g(a)
AU594014B2 (en) 1984-03-21 1990-03-01 Research Corporation Technologies, Inc. Recombinant DNA molecules
US4965188A (en) 1986-08-22 1990-10-23 Cetus Corporation Process for amplifying, detecting, and/or cloning nucleic acid sequences using a thermostable enzyme
US4683195A (en) 1986-01-30 1987-07-28 Cetus Corporation Process for amplifying, detecting, and/or-cloning nucleic acid sequences
US5656493A (en) 1985-03-28 1997-08-12 The Perkin-Elmer Corporation System for automated performance of the polymerase chain reaction
US4683202A (en) 1985-03-28 1987-07-28 Cetus Corporation Process for amplifying nucleic acid sequences
JPS63500636A (en) 1985-08-23 1988-03-10 麒麟麦酒株式会社 DNA encoding multipotent granulocyte colony stimulating factor
US4810643A (en) 1985-08-23 1989-03-07 Kirin- Amgen Inc. Production of pluripotent granulocyte colony-stimulating factor
US5576195A (en) 1985-11-01 1996-11-19 Xoma Corporation Vectors with pectate lyase signal sequence
US5017691A (en) 1986-07-03 1991-05-21 Schering Corporation Mammalian interleukin-4
US4987071A (en) 1986-12-03 1991-01-22 University Patents, Inc. RNA ribozyme polymerases, dephosphorylases, restriction endoribonucleases and methods
US5116742A (en) 1986-12-03 1992-05-26 University Patents, Inc. RNA ribozyme restriction endoribonucleases and methods
US4965195A (en) 1987-10-26 1990-10-23 Immunex Corp. Interleukin-7
US5223409A (en) 1988-09-02 1993-06-29 Protein Engineering Corp. Directed evolution of novel binding proteins
CA2004261A1 (en) 1988-12-01 1990-06-01 Charles T. Tackney Synthetic interleukin-6
US5530101A (en) 1988-12-28 1996-06-25 Protein Design Labs, Inc. Humanized immunoglobulins
WO1991005667A1 (en) 1989-10-13 1991-05-02 Siemens Aktiengesellschaft Printer
DE69033584T2 (en) 1989-10-16 2001-03-08 Amgen Inc Stem cell factor
US5321131A (en) 1990-03-08 1994-06-14 Hybridon, Inc. Site-specific functionalization of oligodeoxynucleotides for non-radioactive labelling
JPH04126084A (en) 1990-05-11 1992-04-27 Hoechst Japan Ltd Production of protein
US5608039A (en) 1990-10-12 1997-03-04 The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Department Of Health And Human Services Single chain B3 antibody fusion proteins and their uses
US6099842A (en) 1990-12-03 2000-08-08 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services Recombinant immunotoxin composed of a single chain antibody reacting with the human transferrin receptor and diptheria toxin
US5268273A (en) 1990-12-14 1993-12-07 Phillips Petroleum Company Pichia pastoris acid phosphatase gene, gene regions, signal sequence and expression vectors comprising same
US5719262A (en) 1993-11-22 1998-02-17 Buchardt, Deceased; Ole Peptide nucleic acids having amino acid side chains
DK51092D0 (en) 1991-05-24 1992-04-15 Ole Buchardt OLIGONUCLEOTIDE ANALOGUE DESCRIBED BY PEN, MONOMERIC SYNTHONES AND PROCEDURES FOR PREPARING THEREOF, AND APPLICATIONS THEREOF
US5389529A (en) 1991-06-12 1995-02-14 Regeneron Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Modified lamβ signal sequence and processes for producing recombinant neurotrophins
US5700922A (en) 1991-12-24 1997-12-23 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. PNA-DNA-PNA chimeric macromolecules
ATE260971T1 (en) 1992-04-01 2004-03-15 Univ Rockefeller METHOD FOR THE IN VITRO CULTIVATION OF DENDRITIC PRECURSOR CELLS AND THEIR USE FOR IMMUNOGENIC PRODUCTION
AU678769B2 (en) 1992-07-27 1997-06-12 Hybridon, Inc. Oligonucleotide alkylphosphonothioates
JPH07508179A (en) 1992-08-21 1995-09-14 シェリング・コーポレーション human interleukin-13
US6288302B1 (en) 1992-11-04 2001-09-11 National Science Council Of R.O.C. Application of α-amylase gene promoter and signal sequence in the production of recombinant proteins in transgenic plants and transgenic plant seeds
WO1994017091A2 (en) 1993-01-21 1994-08-04 Hybridon Inc. Foldback triplex-forming oligonucleotides
US20050271676A1 (en) 1993-03-05 2005-12-08 Epimmune Inc. Inducing cellular immune responses to human immunodeficiency virus-1 using peptide and nucleic acid compositions
US20050049197A1 (en) 1993-09-14 2005-03-03 Epimmune Inc. Induction of immune response against desired determinants
US5546821A (en) 1993-11-08 1996-08-20 Brackett; Douglas C. Motion arrester for a conjugate drive mechanism
US5637684A (en) 1994-02-23 1997-06-10 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Phosphoramidate and phosphorothioamidate oligomeric compounds
WO1995023865A1 (en) 1994-03-03 1995-09-08 Genentech, Inc. Anti-il-8 monoclonal antibodies for treatment of inflammatory disorders
US5470719A (en) 1994-03-18 1995-11-28 Meng; Shi-Yuan Modified OmpA signal sequence for enhanced secretion of polypeptides
AU701342B2 (en) 1994-07-13 1999-01-28 Chugai Seiyaku Kabushiki Kaisha Reconstituted human antibody against human interleukin-8
US5766891A (en) 1994-12-19 1998-06-16 Sloan-Kettering Institute For Cancer Research Method for molecular cloning and polynucleotide synthesis using vaccinia DNA topoisomerase
US5614622A (en) 1995-06-01 1997-03-25 Hybridon, Inc. 5-pentenoyl moiety as a nucleoside-amino protecting group, 4-pentenoyl-protected nucleotide synthons, and related oligonucleotide syntheses
US5955599A (en) 1995-06-01 1999-09-21 Hybridon, Inc. Process for making oligonucleotides containing o- and s- methylphosphotriester internucleoside linkages
US5962674A (en) 1995-06-01 1999-10-05 Hybridon, Inc. Synthesis of oligonucleotides containing alkylphosphonate internucleoside linkages
US6140482A (en) 1995-06-01 2000-10-31 Hybridon, Inc. Primary phosphoramidate internucleoside linkages and oligonucleotides containing the same
US5712114A (en) 1995-06-06 1998-01-27 Basf Aktiengesellschaft Compositions for expression of proteins in host cells using a preprocollagen signal sequence
US6143557A (en) 1995-06-07 2000-11-07 Life Technologies, Inc. Recombination cloning using engineered recombination sites
AU724922B2 (en) 1995-06-07 2000-10-05 Invitrogen Corporation Recombinational cloning using engineered recombination sites
US6720140B1 (en) 1995-06-07 2004-04-13 Invitrogen Corporation Recombinational cloning using engineered recombination sites
US5637683A (en) 1995-07-13 1997-06-10 Cornell Research Foundation, Inc. Nucleic acid analog with amide linkage and method of making that analog
US5788963A (en) 1995-07-31 1998-08-04 Pacific Northwest Cancer Foundation Isolation and/or preservation of dendritic cells for prostate cancer immunotherapy
US5652356A (en) 1995-08-17 1997-07-29 Hybridon, Inc. Inverted chimeric and hybrid oligonucleotides
US5849589A (en) 1996-03-11 1998-12-15 Duke University Culturing monocytes with IL-4, TNF-α and GM-CSF TO induce differentiation to dendric cells
US6017527A (en) 1996-07-10 2000-01-25 Immunex Corporation Activated dendritic cells and methods for their activation
US6117992A (en) 1996-08-26 2000-09-12 Hybridon, Inc. Reagents and process for synthesis of oligonucleotides containing phosphorodithioate internucleoside linkages
US5886165A (en) 1996-09-24 1999-03-23 Hybridon, Inc. Mixed backbone antisense oligonucleotides containing 2'-5'-ribonucleotide- and 3'-5'-deoxyribonucleotides segments
US5739314A (en) 1997-04-25 1998-04-14 Hybridon, Inc. Method for synthesizing 2'-O-substituted pyrimidine nucleosides
US6008378A (en) 1997-10-21 1999-12-28 The Regents Of The University Of California Synthetic molecules that specifically react with target sequences
US5932474A (en) 1997-10-21 1999-08-03 The Regents Of The University Of California Target sequences for synthetic molecules
US6054271A (en) 1997-10-21 2000-04-25 The Regents Of The University Of California Methods of using synthetic molecules and target sequences
US7351578B2 (en) 1999-12-10 2008-04-01 Invitrogen Corp. Use of multiple recombination sites with unique specificity in recombinational cloning
ATE341621T1 (en) 1997-10-24 2006-10-15 Invitrogen Corp RECOMBINATORY CLONING USING NUCLIC ACIDS HAVING RECOMBINATION SITE
EP1100545A4 (en) 1998-07-29 2002-03-20 Invitrogen Corp Regulated expression of recombinant proteins using rna viruses
AU774643B2 (en) 1999-03-02 2004-07-01 Invitrogen Corporation Compositions and methods for use in recombinational cloning of nucleic acids
EP1185559A2 (en) 1999-04-28 2002-03-13 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Compositions and methods for cancer treatment by selectively inhibiting vegf
CA2386341A1 (en) 1999-11-18 2001-05-25 Epimmune Inc. Heteroclitic analogs and related methods
US20020123479A1 (en) 1999-12-08 2002-09-05 Song Elizabeth S. Immunostimulation mediated by gene-modified dendritic cells
DK1250453T3 (en) 1999-12-10 2008-08-11 Invitrogen Corp Use of multiple recombination sites with unique specificity in recombination cloning
US9012141B2 (en) * 2000-03-27 2015-04-21 Advaxis, Inc. Compositions and methods comprising KLK3 of FOLH1 antigen
US20030144204A1 (en) 2001-12-19 2003-07-31 Baylor College Of Medicine Akt-based inducible survival switch
US20060009409A1 (en) 2002-02-01 2006-01-12 Woolf Tod M Double-stranded oligonucleotides
CA2475003A1 (en) 2002-02-01 2003-08-07 Sequitur, Inc. Double-stranded oligonucleotides
WO2003073827A2 (en) 2002-02-28 2003-09-12 Corixa Corporation Methods of modulating dendritic cells using adjuvants
CA2491574A1 (en) 2002-07-05 2004-01-15 Duke University Angio-immunotherapy
US7052694B2 (en) * 2002-07-16 2006-05-30 Mayo Foundation For Medical Education And Research Dendritic cell potentiation
WO2004073641A2 (en) 2003-02-18 2004-09-02 Kevin Slawin Induced activation in dendritic cells
EP1756147A2 (en) 2004-06-01 2007-02-28 Innogenetics N.V. Peptides for inducing a ctl and/or htl response to hepatitis c virus
US20060084136A1 (en) 2004-07-14 2006-04-20 Invitrogen Corporation Production of fusion proteins by cell-free protein synthesis
US20100196336A1 (en) 2006-05-23 2010-08-05 Dongsu Park Modified dendritic cells having enhanced survival and immunogenicity and related compositions and methods

Non-Patent Citations (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
KOHN ET AL.: 'Construction and characterization of a conditionally active version of the serine/threonine kinase Akt' J. BIOL. CHEM. vol. 273, no. 19, 08 May 1998, pages 11937 - 11943 *
RAZZAQ ET AL.: 'Regulation of T-cell receptor signalling by membrane microdomains' IMMUNOLOGY vol. 113, no. 4, December 2004, pages 413 - 426 *

Cited By (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2012055551A3 (en) * 2010-10-26 2012-07-19 Friedrich-Alexander-Universität Erlangen-Nürnberg NF-ĸB SIGNAL PATH-MANIPULATED DENDRITIC CELLS
US9862968B2 (en) 2010-10-26 2018-01-09 Friedrich-Alexander-Universität Erlangen-Nürnberg NF-κB signaling pathway-manipulated dendritic cells
US20200306303A1 (en) * 2017-09-29 2020-10-01 Chiou Hwa YUH Methods and compositions enhancing survival and functionality of anti-tumor and anti-viral t cells

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US8486693B2 (en) 2013-07-16
WO2007137300A3 (en) 2008-06-19
US20100196336A1 (en) 2010-08-05
US20130130386A1 (en) 2013-05-23
WO2007137300A8 (en) 2009-07-23

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US8486693B2 (en) Modified dendritic cells having enhanced survival and immunogenicity and related compositions and methods
JP6818720B6 (en) Methods for Inducing Partial Apoptosis Using Caspase Polypeptides
JP6821568B2 (en) Controlled elimination method of therapeutic cells
JP2020191870A (en) Methods for controlled activation or elimination of therapeutic cells
AU2016370470B2 (en) Dual controls for therapeutic cell activation or elimination
JP6133538B2 (en) Methods and compositions for generating an immune response by inducing CD40 and pattern recognition receptor adapters
JP2021090466A (en) T cell receptors directed against preferentially expressed antigen of melanoma and uses thereof
EP2465511B1 (en) Methods and compositions for generating an immune response by inducing CD40 and pattern recognition receptors and adaptors thereof
JP2018171075A (en) Modified caspase polypeptides and uses thereof
JP2017538401A (en) T cell receptor directed against Bob1 and uses thereof
JP2021505207A (en) Decrease in fratricide in immune cells expressing NKG2D-based receptors
US20070196335A1 (en) Immune Modulation By Regulating Expression Of The &#34;Minor&#34; Gene In Immune Dendritic Cells
EP3544995A1 (en) Signal transduction modifying protein
Cornel et al. Strategies to genetically modulate dendritic cells to potentiate anti-tumor responses in hematologic malignancies
JP2022531577A (en) Cells expressing chimeric receptors from the modified CD247 locus, related polynucleotides, and methods.
Nair et al. Cells treated with TAP-2 antisense oligonucleotides are potent antigen-presenting cells in vitro and in vivo.
Martorelli et al. Remodeling of the epitope repertoire of a candidate idiotype vaccine by targeting to lysosomal degradation in dendritic cells
Rusakiewicz Development of epitope-based immunotherapy for the treatment of chronic myeloid leukaemia
Anderson Nucleoside modifications suppress RNA activation of cytoplasmic RNA sensors

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 07797700

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A2

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 12301021

Country of ref document: US

122 Ep: pct application non-entry in european phase

Ref document number: 07797700

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A2